UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549

Form 10-K/A

X ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES --- EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2006

or

TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES
--- EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the transition period from __________ to __________

Commission File No. 001-14217

ENGlobal Corporation
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

            Nevada                                       88-0322261
 ------------------------------               ---------------------------------
(State or other jurisdiction of              (I.R.S Employer Identification No.)
incorporation or organization)

654 North Sam Houston Parkway East, Suite 400                     77060-5914
---------------------------------------------                     ----------
  (Address of principal executive offices)                       (Zip code)

Registrant's telephone number, including area code: (281) 878-1000

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Exchange Act:

      Title of each class              Name of each exchange on which registered
      -------------------              -----------------------------------------
Common Stock, $0.001 par value                American Stock Exchange

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Exchange Act:
None

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as

defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act
                                                           Yes         No   X
                                                                ---        ---

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports
pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15 (d) of the Act
                                                           Yes         No   X
                                                                ---        ---

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant: (1) has filed all repo required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shortened period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.

Yes X No

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of the registrant's knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.
Yes No X

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, or a non-accelerated filer. See definition of "accelerated filer and large accelerated filer" in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):

                                                       Non-accelerated
Large accelerated filer       Accelerated filer  X         filer
                        ---                     ---                     ---

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act)

Yes No X

The aggregate market value of the registrant's common stock held by non-affiliates of the registrant on June 30, 2006 was $126,159,307 (based upon the closing price for shares of common stock as reported by the American Stock Exchange on that date).

The number of shares outstanding of the registrant's common stock on March 15, 2007 is as follows:

$0.001 Par Value Common Stock 26,829,090 shares

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE
Responses to Items 10, 11, 12, 13 and 14 of Part III of this report are incorporated herein by reference to certain information contained in the Company's definitive proxy statement for its 2007 Annual Meeting of Stockholders to be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on or before April 30, 2007.

2

EXPLANATORY NOTE

This Amendment No. 1 (this "Form 10-K/A") to our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2006 that was originally filed on March 16, 2007 (the "Original Filing"), is being filed to correct certain references and clerical errors.

For the convenience of the reader, this Form 10-K/A sets out the Original Filing in its entirety. However, this Form 10-K/A only amends and restates the following Items of the Original Filing:

Cover Page - A clerical error on the cover page has been corrected; the Original Filing should have indicated that disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K will be contained in the definitive proxy statement.

Page 42 - Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting, the last sentence should read: "Our report thereon dated March 15, 2007 expressed an unqualified opinion."

Page 44 - Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm on Consolidated Financial Statements, the last sentence was omitted and should read: "As discussed in Note 11 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company adopted Statement of Accounting Standards No. 123 (revised 2004), "Share-Based Payment", during the year ended December 31, 2006.

Page 81 - Part III, Items 10, 12, 13 and 14 should refer to the 2007 annual meeting of stockholders.

Finally, in order to provide for completeness in our annual report filing, certain exhibits that were not available in a form acceptable for filing with the SEC, have been added. The Exhibit listing is provided in its entirety on pages 82 through 86.

No attempt has been made in this Form 10-K/A to modify or update other disclosures presented in the Original Filing, other than to correct typographical and other immaterial errors. This Form 10-K/A does not reflect events occurring after the filing of the Original Filing or modify or update disclosures affected by subsequent events. None of the additional exhibits filed herewith update or are affected by subsequent events. Accordingly, this Form 10-K/A should be read in conjunction with our filings made with the Securities and Exchange Commission subsequent to the filing of the Original Filing, including our current reports on Form 8-K filed on March 16, 2007.

i

ENGlobal Corporation
2006 ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 10-K

TABLE OF CONTENTS

                                     PART I
                                     ------
                                                                           PAGE
                                                                           ----
ITEM 1.         BUSINESS                                                    5

ITEM 1A.        RISK FACTORS                                                16

ITEM 1B.        UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS                                   20

ITEM 2.         PROPERTIES                                                  20

ITEM 3.         LEGAL PROCEEDINGS                                           21

ITEM 4.         SUBMISSION OF MATTERS TO A VOTE OF SECURITY HOLDERS         21


                                     PART II
                                     -------
ITEM 5.         MARKET FOR REGISTRANT'S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED
                  STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY        22
                  SECURITIES

ITEM 6.         SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA                                     25

ITEM 7.         MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL
                  CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATION                        27

ITEM 7A.        QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES
                  ABOUT MARKET RISK                                         40

ITEM 8.         FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA                 40

ITEM 9.         CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS
                  ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE                    77

ITEM 9A.        CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES                                     77


                                    PART III
                                    --------
ITEM 10.        DIRECTORS AND EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE REGISTRANT          81

ITEM 11.        EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION                                      81

ITEM 12.        SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND
                  MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS                81

ITEM 13.        CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS              81

ITEM 14.        PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES                      81

                                     PART IV
                                     -------
ITEM 15.        EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SCHEDULES                82

SIGNATURES
SIGNATURES 87

3

PART I

CAUTIONARY NOTICE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

This Annual Report on Form 10-K ("Report"), including "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations," as well as oral statements made by the Company and its officers, directors or employees, contains forward-looking statements within the meaning of Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the "Exchange Act"). Such forward-looking statements are based on Management's beliefs, current expectations, estimates and projections about the industries that the Company and its subsidiaries serve, the economy and the Company in general. The words "expect," "anticipate," "intend," "plan," "believe," "seek," "estimate" and similar expressions are intended to identify such forward-looking statements; however, this Report also contains other forward-looking statements in addition to historical information. Although we believe that the expectations reflected in the forward-looking statements are reasonable, such forward-looking statements are not guarantees of future performance and are subject to risks, uncertainties and other factors that may cause the actual results, performance or achievements of the Company to differ materially from historical results or from any results expressed or implied by such forward-looking statements. The Company cautions readers that the following important factors and the risks described in the section of this report entitled "Risk Factors", among others, could cause the Company's actual results to differ materially from the forward-looking statements contained in this Report: (i) our ability to collect accounts receivable in a timely manner; (ii) our ability to accurately estimate costs and fees on fixed-price contracts; (iii) the effect of changes in laws and regulations with which the Company must comply, and the associated costs of compliance with such laws and regulations, either currently or in the future, as applicable; (iv) the effect of changes in accounting policies and practices as may be adopted by regulatory agencies, as well as by the Financial Accounting Standards Board; (v) the effect of changes in the Company's organization, compensation and benefit plans; (vi) the effect on the Company's competitive position within its market area of the increasing consolidation within its services industries, including the increased competition from larger regional and out-of-state engineering services organizations; (vii) the effect of increases and decreases in oil prices; (viii) the availability of parts from vendors; (ix) our ability to increase or renew our line of credit; (x) our ability to identify attractive acquisition candidates, consummate acquisitions on terms that are favorable to the Company and integrate the acquired businesses into the Company's operations; (xi) our ability to hire and retain qualified personnel; (xii) our ability to retain existing customers and get new customers and (xiii) the effect of changes in the business cycle and downturns in local, regional and national economies. The Company cautions that the foregoing list of important factors is not exclusive. We are under no duty and have no plans to update any of the forward-looking statements after the date of this Report to conform such statements to actual results.

4

ITEM 1. BUSINESS

General

ENGlobal Corporation (which may be referred to as "ENGlobal," the "Company," "we," "us" or "our") is a leading provider of engineering services and systems principally to the petroleum refining, petrochemical, pipeline, production and process industries throughout the United States and internationally. The services provided by our multi-disciplined staff span the lifecycle of a project and include feasibility studies, design, and procurement and construction management. We also supply automation, control and instrumentation systems to our clients worldwide. On May 25, 2006, the Company purchased Denver-based WRC Corporation, expanding our engineering services, by providing integrated land management, engineering, and related services.

The Company was incorporated as Industrial Data Systems Corporation in the State of Nevada in June 1994. In December 2001, we merged with Petrocon Engineering, Inc. ("Petrocon") and in June 2002, we changed the name of the Company from Industrial Data Systems Corporation to ENGlobal Corporation. Effective June 16, 2002, the Company's trading symbol for its common stock, traded on the American Stock Exchange, changed from "IDS" to "ENG".

Since the Company's merger with Petrocon, the net revenue from continuous operations has grown from $89.1 million in 2002 to $303.1 million in 2006, a compounded annual growth rate of approximately 35.8%. We have accomplished this growth by expanding our engineering and systems services and geographic presence through internal growth, including new initiatives and to a lesser extent, through a series of strategic acquisitions. We now have more than 2,100 full-time equivalent employees in offices strategically located in Houston, Beaumont, Clear Lake, Freeport, and Midland, Texas; Baton Rouge and Lake Charles, Louisiana; Tulsa, Cleveland and Blackwell, Oklahoma; Denver, Colorado; and Calgary, Alberta, Canada.

In December 2006, ENGlobal Engineering, Inc. began its plan to cease operations in Dallas, Texas. Some project activities previously performed in the Dallas office have been transferred to other ENGlobal offices. On February 19, 2007, the Company entered into agreements with another firm providing for the sale of the majority of Dallas assets and for the partial sublease of Dallas office space. These actions were the result of a decision to consolidate the Company's Texas-based operations while streamlining or reducing overhead costs. A small number of the Company's former Dallas personnel transferred to other ENGlobal offices and others were asked to remain with the Company through May 31, 2007, to allow for an orderly transfer of on-going projects. However, the majority of the previous Dallas employees are now employed by the firm which purchased certain of the Dallas assets, and the Company expects to utilize some on a subcontract basis for a short period of time and on a discretionary basis to complete projects. Currently the Company has no plans to sell the assets of consolidate any of its other office locations.

Available Information

We file annual, quarterly and current reports, proxy statements and other information with the Securities and Exchange Commission ("SEC"). You can read and copy any materials filed with the SEC at its Public Reference Room at 100 F. Street, N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549. You can obtain information about the operations from the SEC Public Reference Room by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. The SEC also maintains a website, which contains information we file electronically with the SEC, which can be accessed over the Internet at www.sec.gov. Our common stock is listed on the American Stock Exchange (AMEX: ENG), and you can obtain information about ENGlobal at the offices of the American Stock Exchange, 86 Trinity Place, New York, New York 10006-1872 or at their website www.amex.com.

ENGlobal Website

You can find financial and other information about ENGlobal at the Company's website at the URL address www.englobal.com. Copies of our annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K, and amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to
Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Exchange Act are provided free of charge through the Company's website and are available as soon as reasonably practicable after filing electronically or otherwise furnishing reports to the SEC.

5

ITEM 1. BUSINESS (Continued)

Information relating to corporate governance at ENGlobal, including: (i) our Code of Business Conduct and Ethics for all of our employees, including our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer; (ii) our Code of Ethics for our Chief Executive Officer and Senior Financial Officers; (iii) information concerning our Directors, and our Board Committees, including Committee charters, and (iv) information concerning transactions in ENGlobal securities by Directors and officers, is available on our website under the Investor Relations link. Our website and the information contained therein or connected thereto are not intended to be incorporated into this Annual Report on Form 10-K. We will provide any of the foregoing information without charge upon written request to Investor Relations Officer, ENGlobal Corporation, 654 North Sam Houston Parkway East, Suite 400, Houston, Texas 77060-5914.

Business Segments

During 2006, we operated two business segments: engineering and systems. The respective contributions to our total sales in 2006, 2005 and 2004 for the engineering and the systems segments are summarized below.

Note: Previously, within the Systems Segment, ESI provided products and services supporting the advanced automation and integrated controls fields. In January 2006, EAG assumed responsibility for these services, which resulted in a move of this division of ESI to the Engineering Segment. Revenues and expenses have been reclassified between the segments to provide comparative results. Amounts will tie in total to prior reporting, however, individual segments will vary from prior reports.

                                    Percentage of Revenues
                           --------------------------------------
Segment                      2006         2005              2004
                           -------       -------         --------

    Engineering              91.8%          93.9%           90.5%
    Systems                   8.2%           6.1%            9.5%
                           -------       --------        --------
                            100.0%         100.0%          100.0%
                           =======       ========        ========

Revenues from the systems segment remained constant from 2004 to 2005, but increased 75.4% from 2005 to 2006 primarily as a result of the acquisition of certain assets of Analyzer Technology International, Inc. ("ATI") in January 2006. Engineering revenues increased 62.8% and 26.8%, respectively, from 2004 to 2005 and from 2005 to 2006.

Engineering Segment
---------------------------------------------------------------------------

                                       2006        2005         2004
                                    -----------------------------------
                                              (Amounts in thousands)
                                    -----------------------------------

         Revenues                   $278,157     $219,426      $134,778
         Operating profit           $  9,084     $ 18,911      $ 10,437
         Total assets               $ 70,549     $ 54,342      $ 46,122

General

Our engineering segment offers engineering consulting services to clients in the petroleum refining, petrochemical, pipeline, production and process industries for the development, management and turnkey execution of engineering projects and provides inspection services throughout the United States. The engineering segment is currently comprised of the following wholly-owned subsidiaries of ENGlobal Corporation: ENGlobal Engineering, Inc. ("EEI"), ENGlobal Construction Resources, Inc. ("ECR"), ENGlobal Technical Services, Inc. ("ETS"), ENGlobal Automation Group, Inc. ("EAG"), ENGlobal Canada ULC ("ENGlobal Canada"), WRC Corporation ("WRC") and WRC Canada. EEI focuses primarily on providing services to the downstream petroleum refining and petrochemical industry, including refineries and processing plants, upstream and midstream pipeline companies and gas processing plants. ECR primarily provides pipeline inspection services to the oil and gas, utility and pipeline industries and turnaround, asset management, and start-up services for the petrochemical industry. ETS primarily provides Automated Fuel Handling Systems and services to branches of the U.S. military and public sector companies. EAG and

6

ITEM 1. BUSINESS (Continued)

ENGlobal Canada provide engineering services relating to the implementation of process controls, instrumentation, advanced automation and information technology projects. Further expanding our services within the pipeline industry, WRC and WRC Canada primarily provide land management, right-of-way services, environmental compliance, and governmental regulatory services to pipeline, utility and telecom companies and other owner/operators of "infrastructure" facilities. The engineering segment derives revenues primarily from cost-plus fees charged for professional and technical services. We also enter into contracts providing for the execution of projects on a fixed-price basis, whereby some or all of the project activities related to engineering, material procurement and construction are performed for a lump sum amount. As a service company, we are more labor than capital intensive. Our income primarily results from our ability to generate revenues and collect cash under both cost-plus and fixed-price contracts that is in excess of any cost for employees, material, equipment and subcontracts and selling, general and administrative (SG&A) expenses.

As of December 31, 2006, the engineering segment had more than one hundred existing blanket service contracts pursuant to which it provides clients either with services on a time and materials basis or with services on a fixed fee, turnkey basis. Our engineering segment operates out of offices in Baton Rouge and Lake Charles, Louisiana; Beaumont, Clear Lake, Houston, Midland and Freeport, Texas; Tulsa, Cleveland and Blackwell, Oklahoma; Denver, Colorado; and Calgary, Alberta.

During 2004, the engineering segment continued its geographical expansion with new offices in Dallas and Midland, Texas and Cleveland, Oklahoma, plus an additional office in Tulsa, Oklahoma. In January, through ETS, we acquired certain assets of Engineering Design Group, Inc. ("EDGI") located in Tulsa, Oklahoma. As a result of this acquisition, ETS now provides design, installation and maintenance services for various government and public sector facilities, the most active sector being Automated Fuel Handling Systems serving the U.S. military.

In August 2005, we announced the expansion of EEI's operation in the sulfur recovery business in Dallas, Texas. In September 2005, through ECR, we acquired certain assets of AmTech Inspection located in Midland, Texas. The new division's revenues are derived primarily from providing inspectors for regional refining and pipeline operations. In October, again through ECR, we acquired certain assets of Cleveland Inspection Services, Inc. ("CIS") located in Cleveland, Oklahoma. As a result of this acquisition, we now provide inspection and construction management services in support of the oil and gas, utility and pipeline industries.

During 2005, ENGlobal Engineering formed ENGlobal Automation Group, Inc. ("EAG") to provide services relating to the implementation of process control, advance automation and information technology projects providing our clients with a full range of services, including but not limited to, front-end engineering feasibility studies and the execution of turnkey engineering, procurement, and construction projects. By focusing on large-scope projects, EAG intends to pursue distributed control systems (DCS) conversion and new installation projects by utilizing its own resources as well as resources from both ENGlobal Engineering and ENGlobal Systems. EAG will promote our proven capabilities for plant automation services and products to respond to an industry progression toward replacing obsolete technology with newer DCS. In June 2005, we formed ENGlobal Canada, based in Calgary, Alberta, Canada. ENGlobal Canada is a wholly-owned subsidiary of EAG.

In May 2006, ENGlobal Corporation purchased Denver-based WRC Corporation ("WRC") and its subsidiary WRC Canada further expanding our services within the pipeline industry. WRC provides land management, environmental compliance, and governmental regulatory services to the pipeline, utility and telecom companies and other owner/operators of "infrastructure facilities."

In October 2006, ENGlobal Construction Resources acquired selected assets of Watco Management, Inc. located in Clear Lake, Texas. As a result, we now provide turnaround, asset management, and start-up services for the refining and petrochemical industry. The addition of WATCO will provide ECR with opportunities to expand its current

7

ITEM 1. BUSINESS (Continued)

services to existing WATCO clients to a complementary business, allowing expansion of current services to both existing and future clients.

In the first quarter of 2007, the Dallas office was closed with the majority of assets being sold, a major portion of the office lease obligations being assumed by others and remaining operations being transferred to other offices.

Our engineering segment offers its expertise to a broad range of industrial clients. We participate in projects involving both the modification of existing facilities and construction of new facilities. Our predominant type of contract is a blanket services contract that typically provides our clients with engineering, procurement and project management services on a time and materials basis. We also enter into contracts to complete capital projects on a fixed-price, turnkey basis. The engineering staff has the capability of developing a project from the initial planning stages through detailed design and construction management. The engineering services include:

o conceptual studies;
o project definition;
o cost estimating;
o engineering design;
o inspection;
o land management;
o environmental compliance;
o material procurement; and
o project and construction management.

We provide services for major energy-related firms at facilities such as chemical plants, crude oil refineries, electric power generation facilities, cross-country pipelines, pipeline facilities and production processing facilities.

The engineering segment offers a wide range of services from a single source provider. The segment uses an internal virtual private network so that employees in one location can work on projects based in other offices. This "work sharing" capability allows us to provide a greater depth and breadth of expertise to our clients and helps stabilize the workload in our various offices.

Competition

Our engineering segment competes with a large number of firms of various sizes, ranging from the industry's largest firms, which operate on a worldwide basis, to much smaller regional and local firms. Many of our competitors are larger than we are and have significantly greater financial and other resources available to them than we do.

Competition is primarily centered on performance and the ability to provide the engineering, planning and project execution skills required to complete projects in a timely and cost efficient manner. The technical expertise of our management team and technical personnel and the timeliness and quality of our support services, are key competitive factors. Larger projects, especially international work, typically include pricing alternatives designed to shift risk to the service provider, or at least to cause the service provider to share a portion of the risks associated with cost overruns in service delivery. These alternatives include fixed-price, guaranteed maximum price, incentive fee, competitive bidding and other "value based" pricing arrangements.

8

ITEM 1. BUSINESS (Continued)

Systems Segment

Note: Previously, within the Systems Segment, ESI provided products and services supporting the advanced automation and integrated controls fields. In January 2006, EAG assumed responsibility for these services, which resulted in a move of this division of ESI to the Engineering Segment. Revenues and expenses have been reclassified between the segments to provide comparative results. Amounts will tie in total to prior reporting, however, individual segments will vary from prior reports.

                                2006         2005          2004
                               ---------------------------------
                                    (Amounts in thousands)
                               ---------------------------------
Revenues                       $24,933     $ 14,159      $14,110
Operating profit (loss)        $   (14)    $   (852)     $   660
Total assets                   $16,099     $  6,159      $ 7,806

General

Our systems segment designs, assembles, integrates and services control and instrumentation systems for specific applications in the energy and processing related industries. The systems segment currently consists of ENGlobal Systems, Inc. ("ESI"). Beginning in 2005, the operations of ENGlobal Constant Power, ENGlobal Technologies, Inc. and Senftleber & Associates, LP were merged into ESI. The systems segment derives revenues from fees on contracts for the design, assembly and servicing of control and instrumentation systems. Income from the systems segment is primarily derived from our ability to generate revenues and collect cash on fixed-price contracts in excess of our costs for labor, materials and equipment and transportation costs, plus our SG&A expenses.

ESI's control and instrumentation systems are custom designed and are typically based on electronic, programmable controls, however ESI's work also includes conventional pneumatic and hydraulic systems. Typical applications for ESI's systems include refinery, petrochemical and pipeline facility controls; analyzer packaging; fire and gas detection systems; data acquisition systems; oil and gas production safety systems; and control systems for various processing equipment. We perform all facets of control and instrumentation system design, engineering, assembly and testing in-house. Field installation and technical staff perform start-up and commissioning services, modification to existing systems, on-site training and routine maintenance procedures for client operating personnel.

ESI previously provided products and services supporting the advanced automation and environmental technology fields. Advanced automation services provided by ESI included automation technology audits, consulting, advanced process controls and process computer services, multivariable control, optimization (on-line and off-line), neural net applications, operator training simulators, expert systems and on-site support. In January 2006, EAG assumed responsibility for the provision of these services.

In January 2006, ESI acquired certain assets of Analyzer Technology International, Inc. ("ATI"), a Houston-based analyzer systems provider of online process analyzer systems. ATI relocated its operation to ESI's Houston facility, which the Company expects will enable ESI's clients to perform a more efficient factory adaptable test by temporarily connecting both control and analyzer systems onsite prior to delivery. The addition of ATI will provide ESI with a greater presence in the process analyzer sector, especially for larger downstream opportunities of foreign grassroots projects.

Competition

The systems segment has been impacted by price variations attributable to cyclical conditions in the oil and gas, petroleum and processing industries. In addition, during 2006, a large percentage of ESI's revenues were derived from fabrication, which has a lower profit margin than other services. ESI's control systems and modular facilities compete with similar systems built by other companies, most of which compete primarily on the basis of pricing. We believe that pricing, technical competence and ability to provide superior service comprise the basis of competition for ESI's marketplace.

9

ITEM 1. BUSINESS (Continued)

Acquisitions and Sales

We have grown our business over the past several years through both internal initiatives and through strategic mergers and acquisitions. These mergers and acquisitions have allowed us to (i) expand our client base and the range of services that we provide to our clients; and (ii) gain access to new geographic areas. We expect to continue evaluating and assessing acquisition opportunities that will either complement our existing business base or that will provide the Company with additional capabilities or geographical coverage. We believe that strategic acquisitions will enable us to more efficiently serve the technical needs of national and international clients and strengthen our financial performance. The following table lists the businesses we have acquired during the three-year period ended December 31, 2006.

      Name/Location/Business Unit            Date Acquired            Primary Services
      ---------------------------            -------------            ----------------

     Engineering Design Group, Inc.          January 2004      Automated Fuel Handling & Tank
               Tulsa, OK                                               Gauging Systems
     Operates as ETS, formerly EDG

         AmTech Inspection, LLC             September 2004       Onsite Inspection and Plant
              Midland, TX                                            Process Safety Mgt
     Operates as a Division of ECR

  Cleveland Inspection Services, Inc.        October 2004        Onsite Pipeline Inspection
             Cleveland, OK
     Operates as a Division of ECR

    Instrument Services Company, LLC         November 2004          Onsite Instrument and
               Tulsa, OK                                           Electrical Technicians
     Operates as a Division of ETS

       InfoTech Engineering, LLC             December 2004       Advanced Automation System
            Baton Rouge, LA                                                Design
     Operates as a Division of EAG

Analyzer Technology International, Inc.      January 2006         Process Analyzer Systems
              Houston, TX
     Operates as s Division of ESI

          WRC Corporation and                  May 2006          Integrated Land Management
               WRC Canada
               Denver, CO

            PEI Investments                    May 2006                  Real Estate
              Beaumont, TX

         WATCO Management, Inc.              October 2006                Turnaround
             Clearlake, TX                                            Asset Management
     Operates as a Division of ECR                                 Project Commissioning
                                                                  Construction Management


                               10


ITEM 1. BUSINESS (Continued)

Business Strategy

In the past year, the Company has focused considerable attention on streamlining its organizational structure and strengthening its leadership team. It anticipates that these efforts will be ongoing in 2007. In addition, our objective is to strengthen the Company's position as a leading engineering and consulting services provider while enhancing the services we offer and expanding our geographic presence. To achieve this objective, we have developed a strategy comprised of the following key elements:

o Continue to Recruit and Retain Qualified Personnel. We believe recruiting and retaining qualified, skilled professionals is crucial to our success and growth. As a result, we have dedicated staff focused on recruiting personnel with experience in the energy industry. We have also used inter-company recruiting to retain key personnel.

o Improve Utilization of Resources. We have developed a work-sharing program through the use of an internal virtual private network that gives our clients access to technical resources located in any of our offices and allows for higher utilization of our resources. We believe the work-sharing program has reduced employee turnover and provides for a more stable work environment. We are also moving toward standardization of engineering processes and procedures among our offices, which we believe will enhance our work-sharing ability and provide our clients with more consistent and higher quality services.

o Pursue Foreign Technical Resources. Our engineering operations has partnered with several offshore technical resources to establish longer-term access to professional engineering and design work in lower cost countries such as Mexico, Venezuela, Costa Rica and the Far East. The Company has entered into an agreement with a Malaysian firm that provides for "low cost, high value" engineering and drafting services. We believe these partnerships, both formal and informal, will allow us to lower our contract bid prices and enhance our competitive position.

o Enhance and Strengthen Our Ability to Perform Engineering, Procurement and Construction Projects. We rely heavily on repeat business and referrals from existing customers, industry members and manufacturing representatives. One of the engineering segment's goals is to increase revenues by developing and marketing its ability to perform full service turnkey projects, also called EPC (Engineering, Procurement and Construction) projects, that is expected to emphasize a cost plus contracting strategy. The engineering segment has traditionally been responsible only for the engineering portion of its projects, which usually represents between five to fifteen percent of a project's total installed cost.

o Maintain High Quality Service. To maintain high quality service, we focus on being responsive to our customers, working diligently and responsibly, and maintaining schedules and budgets. The Company has a quality control and assurance program to maintain standards and procedures for performance and documentation. The Company intends to audit and monitor compliance with these procedures and quality standards.

o Expand and Enhance Technical Capabilities. We believe that it is important to develop and enhance our overall technical capabilities in the markets we serve. To achieve this objective in the area of advanced computer-aided process simulation, design and drafting, we have purchased computer hardware and software from several suppliers in order to have the latest platforms for the design of plant systems. This initiative should enhance our marketing position with many of our customers who are currently utilizing these design platforms.

o Pursue Balanced Growth. We continue to pursue balanced growth for our business, utilizing both external acquisitions as well as internal measures as a means of future growth. The internal measures include an active business development program, together with selected initiatives to start new business operations. We also pursue acquisitions that will allow us to offer expanded engineering and control system services

11

ITEM 1. BUSINESS (Continued)

to a broad energy complex, increase our technical capabilities, grow our business geographically and improve our market share.

o Continue to Increase Name Recognition. We intend to continue to present a more cohesive image and continue to increase name recognition. All of ENGlobal's operating subsidiaries have adopted "ENGlobal" as part of their name, and we anticipate that newly acquired entities will adopt ENGlobal as a part of their name within 12 to 18 months of their acquisition.

Sales and Marketing

Our various subsidiaries derive revenues primarily from two sources: (1) in-house direct sales and (2) referrals from existing customers and industry members. Our in-house sales managers are assigned to industry segments and territories within the United States. Management believes that this method of selling should result in increased account penetration and enhanced customer service, which should, in turn, create and maintain the foundation for long-term customer relationships. Our growth depends in large measure on our ability to attract and retain qualified sales representatives and sales management personnel. Management believes that in-house marketing allows for more accountability and control, thus increasing profitability.

Products and services are also promoted through general and trade advertising, participation in trade shows and through on-line Internet communication via our corporate home page at www.englobal.com. The ENGlobal site provides information about both of our operating segments. We use in-house resources to maintain and update our website and our subsidiaries' web sites on an ongoing basis. Through the ENGlobal website, we seek to provide visitors with a single point of contact for obtaining information on the services and products offered by the ENGlobal family of companies.

Our business development department focuses on building long-term relationships with customers and providing customers with product application, engineering and after-the-sale services. Additionally, we seek to capitalize on cross-selling opportunities between our various subsidiaries. Sales leads are often jointly developed and pursued by the sales personnel from a number of these subsidiaries.

Much of our business is repeat business and we are introduced to new customers in most cases by referrals from existing customers and industry members. The Company also believes that our acquisition program, although small, has provided the benefit of expanding our existing customer base.

We currently employ 25 full-time professional in-house marketers in our business development department who concentrate on both the engineering and systems segments. We have formed alliances, which include marketing activities, with other engineering and construction firms in Mexico City, Central and South America and Malaysia.

Customers

In 2007, the Company will focus substantial attention on improving customer services in certain of its offices in order to enhance satisfaction and increase customer retention. Our customer base consists primarily of Fortune 500 companies representing a variety of industries in the United States. While we do not have continuing dependence on any single client or a limited group of clients, one or a few clients may contribute a substantial portion of our revenues in any given year or over a period of several consecutive years due to major engineering projects. We have had success undertaking new projects for prior clients and providing ongoing services to clients following the completion of the projects.

The Company believes that about two-thirds of our revenue is generated through sources such as in-plant staffing and alliance relationships that we consider longer-term in nature and that are not typically limited to one project. As an example, our In Plant Staffing division of EEI provides outsourced technical and other personnel that are assigned to work at client locations. The Company's past experience with this activity is that the term of these assignments on average spans multiple projects and multiple years.

12

ITEM 1. BUSINESS (Continued)

A major long-term trend among our clients and their industry counterparts has been toward outsourcing of engineering services, and more recently, sole-sourcing. This trend has fostered the development of ongoing, longer-term alliance arrangements with clients, rather than one-time limited engagements. These arrangements vary in scope, duration and degree of commitment. While there is typically no guarantee of work that will result from these alliance agreements, often they form the basis for a longer-term relationship with our clients. Despite their variety, we believe that these partnering relationships have a stabilizing influence on our service revenues. At December 31, 2006, we maintained some form of partnering or alliance arrangement with 16 major oil and chemical companies. For example, alliance engagements may provide for:

o a minimum number of work man-hours over a specified period;
o the provision of at least a designated percentage of the client's requirements;
o the designation of the Company as the client's sole source of engineering at specific locations; or
o a non-binding preference or intent, or a general contractual framework, for what the parties expect will be an ongoing relationship.

In order to generate revenues in future years, we must continue efforts to obtain new engineering projects. Historically, we have not generated significant revenues from government clients. Also during 2006 we generated $26 million in revenues away from the historical large "owner/operator" type Fortune 500 companies to smaller developer type entities such as smaller refiners and developers of renewable energy.

In the engineering segment, our ten largest customers, who vary from one period to the next, accounted for 71% of our total revenue for 2006, 77% of total revenue for 2005, and 80% of total revenue for 2004. Most of our projects are specific in nature and we generally have multiple projects with the same clients. If we were to lose one or more of our significant clients and were unable to replace them with other customers or other projects, our business would be materially adversely affected. Our top three clients in 2006 were ConocoPhillips, ExxonMobil and Motiva.

In the systems segment, our clients include end-users and operators of facilities relating to oil and gas products, pipelines, refineries, chemical companies and processing plants. Other clients include equipment manufacturers, construction contractors and other engineering firms that incorporate our control systems into facilities and products that they design, construct and manufacture. As in the engineering segment, in any given year, a small number of clients may account for a large percentage of the systems segment's revenues for that year, depending on the number of major projects undertaken. Though the systems segment frequently receives work from repeat clients, its client list may vary significantly from year to year.

In the systems segment, our ten largest customers, who vary from one period to the next, accounted for 64% of our total revenue for 2006, 70% of total revenue for 2005, and 77% of total revenue for 2004. During 2006, foreign customers accounted for 31% of our systems segment revenue compared to less than 1% during both 2005 and 2004. The increase in revenue from foreign customers is based on the expansion of the analytical division that provides online process analyzer systems, through the acquisition of ATI. Our ability to provide analyzer systems is dependent on fundamental contracts with customers doing business in oil producing regions. The loss of business from anyone of such customers could have a material adverse effect on our systems business or results of operations, but not the company as a whole. Other factors affecting our analyzer systems business that are beyond our control include: political instability or armed conflict, the level of customer demand, the willingness of clients to make payments, and to make those payments timely.

We do not have any long-term commitments from systems segment clients and sales of products from the systems segment are typically made according to the client's specifications on a purchase order basis. Our potential revenues are, therefore, dependent on continuing relationships with these customers.

13

ITEM 1. BUSINESS (Continued)

Contracts

We generally enter into two principal types of contracts with our clients:
time and materials contracts and fixed-price contracts. In our engineering segment, in fiscal 2006, 89% and 11% of our net revenue was derived from time and materials and fixed-price contracts, respectively, compared to 95% and 5% of net revenue from time and materials and fixed-price contract respectively in 2005. In our systems segment, in fiscal 2006, 7% and 93% of our net revenue was derived from time and materials and fixed-price contracts, respectively, compared to 3% and 97% of net revenues from time and materials and fixed-price contracts, respectively in 2005. Our clients typically determine the type of contract to be utilized for a particular engagement, with the specific terms and conditions of a contract resulting from a negotiation process between the Company and our client.

o Time and Materials. Under our time and materials contracts, we are paid for labor at either negotiated hourly billing rates or reimbursed for allowable hourly rates and for other expenses. We are paid for material and contracted services at an agreed upon multiplier of our cost, and at times pass these non-labor services through with no profit. Profitability on these contracts is driven by billable headcount, the amount of non-labor related services, and cost control. Some of these contracts may have upper limits, referred to as "not to exceed." If our costs generate billings that exceed the contract ceiling or are not allowable, we will not be able to obtain reimbursement for any excess cost. Further, the continuation of each contract partially depends upon the customer's discretionary periodic assessment of our performance on that contract.

o Fixed-Price. Under a fixed-price contract, we provide the customer a total project for an agreed-upon price, subject to project circumstances and changes in scope. Fixed-price projects vary in scope, including some engineering activities and related services, and procurement of material and construction responsibility. Fixed-price contracts carry certain inherent risks, including risks of losses from underestimating costs, delays in project completion, problems with new technologies and economic and other changes that may occur over the contract period. Another risk includes our ability to secure written change orders prior to commencing work on such orders, which may prevent our getting paid for work performed. Consequently, the profitability of fixed-price contracts may vary substantially, and we plan to limit the size and scope of fixed-price contracts that we enter into in the future due to significant losses on two fixed-price contracts.

Backlog

Backlog represents gross revenue of all awarded contracts that have not been completed and will be recognized as revenues over the life of the project. Although backlog reflects business that we consider to be firm, cancellations or scope adjustments may occur. Further, most contracts with clients may be terminated at will, in which case the client would only be obligated to us for services provided through the termination date. We have adjusted backlog to reflect project cancellations, deferrals and revisions in scope and cost (both upward and downward) known at the reporting date; however, future contract modifications or cancellations may increase or reduce backlog and future revenues. As a result, no assurances can be given that the amounts included in backlog will ultimately be realized.

At December 31, 2006, our backlog was $192.0 million compared to an estimated $170.0 million at December 31, 2005. We expect that a majority of the $192.0 million in backlog to be completed during 2007.

The backlog at December 31, 2006 consists of $187.0 million with commercial customers and $5.0 million with the United States Federal Government. Backlog on the federal programs includes only the portion of the contract award that has been funded by the U.S. Government.

Backlog includes gross revenue under two types of contracts: (1) contracts for which work authorizations have been received on a fixed-price basis and not-to-exceed projects that are well defined, and (2) time and material evergreen contracts at an assumed 12 month run-rate, where we place employees at our clients' site to perform day-to-day project efforts.

There is no assurance as to what percentage of backlog will be recognized.

14

ITEM 1. BUSINESS (Continued)

Customer Service and Support

We provide service and technical support to our customers in varying degrees depending upon the business line and on customer contractual arrangements. The Company's technical staff provides initial telephone support services for its customers. These services include isolating and verifying reported failures and authorizing repair services in support of customer requirements. We also provide on-site engineering support if a technical issue cannot be resolved over the telephone. On projects for which we have provided engineering systems, we provide worldwide start-up and commissioning services. We also provide the manufacturers' limited warranty coverage for products we re-sell.

Dependence Upon Suppliers

Our ability to provide clients with services and systems in a timely and competitive manner depends on the availability of products and parts from our suppliers at competitive prices and on reasonable terms. Our suppliers are not obligated to have products on hand for timely delivery nor can they guarantee product availability in sufficient quantities to meet our demands. There can be no assurance that we will be able to obtain necessary supplies at prices or on terms we find acceptable. However, in an effort to maximize availability and maintain quality control, we generally procure components from multiple distributors.

For example, all of the product components used by our systems segment are fabricated using components and materials that are available from numerous domestic suppliers. There are approximately 5 principal suppliers of these components, each of whom can be replaced by an equally viable competitor. No one manufacturer or vendor provides products that account for 7% or more of our revenues. Thus, we anticipate little or no difficulty in obtaining components in sufficient quantities and in a timely manner to support our manufacturing and assembly operations. Units produced through the systems segment are normally not produced for inventory and component parts; rather, they are typically purchased on an as-needed basis.

Despite the foregoing, some of our subsidiaries rely on certain suppliers for necessary components and there can be no assurance that these components will continue to be available on acceptable terms. If a subsidiary or one of its suppliers terminates a long-standing supply relationship, it may be difficult to obtain alternative sources of supply without a material disruption in our ability to provide products and services to our customers. While we do not believe that such a disruption is likely, if it did occur, it could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

Patents, Trademarks, Licenses

Our success depends in part upon our ability to protect our proprietary technology, which we do primarily through protection of our trade secrets and confidentiality agreements. The U.S. Patent and Trademark Office approved our application for the uses of "ENGlobal" and "Integrated Rack" in September 2004 and March 2005, respectively. In addition, we have pending trademark applications on file with the U.S. Patent and Trademark Office for the names "Engineered for Growth" and "ENGlobal CARES - Communicating Appropriate Responses in Emergency Situations", "Flare-Mon" and "Purchased Data". There can be no assurance that the protective measures we currently employ will be adequate to prevent the unauthorized use or disclosure of our technology, or the independent third party development of the same or similar technology. Although our competitive position to some extent depends on our ability to protect our proprietary and trade secret information, we believe that other factors, such as the technical expertise and knowledge base of our management and technical personnel, as well as the timeliness and quality of the support services we provide, will also help us to maintain our competitive position.

Government Regulations

The Company and certain of our subsidiaries are subject to various foreign, federal, state, and local laws and regulations relating to our business and operations, and various health and safety regulations as established by the Occupational Safety and Health Administration. The Company and members of its professional staff are subject to a variety of state, local and foreign licensing, registration and other regulatory requirements governing the practice of engineering. Currently, we are not aware of any situation or condition relating to the regulation of the

15

ITEM 1. BUSINESS (Continued)

Company, its subsidiaries, or personnel that we believe is likely to have a material adverse effect on our results of operations or financial condition.

Employees

As of December 31, 2006, the Company and its subsidiaries employed 2,100 individuals. Of these employees, 1,127 were employed in engineering and related positions; 332 were employed as inspectors; 310 were employed as project support staff; 211 were employed in technical production positions; 95 were employed in administration, finance and management information systems and 25 were employed in sales and marketing. We believe that our ability to recruit and retain highly skilled and experienced technical, sales and management personnel has been and will continue to be, critical to our ability to execute our business plan. None of our employees is represented by a labor union or is subject to a collective bargaining agreement. We believe that relations with our employees are good.

16

ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS

Set forth below and elsewhere in this Report and in other documents we file with the SEC are risks and uncertainties that could cause actual results to differ materially from the results contemplated by the forward-looking statements contained in this Report. You should be aware that the occurrence of any of the events described in these risk factors and elsewhere in this Report could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations and that upon the occurrence of any of these events, the trading price of our common stock could decline.

Our indebtedness could limit our ability to finance future operations or engage in other business activities. As of December 31, 2006, we had $24 million of total outstanding indebtedness against our revolving line of credit currently limited to $30 million. Significant factors that could increase our indebtedness and/or limit our ability to finance future operations include:

o our inability to collect accounts receivable within contractual terms;
o client demands for extending contractual payment terms;
o material losses and/or negative cash flows on significant projects;
o client's ability to pay our invoices due to economic conditions; and
o our ability to meet current credit facility financial ratios and covenants.

Although we are in compliance with all current credit facility covenants, our indebtedness could limit our ability to finance future operations or engage in other business activities.

Force majeure events such as natural disasters have negatively impacted and could further negatively impact the economy and the industries we service, which may affect our financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.
Force majeure events such as Hurricanes Katrina and Rita that affected the Gulf Coast in August and September of 2005 could negatively impact the economies in which we operate. For example, these two hurricanes caused considerable damage along the Gulf Coast not only to the refining and petrochemical industry but also the commercial segment which competes for labor, materials and equipment resources needed throughout the entire United States. We typically remain obligated to perform our services after such a natural disaster and even though our contract may contain force majeure clause. If we are not able to react quickly and/or negotiate contractual relief under a force majeure event, our operations may be affected significantly, which would have a negative impact on our financial condition, results of operation and cash flows.

16

ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS (Continued)

Our future revenues depend on our ability to consistently bid and win new contracts and to maintain and renew existing contracts and, therefore, our failure to effectively obtain future contracts could adversely affect our profitability.
Our future revenues and overall results of operations require us to successfully bid on new contracts and renew existing contracts. Contract proposals and negotiations are complex and frequently involve a lengthy bidding and selection process, which is affected by a number of factors, such as market conditions, financing arrangements and required governmental approvals. For example, a client may require us to provide a bond or letter of credit to protect the client should we fail to perform under the terms of the contract. If negative market conditions arise, or if we fail to secure adequate financial arrangements or the required governmental approval, we may not be able to pursue particular projects, which could adversely affect our profitability.

The failure to attract and retain key professional personnel could adversely affect the Company.
Our success depends on attracting and retaining qualified personnel in a competitive environment. We are dependent upon our ability to attract and retain highly qualified managerial, technical and business development personnel. Competition for key personnel is intense. We cannot be certain that we will retain our key managerial, technical and business development personnel or that we will attract or assimilate key personnel in the future. Failure to attract and retain such personnel would materially adversely affect our businesses, financial position, results of operations and cash flows. This is a major risk factor that could materially impact our operating results.

If we are not able to successfully manage internal growth initiatives, our business and results of operations may be adversely affected. Our growth strategy is to use our technical expertise in conjunction with industry trends. To support this strategy, the Company may elect to fund internal growth initiatives targeted at markets that the Company believes may have significant potential needs for the Company's services. The downside risks are that such initiatives could have a negative effect on current earnings until they reach critical mass, that industry trends have been misread or delayed or that they Company is unable to successfully execute on these initiatives. In these cases, continued funding could have a negative impact on long term earnings.

If we are not able to successfully manage our growth strategy, our business and results of operations may be adversely affected. We have grown rapidly over the last several years.
Our growth presents numerous managerial, administrative, operational and other challenges. Our ability to manage the growth of our operations will require us to continue to improve our management information systems and maintain discipline in our internal systems and controls. Industry trends and our ability to manage and measure project performance will require us to strengthen our internal project and cost control systems within operations that have traditionally operated in a cost plus environment. In addition, our growth will increase our need to attract, develop, motivate and retain both our management and professional employees. The inability of our management to effectively manage our growth or the inability of our employees to achieve anticipated performance could have a material adverse effect on our business.

Liability claims could result in losses.
Providing engineering and design services involves the risk of contract, professional errors and omissions and other liability claims, as well as adverse publicity. Further, many of our contracts will require us to indemnify our clients not only for our negligence, if any, but also for the concurrent negligence and in some cases, sole negligence of our clients. We currently maintain liability insurance coverage, including coverage for professional errors and omissions. However, claims outside of or exceeding our insurance coverage may be made. A significant claim could result in unexpected liabilities, take management time away from operations, and have a material adverse impact on our cash flow.

Our business and operating results could be adversely affected by our inability to accurately estimate the overall risks, revenue or costs on a contract.

We generally enter into two principal types of contracts with our clients: time and materials contracts and fixed-price contracts. Under our fixed-price contracts, we receive a fixed-price irrespective of the actual costs we incur and, consequently, we are exposed to a

18

ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS (Continued)

number of risks. These risks include underestimation of costs, problems with new technologies, unforeseen expenditures or difficulties, delays beyond our control and economic and other changes that may occur during the contract period. Our ability to secure change orders on scope changes and our ability to invoice for such changes poses an additional risk. In fiscal 2006, approximately 17.9% of our net revenue was derived from fixed-price contracts, and we recorded losses of $13 million on two significant fixed-price EPC projects.

Under our time and materials contracts, we are paid for labor at negotiated hourly billing rates or reimbursement at specified mark-up hourly rates and negotiated rates for other expenses. Profitability on these contracts is driven by billable headcount and cost control. Some time and materials contracts are subject to contract ceiling amounts, which may be fixed or performance-based. If our costs generate billings that exceed the contract ceiling or are not allowable under the provisions of the contract or any applicable regulations, we may not be able to obtain reimbursement for all of our costs.

Revenue recognition for a contract requires judgment relative to assessing the contract's estimated risks, revenue and costs, and technical issues. Due to the size and nature of many of our contracts, the estimation of overall risk, revenue and cost at completion is complicated and subject to many variables. Changes in underlying assumptions, circumstances or estimates may also adversely affect future period financial performance. This is a major risk factor that could materially impact our operating results.

Economic downturns could have a negative impact on our businesses. Demand for the services offered by us has been and is expected to continue to be, subject to significant fluctuations due to a variety of factors beyond our control, including demand for engineering services in the petroleum refining, petroleum chemical and pipeline industries and in other industries that we provide services to. During economic downturns in these industries, our customer's need to engage us may decline significantly. We cannot be certain that economic or political conditions will be generally favorable or that there will not be significant fluctuations adversely affecting our industry as a whole or key markets targeted by us.

Our dependence on one or a few customers could adversely affect us. One or a few clients have in the past and may in the future contribute a significant portion of our consolidated revenues in any one year or over a period of several consecutive years. In 2006, approximately 15% of our revenues were from ConocoPhillips, approximately 14% of our revenues were from ExxonMobil and another 10% were from Motiva. As our backlog frequently reflects multiple projects for individual clients, one major customer may comprise a significant percentage of our backlog at any point in time. Because these significant customers generally contract with us for specific projects, we may lose these customers from year to year as their projects with us are completed. If we do not replace them with other customers or other projects, our business could be materially adversely affected. Also, the majority of our contracts can be terminated at will. Additionally, we have long-standing relationships with many of our significant customers. Our contracts with these customers, however, are on a project-by-project basis and the customers may unilaterally reduce or discontinue their purchases at any time. The loss of business from any one of such customers could have a material adverse effect on our business or results of operations.

If the operating result of either segment is adversely affected, an impairment of goodwill could result in a write down.
Based on factors and circumstances impacting ENGlobal and the business climate in which it operates, the Company may determine that it is necessary to re-evaluate the carrying value of its goodwill by conducting an impairment test in accordance with SFAS No. 142. The Company has assigned goodwill to its two segments based on estimates of the relative fair value of each segment. If changes in the industry, market conditions, or government regulation negatively impact either of the Company's segments resulting in lower operating income, if assets are harmed, if anticipated synergies or cost savings are not realized with newly acquired entities, or if any circumstance occurs which results in the fair value of either segment declining below its carrying value, an impairment to goodwill would be created. In accordance with SFAS No. 142, the Company would be required to write down the carrying value of goodwill.

18

ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS (Continued)

Our backlog is subject to unexpected adjustments and cancellations and is, therefore, an uncertain indicator of our future revenues or earnings.
As of December 31, 2006, our backlog was approximately $192 million. We cannot assure investors that the revenues projected in our backlog will be realized or, if realized, will result in profits. Projects may remain in our backlog for an extended period of time prior to project execution and, once project execution begins, it may occur unevenly over the current and multiple future periods. In addition, project terminations, suspensions or reductions in scope may occur from time to time with respect to contracts reflected in our backlog, reducing the revenue and profit we actually receive from contracts reflected in our backlog. Future project cancellations and scope adjustments could further reduce the dollar amount of our backlog and the revenues and profits that we actually earn.

Additional acquisitions may adversely affect our ability to manage our business.
Acquisitions have contributed to our growth over the past three years and we plan to continue making acquisitions in the future on terms management considers favorable to us. The successful acquisition of other companies involves an assessment of future revenue opportunities, operating costs, economies and earnings after the acquisition is complete, potential industry and business risks and liabilities beyond our control. This assessment is necessarily inexact and its accuracy is inherently uncertain. In connection with our assessments, we perform reviews of the subject acquisitions we believe to be generally consistent with industry practices. These reviews, however, may not reveal all existing or potential problems, nor will they permit a buyer to become sufficiently familiar with the target companies to assess fully their deficiencies and capabilities. We cannot assure you that we will identify, finance and complete additional suitable acquisitions on acceptable terms. We may not successfully integrate future acquisitions. Any acquisition may require substantial attention from our management, which may limit the amount of time that management can devote to day-to-day operations. Our inability to find additional attractive acquisition candidates or to effectively manage the integration of any businesses acquired in the future could adversely affect our ability to grow profitably or at all.

We are engaged in highly competitive businesses and must typically bid against competitors to obtain engineering and service contracts. We are engaged in highly competitive businesses in which customer contracts are typically awarded through competitive bidding processes. We compete with other general and specialty contractors, both foreign and domestic, including large international contractors and small local contractors. Some competitors have greater financial and other resources than we do, which, in some instances, gives them a competitive advantage over us.

Seasonality of our industry may cause our revenues to fluctuate. Holidays and employee vacations during our fourth quarter exert downward pressure on revenues for that quarter, which is only partially offset by the year-end efforts on the part of many clients to spend any remaining funds budgeted for engineering services or capital expenditures during the year. The annual budgeting and approval process under which these clients operate is normally not completed until after the beginning of each new-year, which can depress results for the first quarter. Principally due to these factors, our first an fourth quarters may be less robust than our second and third quarters.

Our dependence on subcontractors and equipment manufacturers could adversely affect us.
We rely on third-party subcontractors as well as third-party suppliers and manufacturers to complete our projects. To the extent that we cannot engage subcontractors or acquire supplies or materials, our ability to complete a project in a timely fashion or at a profit may be impaired. If the amount we are required to pay for these goods and services exceeds the amount we have estimated in bidding for fixed-price or cost-plus contracts, we could experience losses in the performance of these contracts. In addition, if a subcontractor or supplier is unable to deliver its services or materials according to the negotiated terms for any reason, including the deterioration of its financial condition or over-commitment of its resources, we may be required to purchase the services or materials from another source at a higher price. This may reduce the profit to be realized or result in a loss on a project for which the services or materials were needed.

19

ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS (Continued)

A small number of stockholders own a significant portion of our outstanding common stock, thus limiting the extent to which other stockholders can effect decisions subject to stockholder vote. A small number of stockholders own a significant portion of our outstanding common stock, thus limiting the extent to which other stockholders can effect decisions subject to stockholder vote. As of December 31, 2006, directors, executive officers and principal stockholders of ENGlobal and their affiliates, beneficially owned approximately 41% of our outstanding common stock on a fully diluted basis. Accordingly, these stockholders, as a group, are able to affect the outcome of stockholder votes, including votes concerning the adoption or amendment of provisions in our Articles of Incorporation or bylaws and the approval of mergers and other significant corporate transactions. The existence of these levels of ownership concentrated in a few persons makes it unlikely that any other holder of common stock will be able to affect the management or direction of the Company. These factors may also have the effect of delaying or preventing a change in management or voting control of the Company.

Our Board of Directors may authorize future sales of ENGlobal common stock, which could result in a decrease in value to existing stockholders of the shares they hold.
Our Articles of Incorporation authorize our board of directors to issue up to an additional 47,518,533 shares of common stock and an additional 2,000,000 shares of blank check preferred stock as of the date of filing. These shares may be issued without stockholder approval unless the issuance is 20% or more of our outstanding common stock, in which case the American Stock Exchange requires stockholder approval. We may issue shares of stock in the future in connection with acquisitions or financings. In addition, we may issue options as incentives under our 1998 Incentive Option Plan or under a new equity incentive plan. Future issuances of substantial amounts of common stock, or the perception that these sales could occur, may affect the market price of our common stock. In addition, the ability of the board of directors to issue additional stock may discourage transactions involving actual or potential changes of control of the Company, including transactions that otherwise could involve payment of a premium over prevailing market prices to holders of our common stock.

ITEM 1B. UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS

Not applicable.

ITEM 2. PROPERTIES

Facilities
We lease space in 23 buildings in the U.S. and Canada totaling approximately 458,600 square feet, and we own an office building in Baton Rouge, Louisiana with 27,500 square feet. The leases have remaining terms ranging from monthly to six years and are at what we consider to be commercially reasonable rental rates. On May 26, 2006, the Company entered into an exclusive agreement with a third-party, national real estate firm for tenant representation services that covers most of our facilities.

Our principal office locations are in Houston and Beaumont, Texas, and Tulsa, Oklahoma. We have other offices in Clear Lake, Freeport, and Midland, Texas; Baton Rouge and Lake Charles, Louisiana; Cleveland and Blackwell, Oklahoma; Denver, Colorado; and Calgary, Alberta Canada. Approximately 357,000 square feet of our total office space is designated for our professional, technical and administrative personnel. We believe that our office and other facilities are well maintained and adequate for existing and planned operations at each operating location.

Our systems segment performs fabrication assembly in two shop facilities. One facility is in Houston, Texas with approximately 62,600 square feet of space and a second facility is in Beaumont, Texas with approximately 30,000 square feet of space.

On May 25, 2006, the Company, through its wholly-owned subsidiary ENGlobal Corporate Services, Inc., purchased a one-third partnership interest in PEI Investments, A Texas Joint Venture ("PEI"), from Michael L. Burrow, the Company's President and CEO, and another one-third interest from a stockholder who owns less than 1% of the Company's common stock. The partnership interests were purchased for a total of $69,000. The

20

ITEM 2. PROPERTIES (Continued)

remaining one-third interest was already held by the Company through its wholly-owned subsidiary EEI. PEI owns the land on which our Beaumont, Texas office building, destroyed by Hurricane Rita in September 2005, was located. The remains of the building were razed in July 2006. In September 2006, the Company acquired approximately 1.2 acres immediately adjacent to the former facility and is developing plans to construct a new facility utilizing both parcels of land.

On February 16, 2007, the Company, through its wholly-owned subsidiary, RPM Engineering, Inc. ("RPM"), entered into an agreement (the "Agreement") to sell the Company's property located in Baton Rouge, Louisiana. The purchase price is approximately $1.9 million with 20% of the purchase price being paid at closing and the balance self-financed for a period no longer than 60 months, amortized over 180 months, payable in equal monthly installments and one irregular installment consisting of the interest and principal due at the end of the 60 months. The initial interest rate is 8.5% based on an agreed rate of NY prime plus .25%. Under certain conditions, prior to closing and up to 60 days from the last signing of the Agreement, the Purchaser is entitled to terminate the agreement and demand the return in full of any deposit held by RPM. The financed portion of the purchase price is secured by a first mortgage on the property. The Company's basis in the property, together with the building and all improvements, is approximately $1.4 million. The Company expects to close this transaction May 31, 2007. The Company has leased approximately 31,000 square feet of space in two separate facilities to house its EEI and EAG operations in Baton Rouge.

On March 2, 2007, the Company, through its wholly-owned subsidiary, ENGlobal Automation Group, Inc. ("EAG"), entered into a 39 month lease agreement for approximately 4,489 square feet of office space in Alpharetta, Georgia (a suburb of Atlanta).

ITEM 3. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

From time to time, we are involved in various legal proceedings arising in the ordinary course of business alleging, among other things, breach of contract or tort in connection with the performance of professional services, the outcome of which cannot be predicted with certainty. As of the date of this filing, we are party to several legal proceedings that have been reserved for or are covered by insurance, or that, if determined adversely to us individually or in the aggregate, would not have a material adverse effect on our results of operations or financial position.

ITEM 4. SUBMISSION OF MATTERS TO A VOTE OF SECURITY HOLDERS

Not applicable.

21

PART II

ITEM 5. MARKET FOR REGISTRANT'S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER

MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES

Market Information and Holders
The Company's common stock has been quoted on the American Stock Exchange ("AMEX") since June 16, 1998, and is currently traded under the symbol "ENG". From its initial listing on AMEX on June 16, 1998 to June 15, 2002, the Company's stock was traded under the symbol "IDS." Newspaper stock listings identify us as "ENGlobal."

The following table sets forth the high and low sales prices of our common stock for the periods indicated.

                                 Fiscal Year Ended December 31
                          -------------------------------------------
                                  2006                    2005
                          -------------------------------------------
                           High        Low          High       Low
                          -------------------------------------------

First Quarter             14.61       9.14          2.87       2.04
Second Quarter            14.70       6.91          4.03       2.01
Third Quarter              8.88       5.71          9.10       3.69
Fourth Quarter             8.15       5.92          8.75       5.87

The foregoing figures, based on information published by AMEX, do not reflect retail mark-ups or markdowns and may not represent actual trades.

In connection with our December 2001 merger with Petrocon, we issued 2,500,000 shares of Series A Preferred Stock, $0.001 par value per share, to Equus II Incorporated. In 2002 and 2003, we issued dividends to Equus in the form of 234,833 shares of Series A Preferred Stock. Effective August 2003, the Company exercised its right to convert all outstanding Series A Preferred Stock to 1,149,089 shares of common stock. The Series A Preferred Stock had fixed terms that were specific to the 2001 merger with Petrocon. The Company's stockholders at its June, 2006 meeting approved the elimination of the 2,265,167 shares of available and unissued Series A Preferred Stock from its capital structure, and approved the authorization of a like number of "blank check" preferred stock.

The Company's stockholders, at the Company's June, 2006 meeting, approved a new class of capital stock of the Company consisting of 2,000,000 shares of Preferred Stock, par value $0.001 per share (the "Preferred Stock"). The Preferred Stock is referred to as a "blank check" because the Board of Directors, in their discretion, will be authorized to provide for the issuance of all or any shares of the stock in one or more classes or series, specifying the terms of the shares, subject to the limitations of Nevada law. The Board of Directors would make a determination as to whether to approve the terms and issuance of any shares of Preferred Stock based on its judgment as to the best interests of the Company and its stockholders.

As of December 31, 2006, approximately 314 stockholders of record held the Company's common stock. We do not have current information regarding the number of holders of beneficial interest holding our common stock.

22

ITEM 5. MARKET FOR REGISTRANT'S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER
MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES (continued)

The following line graph compares the total returns (assuming reinvestment of dividends) to our Common Stock, the AMEX US Index and the S&P 600 SmallCap Index for the five-year period ended December 31, 2006. This comparison assumes the investment of $100 on December 31, 2000 and the reinvestment of all dividends.

                                 2001         2002        2003        2004       2005        2006
                                 ----         ----        ----        ----       ----        ----
    ENGlobal (ENG)               100.00       57.14       82.29      136.00     225.14      354.29
S&P 600 SmallCap Index           100.00       84.68      116.47      141.61     151.03      172.29
     Amex US Index               100.00       81.74      110.63      127.83     138.33      160.48

23

ITEM 5. MARKET FOR REGISTRANT'S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER
MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES (Continued)

Equity Compensation Plan Information The following table sets forth certain information concerning the Company's equity compensation plans as of December 31, 2006. See Note 11 in the attached financial statements.

                                                                                                    Number of Securities
                                                                                                  Remaining Available for
                               Number of Securities to              Weighted-Average               Future Issuance Under
                               be Issued Upon Exercise             Exercise Price of             Equity Compensation Plans
                               of Outstanding Options,            Outstanding Options,            [Excluding Securities in
                               Warrants and Rights (a)          Warrants and Rights (b)               Column (a)] (c)
                               -------------------------        -------------------------       -----------------------------

Equity compensation plans             1,422,494          (1)             $5.16                            150,806
   approved by security
   holders
                               -------------------------                                        -----------------------------

Dividend Policy
The Company has never declared or paid a cash dividend on its common stock. The Company intends to retain any future earnings for reinvestment in its business and does not intend to pay cash dividends in the foreseeable future. In addition, restrictions contained in our loan agreements governing our credit facility with Comerica Bank preclude us from paying any dividends on our common stock while any debt under those agreements is outstanding. The payment of dividends in the future will depend on numerous factors, including the Company's earnings, capital requirements, and operating and financial position and on general business conditions.

Dividends on outstanding shares of Series A Preferred Stock were paid on the last day of May in 2002 and 2003 in shares of stock of Series A Preferred Stock at a rate of 0.08 shares for each outstanding share of Series A Preferred Stock. The Company elected to convert all shares of preferred stock to 1,149,089 shares of common stock in August 2003. The Company's stockholders eliminated this series of preferred stock at its June, 2006 stockholders meeting.


(1) Includes options issued through our 1998 Incentive Plan. For a brief description of the material features of the Plan, see Note 11 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements. Some of these options, also granted through the 1998 Incentive Plan, were options granted as replacement options for outstanding Petrocon incentive options pursuant to the terms of the December 2001 Merger Agreement with Petrocon.

24

ITEM 6. SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA

Summary Selected Historical Consolidated Financial Data The following tables set forth our selected financial data. The data for the years ended December 31, 2006, 2005, and 2004 have been derived from the audited financial statements appearing elsewhere in this document. The data as of December 31, 2003 and 2002 and for the years ended December 31, 2003 and 2002 have been derived from audited financial statements not appearing in this document. You should read the selected financial data set forth below in conjunction with our financial statements and the notes thereto included in Part II, Item 8, Part II, Item 7, "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations," and other financial information appearing elsewhere in this document.

Note: Previously, within the Systems Segment, ESI provided products and services supporting the advanced automation and integrated controls fields. In January 2006, EAG assumed responsibility for these services, which resulted in a move of this division of ESI to the Engineering Segment. This, along with the sale of Thermaire in 2003, has caused reclassification to provide comparative results. Revenues and expenses have been reclassified between the segments to provide comparative results. Amounts will tie in total to prior reporting, however, individual segments will vary from prior reports.

                                                                                   Years Ended December 31,
                                                              --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                 2006          2005          2004          2003          2002
                                                              --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                           (in thousands, except per share amounts)
                                                              --------------------------------------------------------------------
     Statement of Operations
         Revenues
              Engineering                                     $   278,157   $   219,426   $   134,778   $   110,535   $    75,817
              Systems                                              24,933        14,159        14,110        13,184        13,305
                                                               ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
                  Total revenues                                  303,090       233,585       148,888       123,719        89,122
                                                               ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------

         Costs and expenses
              Engineering                                         254,031       192,264       118,805        95,021        63,322
              Systems                                              22,795        13,048        11,891        11,725        11,395
              Selling, general and administrative                  29,885        19,689        13,700        12,439        10,632
                                                               ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
                  Total costs and expenses                        306,711       225,001       144,396       119,185        85,349
                                                              ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
          Operating income (loss)                                  (3,621 )       8,584         4,492         4,534         3,773
         Interest income (expense), net                            (1,312 )        (800 )        (590 )        (784 )        (821 )
         Other income (expense), net                                  652           116           118          (355 )         143
         Foreign currency gain (loss)                                 (19 )          (2 )           -             -             -
                                                              ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
         Income (loss) from continuing operations before
            provision for income taxes                             (4,300 )       7,898         4,020         3,395         3,095
         Provision for income taxes                                  (814 )       3,116         1,656         1,110         1,197
                                                              ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
         Income (loss) from operations                             (3,486 )       4,782         2,364         2,285         1,898
         Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of
            taxes                                                       -             -             -          (154 )        (146 )
         Income (loss) from disposal of discontinued
            operations                                                  -             -             -            26             -
                                                              ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
                  Net income (loss)                           $    (3,486 ) $     4,782   $     2,364   $     2,157   $     1,752
                                                              ============  ============  ============  ============  ============


                                                                          25

ITEM 6.        SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA (Continued)

                                                                                   Years Ended December 31,
                                                              --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                 2006          2005          2004          2003          2002
                                                              --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                           (in thousands, except per share amounts)
                                                              --------------------------------------------------------------------
     Per Share Data
         Basic earnings (loss) per share
              Continuing operations                           $     (0.13 ) $      0.20   $      0.10   $      0.09   $      0.07
              Discontinued operations                                   -             -             -             -             -
                                                              ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
                  Net income per share                        $     (0.13 ) $      0.20   $      0.10   $      0.09   $      0.07
                                                              ============  ============  ============  ============  ============

         Weighted average common
            shares outstanding - basic                             26,538        24,300        23,455        23,301        22,861

         Diluted earnings (loss) per share
              Continuing operations                           $     (0.13 ) $      0.19   $      0.10   $      0.09   $      0.07
              Discontinued operations                                   -             -             -             -             -
                                                              ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
                  Net income per share                        $     (0.13 ) $      0.19   $      0.10   $      0.09   $      0.07
                                                              ============  ============  ============  ============  ============


         Weighted average common
            shares outstanding - diluted                           26,538        25,250        23,786        23,734        23,013

     Cash Flow Data
         Operating activities, net                            $    (8,953 ) $      (920 ) $    (2,391 ) $     6,557   $     1,302
         Investing activities, net                                 (9,330 )      (2,417 )      (1,811 )        (471 )      (1,290 )
         Financing activities, net                                 19,553         3,492         4,170        (6,122 )      (1,182 )
         Exchange rate changes                                        (26 )          (4 )           -             -             -
                                                              ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
              Net change in cash and cash equivalents         $     1,244   $       151   $       (32 ) $       (36 ) $    (1,170 )
                                                              ============  ============  ============  ============  ============

     Balance Sheet Data
         Working capital                                      $    35,187   $    21,825   $    14,503   $     6,505   $     8,416
         Property and equipment, net                          $     8,725   $     6,861   $     5,262   $     4,302   $     4,779
         Total assets                                         $   106,227   $    75,936   $    57,261   $    42,530   $    40,068
         Long-term debt, net of current portion               $    27,162   $     5,228   $    15,585   $     7,506   $    12,580
         Long-term capital leases, net of current portion     $         -   $         -   $         -   $        12   $        17
         Stockholders' equity                                 $    40,862   $    39,865   $    20,051   $    18,175   $    13,389

26

ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND
RESULTS OF OPERATION

The following discussion is qualified in its entirety by, and should be read in conjunction with, our Consolidated Financial Statements including the Notes thereto, included elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 10-K. Note 18 to the Financial Statements contain segment information.

Overview
We furnish engineering consulting and control system services to the petroleum refining, petrochemical, pipeline, production and processing industries. Our business consists of two segments: engineering and systems. Our engineering segment offers engineering consulting services to clients for the development, management and turnkey execution of engineering projects, construction management, inspection services, land management and environmental compliance services. Our systems segment designs, assembles, integrates and services control and instrumentation systems for specific applications in the energy and process related industries.

The Company's revenue is composed of engineering, construction and procurement service revenue and product sales. The Company recognizes service revenue as soon as the services are performed. The majority of the Company's engineering services have historically been provided through cost-plus contracts whereas a majority of the Company's product sales are earned on fixed-price contracts.

In the course of providing our services, we routinely provide engineering, materials, and equipment and may provide construction services on a subcontractor basis. Generally, these materials, equipment and subcontractor costs are passed through to our clients and reimbursed, along with fees, which in total are at margins lower than those of our normal core business. In accordance with industry practice and generally accepted accounting principles, all costs and fees are included in revenue. The use of subcontractor services can change significantly from project to project; therefore, changes in revenue may not be indicative of business trends.

For analytical purposes only, we have historically segregated from our total revenue the revenues derived from material assets or companies acquired during the first 12 months following their respective dates of acquisition and referred to such revenue as "Acquisition" revenue. We also segregate gross profits and SG&A expenses derived from material assets or company acquisitions on the same basis as we segregate revenues. We analyze, for internal purposes only, the percentage of our revenue that comes from staffing services versus the percentage that comes from engineering services, as engineering services have a higher margin than staffing services.

Operating SG&A expense includes management and staff compensation, office costs such as rents and utilities, depreciation, amortization, travel and other expenses generally unrelated to specific client contracts, but directly related to the support of a segment's operation.

Corporate SG&A expense is comprised primarily of marketing costs, as well as costs related to the executive, governance/investor relations, finance, accounting, safety, human resources, project controls and information technology departments and other costs generally unrelated to specific client projects, but which can vary as costs are incurred to support corporate activities and initiatives.

27

ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND
RESULTS OF OPERATION (Continued)

Results of Operations
The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated, certain financial data derived from our consolidated statements of operations and indicates the percentage of total revenue for each item.

Note: Previously, within the Systems Segment, ESI provided products and services supporting the advanced automation and integrated controls fields. In January 2006, EAG assumed responsibility for these services, which resulted in a move of this division of ESI to the Engineering Segment. Revenues and expenses have been reclassified between the segments to provide comparative results. Amounts will tie in total to prior reporting, however, individual segments will vary from prior reports.

                                                                            Years Ended December 31,
                                                     ------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                             2006                      2005                     2004
                                                     ---------------------     ---------------------    ---------------------
                                                        Amount       %           Amount        %           Amount       %
                                                     ------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                 (in thousands)
                                                     ------------------------------------------------------------------------
Revenue
    Engineering                                      $    261,389    86.3      $   207,368     88.8     $    124,362    83.5
    Systems                                                24,933     8.2           14,159      6.0           14,110     9.5
    Acquisition                                            16,768     5.5           12,058      5.2           10,416     7.0
                                                     ------------- -------     ------------  -------    ------------- -------
         Total revenue                               $    303,090   100.0      $   233,585    100.0     $    148,888   100.0
                                                     ============              ===========              ============

Gross profit
    Engineering                                      $     21,737     8.3      $    25,940     12.5     $     14,300    11.5
    Systems                                                 2,138     8.6            1,111      7.8            2,219    15.7
    Acquisition                                             2,389    14.2            1,222     10.1            1,673    16.1
                                                     ------------              -----------              ------------
         Total gross profit                          $     26,264     8.7      $    28,273     12.1     $     18,192    12.2
                                                     ============              ===========              ============

Selling, general and administrative
    Non-acquisition                                  $     28,211     9.9      $    18,863      8.5     $     11,866     8.6
    Acquisition                                             1,674    10.0              826      6.9            1,834    17.6
                                                     ------------              -----------              ------------
         Total                                       $     29,885     9.9      $    19,689      8.4     $     13,700     9.2
                                                     ============              ===========              ============

Net income (loss)                                    $     (3,486)   (1.2)     $     4,782      2.1     $      2,364     1.6
                                                     ============  =======     ===========   =======    ============= =======

Total revenue increased 29.8% or $69.5 million from 2005 to 2006.

Overall gross profit decreased 7.1%, or $2.0 million from 2005 to 2006.

Total SG&A expense increased 51.8%, or $10.2 million from 2005 to 2006.

Income from continuing operations decreased 172.9%, or $8.3 million from 2005 to 2006.

28

ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND
RESULTS OF OPERATION (Continued)

Year Ended December 31, 2006 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2005

Note: Previously, within the Systems Segment, ESI provided products and services supporting the advanced automation and integrated controls fields. In January 2006, EAG assumed responsibility for these services, which resulted in a move of this division of ESI to the Engineering Segment. Revenues and expenses have been reclassified between the segments to provide comparative results. Amounts will tie in total prior to reporting, however, individual segments will vary from prior reports.

Total Revenue

Engineering revenue accounted for 91.8% of our total revenue for the year, increasing $58.8 million from $219.4 million in 2005 to $278.2 million in 2006.

The increase in engineering revenue was primarily brought about by increased activity in the engineering and construction markets. Refining related activity has been particularly strong, including projects to satisfy environmental mandates, expand existing facilities and utilize heavier sour crude. Capital spending in the pipeline area is also trending higher, with numerous projects in North America currently underway to deliver crude oil, natural gas, petrochemicals and refined products. Renewable energy appears to be an emerging area of activity and potential growth, with the Company currently performing a variety of services for ethanol, biodiesel, coal to liquids, petroleum coke to ammonia, and other biomass processes. The acquisitions of WRC in the second quarter of 2006, together with our clients' increased demand for in-plant and inspection resources, stimulated growth in our staffing services division where revenues increased 90.6%, or $50.9 million, from $56.2 million in 2005 to $107.1 million in 2006.

Revenue from procurement services decreased 67.6%, or $40.2 million, from $59.5 million in 2005 to $19.3 million in 2006. This significant decrease is primarily related to three projects, two of which began in 2003 and one of which began in 2005 and were materially completed in 2006. The level of procurement services is expected to vary over time depending on the volume of procurement activity our customers choose to do themselves as opposed to using our services on larger EPC contracts.

In 2005, the Company was awarded two significant fixed-price engineering, procurement and construction ("EPC") projects in the refining industry that included procurement and subcontractor activities within our scope of work. This accounts for the higher level in that year. Together these two fixed-price EPC projects accounted for approximately $20.2 million of the engineering segment revenues during 2006 compared to approximately $1.8 million during 2005. The current combined contract value of these two projects is approximately $24.6 million and both are currently scheduled for completion by the end of the second quarter of 2007. As a result of revised estimates of the percentage of completion of these projects, the Company suffered a reversal of $6.6 million in the third quarter of 2006 and $7.1 million in the fourth quarter of 2006. Due to losses incurred in the execution of these contracts, we anticipate that we will enter into this type of contract only on a very limited basis, if at all.

The systems segment contributed 8.2% of our total revenue for the year, as its revenue increased $10.7 million, or 75.4%, from $14.2 million in 2005 to $24.9 million in revenue in 2006. A general turnaround in the oil and gas industry, together with the acquisition of ATI in January 2006 has increased the demand for ESI's services. Another factor positively affecting ESI's business is that the computer-based distributed control systems equipment used for facility plant automation becomes technologically obsolete over time, which supports ongoing replacement of these systems. Backlog for ESI at December 31, 2006 reached $10.0 million, compared to $9.1 million at December 31, 2005.

Gross Profit

Primarily due to losses on two EPC fixed-price contracts in our engineering segment, as discussed above, total gross profit decreased $2.0 million, or 7.1%, from $28.3 million in 2005 to $26.3 million in 2006 and, as a percentage of total revenue, decreased from 12.1% to 8.7% during the same period.

29

ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND
RESULTS OF OPERATION (Continued)

Due to the material financial impact of the losses on two significant fixed-price EPC projects* during 2006, the following "non-GAAP" proforma financial is being presented to demonstrate the performance of the historical core business within the Engineering segment.

        Non-GAAP Proforma                                 Years Ended December 31,
                                   ------------------------------------------------------------------------
      Financial Information                2006                      2005                     2004
                                   ---------------------     ---------------------    ---------------------
                                     Amount        %           Amount        %          Amount        %
                                   ------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                               (in thousands)
                                   ------------------------------------------------------------------------
Revenue
    Engineering - Actual           $   261,389               $    207,368              $   124,362
    Less fixed-price projects*          20,155                         -                        -
                                   -----------               ------------             ------------
    Engineering - Revised          $   241,234     85.3      $    207,368    88.8      $   124,362     83.5

    Systems                             24,933      8.8           14,159      6.0           14,110      9.5
    Acquisition                         16,768      5.9           12,058      5.2           10,416      7.0
                                   -----------   -------     ------------  -------    ------------  -------
         Total revenue             $   282,935    100.0      $    233,585   100.0     $    148,888    100.0
                                   ===========               ============             ============

Gross profit
    Engineering - Actual           $    21,737               $     25,940             $     14,300
    Less fixed-price projects*         (13,740 )                       -                        -
    Engineering - Revised          $    35,477     14.7      $     25,940    12.5     $     14,300     11.5

    Systems                              2,138      8.6            1,111      7.8            2,219     15.7
    Acquisition                          2,389     14.2            1,222     10.1            1,673     16.1
                                   -----------               ------------             ------------
         Total gross profit        $    40,004     14.1      $     28,273    12.1     $     18,192     12.2
                                   ===========               ============             ============

* Excluding revenues on two significant fixed-price EPC projects, our Engineering segment, exclusive of acquisition revenue, would have accounted for 85.3% of our total revenue for the year, increasing $33.8 million from $207.4 million in 2005 to $241.2 million in 2006, or an increase of 16.3%.

* Again, excluding the recorded losses on two significant fixed-price EPC projects, our Engineering segment, net of acquisition gross profit, would have reported a gross profit of $35.5 million, an increase of $9.6 million from $25.9 million in 2005, or an increase year-over-year of 37.1%. As a percentage of revenue, the proforma gross profit for our Engineering segment, exclusive of gross profit from acquisitions, would have increased by 17.6%, increasing from 12.5% in 2005 to 14.7% in 2006.

* Also, excluding the recorded losses on the two significant fixed-price EPC projects, our total gross profit would have increased $11.7 million from $28.3 million in 2005 to $40.0 million in 2006, or an increase year-over-year of 41.3%. As a percentage of revenue, total gross profit, again, excluding the recorded losses on two significant fixed-price EPC projects, would have increased 16.5%, increasing from 12.1% in 2005 to 14.1% in 2006.

Due to the significant losses on these two projects the Company plans to limit the size and scope of fixed-price EPC contracts in the future. Both of the significant fixed-price EPC projects are scheduled for completion by the end of the second quarter of 2007.

Also during the past year, the Company has shifted a portion of its services to developer type work for customers that are typically smaller than its historical customer base. The viability of these projects and the creditworthiness of these types of customers must be carefully analyzed to assure profitable results. In the future, the Company intends to analyze these projects much more carefully before accepting them.

The Company has also engaged in a number of entrepreneurial ventures over the past several years, not all of which have been profitable. In the future, the Company intends to scrutinize these projects much more carefully before engaging in them and exit them more quickly if they are not successful.

30

ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND
RESULTS OF OPERATION (Continued)

Gross profit from engineering, including the breakout of acquisitions, decreased $3.1 million, or 11.4%, from $27.2 million in 2005 to $24.1 million in 2006 and, as a percentage of revenue, decreased from 12.4% in 2005 to 8.7% in 2006 primarily due to estimated losses of approximately $13.7 million on two EPC fixed-price contracts. Both projects are currently scheduled for completion by the end of the second quarter of 2007.

The staffing services division , consisting of our in-plant staffing, land management and inspection operations, increased gross profit $7.4 million, or 113.8%, from $6.5 million in 2005 to $13.9 million in 2006.

We earn a lower margin on procurement services as compared to the margin we earn on our core engineering services. As an example, procurement services for 2005 produced a 1.7% gross profit margin. Comparably, in 2006 gross profit margin on core engineering services was 8.3%. Our level of procurement revenue has recently trended down, from $59.5 million or 25.5% of total revenue for 2005 to $19.3 million or 6.4% of total revenue for 2006.

Any shift from engineering only to EPC projects that include material procurement and construction responsibility will negatively impact engineering gross profit as a percentage of revenue. In this case, lower gross profit will occur because higher historical cost plus margins on engineering labor recognized during the period in which it was earned will now be combined with the lower margins on procurement services and construction subcontractor charges and recorded throughout the overall duration and completion of the projects.

At December 31, 2006, we had outstanding unapproved change orders/claims of approximately $17.4 million, net of reserves of $1.2 million associated with ongoing fixed-price EPC projects. If in the future we determine collection of the unapproved change orders/claims is not probable, it will result in a charge to earnings in the period such determination is made.

Gross profit for our systems segment increased $1.0 million, or 90.9%, from $1.1 million in 2005 to $2.1 million in 2006. However, as a percent of revenue, gross profit increased by 0.8% from 7.8% in 2005 to 8.6% in 2006.

Selling, General and Administrative ("SG&A") Expenses Selling, general and administrative expenses increased $10.2 million, or 51.8%, from $19.7 million in 2005 to $29.9 million in 2006, primarily due to increases in salaries and burdens, facilities and office expenses, amortization expense and travel. As a percent of revenue, SG&A increased 1.5% from 8.4% in 2005 to 9.9% in 2006.

Salaries and burden expenses increased $5.0 million in 2006 over 2005 of which $2.2 million of this increase was related to stock compensation expense recorded during the year. The Company did not record stock compensation expense during 2005, as the Company adopted SFAS No. 123R on January 1, 2006 (see Note 11). An additional $0.6 million of the increase was due to increases in corporate salaries, as employees were added, primarily in Business Development, Accounting and IT, to support Company growth. The remainder of the increase came from increases in operation salaries and burdens primarily due to increases in administrative staffing from acquisitions and EAG's continued growth during the year.

Facilities and office expenses increased $2.4 million in 2006 over 2005 due to the expansion of EEI's offices in Tulsa, Houston, and Beaumont to meet both current and projected growth requirements, plus the additional cost of facilities utilized by acquisitions made throughout the year.

Amortization expense increased approximately $700,000 primarily as a result of our completing the valuation of intangible assets acquired in acquisitions completed during 2006 (see Note 16).

31

ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND
RESULTS OF OPERATION (Continued)

Increased business development activity pushed marketing and travel expenses up by over $600,000 in 2006 over similar expenses in 2005.

Operating Profit

Operating profit decreased $12.2 million to $(3.6) million in 2006 as compared to $8.6 million in 2005, decreasing, as a percentage of total revenue, from 3.7% in 2005 to (1.2)% in 2006. This decrease was primarily the result of the Company's performance on two fixed-price contracts.

Other Income (Expense)

Other income increased from $116,000 in 2005 to $651,500 in 2006. The income in 2005 resulted from a legal settlement. The income in 2006 was derived from distributions from PEI Investments, insurance proceeds from Hurricane Rita losses, and income from the sale of assets, partially offset by a reclassification of financing costs.

32

ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND
RESULTS OF OPERATION (Continued)

Year Ended December 31, 2005 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2004

Note: Previously, within the Systems Segment, ESI provided products and services supporting the advanced automation and integrated controls fields. In January 2006, EAG assumed responsibility for these services, which resulted in a move of this division of ESI to the Engineering Segment. Revenues and expenses have been reclassified between the segments to provide comparative results. Amounts will tie in total to prior reporting, however, individual segments will vary from prior reports.

Total Revenue

Engineering revenue accounted for 94.0% of our total revenue for 2005, an increase of $84.6 million from $134.8 million in 2004 to $219.4 million in 2005.

The increase in engineering revenue was primarily brought about by increased activity in the engineering and construction markets. Refining related activity has been particularly strong, including projects to satisfy environmental mandates, expand existing facilities and utilize heavier sour crude. Acquisitions in the fourth quarter of 2004, together with our client's increased demand for in-house technical and inspection resources, stimulated growth in our staffing services division where revenues increased 54.4%, or $19.8 million, from $36.4 million in 2004 to $56.2 million in 2005.

Revenue from procurement services increased 55.8%, or $21.3 million, from 2004 to 2005 and contributed 25.7%, or $21.3 million, of the increase in total engineering revenue during the same period. The level of procurement services varies depending on the volume of procurement activity our customers choose to do themselves as opposed to using our services on the larger EPC contracts.

In 2005, the Company was awarded two significant fixed-price engineering, procurement and construction ("EPC") projects in the refining industry that includes procurement and subcontractor activities within our scope of work.

The systems segment contributed 6.0% of our total revenue for the year, as its revenue increased $0.1 million, or 0.7%, from $14.1 million in 2004 to $14.2 million in revenue in 2005. Projects from one major supplier of distributed control systems ("DCS") equipment, together with projects from a large engineering and construction firm, contributed most of the increase in revenue in 2005. The completion of turnkey remote instrument enclosures ("RIE's") from projects awarded in the fourth quarter of 2004 contributed $4.7 million to ESI's revenue in 2005.

Acquisition revenue, represented only 5.2% of total revenue for 2005, increased 16.3%, or $1.7 million, during the comparable periods, primarily from nine months of revenue generated in 2005 through acquisitions completed in the 4th quarter of 2004.

Gross Profit

Total gross profit increased $10.1 million, or 55.5%, from $18.2 million in 2004 to $28.3 million in 2005 although, as a percentage of total revenue, decreased slightly from 12.2% to 12.1% during the same period.

Gross profit from engineering increased $11.2 million, or 70.0%, from $16.0 million in 2004 to $27.2 million in 2005 and, as a percentage of revenue, increased from 11.5% in 2004 to 12.5% in 2005. Gross profit was negatively impacted by approximately $249,000 during 2005 due to start-up expenses and non-reimbursable proposal activity conducted by two of the Company's internal start-up initiatives, ENGlobal Sulfur Group and ENGlobal Automation Group. The staffing services division increased gross profit $2.2 million, or 51.2%, from $4.3 million in 2004 to $6.5 million in 2005 on margins remaining relatively stable over the comparable periods, although such margins are approximately 1% lower than average margins on all other engineering revenues.

33

ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND
RESULTS OF OPERATION (Continued)

We earn a lower margin on procurement services as compared to the margin we earn on our core engineering services. In 2005, $21.5 million, or 25.1% of the increase in our total revenue was from procurement services, providing a 1.7% gross profit margin. Comparably, gross profit margin on core engineering services was 12.1%. In 2004, procurement services produced a .4% gross profit margin. Due to the increase in procurement services in 2005 over 2004, our overall gross profit, as a percentage of total revenue, was negatively impacted by 4.0% and 3.6%, respectively.

Again, the shift to more fixed-price EPC type projects will negatively impact engineering gross profit as a percentage of revenue because higher historical cost plus margins on engineering labor recognized during the period in which it was earned will now be combined with the lower margins on procurement services and construction subcontractor charges and recorded throughout the overall duration and completion of the projects.

Gross profit for our systems segment decreased $1.1 million, or 50.0%, from $2.2 million in 2004 to $1.1 million in 2005. Also, as a percent of revenue, gross profit decreased by 7.9% from 15.7% in 2004 to 7.8% in 2005. The lower margin in 2005 is a result of several factors. The increase in the workload created a shortage in shop labor which was filled by hiring contract labor leading to inefficiencies and rework. This led to overruns in shop labor on projects, thus dropping margins below already tight budgeted margins. Secondly, with the increase in proposal work, estimates of material and labor cost were underestimated, thus causing lower profit margins. Lastly, market pressures drove down margins on projects overall. Corrective measures were taken during the first quarter of 2006 to replace all contract labor with more stable, direct-hire employees and additional staffing and systems within the estimating and proposal group should improve proposal pricing.

During the fourth quarter of 2005, ESI experienced delays in receiving major components for a project that were being supplied by a third party vendor. As a result, the work ESI expected to perform on such project during 2005 was completed in 2006, resulting in a corresponding delay in our recognition of revenues and profits.

Selling, General and Administrative ("SG&A") Expenses
Selling, general and administrative expenses increased $6.0 million, or 43.8%, from $13.7 million in 2004 to $19.7 million in 2005, primarily due to increases in salaries and burdens, facilities and office expenses, and travel. However, as a percent of revenue, SG&A decreased 0.8% from 9.2% in 2004 to 8.4% in 2005.

Salaries and burden expenses increased $3.6 million in 2005 over 2004. $1.0 million of this increase was related to additional incentives paid under the 2005 incentive plans. An additional $1.0 million of the increase was due to increases in corporate salaries, primarily in Business Development, Accounting and Project Controls, to support Company growth. The remainder of the increase came from increases in operation salaries and burdens primarily due to increases in administrative staffing from acquisitions, EAG's start-up during the year, ESI's expansion into the Beaumont area, and increases in their administrative support staffing in the Houston facility; plus additional overhead due to the growth of EEI's offices in Beaumont and Tulsa.

Facilities and office expenses increased $1.4 million in 2005 over 2004 due to the expansion of EEI's offices in Tulsa, Houston, Dallas, and Beaumont to meet both current and projected growth requirements, plus the additional cost of facilities utilized by acquisitions made in the fourth quarter of 2004.

Increased business development activity pushed marketing and travel expenses up by almost $500,000 in 2005 over similar expenses in 2004.

34

ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND
RESULTS OF OPERATION (Continued)

Operating Profit

Operating profit increased $4.1 million to $8.6 million in 2005 as compared to $4.5 million in 2004, increasing, as a percentage of total revenue, from 3.0% in 2004 to 3.7% in 2005. Although operating profit for 2005 exceeded operating profit for 2004, our net operating profit for the fourth quarter of 2005 was down approximately $1.2 million, or 39%, over third quarter operating results, primarily due to losses of approximately $659,000 in start-up expenses and non-reimbursable proposal activity conducted by two of the Company's internal start-up initiatives, ENGlobal Sulfur Group and EAG. For 2005, the combined operating loss for both groups was approximately $817,000.

Other Income (Expense)

Other income decreased from $118,000 in 2004 to $116,000 in 2005. The income in 2004 resulted from a legal settlement. The income in 2005 was derived from distributions from PEI Investments, insurance proceeds from Hurricane Rita losses, and income from the sale of assets, partially offset by a reclassification of financing costs.

Liquidity and Capital Resources
Historically, we have satisfied our cash requirements through operations and borrowings under a revolving credit facility. The Company's current credit facility is with Comerica Bank ("Comerica") and consists of a line of credit maturing July 26, 2009. The loan agreement positions Comerica as senior to all other debt. The line of credit is limited to $30.0 million subject to loan covenant restrictions. The Comerica Credit Facility is collateralized by substantially all the assets of the Company. As of December 31, 2006, the outstanding balance on the line of credit was $24.0 million and we had working capital of $35.2 million. Our total long-term debt outstanding on December 31, 2006 was $27.2 million (see Note 8), an increase from $5.2 million as of December 31, 2005. Under the terms and conditions of our revolving credit facility, as of December 31, 2006, we have additional borrowing capacity of approximately $6.0 million after consideration of borrowing base limitations with no letters of credit outstanding at December 31, 2006.

The following table summarizes our contractual obligations as of December 31, 2006:

                                                                         Payments Due by Period
                                            ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                               2007          2008          2009          2010        2011 and       Total
                                                                                                    thereafter
                                            ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------ ------------- ------------
                                                                             (in thousands)
                                            ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Long-term debt(1)                           $     4,747   $     3,683  $     27,140  $        441    $       -    $   36,011
Operating leases                                  4,366         2,754         2,165         1,938        1,423        12,646
                                            -----------   -----------  ------------  ------------    ---------    ----------
    Total contractual cash obligations      $     9,113   $     6,437  $     29,305  $      2,379    $   1,423    $   48,657
                                            ===========   ===========  ============  ============    =========    ==========

(1)Long-term debt includes future interest payments assuming the existing long-term debt and revolving credit facility remain outstanding with the interest rate in effect at December 31, 2006. The Company's interest rate on its revolving credit facility fluctuates with the prime rate.

Cash Flow
We believe that we have sufficient available cash required for operations for the next 12 months. However, cash and the availability of cash could be materially restricted if circumstances prevent the timely internal processing of invoices, if amounts billed are not collected or are not collected in a timely manner, if project mix shifts from cost reimbursable to fixed costs contracts during significant periods of growth, if the Company was to lose one or more of its major customers, if the Company experiences further costs overruns on fixed- price contract, or if we not able to meet the covenants of the Comerica Credit Facility. If any such event occurs, we would be forced to consider alternative financing options.

35

ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND
RESULTS OF OPERATION (Continued)

Operating Activities:
Operating activities required the use of $9.0 million, $0.9 million, and $2.4 million in net cash in 2006, 2005 and 2004, respectively. Though a decline in revenues would be likely to adversely impact our cash flow from operations, we believe that future cash flows, our ability to manage the timing of acquisitions, and our borrowing capacity under our line of credit will allow us to meet cash requirements in 2006 and beyond. Future uses of cash in operations will continue to be primarily for labor and material costs required in connection with contract performance.

The primary factors impacting the increase in our need for cash and the year-over-year increase in average accounts receivable days outstanding were:

1) a past due accounts receivable balance of approximately $3.7 million as of December 31, 2006 related to delays in receipts for services on the start-up of a major alliance agreement that began during the second quarter of this year;

2) a decrease in billings in excess of costs from approximately $3.8 million to $540,000 as of December 31, 2005 and 2006 respectively; and

3) an increase in costs and estimated earnings-in-excess of billings from approximately $4.1 million to $5.4 million as of December 31, 2005 and 2006, respectively.

Although the above factors are all within rights and restrictions of contractual terms and conditions within client contracts, we are taking measures to remediate each of these factors and at this time do not expect their impact to continue beyond the first quarter of 2007.

Investing Activities:
Investing activities used cash totaling $9.3 million in 2006, compared to $2.4 million in 2005 and $1.8 million in 2004. In 2006, our investing activities consisted of capital additions of $3.4 million primarily for computers and leasehold improvements to our offices and software implementations. In the fourth quarter, $500,000 was used to complete the acquisition of Watco Management, Inc. Future investing activities are anticipated to remain consistent with prior years and include capital additions for leasehold improvements, technical applications software, and equipment, such as upgrades to computers. On December 31, 2006, we amended our line of credit to permit an increase in annual capital expenditure limits from $3.25 million to $3.5 million.

Financing Activities:
Financing activities provided cash totaling $19.6 million, $3.5 million, and $4.2 million in 2006, 2005, and 2004, respectively. Our primary financing mechanism is our revolving line of credit. The line of credit has been used principally to finance acquisitions and accounts receivable. During 2006, our borrowings, on the line of credit were $143.8 million, and we repaid an aggregate of $123.6 million on our short-term and long-term bank and other debt.

Future cash flows from financing activities are anticipated to be borrowings, payments on the line of credit and payments on long-term debt instruments. Line of credit fluctuations are a function of timing related to operations, obligations and payments received on accounts receivable. Payments on long-term debt, including interest for the coming year, are estimated to be $4.7 million.

In 2006, non-cash transactions included $216,000 notes receivable issued for sale of assets and $3.9 million notes payable issued for acquisitions. Also in 2006, $1.4 million of stock was issued associated with the acquisition of WRC. There were no significant non-cash transactions in 2005. In 2004, non-cash transactions include $2.6 million notes payable issued related to acquisitions and $592,000 note payable issued for treasury stock. We also acquired insurance with notes payable of $1.3 million, $198,000, and $1.1 million in 2006, 2005, and 2004, respectively.

36

ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND
RESULTS OF OPERATION (Continued)

Due to significant losses incurred on two fixed-price projects during the third and fourth quarter, the Company requested and was successful in obtaining a waiver and subsequent amendment to its credit agreement with Comerica Bank in order to meet the monthly fixed charge ratio. If we had not been able to obtain a waiver or amendment of the covenant, we may have been unable to make further borrowings and may have been required to repay all loans then outstanding under the credit facility.

We do not hold any derivative financial instruments for trading purposes or otherwise. Furthermore, we have not engaged in energy or commodity trading activities and do not anticipate doing so in the future, nor do we have any transactions involving unconsolidated entities or special purpose entities.

Asset Management
We typically sell our products and services on short-term credit and seek to minimize our credit risk by performing credit checks and conducting our own collection efforts. Our trade accounts receivable increased to $60.2 million from $46.2 million as of December 31, 2006 and 2005, respectively. The number of days outstanding for trade accounts receivable increased from 59 days at December 31, 2005, to 62 days at December 31, 2006. Our actual bad debt expense has been approximately .03% and .01% of revenues for the years ending December 31, 2006 and 2005. We increased our allowance for doubtful accounts from $503,000 to $670,000 or 1.1% of trade accounts receivable balance for each of the years 2005 and 2006, respectively.

Risk Management
In performing services for our clients, we could potentially be liable for breach of contract, personal injury, property damage or negligence, including professional errors and omissions. We often agree to indemnify our clients for losses and expenses incurred as a result of our negligence and, in certain cases, the sole or concurrent negligence of our clients. Our quality control and assurance program includes a control function to establish standards and procedures for performance and for documentation of project tasks, and an assurance function to audit and to monitor compliance with procedures and quality standards. We maintain liability insurance for bodily injury and third-party property damage, professional errors and omissions, and workers compensation coverage, which we consider sufficient to insure against these risks, subject to self-insured amounts.

Seasonality
Holidays and employee vacations during our fourth quarter exert downward pressure on revenues for that quarter, which is only partially offset by the year-end efforts on the part of many clients to spend any remaining funds budgeted for engineering services or capital expenditures during the year. The annual budgeting and approval process under which these clients operate is normally not completed until after the beginning of each new-year, which can depress results for the first quarter. Principally due to these factors, our revenues during the first and fourth quarters generally tend to be lower than in the second and third quarters.

Critical Accounting Policies
Revenue Recognition
Because the majority of the Company's revenues are recognized under cost-plus contracts, significant estimates are generally not involved in determining revenue recognition. However, in 2006, the Company suffered reversals due to its failure to accurately estimate revenue recognition on our two significant fixed-price EPC contracts.

Most of our contracts are with Fortune 500 companies. As a result, collection risk is generally not a relevant factor in the recognition of revenue. However, timing of accounts receivable collections has resulted in a serious impact in the Company's liquidity. Also, the Company is engaging in more development contracts with smaller companies. We anticipate that collection risk will be a larger risk on these projects.

Our revenues are largely composed of engineering service revenue and product sales. The majority of our services are provided through time-and-material contracts (also referred to as cost-plus contracts), of which have not-to-exceed provisions that place a cap on the revenue that we may receive under a particular contract.

37

ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND
RESULTS OF OPERATION (Continued)

These time and material billings are produced every two weeks. Most of the contracts with not-to-exceed provisions are minor in nature.

On occasion, we serve as purchasing agent by procuring subcontractors, material and equipment on behalf of a client and passing the cost on to the client with no mark-up or profit. In accordance with Statement of Position ("SOP") 81-1, revenues and costs for these type purchases are not included in total revenues and costs. For financial reporting this "pass-through" type of transaction is reported net.

Profits and losses on fixed-fee contracts are recorded on the percentage-of-completion method of accounting, measured by the percentage-of-contract costs incurred to date to estimated total contract costs for each contract. Contract costs include amounts paid to subcontractors. Anticipated losses on uncompleted construction contracts are charged to operations as soon as such losses can be estimated. Changes in job performance, job conditions, estimated profitability and final contract settlements may result in revisions to costs and income and are recognized in the period in which the revisions are determined.

The asset, "costs and estimated earnings in excess of billings on uncompleted contracts," represents revenues recognized in excess of amounts billed on fixed-fee contracts. The liability "billings in excess of costs and estimated profits on uncompleted contracts" represents amounts billed in excess of revenues recognized on fixed-fee contracts.

Goodwill

A change in assumptions in the estimation of the fair market value of the segments would unlikely give rise to an impairment of goodwill without deteriorating operating results in the segments.

In conjunction with each acquisition, we must allocate the cost of the acquired entity to the assets and liabilities assumed based on their estimated fair values at the date of acquisition. As additional information becomes available, adjustments may be made to the original estimates within a short time subsequent to the acquisition. Goodwill is not amortized but instead is periodically assessed for impairment. The impairment testing entails estimating current market value of the segments, based on management's estimate of market conditions including pricing, demand, competition, operating costs and other factors. Determining the fair value of assets and liabilities acquired involves professional judgment and is ultimately based on management's assessment of the value of the assets acquired. We believe our estimates for these items are reasonable, but there is no assurance that actual amounts will not vary significantly from estimated amounts.

Change Orders

Change orders are modifications of an original contract that effectively change deliverables under a contract without adding new provisions. Either we or our clients may initiate change orders. Change orders may include changes in specifications or design, manner of performance, equipment, materials, scope of work, and/or the period of completion of the project.

Change orders occur when changes are experienced once a contract is begun. Change orders are sometimes documented and the terms of change orders are agreed with the client before the work is performed. Other times, circumstances may require that work progress without the client's written agreement before the work is performed. In those cases, we are taking a risk that the customer will not sign a change order or at a later time the customer will seek to negotiate the pricing of the additional work. Costs related to change orders are recognized when they are incurred. Change orders are included in the total estimated contract revenue when it is probable that the change orders will result in a bona fide addition to value that can be reliably estimated.

We have a favorable history of negotiating and collecting for work performed under change orders and our bi-weekly billing cycle has proven to be timely enough to properly account for change orders.

38

ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND
RESULTS OF OPERATION (Continued)

Recent Accounting Pronouncements
In September 2006, the FASB issued SFAS No. 157, "Fair Value Measurements." This statement establishes a framework for measuring fair value in generally accepted accounting principles and expands disclosures about fair value measurements. SFAS No. 157 is effective for financial statements issued for fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2007, and interim periods within those fiscal years. The provisions of SFAS No. 157 should be applied prospectively as of the beginning of the fiscal year in which SFAS No. 157 is initially applied, except in limited circumstances. The Company expects to adopt SFAS No. 157 beginning January 1, 2008. The Company is currently evaluating the impact that this interpretation may have on its consolidated financial statements.

In September 2006, the SEC released Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 108, "Considering the Effects of Prior Year Misstatements when Quantifying Misstatements in Current Year Financial Statements" (SAB No. 108), which provides interpretive guidance on how the effects of the carryover or reversal of prior year misstatements should be considered in quantifying a current year misstatement. The SEC staff believes that registrants should quantify errors using both a balance sheet and an income statement approach and evaluate whether either approach results in quantifying a misstatement that, when all relevant quantitative and qualitative factors are considered, is material. The provisions of SAB No. 108 are effective for the Company beginning in the first quarter of 2007. The Company does not expect any impact to its consolidated financial statements upon adoption of SAB No. 108.

In June 2006, FASB Interpretation (FIN) No. 48, "Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes", an interpretation of FASB Statement 109 Accounting for Income Taxes, was issued. FIN No. 48 describes accounting for uncertainty in income taxes, and includes a recognition threshold and measurement attribute for recognizing the effect of a tax position taken or expected to be taken in a tax return. FIN No. 48 is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2006. The Company adopted FIN No. 48 on January 1, 2007, and the Company expects that it will not have a material effect on the its' financial condition, results of operations, or cash flows.

In December 2004, SFAS No. 123 "Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation" was revised ("SFAS No. 123R"). SFAS No. 123R focuses primarily on accounting for transactions in which an entity obtains employee services in share-based payment transactions and requires that companies record compensation expense for employee stock option awards. SFAS No. 123R is effective for annual periods beginning after June 15, 2005. The Company adopted SFAS No, 123R on January 1, 2006 using the modified prospective method. See Note 11.

In March 2005, FASB Interpretation No. 47, "Accounting for Conditional Asset Retirement Obligations - An interpretation of FASB Statement No. 143", was issued. FIN No. 47 clarifies the term conditional asset retirement obligation as used in SFAS No. 143, "Accounting for Asset Retirement Obligations", and clarifies when an entity would have sufficient information to reasonably estimate the fair value of an asset retirement obligation. FIN No. 47 was effective for the year ended December 31, 2005, but did not have a material effect on the Company's financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.

In February 2006, the FASB issued SFAS No. 155, "Accounting for Certain Hybrid Financial Instruments - an amendment of FASB Statements No. 133 and 140". SFAS No. 155 amends SFAS No. 133, "Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities", and SFAS No. 140, "Accounting for Transfers and Servicing of Financial Assets and Extinguishments of Liabilities". This Statement also resolves issues addressed in Statement No. 133 Implementation Issue No. D1, "Application of Statement 133 to Beneficial Interests in Securitized Financial Assets." SFAS No. 155 permits fair value re-measurement for any hybrid financial instrument that contains an embedded derivative that otherwise would require bifurcation and clarifies which interest-only strips and principal-only strips are not subject to the requirements of SFAS No. 133. SFAS No. 140 is amended to eliminate the prohibition on a qualifying special-purpose entity from holding a derivative financial instrument that pertains to a beneficial interest other than another derivative financial instrument. SFAS No. 155 is effective for all financial instruments acquired or issued during fiscal years beginning after September 15, 2006. The Company does not expect this statement to have a material impact on its consolidated financial statements.

39

ITEM 7A. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

As of December 31, 2005 and 2004, the Company did not participate in any derivative financial instruments or other financial and commodity instruments for which fair value disclosure would be required under SFAS No
107. There are no investments at December 31, 2005. Accordingly, the Company has no quantitative information concerning the market risk of participating in such investments.

As of December 31, 2006 and 2005, the Company did not participate in any derivative financial instruments or other financial and commodity instruments for which fair value disclosure would be required under SFAS No. 133.

The Company's primary interest rate risk relates to its variable-rate line of credit debt obligation, which totaled $24.0 million and $3.8 million as of December 31, 2006 and 2005, respectively. Assuming a 10% increase in the interest rate on this variable-rate debt obligation (i.e., an increase from the actual average interest rate of 8.25% as of December 31, 2006, to an average interest rate of 9.08%, annual interest expense would have been approximately $115,000 higher in 2006 based on the annual average balance. The Company does not have any interest rate swap or exchange agreements.

The Company has no market risk exposure in the areas of interest rate risk from investments because the Company did not have an investment portfolio as of December 31, 2006.

Currently, the Company does not engage in foreign currency hedging activities. Transactions in Canadian dollars in our Canadian subsidiary have been translated into U.S. dollars using the current rate method, such that assets and liabilities are translated at the rates of exchange in effect at the balance sheet date and revenue and expenses are translated at the average rates of exchange during the appropriate fiscal period. As a result, the carrying value of the Company's investments in Canada is subject to the risk of foreign currency fluctuations. Additionally, any revenues received from the Company's international operations in other than U.S. dollars will be subject to foreign exchange risk.

ITEM 8. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA

The audited consolidated balance sheets for ENGlobal Corporation, as of December 31, 2006 and 2005 and statements of income, cash flows and stockholders' equity for the three-year period ended December 31, 2006, are attached hereto and made part hereof.

40

INDEX

Page

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
 ON INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING                           42

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
   ON CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS                                 44

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
     December 31, 2006 and 2005                                         45

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
     Years Ended December 31, 2006, 2005 and 2004                       46

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
     Years Ended December 31, 2006, 2005 and 2004                       47

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOW
     Years Ended December 31, 2006, 2005 and 2004                       48

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS                              50

SCHEDULE II
     Valuation and Qualifying Accounts                                  76

41

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM ON INTERNAL CONTROL
OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING

Board of Directors
Englobal Corporation
Houston, Texas

We were engaged to audit management's assessment included in the accompanying Management's Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting that ENGlobal Corporation and Subsidiaries (the "Company") did not maintain effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2006, because of the effect of material weaknesses described therein, based on criteria established in Internal Control -- Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission ("COSO"). The Company's management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting.

The scope of our audit of management's assessment and the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting was limited as a result of management's substantial delay in the performance of and delivery to us of its completed assessment. Specifically, we were provided substantially all of the documentation related to management's assessment subsequent to December 31, 2006 and, as a result, we were unable to obtain sufficient evidence that the controls were designed and operating effectively at December 31, 2006.

A material weakness is a significant deficiency, or combination of significant deficiencies, that results in more than a remote likelihood that a material misstatement of the annual or interim consolidated financial statements will not be prevented or detected. The following material weaknesses have been identified and included in management's assessment as of December 31, 2006:

1. Deficiencies in the Company's Control Environment. Our control environment did not sufficiently promote effective internal control over financial reporting throughout the organization. Specifically, the Company had a shortage of support and resources in our accounting department, which resulted in insufficient: (i) documentation and communication of our accounting policies and procedures; and (ii) internal audit processes of our accounting policies and procedures.

2. Deficiencies in the Company's Information Technology Access Controls. The Company did not maintain effective controls over preventing access by unauthorized personnel to end-user spreadsheets and other information technology programs and systems.

3. Deficiencies in the Company's Accounting System Controls. The Company did not effectively and accurately close the general ledger in a timely manner and we did not provide complete and accurate disclosure in our notes to financial statements, as required by generally accepted accounting principles.

4. Deficiencies in the Company's Controls Regarding Purchases and Expenditures. The Company did not maintain effective controls over the tracking of our commitments and actual expenditures with third-party subsidiaries on a timely basis.

5. Deficiencies in the Company's Controls Regarding Fixed-Price Contract Information. The Company did not maintain effective controls over the complete, accurate, and timely processing of information relating to the estimated cost of fixed-price contracts.

6. Deficiencies in the Company's Revenue Recognition Controls. The Company did not maintain effective policies and procedures relating to revenue recognition of fixed price contracts.

42

7. Deficiencies in the Company's Controls over Income Taxes. The Company did not maintain sufficient internal controls to ensure that amounts provided for in the financial statements for income taxes accurately reflected the Company's income tax position as of December 31, 2006.

8. Deficiency in Completing Management's Assessment of Internal Control over Financial Reporting in a Timely Manner. The Company did not meet the documentation and testing requirements under section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 as of December 31, 2006. As a result, management was unable to assess the effectiveness of the Company's internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2006 as required by the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 in sufficient time for an audit of management's assessment to be completed as of December 31, 2006.

These material weaknesses were considered in determining the nature, timing, and extent of the audit tests applied in our audit of the 2006 consolidated financial statements, and this report does not affect our report dated March 15, 2007 on those consolidated financial statements.

A company's internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of consolidated financial statements for external purposes in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. A company's internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company's assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

Since management failed to provide us with timely documentation of the Company's internal control over financial reporting and we were unable to apply other procedures to satisfy ourselves as to the effectiveness of the Company's internal control over financial reporting, the scope of our work was not sufficient to enable us to express, and we do not express, an opinion on either management's assessment or on the effectiveness of the Company's internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2006.

We do not express an opinion or any other form of assurance on management's statements referring to any and all remediation steps taken.

We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated balance sheets of ENGlobal Corporation and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2006 and 2005, and the related consolidated statements of operations, stockholders' equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the three year period ended December 31, 2006. Our report thereon dated March 15, 2007 expressed an unqualified opinion.

Hein & Associates LLP
Houston, Texas

March 15, 2007

43

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm on Consolidated Financial Statements

Board of Directors
ENGlobal Corporation
Houston, Texas

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of ENGlobal Corporation and subsidiaries (the"Company") as of December 31, 2006 and 2005, and the related consolidated statements of operations, stockholders' equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the three year period ended December 31, 2006. We have also audited the schedule listed in the accompanying Item 16. These consolidated financial statements and schedule are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements and schedule based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements and schedule are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the consolidated financial statements and schedule, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the consolidated financial statements and schedule. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of ENGlobal Corporation and subsidiaries at December 31, 2006 and 2005, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the years in the three year period ended December 31, 2006 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

Also, in our opinion, the schedule presents fairly, in all material respects, the information set forth, therein in relation to the financial statements taken as a whole.

We were also engaged to audit, in accordance with the standards of Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), management's assessment and the effectiveness of ENGlobal Corporation and subsidiaries internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2006, based on criteria established in Internal Control Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. Our report dated March 15, 2007, did not express an opinion on management's assessment and the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting.

As discussed in Note 11 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company adopted Statement of Accounting Standards No. 123 (revised 2004), "Share-Based Payment", during the year ended December 31, 2006.

Hein & Associates LLP
Houston, Texas
March 15, 2007

See accompanying notes to these consolidated financial statements.

44

                                                 ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

                                                      CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
                                                       DECEMBER 31, 2006 AND 2005


                                                             ASSETS
                                                             ------
Current Assets                                                                                      2006                2005
                                                                                               ---------------     ---------------
     Cash                                                                                      $    1,402,880      $      159,414
     Trade receivables, net                                                                        60,247,612          46,248,458
     Prepaid expenses and other current assets                                                      1,723,907           1,600,369
     Current portion of notes receivable                                                               52,031                   -
     Costs and estimated earnings in excess of billings on uncompleted contracts                    5,390,111           4,148,275
     Deferred tax asset                                                                             2,310,106             305,258
     Inventories                                                                                            -             153,968
     Federal income taxes receivable                                                                1,148,014              52,818
                                                                                               --------------      --------------
         Total Current Assets                                                                      72,274,661          52,668,560
Property and Equipment, net                                                                         8,724,902           6,861,361
Goodwill and Other Intangibles                                                                     19,202,197          15,454,583
Other Intangible Assets, net                                                                        5,426,824             413,596
Long term notes receivable, net of current portion                                                    129,105                   -
Non-current Deferred Tax Asset                                                                              -              74,892
Other Assets                                                                                          468,864             462,938
                                                                                               --------------      --------------

         Total Assets                                                                          $  106,226,553      $   75,935,930
                                                                                               ==============      ==============


                                                    LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
                                                    ------------------------------------
Current Liabilities
     Accounts payable                                                                          $   14,672,165          15,211,331
     Accrued compensation and benefits                                                             12,806,919           9,799,074
     Notes payable                                                                                  1,109,772                   -
     Current portion of long-term debt                                                              1,418,029             547,934
     Deferred rent                                                                                    678,583             361,292
     Billings in excess of costs and estimated earnings on uncompleted contracts                      539,910           3,775,625
     Other liabilities                                                                              5,862,634           1,148,079
                                                                                               --------------      --------------
         Total Current Liabilities                                                                 37,088,012          30,843,335
Long-Term Debt, net of current portion                                                             27,162,263           5,227,976
Deferred Tax Liability                                                                              1,114,224                   -
                                                                                               --------------      --------------

         Total Liabilities                                                                         65,364,499          36,071,311
                                                                                               --------------      --------------
Commitments and Contingencies (Notes 9, 10, 12, 16, 19 and 20)
Stockholders' Equity
     Common stock - $0.001 par value; 75,000,000 shares authorized; 26,807,460
        and 26,289,567 shares outstanding and 26,807,460 and 26,941,944 issued
        at December
        31, 2006 and 2005, respectively                                                                27,459              26,941
     Additional paid-in capital                                                                    31,147,343          27,230,332
     Retained earnings                                                                              9,717,354          13,203,208
     Treasury stock  - 0 and 652,377 shares at cost, at December 31, 2006 and 2005,
        respectively                                                                                        -            (592,231)
     Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)                                                    (30,102)             (3,631)
                                                                                               --------------      --------------

         Total Stockholders' Equity                                                                40,862,054          39,864,619
                                                                                               --------------      --------------

         Total Liabilities and Stockholders' Equity                                            $  106,226,553      $   75,935,930
                                                                                               ==============      ==============

                                      See accompanying notes to these consolidated financial statements.
                                                                  45

                                           ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

                                           CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS


                                                                                                 Years Ended December 31,
                                                                            -------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                2006                  2005                 2004
                                                                            -------------        -------------        -------------
Operating Revenues
     Engineering                                                            $ 278,157,053        $ 219,425,730        $ 134,778,281
     Systems                                                                   24,933,308           14,159,103           14,109,960
                                                                            -------------        -------------        -------------
         Total Revenue                                                        303,090,361          233,584,833          148,888,241
                                                                            -------------        -------------        -------------

Direct Costs
     Engineering                                                              254,031,157          192,263,673          118,804,896
     Systems                                                                   22,794,971           13,048,500           11,891,287
                                                                            -------------        -------------        -------------
         Total Direct Costs                                                   276,826,128          205,312,173          130,696,183

                                                                            -------------        -------------        -------------

Gross Profit                                                                   26,264,233           28,272,660           18,192,058

Selling, General, and Administrative Expenses                                  29,884,682           19,688,765           13,700,088
                                                                            -------------        -------------        -------------

Operating Income (Loss)                                                        (3,620,449)           8,583,895            4,491,970
     Interest Expense                                                          (1,311,794)            (800,072)            (590,227)
     Other income                                                                 632,880              114,538              118,409
                                                                            -------------        -------------        -------------
         Income (Loss) before Provision for Income Taxes                       (4,299,363)           7,898,361            4,020,152

Provision for Income Taxes                                                       (813,510)           3,115,980            1,655,763
                                                                            -------------        -------------        -------------

Net Income (Loss)                                                           $  (3,485,853)       $   4,782,381        $   2,364,389
                                                                            =============        =============        =============

Basic Earnings per Share                                                    $       (0.13)       $        0.20        $        0.10

Weighted Average Common Shares Outstanding for Basic                           26,538,290           24,300,114           23,454,545
                                                                            =============        =============        =============

Diluted Earnings per Share                                                  $       (0.13)       $        0.19        $        0.10

Weighted Average Common Shares Outstanding for Diluted                         26,538,290           25,250,487           23,785,939
                                                                            =============        =============        =============


                         See accompanying notes to these consolidated financial statements.
                                                          46

                                          ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
                                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
                                     FOR YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2006, 2005 AND 2004

                                                                           Accumulated
                                        Common Stock          Additional  Comprehensive                                    Total
                                   ----------------------      Paid-In     Translation      Retained      Treasury     Stockholders'
                                     Shares       Stock        Capital     Gain/(Loss)      Earnings        Stock         Equity
                                   ----------   ---------    ----------    -----------     -----------    ---------     ----------
BALANCES-DECEMBER 31, 2003         24,034,288      24,034    12,094,382              -       6,056,438            -      18,174,854
     Exercise of options               38,242          38        42,474              -               -            -         42,512
     Common stock purchased for
        treasury                     (652,377)          -             -              -               -     (592,231)     (592,231 )
     Common stock issued through
        employee stock purchase
        plan                           46,686          47        61,359              -               -            -         61,406
     Net income                             -           -             -              -       2,364,389            -      2,364,389
                                   ----------   ---------    ----------    -----------   -------------   ----------   ------------

BALANCES-DECEMBER 31, 2004         23,466,839      24,119     12,198,215             -       8,420,827     (592,231)    20,050,930
     Exercise of options              727,793         728     1,484,981              -               -            -      1,485,709
     Common stock issued through
       employee stock purchase
       plan                            94,935          94       231,044              -               -            -        231,138
     Common stock issued through
       private placement            2,000,000       2,000     13,071,092             -               -            -      13,073,092
     Tax benefit of non-qualified
       options exercised                    -           -       245,000              -               -            -        245,000
       Net income                           -           -             -              -       4,782,381            -      4,782,381
     Comprehensive income:
       Foreign currency
           translation adjustment           -           -             -         (3,631)              -            -         (3,631)
                                   ----------   ---------    ----------    -----------   -------------   ----------   ------------

BALANCES-DECEMBER 31, 2005         26,289,567   $  26,941   $27,230,332    $    (3,631)   $ 13,203,208     (592,231)   $ 39,864,619
     Exercise of options              329,273         329       729,580              -               -            -        729,909
     Shares issued at acquisition
       for WRC                        175,000         175     1,399,825              -               -            -      1,400,000
     Common stock issued through
       employee stock purchase
       plan                            13,620          14       102,954              -               -            -        102,968
     Common stock issued through
       private placement                    -           -       (40,000)             -               -                     (40,000)
     Stock based compensation               -           -     2,176,162              -               -                   2,176,162
     Treasury shares retirement                                (592,231)                             -      592,231              -
     Tax benefit of non-qualified
       options exercised                    -           -       140,721              -               -            -        140,721
       Net income                           -           -             -              -      (3,485,853)           -     (3,485,853)
                  Rounding
       difference                           -           -             -              -             (1)            -             (1)
     Comprehensive income:
       Foreign currency
           translation adjustment           -           -             -        (26,471)              -            -        (26,471)
                                   ----------    --------    ----------    -----------    ------------   ----------    -----------

BALANCES-DECEMBER 31, 2006         26,807,460    $ 27,459   $31,147,343    $   (30,102)   $  9,717,354            -    $ 40,862,054
                                   ==========    ========   ===========    ===========    ============   ==========    ===========


                                    See accompanying notes to these consolidated financial statements.
                                                                     47

                                           ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
                                           CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

                                                                                               Years Ended December 31,
                                                                                ---------------------------------------------------
                                                                                     2006               2005               2004
                                                                                -------------      -------------      -------------
Cash Flows from Operating Activities
     Net income (loss)                                                          $  (3,485,853)     $   4,782,381      $   2,364,389
     Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash
        provided by (used in) operating activities -
         Depreciation and amortization                                              3,369,244          1,836,376          1,246,532
         Stock based compensation                                                   2,176,162               --                 --
         Deferred income tax expense                                               (2,317,275)          (313,150)           254,000
         (Gain) Loss on disposal of property, plant and equipment                      42,315           (131,732)             2,564
     Changes in current assets and liabilities, net of acquisitions -
         Trade receivables                                                         (9,825,423)       (15,462,947)       (10,595,425)
         Inventories                                                                  153,968             18,747            (54,375)
         Costs and estimated earnings in excess of billings                        (1,244,902)        (2,980,859)           (90,604)
         Prepaid expenses and other assets                                            509,362            630,559            231,401
         Accounts payable                                                          (1,235,758)         4,699,207            691,093
         Accrued compensation and benefits                                          2,261,018          3,739,853          1,713,253
         Billings in excess of costs and estimated earnings                        (3,235,715)         1,461,670          1,939,616
         Other liabilities                                                          5,078,829            326,655            128,114
         Income taxes receivable (payable)                                         (1,198,936)           473,523           (221,610)
                                                                                -------------      -------------      -------------
              Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities                  (8,952,964)          (919,717)        (2,391,052)
                                                                                -------------      -------------      -------------
Cash Flows from Investing Activities
     Purchase of property and equipment                                            (3,405,141)        (3,229,925)        (1,195,588)
     Additional consideration for acquisitions                                           --              (26,368)          (625,000)
     Proceeds from insurance                                                           68,317               --                 --
     Partnership distributions                                                        350,000               --                 --
     Acquisitions of businesses, net of cash acquired                              (6,528,583)              --                 --
     Proceeds from sale of assets                                                     185,106             15,400              9,897
     Proceeds from sale of Thermaire                                                     --              823,350               --
                                                                                -------------      -------------      -------------
              Net cash used in investing activities                                (9,330,301)        (2,417,543)        (1,810,691)
                                                                                -------------      -------------      -------------
Cash Flows from Financing Activities
     Borrowings on line of credit                                                 143,820,724         92,151,545        134,571,349
     Payments on line of credit                                                  (123,631,669)      (101,907,187)      (126,597,915)
     Proceeds from issuance of common stock                                           933,598         15,034,940            103,918
     Proceeds from notes receivable                                                    38,119               --                 --
     Short-term borrowings (repayments)                                                  --           (1,037,399)        (1,071,885)
     Capital lease repayments                                                            --               (4,371)           (12,478)
     Long-term debt repayments                                                     (1,607,959)          (745,229)        (2,822,679)
                                                                                -------------      -------------      -------------
              Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities                  19,552,813          3,492,299          4,170,310

Effect of Exchange Rate Changes on Cash                                               (26,082)            (3,631)              --
                                                                                -------------      -------------      -------------
              Net Change in Cash and Cash Equivalents                               1,243,466            151,408            (31,433)
Cash and Cash Equivalents - beginning of year                                         159,414              8,006             39,439
                                                                                -------------      -------------      -------------
Cash and Cash Equivalents - end of year                                         $   1,402,880      $     159,414      $       8,006
                                                                                =============      =============      =============


                                       See accompanying notes to these consolidated financial statements.
                                                                       48

                                                 ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES


Supplemental Cash Flow Information                                                               Years Ended December 31,
                                                                                   ------------------------------------------------

                                                                                       2006               2005             2004
                                                                                   ------------        -----------      -----------
Non-Cash Transactions
     Issuance of note for insurance                                                   1,347,232            197,794         1,092,096
     Retirement of treasury stock                                                       592,231               --                --
     Acceptance of note for Constant Power assets                                      (216,000)              --                --
     Issuance of common stock for purchase of WRC Corporation                         1,400,000               --                --
     Acquisition of treasury stock with note payable                                       --                 --             592,231
         Issuance of note for ATI assets                                              1,000,000               --                --
         Issuance of note for purchase of WRC Corporation                             2,400,000               --                --
         Issuance of note for Watco assets                                              500,000               --                --
         Issuance of notes payable for assets of EDG, AmTech, CIS
   and Infotech                                                                            --                 --           2,575,000
Supplemental Cash Flow Information
     Cash paid during the year for -
         Interest                                                                   $   976,841        $   890,266       $   420,627
         State and federal income taxes                                               2,464,848          2,959,133         1,196,761
         Refund from state franchise taxes                                                 --               48,531              --




                                       See accompanying notes to these consolidated financial statements.
                                                                        49


ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 1 - BACKGROUND AND BASIS OF PRESENTATION

Basis of Presentation

Our consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Our Company consolidates all of its wholly-owned subsidiaries and all significant inter-company accounts and transactions have been eliminated in the consolidation.

Organization

Brief descriptions of the active companies included in the consolidated group follow:

ENGlobal Corporation ("ENGlobal") - our public holding company.

ENGlobal Corporate Services, Inc. ("ECS") - provides the corporate oversight function.

ENGlobal Engineering, Inc. ("EEI") - provides general engineering, construction and procurement services for industrial customers primarily in the United States with specialties in the areas of distributive control systems, power distribution, process design and process safety management.

ENGlobal Construction Resources, Inc. ("ECR") - provides pipeline inspection services to the oil and gas, utility and pipeline industries and turnaround, asset management, and start-up services for the petrochemical industry.

RPM Engineering, Inc. d/b/a ENGlobal Engineering, Inc. ("RPM") - provides engineering services primarily in southeast Louisiana.

ENGlobal Systems, Inc. ("ESI") - provides design, fabrication, installation, start-up, checkout and maintenance of specialized systems such as programmable logic controller (PLC) systems integration, supervisory controls and data acquisition (SCADA) and triple modular redundancy (TMR) systems, distribution control system (DCS), and analyzer systems.

ENGlobal Automation Group, Inc. ("EAG") - formerly ENGlobal Technologies, Inc. ("ETI") - provides service relating to the implementation of process controls, advanced automation, and information technology projects.

ENGlobal Technical Services, Inc. ("ETS") - formerly ENGlobal Design Group, Inc. ("EDG") - provides design, installation and maintenance of various government and public sector facilities, the most active sector being Automated Fuel Handling Systems serving the U.S. Military.

ENGlobal Canada, ULC - provides engineering services relating to the implementation of process controls, instrumentation, advanced automation and information technology projects.

WRC Corporation ("WRC") - primarily provides land management, right-of-way services, environmental compliance, and governmental regulatory services to pipeline, utility and telecom companies and other owner/operators of "infrastructure" facilities.

WRC Canada - provides land management and inspection services.

50

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 2 - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Cash

Cash includes cash in bank at December 31, 2006. The Company's banking system provides for daily replenishment of major bank accounts for check-clearing requirements. Accordingly, there were negative book balances of $2.7 million on December 31, 2006 and $2.0 million on December 31, 2005. Such balances result from outstanding checks that have not yet been paid by the bank and are reclassified to accounts payable in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets.

Revenue Recognition

The Company's revenue is composed of engineering, construction and procurement service revenue and product sales. The Company recognizes service revenue as soon as the services are performed. The majority of the Company's engineering services have historically been provided through cost-plus contracts whereas a majority of the Company's product sales are earned on fixed-fee contracts.

On occasion, the Company, serving as an agent for the client procures materials and equipment on behalf of the client and the cost of such materials and equipment is reimbursed with no mark-up or profit. In accordance with Statement of Position (SOP) 81-1, revenue and cost for these types of purchases are not included in total revenue and cost. For financial reporting, this "pass-through" type of transaction is reported net. During 2006 and 2005, pass-through transactions totaled $8.9 million and $20.6 million, respectively.

Profits and losses on fixed-fee contracts are recorded on the percentage-of-completion method of accounting, measured by the percentage-of-contract cost incurred to date relative to estimated total direct contract cost. Direct contract cost includes professional compensation and related benefits, materials, subcontractor services and other direct cost of projects. Any freight charges and inspection costs are directly charged to the project to which the charges relate. The cost recognized for labor includes all actual employee compensation plus a burden factor to cover estimated variable labor expenses for the year. These variable labor expenses consist of payroll taxes, self-insured medical plan expenses, workers compensation insurance, general liability insurance, and employee benefits for paid time off. The actual periodic cost for these expenses is adjusted at the end of each quarter to provide consistent cost recognition throughout the year.

Variable costs such as travel, repairs and maintenance, supplies and depreciation directly related to producing revenues are included in contract costs to arrive at gross profit.

Under the percentage-of-completion method, revenue recognition is dependent upon the accuracy of a variety of estimates, including the progress of engineering and design efforts, material installation, labor productivity, cost estimates and others. These estimates are based on various professional judgments made with respect to the factors noted and are difficult to accurately determine until projects are significantly underway. Due to uncertainties inherent to the estimation process, it is possible that actual completion costs may vary materially from estimates. Anticipated losses on uncompleted contracts are charged to operations as soon as such losses can be estimated. Changes in job performance, job conditions, estimated profitability and final contract settlements may result in revisions to costs and income and are recognized in the period in which the revisions are determined.

Selling, general and administrative cost includes management and staff compensation, office cost such as rents and utilities, depreciation, amortization, travel and other expenses that are unrelated to specific client contracts, but directly relate to the support of each segment's operations.

Occasionally, it is appropriate under SOP 81-1 to combine or segment contracts. Contracts are combined in those limited circumstances when they are negotiated as a package in the same economic environment with an overall profit margin objective and constitute, in essence, an agreement to do a single project. In such cases, we recognize revenue and cost over the performance period of the combined contracts as if they were one. Contracts may be segmented if the customer had the right to accept separate elements of a contract and the total economic returns and risks of the separate contract elements are similar to the economic returns and risks of the

51

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 2 - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Continued)

overall contract. For segmented contracts, we recognize revenue as if they were separate contracts over the performance periods of the individual elements or phases.

We have five major types of contracts:

Cost-Plus, Labor Plus Fixed Mark-up

Under cost-plus, labor plus fixed mark-up contracts, clients are charged based on actual labor rates plus a fixed mark-up that includes estimated recoverable direct and indirect cost and a profit component, which is applied as a percentage of the recoverable labor, to arrive at a total dollar estimate in negotiating a cost-plus, labor plus fixed mark-up contract. We recognize revenue based on a multiple of the actual total number of labor hours completed on a project multiplied by the actual labor rates and multiplied by the negotiated fixed mark-up percentage, plus other non-labor costs at cost plus a fixed mark-up that we negotiate at the time of contract award. Aggregate revenue from cost-plus, labor plus fixed mark-up contracts may vary in scope and we generally must obtain a change order in order to receive additional revenue relating to any additional costs that exceed the original contract estimate (see "Change Orders").

Cost-Plus, Fixed Labor Rate

Under cost-plus, fixed labor rate contracts, clients are charged based on fixed labor rates by work classification (Project Manager, Sr. Engineer, Designer, CADD Operator, etc.) whereby the fixed labor rate includes estimated recoverable direct and indirect cost plus a profit component. In negotiating cost-plus, fixed labor rate contracts the total dollar estimate is a multiple of the fixed labor rates times the recoverable work class labor man-hours estimated to complete the project. We recognize revenues based on a multiple of the fixed labor rates times the actual total number of labor hours completed on a project, plus other non-labor costs at cost plus a fixed rate negotiated at the time of contract award. Aggregate revenues from cost-plus, fixed labor rate contracts may vary in scope and we generally must obtain a change order in order to receive additional revenues relating to any additional cost that exceed the original contract estimate (see "Change Orders").

Cost-Plus, Not-To-Exceed

Under cost-plus, not-to-exceed contracts, clients are charged on the same basis as either cost-plus, labor plus fixed mark-up, or cost-plus fixed labor rate contracts. The contract is awarded with a set maximum aggregate revenue, referred to as the not-to-exceed amount. The Company does not earn revenue over the not-to-exceed amount unless we obtain a change order. The Company is not obligated to complete the contract once the not-to-exceed amount has been reached.

Fixed-Price

Under fixed-price contracts, clients are charged an agreed amount negotiated in advance of a specific scope of work, be it related to engineering, construction and procurement service revenue or product sales. We recognize revenue on fixed-price contracts using the percentage-of-completion method described above. Prior to completion, gross profit recognition on any fixed-price contract is dependent upon the accuracy of our estimates and will increase to the extent that current estimates of aggregate actual cost are below the amounts previously estimated. Conversely, if the Company's current estimated cost exceeds prior estimates, gross profit will decrease and we may realize a loss on a project. In order to increase aggregate revenue on a contract, we generally must obtain a change order to receive payment for additional cost (see "Change Orders").

Guaranteed Max

Under a guaranteed max contract, clients are charged on the same basis as either cost-plus, labor plus fixed markup or cost-plus fixed labor rate. The contract is awarded with a set maximum aggregate revenue amount referred to as the guaranteed max amount. The Company is required to complete the scope of contract even if they have reached the guaranteed max amount. Therefore, the Company recognizes revenue on guaranteed max contracts using the percentage of completion method described above and commonly treats them the same as fixed-price contracts. In order to

52

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 2 - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Continued)

increase aggregate revenue on a contract, we generally must obtain a change order to receive payment for additional cost (see "change orders").

Change Orders

Change orders are modifications of an original contract that effectively change the deliverables under the contract without adding new provisions. Either we or our clients may initiate change orders. Change orders may include changes in specifications or design, manner of performance, equipment, materials, scope of work and/or the period of completion of the project.

Change orders occur when changes are required or requested after work on a contract has begun. Change orders are documented and the terms of change orders are agreed with the client before the work is performed. Circumstances, at times, may require that work progress without the client's written agreement before the work is performed. Cost related to change orders is recognized when they are incurred. Change orders are included in the total estimated contract revenue when it is probable that the change orders will result in a bona fide addition to value that can be reliably estimated.

Inspection and Acceptance (Cost-plus Contracts)

Generally, other than on fixed-price contracts, clients inspect and accept work as executed based on designated milestones or billing cycles, although such acceptance does not waive the client's right to a claim under a warranty provision for work deficiencies that fail to meet industry standards.

Inspection and Acceptance (Fixed-Price Contracts)

Generally, clients inspect and accept work based on designated milestones, although such acceptance does not waive the client's right to a claim under a warranty provision for work deficiencies.

Contract Termination Provisions

Generally, our clients may terminate at any time and for any reason any part of the Company's project work by giving proper notice, specifying the part of the work to be terminated and the effective date of the termination. If any part of the work on a project is terminated, the client, with respect to such work, is required to reimburse the Company for all cost incurred prior to the effective date of termination and for all additional amounts that are directly related to the work performed. The client is required to issue a change order with respect to any termination.

Property and Equipment

All property and equipment is stated at cost, adjusted for accumulated depreciation. Depreciation is calculated using a straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the related assets. The useful life is estimated to be 3 years for computers and autos, 5 years for software, furniture and fixtures, 10 years for machinery and equipment, and 39 years for buildings. Leasehold improvements are amortized over the term of the related lease.

53

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 2 - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Continued)

Intangible Assets and Goodwill

Intangible assets is comprised of non-compete covenants and customer relationships acquired through acquisitions. As of December 31, 2006 and December 31, 2005, the cost and accumulated amortization of our intangible assets were as follows:

                                                          Non-Compete                     Customer
                                                           Covenants       Use of Name  Relationships     Total
                                                         -------------    ------------- ------------  -----------
     As of December 31, 2006
     Intangible assets                                   $       3,846    $        10   $      2,547  $     6,403
         Less: accumulated amortization                            704              6            266          976

                                                         -------------    -----------   ------------  -----------
         Intangible assets, net                          $       3,142    $         4   $      2,281  $     5,427
                                                         =============    ===========   ============  ===========

         As of December 31, 2005
         Intangible assets                               $         550    $        10   $          -  $       560
         Less: accumulated amortization                            142              4              -          146
                                                         -------------    -----------   ------------  -----------
         Intangible assets, net                          $         408    $         6   $          -  $       414
                                                         =============    ===========   ============  ===========


     Intangible assets are amortized using the straight-line method based on the
     estimated useful life of the intangible assets. Expected amortization
     expense of our amortizable intangible assets is as follows:

                                                           Non-Compete                   Customer
     Years Ending, December 31                              Covenants       Use of Name Relationships   Total
---------------------------------------------            --------------    ------------- ----------- ----------

         2007                                            $          683    $        2   $       457  $    1,142
         2008                                                       671             2           456       1,129
         2009                                                       650             -           456       1,106
         2010                                                       570             -           456       1,026
         2011                                                       568             -           456       1,024
                                                         --------------    ----------   -----------  ----------
                                                         $        3,142    $        4   $     2,281  $    5,427
                                                         ==============    ==========   ===========  ==========
         Weighted Average Amortization
         Period Remaining at December 31, 2006 (years)              4.8           2.0          5.0

Goodwill

In July 2001, the FASB issued SFAS No. 142, "Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets." SFAS 142 requires that goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite useful lives no longer be amortized, but instead tested for impairment at least annually. SFAS 142 also requires that intangible assets with estimable useful lives be amortized over their respective estimated useful lives to their estimated residual values and reviewed for impairment in accordance with SFAS No. 144, "Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets."

54

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 2 - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Continued)

The Company adopted SFAS 142 effective January 1, 2002. Upon adoption, the Company tested goodwill for impairment at January 1, 2002 according to the provisions of SFAS 142, which resulted in no impairment identified. The Company tested goodwill for impairment at December 31, 2005 and 2006 resulting in no impairment of goodwill.

In 2004, acquisitions of assets of several companies resulted in an increase of $1,725,000 to goodwill. Acquisitions of the assets of Engineering Design Group, Inc. ("EDGI"), InfoTech, and Cleveland Inspection Services, Inc. ("CIS") resulted in increases to goodwill of $139,000, $270,000 and $1,316,000, respectively. In 2005, goodwill increased $170,000 primarily from earn-outs related to acquisitions. In 2006, goodwill increased $3.0 million primarily from the deferred tax benefit realized on acquisitions of WRC plus additional earn-outs related to acquisitions.

Long-lived Assets

The Company reviews long-lived assets and certain identifiable intangible assets for impairment annually or whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset may not be recoverable. An impairment loss would be recognized when estimated future cash flows expected to result from the use of the asset and its eventual disposition is less than its carrying amount. The Company has not identified any such impairment losses.

Software Development Costs

Under the provisions of SOP-98-1 ENGlobal capitalizes costs associated with software developed or obtained for internal use when both the preliminary project stage is completed and when management authorizes funding for the project which is deemed probable of completion. Costs include 1) external direct costs of materials and services incurred in obtaining and developing the software, and 2) payroll and payroll related costs for employees who are directly associated with and devote time to the project. Capitalization of these costs ceases no later than the point at which the project is substantially complete and ready for its intended use. At that time, the costs are reclassified to fixed assets. Amortization of such costs is provided on the straight-line basis over 5 years.

Income Taxes

The Company accounts for deferred income taxes in accordance with the asset and liability method, whereby deferred income taxes are recognized for the tax consequences of temporary differences by applying enacted statutory tax rates applicable to future years to differences between the financial statement and tax bases of its existing assets and liabilities. The provision for income taxes represents the current tax payable or refundable for the period plus or minus the tax effect of the net change in the deferred tax assets and liabilities during the period.

In June 2006, FASB Interpretation (FIN) No. 48, "Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes", an interpretation of FASB Statement 109 Accounting for Income Taxes, was issued. FIN No. 48 describes accounting for uncertainty in income taxes, and includes a recognition threshold and measurement attribute for recognizing the effect of a tax position taken or expected to be taken in a tax return. FIN No. 48 is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2006. The Company adopted FIN No. 48 on January 1, 2007, and will not have a material effect on the Company's financial condition, results of operations, or cash flows.

Stock Based Compensation

The Company currently sponsors a stock-based compensation plan as described below. Effective January 1, 2006, the Company adopted the provisions of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards ("SFAS") No. 123 (Revised), "Share-Based Payment" ("SFAS No. 123(R)"). Under the fair value recognition provisions of SFAS No. 123 (R), stock-based compensation is measured at the grant date based on the value of the awards and is recognized as expense over the requisite service period (usually a vesting period). The Company selected the modified prospective method of adoption described in SFAS No.
123(R). The fair values of the stock awards recognized under SFAS No. 123(R) are determined based on the vested portion of the awards; however, the total compensation expense is recognized on a straight-line basis over the vesting period.

55

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 2 - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Continued)

Prior to January 1, 2006, the Company accounted for stock-based compensation using the intrinsic value method prescribed in Accounting Principles Board ("APB") Opinion No. 25, "Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees," and related interpretations. Under APB Opinion No. 25, no compensation expense was recognized for stock options issued to employees because the grant price equaled, or was above, the market price on the date of grant for options issued by the Company.

Earnings Per Share
Earnings per share was computed as follows:

                                                            Reconciliation of Earnings per Share Calculation
                                            ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                      2006                       2005                        2004
                                            -------------------------- --------------------------  --------------------------
                                               Basic        Diluted       Basic        Diluted        Basic        Diluted
                                            ------------  ------------ ------------- ------------  ------------  ------------
Net Income (Loss)                           $ (3,485,853)  $(3,485,853) $ 4,782,381   $ 4,782,381   $ 2,364,389   $ 2,364,389
                                            ============   ===========  ============  ===========   ===========   ===========
Weighted average number of shares
   outstanding for basic                      26,538,290                 24,300,114                  23,454,545
Weighted average number of shares
   outstanding for diluted                                  26,538,290                 25,250,487                  23,785,939
Net income (loss) per share available
   for common stock
    Net Income (Loss)                       $      (0.13)        (0.13) $      0.20   $      0.19   $      0.10   $      0.10

Diluted earnings per share are computed including the impact of all
potentially dilutive securities. The following table sets forth the shares
outstanding for the earnings per share calculations for the years ended
December 31, 2006, 2005 and 2004.

                                                                         2006                 2005                 2004
                                                                   -----------------    -----------------    ----------------
Common stock issued - beginning of year                                  26,289,567           23,466,839          24,034,288
Weighted average common stock issued (repurchased)                          248,723              833,275            (579,743)
                                                                   ----------------     ----------------     ---------------
    Shares used in computing basic earnings per share                    26,538,290           24,300,114          23,454,545
Assumed conversion of dilutive stock options                                      -              950,373             331,394
                                                                   ----------------     ----------------     ---------------
Shares used in computing diluted earnings per share                      26,538,290           25,250,487          23,785,939
                                                                   ================     ================     ===============

Use of Estimates

The preparation of the Company's consolidated financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America requires the Company's management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported in these financial statements and accompanying results. Actual results could differ from these estimates.

Fair Value of Financial Instruments

The fair value of financial instruments, primarily accounts receivable, notes receivable and accounts payable, closely approximate the carrying values of the instruments due to the short-term maturities of such instruments. Based on the borrowing rate currently available to the Company for loans with similar terms, we believe the fair value of the long-term obligations approximate their carrying value.

56

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 2 - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Continued)

Comprehensive Income

Comprehensive income is defined as all changes in stockholders' equity, exclusive of transactions with owners, such as capital investments. Comprehensive income includes net income or loss, changes in certain assets and liabilities that are reported directly in equity, such as translation adjustments on investments in foreign subsidiaries, and certain changes in minimum pension liabilities. The cumulative translation adjustment is included in accumulated other comprehensive income. (See Note 4)

Reclassifications

Amounts in prior years' financial statements are reclassified as necessary to conform to the current year's presentation. Such reclassifications had no effect on net income.

NOTE 3 - RECENT ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS

In September 2006, the FASB issued SFAS No. 157, "Fair Value Measurements." This statement establishes a framework for measuring fair value in generally accepted accounting principles and expands disclosures about fair value measurements. SFAS No. 157 is effective for financial statements issued for fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2007, and interim periods within those fiscal years. The provisions of SFAS No. 157 should be applied prospectively as of the beginning of the fiscal year in which SFAS No. 157 is initially applied, except in limited circumstances. The Company expects to adopt SFAS No. 157 beginning January 1, 2008. The Company is currently evaluating the impact that this interpretation may have on its consolidated financial statements.

In September 2006, the SEC released Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 108, "Considering the Effects of Prior Year Misstatements when Quantifying Misstatements in Current Year Financial Statements" (SAB No. 108), which provides interpretive guidance on how the effects of the carryover or reversal of prior year misstatements should be considered in quantifying a current year misstatement. The SEC staff believes that registrants should quantify errors using both a balance sheet and an income statement approach and evaluate whether either approach results in quantifying a misstatement that, when all relevant quantitative and qualitative factors are considered, is material. The provisions of SAB No. 108 are effective for the Company beginning in the first quarter of 2007. The Company does not expect any impact to its consolidated financial statements upon adoption of SAB No. 108.

In June 2006, FASB Interpretation (FIN) No. 48, "Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes", an interpretation of FASB Statement 109 Accounting for Income Taxes, was issued. FIN No. 48 describes accounting for uncertainty in income taxes, and includes a recognition threshold and measurement attribute for recognizing the effect of a tax position taken or expected to be taken in a tax return. FIN No. 48 is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2006. The Company is in the process of assessing the impact on its financial statements, but does not expect any material impact on the Company's financial condition, results of operations, or cash flows.

In December 2004, SFAS No. 123 "Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation" was revised ("SFAS No. 123R"). SFAS No. 123R focuses primarily on accounting for transactions in which an entity obtains employee services in share-based payment transactions and requires that companies record compensation expense for employee stock option awards. SFAS No. 123R is effective for annual periods beginning after June 15, 2005. The Company adopted SFAS No, 123R on January 1, 2006 using the modified prospective method. See Note 11.

In March 2005, FASB Interpretation No. 47, "Accounting for Conditional Asset Retirement Obligations - An interpretation of FASB Statement No. 143", was issued. FIN No. 47 clarifies the term conditional asset retirement obligation as used in SFAS No. 143, "Accounting for Asset Retirement Obligations", and clarifies when an entity would have sufficient information to reasonably estimate the fair value of an asset retirement obligation. FIN No. 47 was effective for the year ended December 31, 2005, but did not have a material effect on the Company's financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.

57

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 3 - RECENT ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS (Continued)

In February 2006, the FASB issued SFAS No. 155, "Accounting for Certain Hybrid Financial Instruments - an amendment of FASB Statements No. 133 and 140". SFAS No. 155 amends SFAS No. 133, "Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities", and SFAS No. 140, "Accounting for Transfers and Servicing of Financial Assets and Extinguishments of Liabilities". This Statement also resolves issues addressed in Statement No. 133 Implementation Issue No. D1, "Application of Statement 133 to Beneficial Interests in Securitized Financial Assets." SFAS No. 155 permits fair value remeasurement for any hybrid financial instrument that contains an embedded derivative that otherwise would require bifurcation and clarifies which interest-only strips and principal-only strips are not subject to the requirements of SFAS No. 133. SFAS No. 140 is amended to eliminate the prohibition on a qualifying special-purpose entity from holding a derivative financial instrument that pertains to a beneficial interest other than another derivative financial instrument. SFAS No. 155 is effective for all financial instruments acquired or issued during fiscal years beginning after September 15, 2006. The Company does not expect this statement to have a material impact on its consolidated financial statements.

NOTE 4 - COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)

Comprehensive income (loss) represents net earnings (loss) and any revenue, expenses, gains and losses that, under accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America, are excluded from net earnings (loss) and recognized directly as a component of stockholders' equity.

Accumulated other comprehensive income is as follows:

                                                                                             2006         2005         2004
                                                                                          ----------   ----------    ---------
                                                                                                       (in thousands)
                                                                                          -------------------------------------
              Net income (loss) Before Foreign Currency Translation                          (3,486)   $   4,782     $    2,364
                  Other comprehensive income:                                                     -           -              -
                  Foreign Currency Translation Adjustment                                       (26)          (4)            -
                                                                                          ---------    ---------     ----------
              Comprehensive Income (Loss)                                                    (3,512)   $   4,778     $    2,364
                                                                                          =========    =========     ==========

NOTE 5 - PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT

     Property and equipment consisted of the following at December 31, 2006 and 2005:

                                                                                           2006          2005
                                                                                         ---------      ---------
                                                                                                 (in thousands)
                                                                                         -------------------------
              Land                                                                       $     418      $      202
              Building                                                                        1,331          1,359
              Computer equipment and software                                                 9,048          6,374
              Shop equipment                                                                  1,093            904
              Furniture and fixtures                                                            628            477
              Building and leasehold improvement                                              2,018          1,561
              Autos and trucks                                                                  260            191
                                                                                         ----------     ----------
                                                                                             14,796         11,068
              Accumulated depreciation and amortization                                      (6,536)        (4,254)
                                                                                         ----------     ----------
                                                                                              8,260          6,814
              Project controls and software upgrade in process                                  465             47
                                                                                         ----------     ----------
                  Property and equipment, net                                            $    8,725     $     6,861
                                                                                         ==========     ==========

58

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 6 - DETAIL OF CERTAIN BALANCE SHEET ACCOUNTS

     The components of trade receivables as of December 31, 2006 and 2005 are as follows:

                                                                                          2006                   2005
                                                                                        --------               --------
                                                                                                (in thousands)
                                                                                        -------------------------------
              Amounts billed                                                            $ 43,655               $ 28,964
              Amounts billable
                billed January of the following year                                      15,689                 16,523
              Retainage                                                                    1,573                  1,265
              Less: Allowance for uncollectible accounts                                    (670)                  (503)
                                                                                        --------               --------
                  Trade receivables, net                                                $ 60,247               $ 46,249
                                                                                        ========               ========

     The components of other liabilities as of December 31, 2006 and 2005 are as follows:

                                                                                            2006             2005
                                                                                         ------------     ------------
                                                                                                (in thousands)
                                                                                         -----------------------------
              Reserve for known contingencies                                            $ 4,724                  $  --
              Accrued interest                                                               297                     144
              Federal and State Taxes Payable                                                510                     408
              Other                                                                          332                     596
                                                                                          ------                  ------
                  Other liabilities                                                       $5,863                  $1,148
                                                                                          ======                  ======

NOTE 7 - FIXED-PRICE CONTRACTS

     Costs, estimated earnings and billings on uncompleted contracts consisted of the following at December 31, 2006 and 2005:

                                                                                           2006                 2005
                                                                                         --------             --------
                                                                                                (in thousands)
                                                                                         -----------------------------
Costs incurred on uncompleted contracts                                                  $ 75,317             $ 23,426
              Estimated earnings (losses) on uncompleted contracts                         (7,390)               4,437
                                                                                         --------             --------
              Earned revenues                                                              67,927               27,863
              Less:  Billings to date                                                      63,077               27,490
                                                                                         --------             --------
                  Net costs and estimated earnings in excess of
                     billings on uncompleted contracts                                   $  4,850             $    373
                                                                                         ========             ========

              Costs and estimated earnings in excess of
                billings on uncompleted contracts                                        $  5,390             $  4,148
              Billings in excess of costs and estimated
                earnings on uncompleted contracts                                            (540)              (3,775
                                                                                         --------             --------
                  Net costs and estimated earnings in excess of
                     billings on uncompleted contracts                                   $  4,850             $    373
                                                                                         ========             ========

59

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 8 - LINE OF CREDIT AND DEBT

The Company has a Credit Facility with Comerica Bank ("Comerica"). Effective July 27, 2006, the Company and Comerica entered into an amendment to the Company's existing Credit Facility (the "Comerica Credit Facility"). The maturity date of the Comerica Credit Facility was extended to July 26, 2009 and the limit on the revolving note was increased from $22 million to $30 million, subject to loan covenant restrictions. The Comerica Credit Facility is collateralized by substantially all the assets of the Company. The outstanding balance on the line of credit as of December 31, 2006 and 2005 was $24.0 million and $3.8 million, respectively. At the election of the Company, the interest rate will be the lesser of prime or a three tiered Eurodollar rate, plus 150, 175, or 200 basis points, respectively, based on the ratio of total funded debt to EBITDA for the trailing 12 months, of less than 2.00, between 2.00 and 2.50, and greater than 2.50, respectively. The commitment fee on the unused line of credit is 0.250%. The remaining borrowings available under the line of credit as of December 31, 2006 and 2005, respectively, were $6.0 and $12.0 million after consideration of loan covenant restrictions.

The Comerica Credit Facility contains covenants requiring the Company, as of the end of each calendar month, to maintain certain ratios, including total average funded debt to EBITDA; total average funded debt to total liabilities, plus net worth; and total funded debt to accounts/unbilled receivables. The Company is also required, as of the end of each quarter, to maintain minimum levels of net worth, and the Company must comply with an annual limitation on capital expenditures. Due to additional losses incurred on two fixed-price projects during the fourth quarter, the Company requested and was successful in obtaining a waiver and subsequent amendment to its credit agreement with Comerica Bank in order to meet the monthly fixed charge ratio. The Company was in compliance with all covenants under the Comerica Credit Facility as of December 31, 2006.

Letters of credit
As of December 31, 2006, the Company had no standby letters of credit outstanding. Standby letters of credit had previously been issued to a refining client to cover contractual obligations funded by the client for progress payments made to equipment manufacturers for major project items. That contractual obligation expired in August 2006.

60

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 8 - LINE OF CREDIT AND DEBT (Continued)

Long-term debt consisted of the following at December 31, 2006 and 2005:

                                                                                    2006            2005
                                                                                 ----------      ----------
                                                                                        (in thousands)
                                                                                 --------------------------
Comerica Credit Facility - Line of credit, prime (8.25% at December 31,          $   23,963      $    3,774
   2006), maturing in July 2009
The following notes are subordinate to the credit facility and are
   unsecured:
     Sterling Planet and EDGI - Notes payable, interest at 5%,
       principal payment installments of $15,000 plus interest due
       quarterly, maturing
       in December 2008                                                                 120             195
     Significant PEI Shareholders (See Note 19)                                           -             188
     Cleveland Inspection Services, Inc., CIS Technical Services and
       F.D. Curtis - Notes payable, discounted at 5% interest,
       principal in installments of $100,000 due quarterly,
       maturing in October 2009                                                       1,109           1,444
     InfoTech Engineering, Inc. - Note payable, interest at 5%, principal
       payments in installments of $65,000 plus interest due annually,
       maturing in December 2007                                                         75             130
     ATI Technologies - Note payable, interest at 6%, principal payments in
       installments of $30,422 including interest due monthly, maturing in
       January 2009                                                                     713               -
     Michael Lee - Note payable, interest at 5%, principal payments in
       installments of $150,000 plus interest due quarterly, maturing in July
       2010                                                                           2,100               -
     Watco Management, Inc. - Note payable, interest at 4%, principal
       payments in installments of $137,745 including interest annually,
       maturing in October 2010                                                         500               -
     Miscellaneous                                                                        -              45
                                                                                 ----------      ----------

         Total long-term debt                                                        28,580           5,776

         Less:  Current maturities                                                   (1,418)           (548)
                                                                                 ----------      ----------

         Long-term debt, net of current portion                                  $   27,162      $    5,228
                                                                                 ==========      ==========

Maturities of long-term debt as of December 31, 2006, are as follows:

Maturities

(in thousands)
Years Ending December 31,

2007                                        $    1,418
2008                                             1,535
2009                                            25,109
2010                                               432
                                            ----------
    Total long-term debt                     $  28,580
                                            ==========

61

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 9 - OPERATING LEASES

The Company leases equipment and office space under long-term operating lease agreements.

The future minimum rental payments on operating leases (with initial or remaining non-cancelable terms in excess of one year) as of December 31, 2006 are as follows:

                                           Operating
                                          ------------
                                              (in
                                            thousands)
                                          ------------
Years Ending December 31,
    2007                                  $    4,366
    2008                                       2,754
    2009                                       2,165
    2010                                       1,938
    2011 and after                             1,423
                                          ----------
        Total minimum lease payments      $   12,646
                                          ==========

Rent expense for the years ended December 31, 2006, 2005 and 2004 was $5,502,000, $2,167,000 and $1,754,000, respectively.

NOTE 10 - EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS

The Company sponsors a 401(k) profit sharing plan for its employees. Effective October 1, 2005, the Company amended the Plan to implement a mandatory matching contribution equal to 25% of employee contributions up to 4% of employee compensation for non-regular employees. For regular employees, the Company makes mandatory matching contributions equal to 50% of employee contributions up to 4% of employee compensation. The Company, as determined by the Board of Directors, may make other discretionary contributions. The employees may elect to make contributions pursuant to a salary reduction agreement upon meeting age and length-of-service requirements. The Company made contributions of approximately $1,310,000, $401,000, and $221,000, respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2006, 2005, and 2004. Effective April 1, 2006, the Company increased its matching contributions to the ENGlobal Corporation 401(k) Plan equal to 50% of regular employee contributions up to 6% of employee compensation, and all other employees will be matched at 33.33% of employee contribution up to 6% of compensation, as defined.

On June 17, 2004, ENGlobal shareholders ratified the Company's adoption of the 2004 Employee Stock Purchase Plan ("Plan"). Beginning April 2004, the Company provided eligible employees with the opportunity and a convenient means to purchase shares of the Company's common stock as an incentive to exert maximum efforts for the success of the Company. ENGlobal intended that options to purchase stock granted under the Plan would qualify as options granted under an "employee stock purchase plan" as defined in
Section 423(b) of the Code. The Plan was construed so as to be consistent with Section 423 of the Code, including Section 423(b)(5) which requires that all participants have the same rights and privileges with respect to options granted under the Plan. The cash deferred by participants into the plan, although not significant, was used to meet the Company's cash requirements or was applied to the reduction of the Company's long-term debt. Because of requirements of SFAS 123(R), and probable reduction of benefits that would result, the Company elected to terminate the Plan effective December 31, 2005.

62

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 11 - STOCK OPTION PLAN

The Company has an incentive plan that provides for the issuance of options to acquire up to 2,650,000 shares of common stock. The incentive plan ("Option Plan") provides for grants of non-statutory options, incentive stock options, restricted stock awards and stock appreciation rights. All stock option grants are for a ten-year term. Stock options issued to executives and management generally vest over a four-year period; one-fifth at grant date and one-fifth at December 31 of each year until they are fully vested. Stock options issued to directors vest one-half on grant date and the remaining half upon the first anniversary of grant date. In 2006 one grant was issued fully vested following termination of a series under which the employee held a similar amount of shares. All stock options grants are issued at the market value of the Company's stock on the date of the grant.

Effective January 1, 2006, the Company adopted SFAS No. 123(R). This statement requires compensation expense relating to share-based payments to be recognized in net income using a fair-value measurement method. Under the fair value method, the estimated fair value of awards is charged over the requisite service period, which is generally the vesting period. The Company elected the modified prospective method as prescribed in SFAS No. 123(R) and therefore, prior periods were not restated. Under the modified prospective method, this statement was applied to new awards granted after the time of adoption.

Options Granted in 2006 Fair Values, Assumptions, and Impact on Net Income
--------------------------------------- --------------------- --------------------- ---------------------- -----------------------
                                                                                                                         Weighted
                                                                                                                          Average
Series                                            $    11.97             $    9.15              $    6.83              Fair Value
                                        ---------------------    ------------------        ---------------       ----------------
Grant Date                                         4/17/2006              6/1/2006              12/4/2006

Number of Options Granted(1)                         205,000               150,000                175,000                 530,000

Strike Price                                      $    11.97             $    9.15              $    6.83
Market Price - Date of Grant                      $    11.97             $    9.15              $    6.83

Total Compensation at Grant Date                   1,622,494               906,090                754,606               3,283,189

Compensation Recognized
  Vesting In 2006                                    630,079               453,045                754,606               1,837,729

Amount Remaining to Be
Recognized in Compensation                           992,415               453,045                      -               1,445,460

Weighted Average Fair Value
  At Grant Date                                    $    7.91              $   6.04              $    4.31                $   6.19

Assumptions

Expected Life (months)                                 70.42                 63.75                  60.00
Risk-Free Rate of Return                                4.93%                 5.05%                  5.20%
Expected Volatility                                    73.75%                74.45%                 75.06%
Expected Dividend Yield                                 0.00%                 0.00%                  0.00%
Expected Forfeiture Rate                                2.80%                 0.00%                  2.80%

(1)      The 11.97 Series had 193,000 options remaining at year end due to
         employee termination and forfeiture. Compensation recognized for 2006
         was adjusted to reflect the forfeitures.

Stock compensation expenses will be recognized over a weighted average remaining
life of 2.41 years.

                                       63

                      ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

                   NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS


NOTE 11 - STOCK OPTION PLAN (Continued)

         Amount of Compensation Expense                     2006 Grants           Pre-2006 Grants             Total Compensation
---------------------------------------------------     --------------------    ---------------------       -----------------------

                                              2006         $      1,837,729           $   338,433              $      2,176,162
                                              2007                  758,625               293,095                     1,051,719
                                              2008                  305,580               119,862                       425,441

                                              2009                  305,580                     -                       305,580
                                                           $      3,207,514           $   751,389              $      3,958,903


No compensation cost has been recognized for grants under the Option Plan prior
to 2006 because the exercise price of the options granted to employees equaled
or exceeded the market price of the stock on the date of the grant. Had the
method prescribed by SFAS No. 123 been applied, the Company's net income
available to common stockholders for the years ended December 31, 2005 and 2004
would have been changed to the pro forma amount indicated below:

                                                                                                    2005                2004
                                                                                              ---------------     --------------
         Net income available for common stock-as reported                                    $    4,782,381      $    2,364,389
         Compensation expenses if the fair value method had been applied to the
            grants, net of taxes                                                                    (538,273)           (112,830)
                                                                                              --------------      --------------
              Net income available for common stock-pro forma                                 $    4,244,108      $    2,251,559
                                                                                              ==============      ==============

         Net income per share-as reported
              Basic                                                                           $         0.20      $         0.10
              Diluted                                                                         $         0.19      $         0.10
         Net income available per share-pro forma
              Basic                                                                           $         0.17      $         0.10
              Diluted                                                                         $         0.17      $         0.10

The fair value of each option granted is estimated on the date of grant using the Black-Scholes option-pricing model with the following weighted average assumptions used for grants in the pro-forma years 2005 and 2004, dividend yield of 0%, expected volatility of 73.8% to 75.1%, and risk-free interest rates of 4.93% to 5.20%, 5% and 5% for each year presented, and expected lives of two to six years based on the simplified-method calculation. The maximum term of each option is ten years.

The Company's policy for exercising options begins with the option holder submitting an "Exercise Notice" to the Investor Relations Officer ("IRO"). The IRO determines the option holder's eligibility and current employment status. The IRO then prepares the "Option Exercise Notification Form". Options holders at the "Named Executive" level must be approved to exercise their options by the Compensation Committee. Any required notice is then filed with the SEC. The options holder may then purchase shares at the exercise price.

64

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 11 - STOCK OPTION PLAN (Continued)

The following table summarizes total aggregate stock option activity for the period December 31, 2003 through December 31, 2006:

                                                                                          Weighted
                                                             Number of Shares             Average
                                                                Outstanding           Exercise Price
                                                             ------------------
     Balance at December 31, 2003                                    1,257,168                 2.11
         Granted                                                       386,000                 2.01
         Exercised                                                     (87,332)                1.03
         Canceled or expired                                           (28,686)                1.19
                                                             -----------------
     Balance at December 31, 2004                                    1,527,150                 2.10
         Granted                                                       425,000                 3.91
         Exercised                                                    (493,019)                 .98
         Canceled or expired                                           (21,164)                1.43
                                                             -----------------
     Balance at December 31, 2005                                    1,437,967                 3.07
         Granted                                                       530,000                 9.47
         Exercised                                                    (329,273)                2.22
         Canceled or expired                                          (216,200)                6.33
                                                             -----------------
     Balance at December 31, 2006                                    1,422,494                 5.16
                                                             =================

     The following table summarizes information concerning outstanding and
     exercisable Company common stock options at December 31, 2006.


                                                              Average            Options                           Un-Vested Options
                            Options             Average      Remaining         Fully-Vested         Market Value
          Exercise       Outstanding at        Exercise     Contractual      And Exercisable at          At           Balance at
           Prices       December 31,2006         Price          Life         Dece,ber 31,  2006     Grant Date     December 31, 2006
        -----------     -----------------     ----------    -----------      ------------------    -------------   -----------------

        $      0.96            104,656        $     0.96           3.8                104,656       $      0.96                   -
        $      1.00             20,000        $     1.00           4.2                 20,000       $      1.00                   -
        $      1.25             60,000        $     1.25           3.0                 60,000       $      1.25                   -
        $      1.81             40,000        $     1.81           7.5                 40,000       $      1.81                   -
        $      1.87             34,000        $     1.87           6.3                 34,000       $      1.87                   -
        $      1.97             25,000        $     1.97           7.2                 25,000       $      1.97                   -
        $      2.05            171,650        $     2.05           7.2                122,250       $      2.05              49,400
        $      2.32             40,000        $     2.32           6.4                 40,000       $      2.32                   -
        $      2.39             80,000        $     2.39           8.1                 40,000       $      2.39              40,000
        $      2.50             75,000        $     2.50           8.2                 45,000       $      2.50              30,000
        $      3.75            150,000        $     3.75           8.5                150,000       $      3.75                   -
        $      6.24              4,188        $     6.24           1.0                  4,188       $      6.24                   -
        $      6.71            100,000        $     6.71           8.9                 60,000       $      6.71              40,000
        $      6.83            175,000        $     6.83           9.9                175,000       $      6.83                   -
        $      9.15            150,000        $     9.15           9.4                 75,000       $      9.15              75,000
        $     11.97            193,000        $    11.97           9.3                 77,200       $     11.97             115,800
                        --------------                                         --------------                       ---------------
                             1,422,494                                              1,072,294                               350,200
                        ==============                                         ==============                       ===============


                                                                       65

                      ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

                   NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS


NOTE 11 - STOCK OPTION PLAN (Continued)

     Total intrinsic value of options outstanding at December 31, 2006 (000's)                   $   4,738
     Total intrinsic value of options exercisable at December 31, 2006 (000's)                   $   4,031
     Total intrinsic value of options exercised during 2006 (000's)                              $   2,466
     Available for grant at December 31, 2006                                                      150,806
     Weighted-average fair value of options at grant date, granted in 2005                       $    3.52
     Weighted-average fair value of options at grant date, granted in 2004                       $    2.15
     Weighted-average remaining life of all options outstanding at December 31, 2006             7.9 years

For 2002 through 2004, the summary above does not include 234,774 non-qualified options issued at the time of the Merger to replace existing options issued by Petrocon in consideration for services. Such options had an exercise price of $4.26 per share. In September 2005, these options were exercised.

Replacement warrants of 305,102 (not included in the table above) with an exercise price of $6.24 expired in October 2003.

NOTE 12 - RELATED-PARTY TRANSACTIONS

On May 25, 2006, the Company, through its wholly-owned subsidiary ENGlobal Corporate Services, Inc., purchased a one-third partnership interest in PEI Investments, A Texas Joint Venture ("PEI"), from Michael L. Burrow, the Company's President and CEO, and another one-third interest from a stockholder who owns less than 1% of the Company's common stock. The partnership interests were purchased for a total of $69,000. The remaining one-third interest was already held by the Company through its wholly-owned subsidiary EEI. PEI owns the land on which our Beaumont, Texas office building, destroyed by Hurricane Rita in September 2005, was located. The remains of the building were razed in July 2006. In September 2006, the Company acquired approximately 1.2 acres immediately adjacent to the former facility and is developing plans to construct a new facility utilizing both parcels of land.

NOTE 13 - CONCENTRATION OF CREDIT RISK AND MAJOR CUSTOMERS

The Company provides engineering and fabricated systems and services primarily to major integrated oil and gas companies throughout the world. It also fabricates power systems and battery chargers. The Company performs ongoing credit evaluations of its customers and generally does not require collateral. Management reviews all trade receivable balances that exceed 30 days past due and based on its assessment of current credit worthiness, estimate what portion, if any seems doubtful for collection. A valuation allowance that reflects management's best estimate of the amounts that will not be collected is established.

For the years ended December 31, 2006, 2005, and 2004, the Company had sales in the engineering segment totaling approximately $42.5 million, $84.8 million and $87.9 million attributable to a single customer. In 2006, approximately 16% of our revenues were from one client, approximately 15% of our revenues were from another client and another 10% were from a third client. During 2005 and 2004, a single customer represented approximately 44% and 59% of total sales, respectively. As of December 31, 2006 the Company had amounts due from 2 customers totaling $11.7 million with 1 customer exceeding 10% of trade receivables. At December 31, 2005, the Company had amounts due from two customer totaling $8.3 million with neither customer exceeding 10% of trade receivables. At December 31, 2004, the Company had amounts due from one customer totaling $7.0 million; no other customer exceeded 10% of trade receivables at that date.

66

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 14 - RETIREMENT OF TREASURY SHARES AND REDEEMABLE PREFERRED STOCK

Treasury stock was recorded on our books at $592,231. Upon retirement/cancellation of the shares in 2006 our Paid in Capital account was reduced by $592,231 and the treasury stock account was credited to reduce it to zero.

ENGlobal has a class of preferred stock with 5,000,000 shares originally authorized for issuance. The Company issued to Equus II Incorporated 2,500,000 shares of preferred stock in 2001 and stock dividends totaling 88,000 shares in 2002 and 146,833 shares in 2003. Par value for the preferred stock was $0.001 with a fair value of $1.00 per share at the time of issuance. The preferred shares outstanding were converted into 1,149,089 shares of common stock in August 2003. Following the conversion, the Company reduced the authorized shares of preferred stock to 2,265,167. This class of preferred stock was eliminated by a vote of the Company's stockholders in June, 2006.

A new class of capital stock of the Company, consisting of 2,000,000 shares of Preferred Stock, par value $0.001 per share (the "Preferred Stock") was approved by the Company's stockholders at its June 2006 meeting. The Board of Directors have the authority to approve the issuance of all or any shares of these shares of Preferred Stock in one or more series, to determine the number of shares constituting any series and to determine any voting powers, conversion rights, dividend rights, and other designations, preferences, limitations, restrictions and rights relating to such shares without any further action by the stockholders. The designations, preferences, limitations, restrictions and rights of any series of Preferred Stock designated by the Board of Directors will be set forth in an amendment to the Amended and Restated Articles of Incorporation ("Amended Articles") filed in accordance with Nevada law.

Blank Check Authority

The Preferred Stock is referred to as a "blank check" because the Board of Directors, in their discretion, will be authorized to provide for the issuance of all or any shares of the stock in one or more classes or series, specifying the terms of the shares, subject to the limitations of Nevada law. The Board of Directors would make a determination as to whether to approve the terms and issuance of any shares of Preferred Stock based on its judgment as to the best interests of the Company and its stockholders.

Reason for the Authorization of "Blank Check" Preferred Stock. The reason for authorizing blank check Preferred Stock is to provide the Company with the flexibility in connection with its future growth. Although the Company presently has no intentions of issuing shares of Preferred Stock, opportunities may arise that require the Board to act quickly, such as businesses becoming available for acquisition or favorable market conditions for the sale of a particular type of Preferred Stock. The Board believes that the authorization to issue Preferred Stock is advisable in order to enhance the Company's ability to respond to these and similar opportunities.

67

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 15 - FEDERAL INCOME TAXES

The components of income tax expense (benefit) from continuing operations for the years ended December 31, 2006, 2005 and 2004 were as follows:

                                                        2006                 2005                2004
                                                  -----------------    -----------------    ---------------
                                                                       (in thousands)
                                                  ---------------------------------------------------------
         Current
              Federal                             $          1,047     $          3,016     $           975
              Foreign                                           53                    -                   -
              State                                            403                  413                 427
                                                  -----------------    ----------------     ---------------
                                                             1,503                3,429               1,402
                                                  -----------------    ----------------     ---------------
         Deferred
              Federal                                       (1,917)                (313)                254
              Foreign                                          (38)                   -                   -
              State                                           (362)                   -                   -
                                                  -----------------      --------------      --------------
                                                            (2,317)                (313)                254
                                                  -----------------      --------------      --------------

                  Total tax provision             $           (814)    $          3,116     $         1,656
                                                  =================    ================     ===============

     The components of the deferred tax asset (liability) consisted of the
following at December 31, 2006 and 2005:

                                                                              2006                 2005
                                                                        -----------------    -----------------
                                                                                   (in thousands)
                                                                         -------------------------------------
         Deferred tax asset
              Allowance for doubtful accounts                           $            255     $            171
              Net operating loss carry-forward                                       665                  474
              Accruals not yet deductible for tax purposes                         2,636                  310
              Stock Options                                                          235
              Alternative minimum tax credit carry-forward                             -                  194
                                                                        ----------------     ----------------
                                    Deferred tax assets                            3,791                1,149
                                                                        ----------------     ----------------
                           Less:  Valuation Allowance                                308                    -
                  Deferred tax assets                                              3,483                    -
                                                                        ----------------     ----------------

         Deferred tax liabilities
              Depreciation                                                          (403)                (436)
              Prepaid expenses                                                      (477)                (293)
              Goodwill                                                            (1,407)                 (40)
                                                                        ----------------     ----------------
                  Deferred tax liability                                          (2,287)                (769)
                                                                        ----------------     ----------------

                  Deferred tax asset, net                               $          1,196     $            380
                                                                        ================     ================


                                       68

                      ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

                   NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS


NOTE 15 - FEDERAL INCOME TAXES (Continued)

     The following is a reconciliation of expected to actual income tax expense
from continuing operations:

                                                                              2006                 2005                2004
                                                                        -----------------    -----------------    ---------------
                                                                                             (in thousands)
                                                                        ---------------------------------------------------------
         Federal income tax expense at 34%                              $         (1,462)    $          2,685     $         1,147
         State and foreign taxes, net of tax effect                                  (16)                 273                 212
         Nondeductible expenses                                                      102                    9                  53
         Stock compensation expense                                                  530                    -                   -
         Valuation allowance                                                         308                    -                   -
         Prior year correction                                                      (169)                   -                   -
         Other                                                                      (107)                 149                 244
                                                                        ----------------     ----------------     ---------------
                                                                        $           (814)    $          3,116     $         1,656
                                                                        ================     ================     ===============

The Company has a federal net operating loss carryforward at December 31, 2006 of approximately $1,049,000. Earlier utilization of the net operating loss on the Company's 2002 and 2003 consolidated tax returns was disallowed by the IRS which resulted in a reinstated carry-forward that will be available for utilization in 2007 through 2010.

The Company also has a foreign net operating loss carryforward at December 31, 2006 of approximately $770,000. This loss is available for utilization in 2007 through 2016.

The Company is unsure of its ability to fully utilize the foreign net operating loss. Therefore, the Company has set up a valuation allowance of $308,000 against the entire net operating loss.

NOTE 16 - ACQUISITIONS

Assets acquired and liabilities assumed by the Company in acquisitions have been recorded on the Company's Consolidated Balance Sheets as of the respective acquisition dates based upon their estimated fair values at such dates. The results of operations of our acquisitions have been included in the Company's Consolidated Statement of Operations since the respective dates of acquisition. The excess of the purchase price over the estimated fair values of the underlying assets acquired and liabilities assumed has been allocated to goodwill.

During 2006, the Company acquired Denver-based WRC Corporation ("WRC") and certain assets of Analyzer Technology International, Inc. ("ATI"), and accounted for the acquisitions using the purchase method of accounting for business combinations. In both cases, the purchase price and costs associated with the acquisitions exceeded the preliminary estimated fair value of net assets acquired by approximately $5.6 million and $1.8 million respectively, which was preliminarily assigned to goodwill. During early 2007, the Company completed the valuation of the intangible assets acquired in both the WRC and the ATI transactions and pursuant to those valuations has re-assigned approximately $4.0 million and $1.8 million respectively from goodwill to non-compete agreements and customer relationships with such assets being amortized over 5-6 years.

On October 6, 2006, the Company, through its wholly-owned subsidiary, ENGlobal Construction Resources, Inc. ("ECR"), acquired certain assets of WATCO Management, Inc. ("WATCO"), a Houston-based business providing construction management, turnaround management, asset management, and project commissioning and start-up services, and related services for projects and facilities located in process plants. The addition of WATCO will provide ECR with opportunities to expand its current services to existing WATCO clients in addition to a complementary business allowing expansion of current services to both existing and future clients. The aggregate purchase price was $1.0 million, including $500,000 in cash and an unsecured promissory note in the principal amount of $500,000 payable in four equal annual installments, bearing interest at the rate of 4% per annum. The estimated fair values of the acquired assets include approximately $800,000 in intellectual property, $52,000 in fixed assets

69

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 16 - ACQUISITIONS (Continued)

and $148,000 in goodwill. The Company is in the process of obtaining third-party valuations of the intangible assets; thus the allocation of the purchase price is subject to adjustment.

The Company purchased Denver-based WRC Corporation ("WRC") on May 25, 2006. WRC provides integrated land management, engineering, and related services to the pipeline, power, and transportation industries, among others. WRC has become a wholly-owned subsidiary of ENGlobal and will now serve as the Company's provider of land management, environmental compliance and governmental regulatory services. WRC currently has approximately 200 employees, with revenues in the 12 months prior to the acquisition exceeding $20 million. The Company expects to utilize WRC's Denver facility as a beachhead for expansion of its services into the Rocky Mountain and Western U.S. regions. ENGlobal purchased all of the outstanding capital stock of WRC in exchange for consideration of cash, a promissory note of $2.4 million to be paid over four years, 175,000 shares of ENGlobal common stock and the repayment of certain obligations of WRC as part of the transaction. At June 30, 2006, goodwill from this transaction was estimated to be $1.5 million.

In January 2006, one of the Company's subsidiaries, ENGlobal Systems, Inc. ("ESI") acquired certain assets of Analyzer Technology International, Inc. ("ATI"), a Houston-based analyzer systems provider of online process analyzer systems. ATI relocated its operation to ESI's Houston facility, which the Company expects will enable ESI's clients to perform a more efficient factory adaptable test by temporarily connecting both control and analyzer systems onsite prior to delivery. The addition of ATI will provide ESI with a greater presence in the process anlayzer sector, especially for larger downstream opportunities of foreigh grassroots projects.

In December 2004, ESI purchased contract rights and other assets of InfoTech Engineering Company, LLC, a limited liability company ("InfoTech"), headquartered in Baton Rouge, Louisiana. The Company paid $325,000 in cash, a promissory note in the amount of $225,000 and entered into a non-compete agreement with the former owner in exchange for approximately $55,000 in computer equipment and certain intangible assets. The acquisition resulted in approximately $270,000 in goodwill which is being recorded and amortized over 15 years for tax purposes. The InfoTech acquisition expands ESI's capability in controls system integration in both the automation and process control services. InfoTech's primary experience is in the onshore and offshore oil and gas and petrochemical industries.

In October 2004, one of the Company's subsidiaries, ENGlobal Construction Resources, Inc., purchased the name and certain assets of Cleveland Inspection Services, Inc. ("CIS"). CIS provides inspection and constructionmanagement services in support of the oil and gas, utility, and pipeline industries. The Company paid $2.5 million consisting of cash, discounted promissory notes and the assumption of certain designated contract obligations and entered into non-compete agreements with CIS and its principals in exchange for approximately $1.0 million in machinery and equipment, furniture and fixtures, computer equipment, software and other intangible assets. The acquisition resulted in approximately $1.3 million in goodwill which is being recorded and amortized over 15 years for tax purposes.

One of the Company's subsidiaries, ENGlobal Technical Services, Inc. ("ETS") (formerly known as ENGlobal Design Group, Inc. ("EDG")), purchased certain assets of Tulsa-based Engineering Design Group, Inc. ("EDGI") effective February 1, 2004. The Company believes that the acquisition of these assets enhance its capabilities related to various government and public sector facilities. ETS's most active sector is the Automated Fuel Handling Systems which serves the U.S. Military. In connection with the purchase, the Company acquired $344,000 in tangible assets including furniture and fixtures, computer equipment and software. The Company also assumed a liability for $44,000 in accrued compensated absences for former EDGI employees hired at the time of the purchase, issued two $150,000 notes bearing interest at 5% per annum maturing in December 2008 and a $2.5 million five-year contingent promissory note, with payments due annually, as part of an earn-out based on revenues of the ETS operations over the five years following the acquisition. ETS did not pay any cash or issue any stock in the transaction. The original consideration given for the purchase of certain EDGI assets approximated the fair value of the net assets acquired; therefore, no goodwill arose from the transaction. Principal

70

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 16 - ACQUISITIONS (Continued)

and interest on the $2.5 million five-year contingent promissory note is being charged to goodwill. As of December 31, 2005, $218,000 in principal and interest payments on the contingent promissory note has been charged to goodwill and is being amortized over 15 years for tax purposes.

NOTE 17 - SALE OF THERMAIRE

The Company completed its sale of assets of its subsidiary, Thermaire, Inc., d/b/a Thermal Corporation, the only company in the manufacturing segment, to a medium-sized HVAC equipment manufacturer in December 2003. The disposition had been actively pursued since November 2001 in order to permit the Company to strategically focus on its core operations. This discontinued segment had reported losses from operations of $154,000 in 2003. The sale resulted in the receipt of $545,000 in cash and a $26,000 gain, net of tax. The 37,000 square foot office and manufacturing facility owned by Thermaire was not included in the transaction and has been separately listed for sale.

In March 2005, the Company completed the sale of the building formerly occupied by Thermaire, Inc. The Company received proceeds of $823,350. The Company realized a gain on the sale of the building of $119,000.

NOTE 18 - SEGMENT INFORMATION

With the sale of the manufacturing segment, the Company operates in two business segments: engineering and systems. The engineering segment provides services primarily to major integrated oil and gas companies that for the most part are located in the United States. The systems segment operates primarily full-service systems/controls engineering and integration with some uninterruptible power systems and battery chargers that for the most part are located in the United States. Sales, operating income, identifiable assets, capital expenditures and depreciation for each segment are set forth in the following table. The amount in the corporate segment includes those activities that are not allocated to the operating segments and include costs related to business development, executive functions, finance, accounting, safety, human resources and information technology that are not specifically identifiable with the two segments. The inter-company elimination column includes the amount of administrative costs allocated to the segments. The Corporate function supports both business segments and therefore cannot be specifically assigned to either. A significant portion of Corporate costs are allocated to each segment based on each segment's revenues and subsequently eliminated in consolidation.

Financial information about geographic areas
Revenues from the Company's non-U.S. operations are currently not material. Long-lived assets located in Canada are currently not material.

71

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 18 - SEGMENT INFORMATION (Continued)

Segment information for 2006, 2005 and 2004 was as follows:

Note: Previously, within the Systems Segment, ESI provided products and services supporting the advanced automation and integrated controls fields. In January 2006, EAG assumed responsibility for these services, which resulted in a move of this division of ESI to the Engineering Segment. Revenues and expenses have been reclassified between the segments to provide comparative results. Amounts will tie in total to prior reporting, however, individual segments will vary from prior reports.

                                                                       Intercompany
                            Engineering      Systems     Corporate     Eliminations           Total
                                                       (in thousands)
                       -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                   2006
                   ----
Net sales from external
              customers  $  278,157     $   24,933     $        -     $            -       $  303,090
Operating profit (loss)       9,084            (14)       (12,690)                 1           (3,620)
       Depreciation and
           amortization       1,419            344            512                  -            2,275
        Tangible assets      65,339         15,122          6,563                  -           87,024
               Goodwill      18,224            978              -                  -           19,202
   Capital expenditures       3,286            185            674                  -            4,145

                   2005
                   ----
Net sales from external
              customers  $  219,426     $   14,159     $        -     $            -       $  233,585
Operating profit (loss)      18,911           (851)           733            (10,209)           8,584
       Depreciation and
           amortization       1,256            101            479                  -            1,836
        Tangible assets      52,602          5,460          2,419                  -           60,481
               Goodwill      14,756            699              -                  -           15,455
   Capital expenditures       2,569            172            489                  -            3,230

                   2004
                   ----
Net sales from external
              customers  $  134,778     $   14,110     $        -     $            -       $  148,888
Operating profit (loss)      10,461            636          2,267             (8,872)           4,492
       Depreciation and
           amortization         706            108            432                  -            1,246
        Tangible assets      31,971          6,673          3,332                  -           41,976
               Goodwill      14,585            699              -                  -           15,284
   Capital expenditures       1,378             20             67                  -            1,465

Tangible assets include cash, accounts receivable, costs in excess of billings, prepaid expenses, income tax receivables, deferred tax assets, property and equipment and deferred financing. Goodwill, investments in subsidiaries, and inter-company accounts receivables and payables are excluded.

72

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 19 - COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES

In connection with the 2001 merger of Petrocon Engineering, Inc. ("Petrocon") and a wholly-owned subsidiary of ENGlobal Corporation, certain former Petrocon shareholders (the "Significant PEI Shareholders") entered into an Indemnification Escrow Agreement, an Option Escrow Agreement, a Voting Agreement and a Significant PEI Shareholder Voting Agreement (collectively, the "2001 Agreements"). In August 2004, the Company and the requisite percentage of Significant PEI Shareholders entered into a Termination Agreement (the "Termination Agreement") terminating the 2001 Agreements. The 2001 Agreements included the following:

Indemnification Escrow.
Pursuant to the Indemnification Escrow Agreement, 1,000,000 shares of ENGlobal common stock owned by the Significant PEI Shareholders were deposited into an escrow to serve as a fund against which the Company could make claims for indemnity pursuant to the Merger Agreement with Petrocon. Pursuant to the terms of the Termination Agreement, the remaining shares in the Indemnification Escrow agreement have been released pro rata to the Significant PEI Shareholders.

Voting Agreement.
ENGlobal, the Significant PEI Shareholders, and certain other parties entered into a Voting Agreement which obligated the parties thereto to vote for certain persons to serve on the Board of Directors of ENGlobal. Pursuant to the terms of the Termination Agreement, the Voting Agreement has been terminated.

Significant PEI Shareholder Voting Agreement.
The Significant PEI Shareholders entered into a Significant PEI Shareholders Voting Agreement governing the manner in which they would designate three ENGlobal director nominees under the Voting Agreement and vote shares held in escrow. Pursuant to the terms of the Termination Agreement, the Significant PEI Shareholders Voting Agreement has been terminated.

Option Escrow.
Pursuant to the Option Escrow Agreement, the Significant PEI Shareholders deposited 1,737,473 shares of ENGlobal common stock into an escrow account. The Option Escrow Agreement required that if ENGlobal issued shares of its common stock on the exercise of incentive options granted as replacement options for outstanding Petrocon incentive options ("Replacement Options"), a like number of shares of ENGlobal common stock would be surrendered from the escrow account to ENGlobal. As a result, no dilution to ENGlobal stockholders would occur upon the exercise of Replacement Options.

The Company's management determined that, due to the cost and complexity associated with administering the 2001 Agreements, it would be in the best interest of the Company and its stockholders to terminate the same. Pursuant to the terms of the Termination Agreement, ENGlobal purchased the 652,377 shares being held in escrow underlying the Replacement Options with an exercise price of $0.96 per share for a discounted payment of $592,231, payable over three years to the Significant PEI Shareholders. ENGlobal also terminated its rights to any of the remaining shares held in escrow and those shares were distributed to the Significant PEI Shareholders. The transaction resulted in 652,377 shares of Treasury Stock and a decrease in Shareholders' Equity of $592,231 until such time as the replacement options are exercised and the exercise price is remitted to the Company. As of December 31, 2006, all payments due to Significant PEI Shareholders had been made.

Employment Agreements

The Company has employment agreements with certain of its executive officers and certain other officers, the terms of which expire in January 2009. Such agreements provide for minimum salary levels. If the Company terminates the employment of the employee for any reason other than 1) termination for cause, 2) voluntary resignation, or 3) employee's death, the Company is obligated to provide a severance benefit equal to six months of the employee's salary, and, at its option, an additional six months at 50% to 100% of the employee's salary in exchange for an extension of the non-compete. These agreements are renewable for one year at the Company's option.

73

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 19 - COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES (Continued)

Litigation

From time to time, we are involved in various legal proceedings arising in the ordinary course of business alleging, among other things, breach of contract or tort in connection with the performance of professional services, the outcome of which cannot be predicted with certainty. As of the date of this filing, we are party to several legal proceedings that have been reserved for or are covered by insurance, or that, if determined adversely to us individually or in the aggregate, would not have a material adverse effect on our results of operations or financial position.

Insurance

The Company carries a broad range of insurance coverage, including general and business automobile liability, commercial property, professional errors and omissions, workers' compensation insurance and a general umbrella policy. The Company is not aware of any claims in excess of insurance recoveries. ENGlobal is partially self-funded for health insurance claims. Provisions for expected future payments are accrued based on the Company's experience. Specific stop loss levels provide protection for the Company with $175,000 per occurrence and approximately $12.1million in aggregate in each policy year being covered by a separate insurance policy.

NOTE 20 - SUBSEQUENT EVENTS

In December 2006, ENGlobal Engineering, Inc. began its plan to merge its Dallas, Texas operations with operations being performed at the Tulsa, Oklahoma and Houston, Texas offices. The transfer of activities at the Dallas office was the result of a decision to consolidate the Company's Texas-based operations while streamlining or reducing overhead costs. A large number of the 25 Dallas employees were offered transfers to ENGlobal's Tulsa, Oklahoma or Houston, Texas offices. Certain employees were asked to remain with the Company in Dallas through March 31, 2007 to allow for an orderly transfer of on-going projects.

On February 14, 2007, the Company ceased operations through its Dallas office and transferred all remaining operational support to its Tulsa office. At the same time, the Company entered into a sublease commencing on March 1, 2007, for approximately 75% of the continuing lease obligations and sold a majority of the assets which were valued at approximately $90,000. The Company will calculate the remaining obligations related to the move from the Dallas area and record a charge during the first quarter of 2007. The Company estimates the charge will range from $100,000 to $125,000.

On February 16, 2007, the Company, through its wholly-owned subsidiary, RPM Engineering, Inc. ("RPM"), entered into an Agreement to Purchase and Sell the property (the "Agreement"), together with the building and all improvements thereon located in Baton Rouge, Louisiana for approximately $1.9 million with 20% of purchase price being paid at closing and the balance self-financed for a period no longer than 60 months, amortized over 180 months, payable in equal monthly installments and one irregular installment consisting of the interest and principle due at the end of the 60 months. The interest rate is based on NY prime plus .25%, initially to be 8.5%. Under certain conditions prior to closing and up to sixty days for the last signing of the Agreement, the purchaser may be entitled to the return in full of any deposit held by RPM. The financed portion of the purchase price is secured by a first mortgage on the property. The Company's basis in the property, together with the building and all improvements is approximately $1.4 million at December 31, 2006. It is intended that the closing shall take place on or about April 30, 2007.

74

NOTE 21 - QUARTERLY FINANCIAL INFORMATION (UNAUDITED)

                                                             For the Quarters Ended - 2006
                                       March                  June               September               December
                                    -------------          ------------        --------------           ------------
                                                       (in thousands, except per share amounts)
Revenues per segment
    Engineering                     $     62,587    93.9%   $    69,752   92.9%  $     76,617    92.9%   $    69,201    87.7%
    Systems                                4,040     6.1%         5,314    7.1%         5,887     7.1%         9,692    12.3%
                                    -------------           -----------          ------------            -----------
         Total                      $     66,627   100.0%   $    75,066  100.0%  $     82,504   100.0%   $    78,893   100.0%
                                    =============           ===========          ============            ===========

Gross profit per segment
    Engineering                     $      7,796    12.5%   $    10,189   14.6%  $      4,426     5.8%   $     1,715     2.5%
    Systems                                  426    10.5%   $       539   10.1%           123     2.1%         1,050    10.8%
                                    -------------           -----------          ------------            -----------
         Total                      $      8,222    12.3%   $    10,728   14.3%  $      4,549     5.5%   $     2,765     3.5%
                                    =============           ===========          ============            ===========

    Net income (loss)               $      1,234            $     2,331          $     (1,570)           $    (5,481)
                                    =============           ===========          ============            ===========

Earnings per share - basic          $       0.05            $      0.09          $      (0.06)           $     (0.21)

Earnings per share - diluted        $       0.05            $      0.09          $      (0.06)           $     (0.21)


                                                             For the Quarters Ended - 2005
                                       March                  June               September               December
                                    -------------          ------------        --------------           ------------
                                                       (in thousands, except per share amounts)
Revenues per segment
    Engineering                     $     41,226    92.4%  $     54,962   92.5%  $     55,923   94.4%   $    67,315    95.8%
    Systems                                3,403     7.6%         4,457    7.5%         3,343    5.6%         2,956     4.2%
                                    ------------           ------------          ------------           -----------
         Total                      $     44,629   100.0%  $     59,419  100.0%  $     59,266  100.0%   $    70,271   100.0%
                                    ============           ============          ============           ===========

Gross profit per segment
    Engineering                     $      5,405    13.1%  $      6,925   12.6%  $      7,635   13.7%   $     7,197    10.7%
    Systems                                  294     8.6%           354    7.9%           203    6.1%           260     8.8%
                                    ------------           ------------          ------------           -----------
         Total                      $      5,699    12.8%  $      7,279   12.3%  $      7,838   13.2%   $     7,457    10.6%
                                    ============           ============          ============           ===========

    Net income                      $        921           $     1,520           $      1,620           $       721
                                    ============           ============          ============           ===========

Earnings per share - basic          $       0.04           $      0.06           $       0.07           $      0.03

Earnings per share - diluted        $       0.04           $      0.06           $       0.07           $      0.03

Note: Previously, within the Systems Segment, ESI provided products and services supporting the advanced automation and integrated controls fields. In January 2006, EAG assumed responsibility for these services, which resulted in a move of this division of ESI to the Engineering Segment. Revenues and expenses have been reclassified between the segments to provide comparative results. Amounts will tie in total to prior reporting, however, individual segments will vary from prior reports.

75

                                                          Schedule II
                                                          -----------

                                                      ENGlobal Corporation

                                              VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS


                                                     Balance -                                            Balance -
                                                     Beginning                          Deductions-         End of
                         Description                 of Period         Additions         Write offs         Period
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                             (in thousands)
                                                   --------------------------------------------------------------------
Allowance for doubtful accounts

     For year ended December 31, 2006               $         503    $          251    $          (84)  $          670

     For year ended December 31, 2005               $         476    $           53    $          (26)  $          503

     For year ended December 31, 2004               $         376    $          134    $          (34)  $          476

76

ITEM 9. CHANAGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE

None.

ITEM 9A. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

(a) Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures

Disclosure controls and procedures are controls and other procedures of a registrant designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed by the registrant in the reports that it files or submits under the Exchange Act is properly recorded, processed, summarized, and reported, within the time periods specified in the Securities and Exchange Commission's ("SEC") rules and forms. Disclosure controls and procedures include processes to accumulate and evaluate relevant information and communicate such information to a registrant's management, including its Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, as appropriate, to allow for timely decisions regarding required disclosures.

We evaluated the effectiveness of the design and operation of our disclosure controls and procedures as of December 31, 2006, as required by Rule 13a-15 of the Exchange Act. As described below, under "Management's Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting," material weaknesses were identified in our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2006, relating to our control environment, information technology access, accounting system, purchases and expenditures, fixed-price contract information, and revenue recognition. Based on the evaluation described above, our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer have concluded that, as of December 31, 2006, our disclosure controls and procedures were not effective to ensure (1) that information required to be disclosed by us in the reports we file or submit under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized, and reported, within the time periods specified in the SEC's rules and forms, and (2) information required to be disclosed by us in our reports that we file or submit under the Exchange Act is accumulated and communicated to our management, including our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, as appropriate, to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure.

(b) Management's Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting

Effective June 30, 2006, ENGlobal Corporation met the definition of "accelerated filer," as described by Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. As an accelerated filer, we are required by the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 to include an assessment of our internal control over financial reporting for the year ended December 31, 2006. Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. Our internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of our financial statements for external reporting purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.

Internal control over financial reporting cannot provide absolute assurance of achieving financial reporting objectives because of its inherent limitations. Internal control over financial reporting is a process that involves human diligence and compliance and is subject to lapses in judgment and breakdowns resulting from human failures. Internal control over financial reporting also can be circumvented by collusion or improper management override. Because of such limitations, there is a risk that material misstatements may not be prevented or detected on a timely basis by internal control over financial reporting. However, these inherent limitations are known features of the financial reporting process. Therefore, it is possible to design into the process safeguards to reduce, though not eliminate, this risk.

A material weakness in internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Auditing Standard No. 2 of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board) is a significant deficiency, or combination of significant deficiencies, that results in more than a remote likelihood that a material misstatement of the annual or interim financial statements will not be prevented or detected. A significant deficiency is a control deficiency, or combination of control deficiencies,

77

ITEM 9A. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES (continued)

that adversely affects a company's ability to initiate, authorize, record, process, or report external financial data reliably in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, such that there is more than a remote likelihood that a misstatement of the company's annual or interim financial statements that is more than inconsequential will not be prevented or detected.

Management assessed the effectiveness of the Company's internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2006, the end of the fiscal period covered by this report, but management did not complete its assessment until March 2, 2007. Due to the lack of adequate time to permit Hein to audit management's assessment, Hein is unable to render an opinion on our assessment of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2006. Accordingly, management has identified this as a material weakness. Management's assessment process did not conclude in adequate time to permit Hein to audit management's assessment due to a number of factors, including: (i) our failure to prepare and plan for a timely completion of management's assessment, including adding the resources necessary to do so; and
(ii) our failure to ensure that our accounting department was adequately staffed and sufficiently trained to meet deadlines.

Management assessed the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2006, using the criteria set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission ("COSO") in Internal Control--Integrated Framework. In assessing the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting, management identified the following additional material weaknesses in internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2006:

1. Deficiencies in the Company's Control Environment. Our control environment did not sufficiently promote effective internal control over financial reporting throughout the organization. Specifically, we had a shortage of support and resources in our accounting department, which resulted in insufficient: (i) documentation and communication of our accounting policies and procedures; and (ii) internal audit processes of our accounting policies and procedures.

2. Deficiencies in the Company's Information Technology Access Controls. We did not maintain effective controls over preventing access by unauthorized personnel to end-user spreadsheets and other information technology programs and systems.

3. Deficiencies in the Company's Accounting System Controls. We did not effectively and accurately close the general ledger in a timely manner and we did not provide complete and accurate disclosure in our notes to financial statements, as required by generally accepted accounting principles.

4. Deficiencies in the Company's Controls Regarding Purchases and Expenditures. We did not maintain effective controls over the tracking of our commitments and actual expenditures with third-party subsidiaries on a timely basis.

5. Deficiencies in the Company's Controls Regarding Fixed-Price Contract Information. We did not maintain effective controls over the complete, accurate, and timely processing of information relating to the estimated cost of fixed-price contracts.

6. Deficiencies in the Company's Revenue Recognition Controls. We did not maintain effective policies and procedures relating to revenue recognition of fixed price contracts, which accounted for approximately 11% of the Company's revenues in 2006.

7. Deficiencies in the Company's Controls over Income Taxes. We did not maintain sufficient internal controls to ensure that amounts provided for in our financial statements for income taxes accurately reflected our income tax position as of December 31, 2006.

78

ITEM 9A. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES (continued)

As a result of the material weaknesses described above, our management concluded that we did not maintain effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2006, based on the criteria established by COSO.

(c) Changes in Internal Controls Over Financial Reporting

No change in our internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934) occurred during the fourth quarter of fiscal 2006 that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting. Management and the Audit Committee of the Company's Board of Directors have begun to develop remedial measures to address the internal control deficiencies identified above. The Company will monitor the effectiveness of planned actions and will make any other changes and take such other actions as management or the Audit Committee determines to be appropriate.

(d) Remediation Initiatives

During 2007, we plan to implement a number of remediation measures to address the material weaknesses described above. The Company's remediation plans include:

1. We plan to hire additional personnel to assist us with documenting and communicating our accounting policies and procedures to ensure the proper and consistent application of those policies and procedures throughout the Company. Recruitment for this position(s) has begun and the selection process is expected to be completed during the second quarter of 2007.

2. We plan to implement formal processes requiring periodic self-assessments, independent tests, and reporting of our personnel's adherence to our accounting policies and procedures.

3. We plan to design effective policies and procedures to control security of and access to spreadsheet information. If necessary, we will also consider implementing a software solution with automatic control checkpoints for day-to-day business processes.

4. We plan to (i) require additional training for our current accounting personnel; (ii) to hire additional accounting personnel to enable the allocation of job functions among a larger group of accounting staff; (iii) to engage outside consultants with technical accounting expertise, as needed; and
(iv) to consider restructuring our accounting department, each to increase the likelihood that our accounting personnel will have the resources, experience, skills, and knowledge necessary to effectively perform the accounting system functions assigned to them.

5. We plan to improve procurement and operational efficiencies by implementing a software system and a matrix organization to more completely, accurately, and timely track commitments on Company-wide purchase and expenditure transactions.

6. We plan to improve revenue recognition policies and procedures relating to fixed-price contracts by evaluating the level of economic success achieved by past fixed-price contracts and by stressing throughout the Company the importance of (i) accurately estimating costs, (ii) timely updating cost estimates to reflect the accuracy of the cost savings, (iii) accurately estimating expected profit, (iv) timely identifying when a project's scope changes, (v) promptly reporting man hours and costs in excess of those originally estimated; and (vi) closely scrutinizing the bid process.

79

ITEM 9A. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES (continued)

7. We plan to train personnel to effectively implement and evaluate the overall design of the Company's fixed-price project control processes. Specifically, we plan to enhance and tighten controls as they relate to the initial bid process and the attendant recognition and management of risk by only bidding on large procurement and construction activities on a cost plus basis.

Management recognizes that many of these enhancements require continual monitoring and evaluation for effectiveness. The development of these actions is an iterative process and will evolve as the Company continues to evaluate and improve our internal controls over financial reporting.

Management will review progress on these activities on a consistent and ongoing basis at the Chief Executive Officer and senior management level in conjunction with our Audit Committee. We also plan to take additional steps to elevate Company awareness about and communication of these important issues through formal channels such as Company meetings, departmental meetings, and training.

80

PART III

ITEM 10. DIRECTORS AND EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE REGISTRANT

The information under the captions Election of Directors and Executive Officers Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance and Corporate Code of Conduct, in our definitive proxy statement for our 2007 annual meeting of stockholders to be filed with the SEC pursuant to Regulation 14A under the Exchange Act is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 11. EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

The information under the captions Executive Compensation, Director Compensation, Compensation Committee, and Report of the Compensation Committee on Executive Compensation and Comparative Stock Performance Graph contained in our definitive proxy statement for our 2007 annual meeting of stockholders to be filed with the SEC pursuant to Regulation 14A under the Exchange Act is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 12. SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND
RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS

The information under the caption Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management contained in our definitive proxy statement for our 2007 annual meeting of stockholders to be filed with the SEC pursuant to Regulation 14A under the Exchange Act is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 13. CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS

The information under the caption Certain Relationships and Related Transactions contained our definitive proxy statement for our 2007 annual meeting of stockholders to be filed with the SEC pursuant to Regulation 14A under the Exchange Act is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 14. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES

The information under the caption Principal Accounting Fees and Services in our definitive proxy statement for our 2007 annual meeting of stockholders to be filed with the SEC pursuant to Regulation 14A under the Exchange Act is incorporated herein by reference.

81

PART IV

ITEM 15. EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENTS SCHEDULES

(a)(1) Financial Statements The consolidated financial statements filed as part of this Form 10-K are listed and indexed in Part II, Item 8.

(a)(2) Schedules All schedules have been omitted since the information required by the schedule is not applicable, or is not present in amounts sufficient to require submission of the schedule, or because the information required is included in the consolidated financial statements and notes thereto.

(a)(3) Exhibits

82

                                                            EXHIBIT INDEX

                                                                                    Incorporated by Reference to:
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ----------------------------------------
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
Exhibit No.                      Description                        Form or    Exhibit No.  Filing Date     SEC File
                                                                   Schedule                   with SEC       Number
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
        2.1  Agreement and Plan of Merger by and between            10-QSB        2.23      8/14/01       001-14217
             Industrial Data Systems Corporation, IDS
             Engineering Management, LC, PEI Acquisition, Inc.
             and Petrocon Engineering, Inc.
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
        2.2  First Amendment of the Agreement and Plan of Merger     S-4/A        2.24      11/6/01       333-68288
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
        2.3  Letter Agreement of the Agreement and Plan of           S-4/A        2.25      11/6/01       333-68288
             Merger
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
        3.1  Restated Articles of Incorporation of ENGlobal          10-Q          3.1      11/14/02      001-14217
             Corporation
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
        3.2  Amended and Restated Bylaws of Registrant                S-3          4.4      10/31/05      333-129336
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
        4.1  Specimen common stock certificate                        S-3          4.1      10/31/05      333-129336
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
        4.2  Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of               S-3          4.2      10/31/05      333-129336
             September 29, 2005, by and among ENGlobal
             Corporation and Certain Investors named therein
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
        4.3  Securities Purchase Agreement, dated September 29,       S-3          4.5      10/31/05      333-129336
             2005, by and between Tontine Capital Partners,
             L.P. and Registrant
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
        4.4  Form of Subscription Agreement by and among              S-3          4.6      10/31/05      333-129336
             Registrant, Michael L. Burrow, Alliance 2000, Ltd.
             and certain subscribers
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
       10.1  Option Pool Agreement between Industrial Data          10-KSB        10.48     4/1/2002      001-14217
             Systems Corporation and Alliance 2000, Ltd. Dated
             December 21, 2001
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
       10.2  Guaranty and Suretyship Agreement between               10-Q         10.64     8/12/02       001-14217
             Industrial Data Systems Corporation and Corporate
             Property Associates 4 dated April 26, 2002
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
       10.3  1998 Incentive Plan                                      S-8         10.49     8/24/05       333-127803
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
       10.4  Amendment No. 1 to 1998 Incentive Plan                   S-8        10.65A     6/9/03        333 - 105966
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
       10.5  Amendment No. 2 to the 1998 Incentive Plan               S-8        10.65A     6/9/03        333 - 105966
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
       10.6  Amendment No. 3 to the 1998 Incentive Plan               S-8         10.52     8/24/05       333-127803
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
       10.7  Form of ENGlobal Corporation (f/k/a Industrial           S-8         10.80     8/24/05       333-127803
             Data Systems Corporation) Non-qualified Stock
             Option Agreement Granted Outside of 1998 Incentive
             Plan
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
       10.8  Lease Agreement between Petrocon Engineering, Inc.      10-Q         10.66     11/14/02      001-14217
             and Phelan Investments on July 25, 2002
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------


                                                                83

                                                                                    Incorporated by Reference to:
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ----------------------------------------
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
Exhibit No.                      Description                        Form or    Exhibit No.  Filing Date     SEC File
                                                                   Schedule                   with SEC       Number
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
       10.9  Lease Agreement between Petro-Chem Engineering and      10-Q         10.72     8/14/03       001-14217
             ENGlobal Engineering, Inc. dated June 4, 2003
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
      10.10  Contract between BASF and ENGlobal Engineering,         10-Q         10.73     8/14/03       001-14217
             Inc. dated June 9, 2003
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
      10.11  Sublease Agreements between Family Connect, Inc.,       10-Q         10.74     11/14/03      001-14217
             a tenant of CitiPlex Towers Building and IDS
             Engineering dated February 2, 2003
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
      10.12  Lease Agreement between Oral Roberts University         10-Q         10.75     11/14/03      001-14217
             and IDS Engineering, dba ENGlobal Engineering,
             Inc. dated October 20, 2003
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
      10.13  Second Amendment of the ENGlobal Engineering, Inc.      10-K         10.77     3/30/04       001-14217
             401(k) Plan dated January 1, 2004 (formerly called
             the "Petrocon Engineering, Inc. 401(k) Plan")
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
      10.14  Lease Agreement between ENGlobal Design Group,          10-K         10.79     3/30/04       001-14217
             Inc. and TC Meridian Tower LP dated January 24,
             2004
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
      10.15  Credit Agreement by and between Comerica Bank and        8-K         10.1      8/9/04        001-14217
             ENGlobal Corporation and its subsidiaries dated
             July 27, 2004
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
      10.16  Security Agreement by and between Comerica Bank          8-K         10.2      8/9/04        001-14217
             and ENGlobal Corporation and its subsidiaries
             dated July 27, 2004
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
      10.17  Master Revolving Note by and between Comerica Bank       8-K         10.3      8/9/04        001-14217
             and ENGlobal Corporation and its subsidiaries
             dated July 27, 2004
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
      10.18  Third Amendment of the ENGlobal Engineering, Inc.       10-K         10.48     3/30/05       001-14217
             401(k) Plan (formerly called the "Petrocon
             Engineering, Inc. 401(k) Plan") dated March 9,
             2005 and effective January 1, 2005
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.19  Option to Purchase Share Agreement between Yong
             Choy Lin @ Yong Chai Lin and ENGlobal Engineering,
             Inc. effective September 8, 2006
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.20  Management Agreement between ENGlobal Engineering,
             Inc. and SchmArt Technologies Sdn. Bhd effective
             September 8, 2006
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.21  First Amendment of the ENGlobal 401(k) Plan
             effective December 21, 2001
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.22  Amended and Restated ENGlobal 401(k) Plan
             effective October 1, 2005
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.23  Second Amendment to the ENGlobal 401(k) Plan
             effective April 1, 2006
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.24  Third Amendment to the ENGlobal 401(k) Plan
             effective July 1, 2006
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------


                                                                84

                                                                                    Incorporated by Reference to:
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ----------------------------------------
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
Exhibit No.                      Description                        Form or    Exhibit No.  Filing Date     SEC File
                                                                   Schedule                   with SEC       Number
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.25  Regulations Amendment to the ENGlobal 401(k) Plan
             effective January 1, 2006
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.26  First Amendment to the Lease Agreement between
             Oral Roberts University and ENGlobal Engineering,
             Inc. dated April 5, 2005
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.27  Second Amendment to the Lease Agreement between
             Oral Roberts University and ENGlobal Engineering,
             Inc. dated June 15, 2005
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.28  Third Amendment to the Lease Agreement between
             Oral Roberts University and ENGlobal Engineering,
             Inc. dated December 28, 2005
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.29  Fourth Amendment to the Lease Agreement between
             Oral Roberts University and ENGlobal Engineering,
             Inc. dated February 27, 2006
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.30  Fifth Amendment to the Lease Agreement between
             Oral Roberts University and ENGlobal Engineering,
             Inc. dated July 28, 2006
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.31  First Amendment to Credit Agreement by and among Comerica Bank and
             ENGlobal Corporation and its subsidiaries dated September 30, 2004
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.32  Second Amendment to Credit Agreement by and among Comerica Bank and
             ENGlobal Corporation and its subsidiaries dated April 1, 2005
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.33  Third Amendment to Credit Agreement by and among Comerica Bank and
             ENGlobal Corporation and its subsidiaries dated July 31, 2005
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.34  Fourth Amendment to Credit Agreement by and among Comerica Bank and
             ENGlobal Corporation and its subsidiaries dated December 31, 2005
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.35  Fifth Amendment to Credit Agreement by and among Comerica Bank and
             ENGlobal Corporation and its subsidiaries dated July 26, 2006
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.36  Sixth Amendment to Credit Agreement by and among Comerica Bank and
             ENGlobal Corporation and its subsidiaries effective December 31,
             2006
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.37  ENGlobal Corporation Key Manager Incentive Plan
             effective January 1, 2006
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.38  ENGlobal Corporation Executive Level Incentive
             Plan effective January 1, 2006
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------


                                                                85

                                                                                    Incorporated by Reference to:
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ----------------------------------------
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
Exhibit No.                      Description                        Form or    Exhibit No.  Filing Date     SEC File
                                                                   Schedule                   with SEC       Number
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.39  ENGlobal Corporation Key Executive Employment
             Agreement - William A. Coskey effective January 1,
             2006
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.40  ENGlobal Corporation Key Executive Employment
             Agreement - Michael L.  Burrow effective January
             1, 2006
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.41  ENGlobal Corporation Key Executive Employment
             Agreement - Robert W. Raiford effective January 1,
             2006
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
     *10.42  ENGlobal Corporation Key Executive Employment
             Agreement - Michael M. Patton effective January 1,
             2006
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
      *11.1  Statement Regarding Computation of Per Share
             Earnings is included as Note 2 to the Notes to
             Consolidated Financial Statements
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
       14.1  ENGlobal Corporation Code of Ethics for Chief           10-K         99.5      3/30/04       001-14217
             Executive Officer and Senior Financial Officers
             dated March 25, 2004
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
       14.2  ENGlobal Corporation Code of Business Conduct and       10-K         99.6      3/30/04       001-14217
             Ethics dated March 25, 2004
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
      *21.1  Subsidiaries of the Registrant
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
      *23.1  Consent of Hein & Associates LLP
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
      *31.1  Certification of Chief Executive Officer pursuant
             to Exchange Act Rules 13a-14 or 15d-14
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
      *31.2  Certification of Chief Financial Officer pursuant
             to Exchange Act Rules 13a-14 or 15d-14
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
      *32.1  Certification of Chief Executive Officer pursuant
             to Exchange Act Rules 13a-14(b) or 15d-14(b) and
             18 U.S.C. Section 1350
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------
      *32.2  Certification of Chief Financial Officer pursuant
             to Exchange Act Rules 13a-14(b) or 15d-14(b) and
             U.S.C. Section 1350
------------ ---------------------------------------------------- ------------ ------------ ------------- -------------

* Filed herewith

86

SIGNATURES

In accordance with Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has caused this Annual Report on Form 10-K to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

ENGlobal CORPORATION

Dated:   March 15, 2007
                                        By:  //s// Michael L. Burrow
                                             Michael L. Burrow, P.E.,
                                             Chief Executive Officer, Director

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this Report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated:

By:  //s// Michael L. Burrow
     Michael L. Burrow, P.E.
     Chief Executive Officer, Director

By:  //s// William A. Coskey
     William A. Coskey, P.E.
     Chairman of the Board, Director

By:  //s// Robert W. Raiford
     Robert  W. Raiford
     Chief Financial Officer, Treasurer

By:  //s// David W. Gent
     David W. Gent, P.E., Director

By:  //s// Randall B. Hale
     Randall  B. Hale, Director

By:  //s// David C. Roussel
     David C. Roussel, Director

87

EXHIBIT 10.19


DATED THIS 8th DAY OF SEPTEMBER, 2006


BETWEEN

YONG CHOY LIN @ YONG CHAI LIN

AND

ENGlobal Engineering, Inc

*************************************************************

OPTION TO PURCHASE SHARE AGREEMENT

**************************************************************


This Option To Purchase Share Agreement

is made on between the following parties:

1. Yong Choy Lin @ Yong Chai Lin NRIC No. 460330-04-5154 of 10, Jalan USJ 14/1J, 47630 Subang Jaya, Selangor Darul Ehsan.
(Vendor)

2. Englobal Engineering Inc.
(Company No: 0106962700) Texas, USA chartered
(Purchaser)

Recitals:

A. SchmArt Technologies Sdn Bhd (Company No.655264-W) (Company) is a company incorporated in Malaysia under the Companies Act 1965, the corporate particulars of which are set out in Schedule 1.

B. The Vendor is the registered and beneficial owner of 210,000 ordinary shares of RM 1.00 each in the Company, representing 100% of the entire issued and paid-up share capital of the Company (Sale Shares). Among the 210,000 ordinary shares, 63,000 of the ordinary shares are registered in the name of the Vendor, 126,000 of the ordinary shares were registered in the name of the shareholder named Mohamed Ghazali Bin Ismail (NRIC No.490302-11-5041) who holds the said 126,000 of the ordinary shares on trust for the Vendor and 21,000 of the ordinary shares were registered in the name of the shareholder named Edwin Pang Loo Chee (NRIC No.660224-04-5173) who holds the said 21,000 of the ordinary shares on trust for the Vendor (both, Other Shareholders).

C. The Vendor has agreed to grant/sell and the Purchaser has agreed to purchase the option, to purchase the Sale Shares (Option To Purchase) on the terms and subject to the conditions set out in this option to purchase share agreement.

1 GRANT/SALE AND PURCHASE OF OPTION

1.1 Grant/sale

The Vendor grants/sells to Purchaser and the Purchaser agrees to purchase the Option to Purchase from the Vendor on the terms and subject to the conditions set out in this option to purchase share agreement.

1.2 Basis of sale

The Option to Purchase is granted/ sold -

(a) On the basis that the Purchaser can exercise this Option to Purchase, for all or any lesser portion of the Sale Shares as Purchaser shall determine in its sole discretion, at any time up to ninety (90) days immediately after the 3rd year from the date of this option to purchase share agreement, or such extended period as may be agreed between the parties (Option Period) for the payment to the Vendor of additional price of USD$1.00 (Share Consideration) and the Purchaser shall, subject to the Purchaser obtaining the approval from and conditions to be imposed by the Malaysia Foreign Investment Committee for such acquisition of the Vendor's shares, become the registered and/or beneficial owner of the Sale Shares;

1

(b) In the event that the Purchaser exercises this Option to Purchase after paying the additional price of $1.00, both Vendor and Purchaser further agree to execute Share Sales Agreement to effect and complete the sales of the said Sale Shares.

(c) On the basis that the Purchaser and Company will enter into a Management Agreement on an even date herewith;

(d) On the basis that the Vendor is to procure that the Company and SchmArt Engineering, Inc. will enter into a licensing agreement for use of the relief ++ system and software for all work in Malaysia;

(e) On the basis that the Vendor will be retained as a paid Director of the Company for a minimum of three (3) years from the date of this option to purchase share agreement regardless of whether the Purchaser exercises the Option to Purchase or not; and

(f) On the basis of the Warranties given by the Vendor as referred to in clause 4.1.

1.3 Waiver of pre-emption rights

(a) The Vendor [and each of the Other Shareholders] waives all rights of pre-emption, rights of first refusal or options over any of the Sale Shares conferred by the Articles of Association of the Company or in any other way.

(b) The Vendor must procure and undertakes and warrants to the Purchaser that the Other Shareholders waive all rights of pre-emption, rights of first refusal or options over any of the Sale Shares conferred by the Articles of Association of the Company or in any other way.

2 CONSIDERATION AND ADVANCE

2.1 Amount

The consideration for the Option to Purchase is USD$150,000.00 (Option Consideration).

2.2 Satisfaction

The Option Consideration will be paid in the following manner:

(a) A sum of USD$50,000.00 non-refundable deposit has been paid by the Purchaser to the Vendor upon the execution of this option to purchase share agreement.

(b) The balance of the Option Consideration will be paid by the Purchaser in the following manner :

(1) USD$25,000.00 will be paid to the Vendor on 15th day of September 2006;

(2) USD$25,000.00 will be paid to the Vendor on 15th day of October 2006;

(3) USD$25,000.00 will be paid to the Vendor on 15th day of November 2006; and

(4) USD$25,000.00 will be paid to the Vendor on 15th day of December 2006.

2.3 The Option Consideration is non-refundable in the event that the Purchaser decides not to exercise the Option to Purchase.

2

3 OPTION EXERCISE AND COMPLETION

3.1 Time for Exercise

The Option to Purchase may be exercised at any time during the Option Period.

3.2 Effect of Exercise and Completion

Except to the extent already performed, all the provisions of this option to purchase share agreement will, so far as they are capable of being performed or observed, continue in full force and effect notwithstanding completion of the purchase and transfer of the Sale Shares (Completion).

4 WARRANTIES

4.1 Warranties

The Vendor warrants to the Purchaser that during the Option Period -

(a) the warranties given by the Vendor as set out in Schedule 2 (Warranties) are as at the date of this option to purchase share agreement and will immediately before Completion in respect of the facts then existing be, true and accurate in all respects;

(b) the contents of any disclosure in writing, and of all accompanying documents, are true and accurate in all respects and fully, clearly and accurately disclose every matter to which they relate;

(c) the Vendor will not permit the Company to introduce any new management for which negotiations for hire were not previously underway, or to adjust or introduce new operating or accounting methods without the written approval of Purchaser;

(d) the Vendor will not permit the Company to sell, transfer, lease, or encumber any material asset (if any);

(e) the Vendor will not permit the Company to make any expenditures outside the ordinary course of business, to declare or pay any dividends, to redeem any stock, to prepay any debt, to enter into non-standard agreements with its officers, directors or shareholders, to increase unreasonably the compensation to be paid to employees, to substantially modify any existing personnel or employee benefit policy or program or to create or modify any bonus plan, except as previously planned, or as approved in advance and in writing by the Purchaser;

(f) the Vendor will cause the Company to perform all its material obligations under the debt and lease instruments and other arrangements relating to or affecting the assets;

(g) the Vendor will not permit the Company to enter into any new, or to amend any existing, lease agreement other than renewals of existing leases in the ordinary course of business and on the terms not materially less favourable to the Company than the terms of its existing leases and equipment leases entered into the ordinary course of business, except as previously planned and made known to Purchaser, or as approved in advance and in writing by the Purchaser;

(h) the Vendor will cause the Company to keep in effect its present insurance policies or comparable insurance coverage; and

(i) the Vendor will cause the Company to use its best efforts to maintain and preserve its business organisation, retain its present employees, and to maintain its relationships with suppliers, customers, and others having business relations with the Vendor.

3

4.2 Basis of warranties

(a) Each of the Warranties is without prejudice to any other warranty or undertaking and, except where expressly stated, no Warranty contained in this option to purchase share agreement governs or limits the extent or application of any other Warranty.

(b) Each of the Warranties is deemed to be given as at the date of this option to purchase share agreement and to be repeated immediately before Completion in relation to the facts then existing.

4.3 Rights & remedies

The rights and remedies of the Purchaser in respect of any breach of the Warranties will not be affected by -

(a) Completion;

(b) any investigation made by or on behalf of the Purchaser into the affairs of the Company;

(c) any failure to exercise or delay in exercising any right or remedy or by any other event or matter whatsoever, except a specific and duly authorised written waiver or release; or

(d) any information the Purchaser may have received or been given or have actual implied or constructive notice of prior to the date of this option to purchase share agreement.

4.4 Due inquiry

Vendor undertakes that in relation to any Warranty which refers to the knowledge, information or belief of the Vendor, that the Vendor has made full inquiry into the subject matter of that Warranty.

4.5 Disclosure prior to completion

The Vendor must promptly disclose in writing to the Purchaser any event or circumstance, which arises or becomes known to the Vendor after the date of this option to purchase share agreement and prior to Completion, which is inconsistent with any of the Warranties, or which might be material to be known by a purchaser for value of the Sale Shares.

5 UNDERTAKINGS

5.1 Undertakings

Upon execution of this option to purchase share agreement, the Vendor must not do and must ensure none of the Connected Persons does, directly or indirectly, any of the following without first obtaining the written consent of the Purchaser: carry on (whether alone or in partnership or joint venture with anyone else) or otherwise be concerned with or interested in (whether as trustee, principal, agent, shareholder, unit holder or in any other capacity) any business which uses or includes as any part of its corporate or business name, the words 'SchmArt Technologies', other than in respect of or through the Company itself.

5.2 Injunction

The Vendor acknowledges that monetary damages would not be adequate compensation to the Purchaser for the Vendor's breach of either clauses 5.1 or 6.1 and that the Purchaser is entitled to seek an injunction from a court of competent jurisdiction.

4

6 CONFIDENTIALITY AND ANNOUNCEMENTS

6.1 Confidentiality

(a) Each party must treat as strictly confidential all information received or obtained as a result of entering into or performing this option to purchase share agreement which relates to the provisions or subject matter of this option to purchase share agreement, to any other party to this option to purchase sale agreement or the negotiations relating to this option to purchase share agreement.

(b) Each party must use its reasonable endeavours to cause all of its directors, officers, employees and agents who have or are likely to have access to all such information as referred to in clause 6.1(a), to observe all the obligations of confidentiality under this clause 6.

7 COSTS AND EXPENSES

7.1 Costs

Each party will bear its own costs and expenses incurred in the preparation, execution and implementation of this option to purchase share agreement.

7.2 Stamp duty

The Purchaser will pay all stamp and other transfer duties and registration fees applicable to any document to which it is a party and which arise as a result of or in consequence of this option to purchase share agreement.

8 NOTICES

8.1 How notices may be given

A notice, request, demand, consent or approval (each a notice) under this option to purchase share agreement:

(a) must be in writing;

(b) may be signed for the party giving it by the party's authorized officer, attorney or solicitor;

(c) may be delivered personally to the person to whom it is addressed, or left at or sent by prepaid post to the person's address stated on page 1 of this option to purchase share agreement or by facsimile.

8.2 When notice taken as given

A notice is taken as given by the sender and received by the intended recipient:

(a) if delivered by hand or courier prior to 5.00 p.m. on a business day (which expression means a business day in Texas, U.S.), at the time of delivery to the addressee or, if delivered by hand or courier at any other time, at 9.00 a.m. on the next business day following the date of delivery to the addressee;

(b) if sent by mail on the 3rd business day falling after the date of posting; or

(c) if transmitted by way of facsimile transmission prior to 5.00
p.m. on a business day, at the time of transmission, or if transmitted by way of facsimile transmission at any other time, at 9.00 a.m. on the next business day following the date of such transmission.

References to time are to time in Texas, U.S.

5

8.3 Proof

In providing the giving of a notice or any other document under or in respect of this option to purchase share agreement it shall be sufficient to show -

(a) in the case of mail that the notice or other document was duly addressed and posted; or

(b) in the case of facsimile transmission, that the notice or other document was duly transmitted from the despatching terminal as evidenced by a transmission report generated by the despatching terminal.

8.4 Change of address or fax number

A party may change its address or fax number for notices by giving notice to the other party.

9 TERMINATION

9.1 Vendors' right to terminate

The Vendor may, at any time while such default subsists, give a Notice of Termination to the Purchaser in the event that the Purchaser defaults in the satisfaction of the Consideration in accordance with the provisions of this option to purchase share agreement.

9.2 Purchaser's right to terminate

The Purchaser may, at any time while such default subsists, give a Notice of Termination to the Vendor in the event that there has been any material event, matter or circumstance which is inconsistent with, contrary to or otherwise a material breach of the Warranties or the provisions of this option to purchase share agreement.

9.3 Termination in event of bankruptcy

The Purchaser may, at any time, give a Notice of Termination to the Vendor if -

(a) the Vendor or any of the Other Shareholders is or becomes, or is adjudicated or found to be, bankrupt; or

(b) a distress, attachment or execution is levied or enforced upon, any part of the assets or undertaking of the Vendor or any of the Other Shareholders.

9.4 Consequences of termination

(a) In the event of a Notice of Termination being duly given under the provisions of clause 9.1, clause 9.2, or clause 9.3 -

(1) the Purchaser must, within seven days from the Notice of Termination, return all documents, if any, delivered to them by or on behalf of the Vendor to the Vendor;

(2) the Vendor must, within seven days from the Notice of Termination, return all documents, if any, delivered to them by or on behalf of the Purchaser and return any part of the Option Consideration received by or on behalf of the Vendor to the Purchaser.

9.5 Post-termination

Following the giving of a Notice of Termination under any of the provisions of this option to purchase share agreement, and complete performance of the obligations under clause 9.4 and subject to clause 10, neither party will have any further obligation under this option to purchase share agreement to the other party.

6

10 INDEMNIFICATION OF PURCHASER

a. For a period of two years from and after Completion, Vendor hereby agrees to indemnify, defend, and hold harmless Purchaser and its partners, officers, employees, advisors, affiliates, agents, representatives and assigns (the "Purchaser Indemnitees") from and against any and all liabilities, penalties, damages, losses, claims, costs, and expenses (including reasonable attorneys fees and expenses for the defense of any claim which, if proved, would give rise to an obligation of indemnity hereunder, notwithstanding that such claim may be settled prior to final judgment) arising out of or resulting directly or indirectly from (a) breach, falsity, inaccuracy, incompleteness or misleading nature of any warranty, representation or covenant by Vendor contained in this option to purchase share agreement; or (b) nonperformance of any obligations or covenants on the part of Vendor under this option to purchase share agreement (each hereafter a "Claim").

b. Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, the maximum amount that the Vendor shall be obligated to pay in respect of any and all obligations of indemnity under this clause 10 shall be equal to the sum of USD$150,000. In addition, a Claim shall not be brought by Purchaser under or pursuant to this clause 10, unless either (i) the amount of that Claim exceeds USD$10,000, or (ii) the aggregate amount of all Claims (whether reimbursed or unreimbursed, and including both theretofore made and any Claims then being made) exceeds USD$10,000.

11 GENERAL

11.1 Entire Agreement

This option to purchase share agreement -

(a) constitutes the entire agreement and understanding between the parties with respect to the matters dealt with in this option to purchase share agreement;

(b) supersedes any other agreement, letters, correspondence (oral or written or expressed or implied) entered into prior to this option to purchase share agreement in respect of the matters dealt with in this option to purchase share agreement; and

(c) was not entered into by the parties in reliance of any agreement, understanding, warranty or representation of any party not expressly contained or referred to in this option to purchase share agreement.

11.2 Execution

The execution of this option to purchase share agreement by or on behalf of a party shall constitute an authority to the solicitors acting for that party in connection with this option to purchase share agreement to deliver and date it on behalf of that party.

11.3 Effective date

This option to purchase share agreement will take effect on the date entered on the first page of this option to purchase share agreement irrespective of the diverse dates upon which the respective parties may have executed this option to purchase share agreement.

11.4 Amendments & additions

No amendment, variation, revocation, cancellation, substitution or waiver of, or addition or supplement to, any of the provisions of this option to purchase share agreement shall be effective unless it is in writing and signed by both of the parties.

7

11.5 Successors & assigns

This option to purchase share agreement will be binding upon and inure for the benefit of the respective heirs, personal representatives, successors-in-title or permitted assigns, as the case may be, of the parties.

11.6 No Partnership or agency

The provisions of this option to purchase share agreement will not be construed or taken to constitute -

(a) a partnership between the parties;

(b) either party to be the agent of the other party; or

(c) an authority to either party to represent or bind or pledge the credit of the other party in any way.

11.7 Invalidity & severability

If any provision of this option to purchase share agreement is or may become under any written law, or is found by any court or administrative body or competent jurisdiction to be, illegal, void, invalid, prohibited or unenforceable then -

(a) such provision will be ineffective to the extent of such illegality, voidness, invalidity, prohibition or unenforceability;

(b) the remaining provisions of this option to purchase share agreement will remain in full force and effect; and

(c) the parties must use their respective best endeavours to negotiate and agree a substitute provision which is valid and enforceable and achieves to the greatest extent possible the economic, legal and commercial objectives of such illegal, void, invalid, prohibited or unenforceable term, condition, stipulation, provision, covenant or undertaking.

11.8 Time of the essence

Time wherever mentioned is of the essence of this option to purchase share agreement, both as regards the dates and periods specifically mentioned and as to any dates and periods which may be agreed in writing between the parties be substituted for them.

11.9 Knowledge & acquiescence

Knowledge or acquiescence by any party of, or in, any breach of any of the provisions of this option to purchase share agreement will not operate as, or be deemed to be, a waiver of such provisions and, notwithstanding such knowledge or acquiescence, such party will remain entitled to exercise its rights and remedies under this option to purchase share agreement, and at law, and to require strict performance of all of the provisions of this option to purchase share agreement.

11.10 Rights & remedies

The rights and remedies provided in this option to purchase share agreement are cumulative, and are not exclusive of any rights or remedies of the parties provided at law or in equity, and no failure or delay in the exercise or the partial exercise of any such right or remedy or the exercise of any other right or remedy will affect or impair any such right or remedy.

11.11 Governing Law; Arbitration.

This option to purchase share agreement shall be governed in all respects in conformity with the intent of the parties as expressed in the provisions of this option to purchase share agreement. To the

8

extent any issue between the parties is not controlled by this Agreement, then any dispute between the parties shall be governed and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of Texas, U.S. without regard to its choice of law principles. UNLESS THIS AGREEMENT SPECIFICALLY PROVIDES FOR ANOTHER TYPE OF DISPUTE RESOLUTION WITH RESPECT TO A PARTICULAR KIND OF DISPUTE, ANY AND ALL CONTROVERSIES AND CLAIMS ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO THIS OPTION TO PURCHASE SHARE AGREEMENT, OR THE BREACH THEREOF, SHALL BE SETTLED BY FINAL AND BINDING ARBITRATION IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE COMMERCIAL ARBITRATION RULES OF THE AMERICAN ARBITRATION ASSOCIATION THEN IN EFFECT. Any such arbitration proceedings shall be and remain confidential. The panel of arbitrators for any such arbitration shall consist of three members of the American Arbitration Association, one of whom shall be selected by the Purchaser, one of whom shall be selected by the Vendor, and the third who will be selected by the other two. Judgment upon the decision rendered by the arbitrators may be entered in any court having jurisdiction thereof. The place of arbitration shall be Houston, Texas.


Schedule 1 - Corporate particulars

1. Registered number 655264-W

2. Date of Incorporation 8th June 2004

3. Address of registered office Unit 920, 9th Floor, Block A, Damansara Intan, No.1, Jalan SS 20/27, 47400 Petaling Jaya, Selangor Darul Ehsan

4. Authorized share capital RM500,000.00 divided into 500,000 ordinary shares of RM1.00 each

5. Issued share capital RM210,000.00 divided into 210,000 ordinary shares of RM1.00 each

6. Directors Yong Choy Lin @ Yong Chai Lin (F); Mohamed Ghazali Bin Ismail; and Zuriati Binti Mohamed Yusoff

7. Shareholders Yong Choy Lin @ Yong Chai Lin 30%

Mohamed Ghazali Bin Ismail 60%
(held on trust for Yong Choy Lin)

Edwin Pang Loo Chee 10% (held on
trust for Yong Choy Lin)

8. Secretary Rebecca Yu (MAICSA 0829744)

9. Accounting reference date 31st December

9


Schedule 2 - Warranties

I. The Vendor

A. Capacity

(1) The Vendor has the requisite power and authority to enter into and perform this option to purchase share agreement.

(2) This option to purchase share agreement constitutes and imposes valid legal and binding obligations on the Vendor and is fully enforceable in accordance with its terms.

(3) The Vendor has not entered into any prior option to purchase share agreement with any party to dispose of the Sale Shares of which the said agreement is still valid and subsisting.

II. Shares and Capital

A. Title

The Vendor is the beneficial owner of all the Sale Shares. The registered owners of the Sale Shares are as follows :

Registered Owners                                       Sale Shares
-----------------                                       -----------

Mohamed Ghazali Bin Ismail (NRIC : 490302-11-5041)          126,000
holding on trust for the Vendor

Vendor                                                       63,000

Edwin Pang Loo Chee (NRIC : 660224-04-5173)                  21,000
holding on trust for the Vendor

The Sale Shares are free of all Security Interests other than described above.

B. Issued capital

The Sale Shares constitute 100% of the total issued and paid up capital of the Company.

C. Capital

The authorised capital of the Company is RM500,000.00 divided into 500,000 ordinary shares of RM1.00 each. The amount of issued and paid up capital is RM210,000.00 divided into 210,000 ordinary shares of RM1.00 each.

D. Fully paid

The Sale Shares are fully paid and no money is owing to the Company in respect of them.

III. Company

A. Corporate existence

The Company -

(1) is a private limited company; and

(2) has the power to own its assets and carry on its business.

B. Compliance with constituent documents

The business affairs of the Company have been conducted in accordance with the constitution of the Company.

10

IV. Corporate matters

A. Insolvency of the Company

(1) No order has been made, no resolution has been passed, no petition presented, no meeting convened for the winding up of the Company or for a provisional liquidator to be appointed in respect of the Company and the Company has not been a party to any transaction which could be avoided in a winding up.

(2) No administration order has been made and no petition for one has been presented in respect of the Company.

(3) No receiver or administrative receiver has been appointed in respect of the Company or any of its assets.

(4) The Company :

(a) is not insolvent,

(b) has not failed and is able to pay, and has a reasonable prospect of being able to pay, any of its debts as they fall due,

as those expressions are defined in section 218 of the Companies Act 1965.

(5) The Company has not made or proposed any arrangement or composition with its creditors or any class of them.

(6) No distress, execution or other process has been levied on any of the Company's assets or action taken to repossess goods in the possession of the Company.

(7) No unsatisfied judgment is outstanding against the Company and no demand has been served on the Company under section 218 of the Companies Act.

V. Information

B. Accuracy and adequacy of information

(1) The information contained in schedules to this option to purchase share agreement is accurate and complete.

(2) All written information supplied to the Purchaser or its advisers by or on behalf of the Vendor or any of their advisers or by the Company is complete and accurate and is not misleading because of any omission or ambiguity or for any other reason and where information is expressed as an opinion, it is truly and honestly held and not given casually, recklessly or without due regard for its accuracy.

(3) So far as the Vendor is aware, there is no fact or circumstance relating to the business and affairs of any of the Company which, if disclosed to the Purchaser or any of its advisers, might reasonably be expected to influence the decision of the Purchaser to purchase the Sale Shares on the terms contained in this option to purchase share agreement and which has not been so disclosed.

VI. Accounts

A. Basis of preparation

The Accounts -

(1) have been prepared in accordance with current standard accountancy practices applicable to a Malaysian company;

(2) show a true and fair view of the financial position and the assets and liabilities of the Company at the Accounts Date;

11

(3) are not affected by any unusual or non-recurring item;

(4) take account of all gains and losses, whether realised or unrealised arising from any transaction; and

(5) include all reserves and provisions for taxation that are necessary to cover all Tax liabilities of the Company in respect of any period up to the Accounts Date.

B. Management Accounts

The management accounts fairly reflect the trading position of the Company as at the date and for the period to which they relate and are not affected by any extraordinary, exceptional, unusual or non-recurring income, capital gain or expenditure or by any other factor known by the Vendor rendering Profits or losses for the period covered exceptionally high or low.

C. Position since Accounts Date

Since the Accounts Date -

(1) the Company's business has been conducted in the ordinary course of business and in a proper and efficient manner;

(2) the Company has not incurred any liabilities other than in the ordinary course of business; and

(3) there has been no material adverse change affecting the business, the assets of the Company, or the financial or trading position or prospects of the Company.

VII. Properties

The Company has no interest in land.

VIII. Financial

A. Financial commitments and borrowings

(1) The Company is not a party to, nor has it agreed to enter into, any lending, or purported lending, agreement or arrangement (other than agreements to give credit in the ordinary course of its business).

(2) The Company is not exceeding any borrowing limit imposed upon it by its bankers, other lenders, its articles of association or otherwise nor has the Company entered into any commitment or arrangement which might lead it so to do.

(3) No event has occurred or been alleged which is or, with the passing of any time or the giving of any notice, certificate, declaration or demand, would become an event of default under, or breach of, any of the terms of any loan capital, borrowing or financial facility of the Company or which would entitle any person to call for repayment prior to normal maturity.

(4) The Company is not, nor has it agreed to become, bound by any guarantee, indemnity, surety or similar commitment.

IX. Trading and contracts

A. Contracts and commitments

(1) The Company is not a party to any agreement, arrangement or commitment which -

(a) has or is expected to have material consequences in terms of expenditure or revenue;

(b) relates to matters outside its ordinary business or was not entered into on arms' length terms;

12

(c) constitutes a commercial transaction or arrangement which deviates from the usual pattern for it;

(d) can be terminated in the event of any change in the underlying ownership or control of it or would be materially affected by such change;

(e) cannot readily be fulfilled or performed by it on time; or

(f) cannot be terminated, without giving rise to any liabilities on it, by it giving three months' notice or less.

however, the Purchaser and Company will enter into a Management Agreement on or about the date of this option to purchase share agreement.

B. Litigation and disputes

(1) Except for actions to recover any debt incurred in the ordinary course of the business owed to the Company -

(a) neither the Company nor any person for whose acts the Company may be liable is engaged in any litigation, arbitration, administrative or criminal proceedings, whether as plaintiff, defendant or otherwise;

(b) no litigation, arbitration, administrative or criminal proceedings by or against the Company or any person for whose acts it may be liable are threatened or expected and, as far as the Vendor are aware, none are pending; and

(c) there are no facts or circumstances likely to give rise to any litigation, arbitration, administrative or criminal proceedings against the Company or any person for whose acts it may be liable.

(2) The Company is not subject to any order or judgment given by any court or governmental or other authority, department, board, body or agency or has not been a party to any undertaking or assurance given to any court or governmental or other authority, department, board, body or agency which is still in force.

X. Assets

A. Charges and encumbrances over assets

(1) Save as described in paragraph II(A) above, no option, right to acquire, mortgage, charge, pledge, lien (other than a lien arising by operation of law in the ordinary course of trading) or other form of security or encumbrance or equity (Security Interest) on, over or affecting the shares or the whole or any part of the undertaking or assets of the Company, including any investment in any other company, is outstanding and, apart from this option to purchase share agreement, there is no agreement or commitment to give or create any of them and no claim has been made by any person to be entitled to any of them.

(2) The Company has not received notice from any person intimating that it will enforce any security which it may hold over the asset of the Company, and there are no circumstances likely to give rise to such a notice.

XI. Intellectual Property

(1) No licences, registered user or other rights have been granted or agreed to be granted by the Company to any person in respect of any Intellectual Property.

(2) Except in the ordinary course of business and on a confidential basis, no disclosure has been made of any of the confidential information, know-how, technical processes, financial or trade secrets or customer or supplier lists or information of the Company (Proprietary Rights).

13

(3) The Company's use of the Proprietary Rights is not infringing upon or otherwise violating the rights of any third party in or to such Proprietary Rights, and no proceedings have been instituted against or notices received by the Company that are presently outstanding alleging that the Company's use of its Proprietary Rights infringes upon or otherwise violates any rights of a third party in or to such Proprietary Rights.

XII. Employment

A. Industrial relations

(1) The Company is not a party to any contract, agreement or arrangement with any trade union or other body or organisation representing any of its employees.

(2) The Company has in relation to its employees and former employees complied with all conditions of service, customs and practices and, where relevant, all collective agreements and recognition agreements for the time being.

(3) No dispute has arisen between the Company and a material number or category of its employees nor are there any present circumstances known to the Vendors which are likely to give rise to any such dispute.

XIII. Taxation

(1) The Company has at all times been resident for Tax purposes in Malaysia, which is the only country whose Tax Authorities seek to charge tax on the Profits of the Company.

(2) Any Tax arising under any Taxation payable in respect of any transaction, income or asset of the Company will be paid.


IN WITNESS WHEREOF the parties hereto have hereunto set their hands the day and year first above written.

Signed by                        )
                                 )
YONG CHOY LIN @ YONG CHAI LIN    )
                                 )
presence of :-                   )           -----------------------------------
                                             YONG CHOY LIN @ YONG CHAI LIN

14

AGREED TO PRO FORMA:

Signed by                        )
                                 )
MOHAMED GHAZALI BIN ISMAIL       )
                                 )
presence of :-                   )           -----------------------------------
                                             MOHAMED GHAZALI BIN ISMAIL




Signed by                        )
                                 )
EDWIN PANG LOO CHEE              )
                                 )
presence of :-                   )           -----------------------------------
                                             EDWIN PANG LOO CHEE



Signed by : Michael L. Burrow    )           ENGlobal Engineering, Inc.
                                 )
ENGLOBAL Engineering Inc         )
                                 )
in the presence of :-            )           -----------------------------------
                                             By: Michael L. Burrow, Chairman of
                                             the Board

15

EXHIBIT 10.20

MANAGEMENT AGREEMENT

THIS AGREEMENT made on the 8th day of September, 2006

Between

ENGlobal Engineering Inc. a Texas Corporation, having its principal offices at 654 N. Sam Houston Parkway E., Suite 400, Houston, Texas 77060 (hereinafter referred to as "the Managing Company") .

and

SchmArt Technologies Sdn Bhd, a company incorporated in Malaysia and having its principal office at 15th Floor, Menara Kemayan, Jalan Ampang 50450 Kuala Lumpur (hereinafter referred to as "Owner").

WITNESSETH

WHEREAS:-

A. The Owner is engaged in the business of providing "low cost, high value" engineering and drafting services to customers in Malaysia and throughout the world (the "Business");

B. The Managing Company is experienced in providing engineering and drafting services to customers in the United States and throughout the world;

C. The Owner is desirous of retaining the services of the Managing Company as its technical operation manager of the Business and the Managing Company is desirous of performing such services in the manner and upon the terms and provisions hereinafter set forth;

D. Owner's Representative is herein defined as Jenny Schmieder.

1. COMMENCEMENT DATE AND VALIDITY

Subject to the terms and conditions herein, the Managing Company shall assume the responsibility as the technical operations manager of the Business for a period of three (3) years commencing from the effective date, renewable for subsequent periods of one (1) year each, unless specifically cancelled by either Owner or Managing Company in writing 60 days prior to the renewal date. The date of execution of this Agreement shall be the effective date. This Agreement shall be automatically terminated in the event of the sale or transfer of the entire issued and paid up share capital of the Owner.


2. SERVICES OF THE MANAGING COMPANY

2.1 The Managing Company is given discretionary power to:-

i. Supervise the technical performance of the Business;

ii. Hiring of engineers and drafters for the technical performance of the Business;

iii. Establishing work processes and procedures including quality control and assurance methods for executing all engineering and design work.

2.2 Save and except for the above, the Managing Company shall, subject to the supervision and approval of the board of directors of the Owner, use its reasonable efforts to operate and manage the technical operation of the Owner in accordance with the scope as herein stated.

i. In exercise of its function and performing its duty under this clause 2.2, the Managing Company shall comply with directions, guidelines and policies provided by the Owner at all material times.

ii. Managing Company shall take all reasonable steps to prevent and shall not cause any third party to cause to commit an act of breach of the terms and conditions herein or any act which is contrary to the directions, guidelines and/or policies issued by the Owner.

2.3 The board of directors of the Owner shall not unreasonably intervene in the actions of the Managing Company in managing the technical operation of the Owner as stated in clause 2.1 above.

2.4 The Managing Company shall at all times perform the services to be provided hereunder diligently and in a first class manner designed to protect and to promote the interests of the Owner in the profitable operation of the Business.

2.5 The scope of services provided in clause 2.1 above shall be further determined by mutual agreement by both Managing Company and Owner, including any future additions, deletions or modifications.

2.6 The Managing Company agrees that it shall at all time conduct the Business in a lawful manner and in full compliance with all applicable governmental laws, ordinances, rules and regulations. The Owner warrants that it is and it will at all times remain in compliance with all laws and ordinances relevant to this Agreement.

2.7 The parties will perform their respective obligations under this Agreement in good faith towards one another.

2

3. EMPLOYEE

3.1 The Managing Company is hereby authorized to employ, through the Owner, and supervise employees and/or independent contractors as may be reasonably required in performing its services in clause 2.1 above.

3.2 The Managing Company shall not be allowed to dismiss such employees and/or independent contractors without consultations and approval of the Owner's Representative (which approval shall not be unreasonably withheld) to ensure that such dismissal is/are fully in compliance with the Malaysia industrial relation practice and laws.

3.3 The employee/s and/or independent contractor/s so employed shall be deemed to be the employee/s and/or independent contractor/s of the Owner.

3.4 MANAGING COMPANY SHALL INDEMNIFY, DEFEND, AND HOLD OWNER, ITS EMPLOYEES, AGENTS, OFFICERS, DIRECTORS, SHAREHOLDERS, SUBSIDIARIES AND AFFILIATES HARMLESS FROM AND AGAINST ANY AND ALL LOSSES, COSTS, EXPENSES, LIABILITIES, CLAIMS AND/OR DEMANDS WHATSOEVER TO WHICH SUCH PARTIES MAY BE SUBJECTED TO BY REASON OF ANY INJURY TO ANY PERSON OR DAMAGE TO ANY PROPERTY OR CONTRACTUAL CLAIM BY ANY THIRD PARTY RESULTING FROM ANY AND ALL ACTIONS (OR FAILURES TO ACT) OF MANAGING COMPANY UNDER THIS AGREEMENT, EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT CAUSED BY OWNER'S NEGLIGENCE AND/OR WILLFUL MISCONDUCT. THE PARTIES AGREE AND ACKNOWLEDGE THAT THIS INDEMNIFICATION CLAUSE COMPLIES WITH THE EXPRESS NEGLIGENCE RULE, IF APPLICABLE, AND IS CONSPICUOUS.

OWNER SHALL INDEMNIFY, DEFEND AND HOLD MANAGING COMPANY, ITS EMPLOYEES, AGENTS, OFFICERS, DIRECTORS, SHAREHOLDERS, SUBSIDIARIES AND AFFILIATES HARMLESS FROM AND AGAINST ANY AND ALL LOSSES, COSTS, EXPENSES, LIABILITIES, CLAIMS AND/OR DEMANDS WHATSOEVER TO WHICH SUCH PARTIES MAY BE SUBJECTED TO BY REASON OF ANY INJURY TO ANY PERSON OR DAMAGE TO ANY PROPERTY OR CONTRACTUAL CLAIM BY ANY THIRD PARTY RESULTING FROM ANY AND ALL ACTIONS (OR FAILURES TO ACT) OF OWNER UNDER THIS AGREEMENT, EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT CAUSED BY MANAGING COMPANY'S NEGLIGENCE AND/OR WILLFUL MISCONDUCT. THE PARTIES AGREE AND ACKNOWLEDGE THAT THIS INDEMNIFICATION CLAUSE COMPLIES WITH THE EXPRESS NEGLIGENCE RULE, IF APPLICABLE, AND IS CONSPICUOUS.

3

4. PURCHASE OF SUPPLIES & CONTRACTS FOR LABOR & MATERIAL

All purchases of the necessary supplies and contracts for labor and material for providing the services shall be made upon a competitive basis and charged to the Owner, although Managing Company shall be under no obligation to seek or accept the lowest bid. All invoices shall be paid by the Owner and all discounts shall accrue to the benefit of the Owner.

5. FEE COLLECTION

5.1 The Managing Company shall be obligated to account to the Owner for all fees or other income derived from the Business.

5.2 Should it become necessary to seek legal action to collect any account owed to Owner, the Owner shall be responsible for taking such actions as may be necessary to recover such fees due. All expenses in connection with such legal recovery of debt proceedings shall be borne by the Owner. In the event the amount to be collected exceeds USD$50,000.00, no form of legal action shall be instituted and no settlement, compromise or adjustment of any matters involved herein shall be made without the prior written consent of Managing Company.

5.3 All monies collected by the Managing Company for the account of the Owner shall be promptly deposited with a bank or banks designated by the Owner.

6. PAYMENT TO MANAGING COMPANY

6.1 During the term of this Agreement, the Managing Company shall receive as its payment fifty percent (50%) of all pre-taxed profits from the Business for both Owner's local Malaysian clients and Managing Company's clients whose work is performed in Owner's Malaysian office.

6.2 Pre-Tax profits are defined as net profit after deduction of all interest expense but before income taxes or payment to the Managing Company required under clause 6.1 above, as calculated using generally accepted accounting principles and the accrual method of accounting.

6.3 The Owner will present the calculation, along with all supporting detail, to the Managing Company on or before March 1st of each year for Owner's preceding accounting year ending December 31st. The Owner shall provide Managing Company with full and complete sets of Owner's books and records to verify the Owner's calculation. Should the Managing Company agree with the calculation, the Owner shall pay Managing Company its payment within ten (10) days of receiving notice that Managing Company agrees with the calculation. In the event that the Managing Company does not agree with the calculation, Managing Company shall notify the owner in writing before March 15th of Managing Company's disagreement.

4

6.4 In the event of disagreement concerning the calculation, the matter shall be submitted to mediation to be held within thirty days. In the event that the payment calculation can not be resolved through mediation, the matter shall be submitted to arbitration after thirty days and the payment shall either be increased or decreased in accordance with Arbitration decision.

6.5 In the event that Managing Company exercises its Option to Purchase under the Option to Purchase Share Agreement with the shareholders of the Owner, the Managing Company and the vendor, Yong Choy Lin shall share the Pre-Tax Profits for the Business for a period of three (3) years from the date of the execution of this Agreement under the terms stated hereinabove. The parties shall each bear their pro-rata share of the total combined United States and Malaysian tax burden associated with their portion of the pre-tax profits.

7. MANAGEMENT OF RECORDS AND ACCOUNTS

7.1 The parties shall maintain an accounting system which is agreed upon by the parties including accurate books of account, records and reports of all matters pertaining to the Business in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, which books and records shall be compiled employing standards and procedures in conformity with mandatory requirements of Malaysian law.

7.2 The parties shall be kept in close touch with the Business and shall be promptly furnished to such extent and in such form and detail as they may from time to time reasonably require with particulars of any matters concerned with and arising out of the Business.

8. INSURANCE

8.1 The parties agree that the Owner shall procure and keep in force, at the Owner's expense, during the existence of this Agreement, comprehensive general liability insurance, to provide the following minimum coverage:-

     Bodily injury liability                        equivalent to $1,000,000 USD
     Professional liability insurance               equivalent to $5,000,000 USD
     Property Damage Liability                      equivalent to $1,000,000 USD
     Contractual liability:
                     Bodily Injury                  equivalent to $1,000,000 USD
                     Property Damage                equivalent to $1,000,000 USD

                                        5

9.   TERMINATION

9.1 In this Agreement, termination 'with cause' shall mean any termination by either party, which is effected due to either:-

i) the other party's failure to perform, breach, default, or non-compliance of any obligation after the date of its agreed execution and after reasonable notice of that failure, breach, default, or non-compliance has been given to the other party, and such failure, breach, default or non-compliance has not been rectified or remedied; or

ii) the happening of a frustrating event that was not contemplated by the parties.

9.2 In this Agreement, termination `without cause' shall mean any termination by either party, which is effected after pre-requisite 30 day notice in writing is given, where the other party has done nothing to warrant such a termination.

9.3 In essence, if the Managing Company wants to terminate this Agreement 'without cause', then the Managing Company will have to pay the Owner compensation of $50,000.00 and vice versa.

9.4 Upon reasonable notice in writing, this Agreement may be terminated immediately `with cause' by either party, upon the occurrence of any one of the following events:-

i) the filing by such other party of a voluntary petition in bankruptcy or insolvency, or a petition for reorganization or protection under any bankruptcy or insolvency law;

ii) the consent by such other party to any involuntary petition in bankruptcy or insolvency; or

iii) the making of an order or judgment by any competent court, on the application of a creditor, adjudicating such other party bankrupt or insolvent, or approving a petition seeking reorganization, or appointing a receiver, for all or a substantial part of such party's assets which order or judgment shall continue non-stayed and in effect for sixty (60) days.

9.5 In addition to clause 9.4, the Owner shall have the right to terminate this Agreement 'with cause' by reason of failure, breach, default, or non-compliance by the Managing Company with regard to any obligations contained in this Agreement, upon the failure by the Managing Company to remedy such a failure, breach, default or non-compliance within thirty (30) days of receipt of notice thereof from the Owner, unless the Managing Company has given a reasonable explanation as to its delay, after which the Owner shall extend the time period for an additional thirty (30) days or such longer period as may be agreed to by both parties. The Owner will be allowed to receive compensation of USD$50,000.00 for such failure, breach, default or non-compliance by the Managing Company.

6

9.6 In addition to clause 9.4, the Managing Company shall have the right to terminate this Agreement 'with cause' by reason of failure, breach, default, or non-compliance by the Owner with regard to any obligations contained in this Agreement, upon the failure by the Owner to remedy such a failure, breach, default or non-compliance within thirty (30) days of receipt of notice thereof from the Managing Company, unless the Owner has given a reasonable explanation as to its delay, after which the Managing Company shall extend the time period for an additional thirty (30) days or such longer period as may be agreed to by both parties. The Managing Company will be allowed to receive compensation of USD$50,000.00 for such failure, breach, default or non-compliance by the Owner.

9.7 In the event that the Managing Company fails to perform any obligation under this Agreement prior to termination, the Owner may fulfill the relevant obligation on behalf of the Managing Company and the Managing Company shall be liable to reimburse the Owner forthwith all sums expended by the Owner in relation to such failure.

9.8 In the event that the Owner fails to perform any obligation under the Agreement prior to termination, the Managing Company may fulfill the relevant obligation on behalf of the Owner, and the Owner shall be liable to reimburse the Managing Company forthwith all sums expended by the Managing Company in relation to such failure.

10. NO PROPERTY INTEREST CREATED

Nothing contained in this Agreement shall be deemed to create or shall be construed as creating in Managing Company any property interest in the Business. The Managing Company shall have no authority to convey or otherwise transfer, pledge or encumber any property or asset of the Business of the Owner, except in the ordinary course of business.

11. MANAGING COMPANY AS INDEPENDENT CONTRACTOR

Managing Company is an independent contractor and is not an employee of the Owner for any purpose. This Agreement is not intended to create, and shall not be construed as creating a partnership or joint venture between the parties. The duties and obligations of the Owner and Managing Company hereunder shall be several, and not joint or collective.

7

12. NOTICE

All notices required or permitted to be given under this Agreement shall be in writing and may be delivered by personal delivery, by facsimile, by nationally recognized private courier, by PDF/email, or by postal mail. Notice delivered by mail shall be deemed given five business days after deposit in the postal States mail, postage prepared, registered or certified mail, return receipt requested. Notices delivered by personal delivery, by facsimile, or by nationally recognized private courier shall be deemed given on the first business day following receipt. However, a notice delivered by facsimile or PDF/email shall only be effective upon electronic confirmation of receipt. All notices shall be addressed as follows:-

If to Owner:

SchmArt Technologies Sdn Bhd
15th Floor, Menara Kemayan Jalan Ampang Kuala Lumpur, Malaysia
Fax Number:
Email Address: richard@schmarttech.com

And if to the Managing Company at:

ENGlobal Engineering, Inc.
Attn: Michael L. Burrow
654 N. Sam Houston Parkway E., Suite 400 Houston, Texas 77060
Fax Number: 00 1 409-840-2338
Email Address: mike.burrow@englobal.com

13. ASSIGNMENT

This Agreement shall be binding on and inure to the benefit of the successors and assigns of the parties hereto; provided, however, that this Agreement may not be assigned by Managing Company without the prior written consent of Owner or by Owner without prior written consent of Managing Company.

14. MODIFICATION

This Agreement may not be modified unless such modification is in writing and signed by the parties to this Agreement.

15. MISCELLANEOUS

(a) CONFIDENTIALITY

Owner and Managing Company will each hold all confidential and proprietary information related to the performance of the services or this Agreement in strictest confidence and neither will use such information nor other information concerning either Owner or Managing Company for any purpose intended to result in economic gain, whether or not such undertaking might be competitively disadvantageous to Owner or Managing Company.

8

(b) SEVERABILITY

If any term or provision of this Agreement or the application thereof to any person or circumstance shall, to any extent, be invalid or unenforceable, the remainder of this Agreement or the application of such term or provision to persons or circumstances other than those as to which it is invalid or unenforceable shall not be affected thereby, and each term and provision of this Agreement shall be valid and enforceable to the extent permitted by law.

(c) COUNTERPART AND FAXES

This Agreement may be executed in two or more counterparts, each of which shall be deemed an original, and it shall not be necessary in making proof of this Agreement to produce or account for more than one counterpart. A signature transmitted by facsimile shall have the same force and effect as an original signature.

(d) INTERPRETATION

The headings in this Agreement are for convenience of reference only and shall not define or limit any of the terms or provisions hereof. All pronouns shall be deemed to refer to the masculine, feminine, neuter, singular or plural as the identity of the person or persons referred to may require. Each defined term identified herein with initial capital letters shall have the meaning ascribed to such term herein. Each party agrees that the language and all parts of this Agreement shall be construed as a whole according to its fair meaning, and irrespective of any party or its counsel's role in drafting this Agreement shall not be strictly construed for or against any party. The parties acknowledge that each has reviewed this Agreement and have had the opportunity to have it reviewed by its attorney and that any rule of construction to the effect that ambiguities are to be resolved against the drafting party shall not apply in the interpretation of this Agreement or any part thereof or attachment thereto.

(e) GOVERNING LAW; ARBITRATION.

This Agreement shall be governed in all respects in conformity with the intent of the parties as expressed in the provisions of this Agreement. If in the process of interpreting or carrying out this Agreement, there should arise any disputes between the parties, the parties shall make good-faith efforts to resolve them through mutual friendly consultation. To the extent any issue between the parties is not controlled by this Agreement, then any dispute between the parties shall be governed and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of Texas, United States of America, without regard to its choice of law principles. UNLESS THIS AGREEMENT SPECIFICALLY PROVIDES FOR ANOTHER TYPE OF DISPUTE RESOLUTION WITH RESPECT TO A PARTICULAR KIND OF DISPUTE, ANY AND ALL CONTROVERSIES AND CLAIMS ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO THIS AGREEMENT, OR THE BREACH THEREOF, SHALL BE SETTLED BY FINAL AND BINDING ARBITRATION IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE COMMERCIAL ARBITRATION RULES OF THE AMERICAN ARBITRATION ASSOCIATION THEN IN EFFECT. Any such arbitration proceedings shall be and remain confidential. The panel of arbitrators for any such arbitration shall consist of three members of the American Arbitration Association.

9

OWNER
SCHMART TECHNOLOGIES, SDN BHD

The Common Seal of                          )
SchmArt Technologies Sdn Bhd                )
(Company No 655264-W) was affixed here      )
in the presence of:                         )


, Director Director / Secretary

MANAGING COMPANY
ENGLOBAL ENGINEERING, INC.


Michael L. Burrow, Chairman of the Board

10

Exhibit 10.21

AMENDMENT OF THE PLAN FOR EGTRRA,
REVENUE RULING 2002-27 AND
REVENUE PROCEDURE 2002-29

AMENDMENT NUMBER ONE TO

ENGLOBAL 401 (K) PLAN


AMENDMENT OF THE PLAN FOR EGTRRA, REVENUE RULING 2002-27 AND
REVENUE PROCEDURE 2002-29

AMENDMENT NUMBER ONE TO ENGLOBAL 401(K) PLAN

BY THIS AGREEMENT, ENGlobal 40I (k) Plan (herein referred to as the Plan) is hereby amended as follows:

ARTICLE I
PREAMBLE

1.1 Adoption and effective date of amendment. This amendment of the Plan is adopted to reflect certain provisions of the Economic Growth and Tax Relief Reconciliation Act of 2001 (EGTRRA), the model amendment of Revenue Ruling 2002-27 and the model amendment of Revenue Procedure 2002-29. This amendment is intended as good faith compliance with the requirements of EGTRRA, the model amendment of Revenue Ruling 2002-27 and the model amendment of Revenue Procedure 2002-29 and is to be construed in accordance with EGTRRA, the model amendment of Revenue Ruling 2002-27 and the model amendment of Revenue Procedure 2002-29 and guidance issued thereunder. Except as otherwise provided, this amendment shall be effective as of the first day of the first Plan Year beginning after December 31, 2001.

1.2 Supersession of inconsistent provisions. This amendment shall supersede the provisions of the Plan to the extent those provisions are inconsistent with the provisions of this amendment.

ARTICLE II
LIMITATIONS ON CONTRIBUTIONS

2.1 Effective date. This Article shall be effective for "limitation years" beginning after December 31, 2001.

2.2 Maximum annual addition. Except to the extent permitted under Article VIII of this amendment and Code Section 414(v), the "annual addition" that may be contributed or allocated to a Participant's account under the Plan for any "limitation year" shall not exceed the lesser of:

(a) $40,000, as adjusted for increases in the cost-of-living under Code
Section 415(d),or

(b) one-hundred percent (100%) of the Participant's "415 Compensation" for the "limitation year."

The "415 Compensation" limit referred to in (b) shall not apply to any contribution for medical benefits after separation from service (within the meaning of Code Section 401(h) or Code Section 419A(f)(2)) which is otherwise treated as an "annual addition.(1)'


ARTICLE III
INCREASE IN COMPENSATION LIMIT

The annual Compensation of each Participant taken into account in determining allocations for any Plan Year beginning after December 31, 2001, shall not exceed $200,000, as adjusted for cost-of-living increases in accordance with Code Section 401(a)(17)(B).

ARTICLE IV
MODIFICATION OF TOP-HEAVY RULES

4.1 Effective date. This Article shall apply for purposes of determining whether the Plan is a top-heavy plan under Code Section 416(g) for Plan Years beginning after December 31, 2001, and whether the Plan satisfies the minimum benefits requirements of Code Section 416(c) for such years. This Article amends Article VIII of the Plan.

4.2 Determination of top-heavy status.

(a) Key employee. Key employee means any Employee or former Employee (including any deceased Employee) who at any time during the Plan Year that includes the determination date was an officer of the Employer having "415 Compensation" greater than $130,000 (as adjusted under Code Section 416(i)(l) for Plan Years beginning after December 31, 2002), a 5-percent owner of the Employer, or a 1-percent owner of the Employer having "415 Compensation" of more than $150,000. The determination of who is a key employee will be made in accordance with Code Section 416(i)(l) and the applicable regulations and other guidance of general applicability issued thereunder.

(b) Determination of present values and amounts. This section (b) shall apply for purposes of determining the present values of accrued benefits and the amounts of account balances of Employees as of the determination date.

(1) Distributions during year ending on the determination date. The present values of accrued benefits and the amounts of account balances of an Employee as of the determination date shall be increased by the distributions made with respect to the Employee under the Plan and any plan aggregated with the Plan under Code Section 416(g)(2) during the 1-year period ending on the determination date. The preceding sentence shall also apply to distributions under a terminated plan which, had it not been terminated, would have been aggregated with the Plan under Code Section 416(g)(2)(A)(i). In the case of a distribution made for a reason other than separation from service, death, or disability, this provision shall be applied by substituting "5-year period" for " 1-year period."

(2) Employees not performing services during year ending on the determination date. The accrued benefits and accounts of any individual who has not performed services for the Employer during the 1-year period ending on the determination date shall not be taken into account,

4.3 Minimum benefits. Employer matching contributions shall be taken into account for purposes of satisfying the minimum contribution requirements of Code Section 416(c)(2) and the Plan. The preceding sentence shall apply with respect to matching contributions under the Plan


or, if the Plan provides that the minimum contribution requirement shall be met in another plan, such other plan. Employer matching contributions that are used to satisfy the minimum contribution requirements shall be treated as matching contributions for purposes of the actual contribution percentage test and other requirements of Code Section 401(m).

ARTICLE V
DIRECT ROLLOVERS OF PLAN DISTRIBUTIONS

5.1 Effective date. This Article shall apply to distributions made after December 31, 2001.

5.2 Modification of definition of eligible retirement plan. For purposes of the direct rollover provisions in Section 6.13 p,63 of the Plan, an eligible retirement plan shall also mean an annuity contract described in Code Section 403(b) and an eligible plan under Code Section 457(b) which is maintained by a state, political subdivision of a state, or any agency or instrumentality of a state or political subdivision of a state and which agrees to separately account for amounts transferred into such plan from this Plan. The definition of eligible retirement plan shall also apply in the case of a distribution to a surviving spouse, or to a spouse or former spouse who is the alternate payee under a qualified domestic relation order, as defined in Code Section 414(p).

5.3 Modification of definition of eligible rollover distribution to exclude hardship distributions. For purposes of the direct rollover provisions in
Section 6.13 p. 63 of the Plan, any amount that is distributed on account of hardship shall not be an eligible rollover distribution and the distributee may not elect to have any portion of such a distribution paid directly to an eligible retirement plan.

ARTICLE VI
ROLLOVERS FROM OTHER PLANS

The Administrator, operationally and on a nondiscriminatory basis, may limit the source of rollover contributions that may be accepted by this Plan.

ARTICLE VII
REPEAL OF MULTIPLE USE TEST

The multiple use test described in Treasury Regulation Section 1.401(m)-2 and Section 4.7(a)(2) p.36 of the Plan shall not apply for Plan Years beginning after December 31, 2001.

ARTICLE VIII
CATCH-UP CONTRIBUTIONS

8.1 Effective date. This Article shall apply to catch-up contributions made on and after January 1, 2006.

8.2 Applicability. All Employees who are eligible to make salary reductions under this Plan and who are projected to attain age 50 before the end of a calendar year shall be eligible to make catch-up contributions as of the January 1st of that calendar year in accordance with, and subject to the limitations of, Code Section 414(v). Such catch-up contributions shall not be taken into account for purposes of the provisions of the Plan implementing the required limitations of Code Sections 402(g) and 415. The Plan shall not be treated as failing to satisfy the provisions of the 8.1


Plan implementing the requirements of Code Section 401(k)(3), 401(k)(l 1),
401(k)(12), 410(b), or 416, as applicable, by reason of the making of such catch-up contributions.

8.3 Matching contributions. Notwithstanding anything in the Plan to the contrary, catch-up contributions shall not be matched.

ARTICLE IX
SUSPENSION PERIOD FOLLOWING HARDSHIP DISTRIBUTION

A Participant who, after December 31, 2001, receives a hardship distribution pursuant to Regulation 1.401(k)-l(d)(2)(iv) of elective deferrals, shall be prohibited from making elective deferrals and after-tax Employee contributions under this Plan and all other plans maintained by the Employer for six (6) months after receipt of the hardship distribution. A Participant who receives such a hardship distribution in calendar year 2001 shall be prohibited from making elective deferrals and after-tax Employee contributions under this Plan and all other plans maintained by the Employer for six (6) months after receipt of the hardship distribution or until January 1, 2002, if later.

The provisions of paragraph (4) of Section 6.1 l(b) of the Plan with respect to limitations on the amount of deferrals in the year following a hardship distribution shall not apply for years beginning on or after January 1, 2002.

ARTICLE X
DISTRIBUTION UPON SEVERANCE FROM EMPLOYMENT

10.1. Effective date. This Article shall apply for distributions occurring on and after January 1, 2006 regardless of when severance from employment occurred.

10.2. New distributable event. A Participant's Elective Contributions and earnings attributable to these contributions shall be distributed on account of the Participant's severance from employment. However, such a distribution shall be subject to the other provisions of the Plan regarding distributions, other than provisions that require a separation from service before such amounts may be distributed.

ARTICLE XI
MODEL AMENDMENT UNDER REVENUE PROCEDURE 2002-29
MINIMUM DISTRIBUTION REQUIREMENTS

11.1 General Rules.

(a) Effective Date. The provisions of this Article will apply for purposes of determining required minimum distributions for calendar years beginning with the 2003 calendar year, as well as required minimum distributions for the 2002 distribution calendar year that are made on or after December 31, 2002.

(b) Coordination with Minimum Distribution Requirements Previously in Effect. If the total amount of 2002 required minimum distributions under the Plan made to the distributee prior to the effective date of this Article equals or exceeds the required minimum distributions determined under this Article, then no additional distributions will be required to be made for 2002 on or after such date to the distributee. If the total


          amount of 2002 required minimum distributions under the Plan made to
          the distributee prior to the effective date of this Article is less
          than the amount determined under this Article, then required minimum
          distributions for 2002 on and after such date will be determined so
          that the total amount of required minimum distributions for 2002 made
          to the distributee will be the amount determined under this Article.

     (c)  Precedence. The requirements of this Article will take precedence over
          any inconsistent provisions of the Plan.

     (d)  Requirements of Treasury Regulations Incorporated. All distributions
          required under this Article will be determined and made in accordance
          with the Treasury regulations under Code Section 40I(a)(9).

11.2    Time and Manner of Distribution.

     (a)  Required Beginning Date, The Participant's entire interest will be
          distributed, or begin to be distributed, to the Participant no later
          than the Participant's required beginning date.

     (b)  Death of Participant Before Distributions Begin. If the Participant
          dies before distributions begin, the Participant's entire interest
          will be distributed, or begin to be distributed, no later than as
          follows:

          (1) If the Participant's surviving spouse is the Participant's sole
          designated Beneficiary, then, except as provided in Section
          11.2(b)(3), distributions to the surviving spouse will begin by
          December 31st of the calendar year immediately following the calendar
          year in which the Participant died, or by December 31st of the
          calendar year in which the Participant would have attained age 70 1/2,
          if later.

          (2) If the Participant's surviving spouse is not the Participant's
          sole designated Beneficiary, then, except as provided in Section
          11.2(b)(3), distributions to the designated Beneficiary will begin by
          December 31st of the calendar year immediately following the calendar
          year in which the Participant died.

          (3) Participants or Beneficiaries may elect on an individual basis
          whether the 5-year rule or the life expectancy rule in Sections 1
          l,2(b) and 11.4(b) applies to distributions after the death of a
          Participant who has a designated Beneficiary. The election must be
          made no later than the earlier of September 30th of the calendar year
          in which distribution would be required to begin under Section
          11.2(b), or by September 30th of the calendar year which contains the
          fifth anniversary of the Participant's (or, if applicable, surviving
          spouse's) death. If neither the Participant nor Beneficiary makes an
          election under this paragraph, distributions will be made in
          accordance with Sections 11.2(b) and 11,4(b).

          (4) If there is no designated Beneficiary as of September 30th of the
          year following the year of the Participant's death, the Participant's
          entire interest will be distributed by December 31st of the calendar
          year containing the fifth anniversary of the Participant's death.


(5) If the Participant's surviving spouse is the Participant's sole designated Beneficiary and the surviving spouse dies after the Participant but before distributions to the surviving spouse begin, this Section 11,2(b), other than Section 11.2(b)(l), will apply as if the surviving spouse were the Participant.

For purposes of this Section 11.2(b) and Section 11.4, unless Section ll,2(b)(5) applies, distributions are considered to begin on the Participant's required beginning date. If Section 11.2(b)(5) applies, distributions are considered to begin on the date distributions are required to begin to the surviving spouse under Section 11.2(b)(l). If distributions under an annuity purchased from an insurance company irrevocably commence to the Participant before the Participant's required beginning date (or to the Participant's surviving spouse before the date distributions are required to begin to the surviving spouse under Section 11.2(b)(l)), the date distributions are considered to begin is the date distributions actually commence.

(c) Form of Distribution. Unless the Participant's interest is distributed in the form of an annuity purchased from an insurance company or in a single sum on or before the required beginning date, as of the first distribution calendar year distributions will be made in accordance with Sections 11.3 and 11.4 of this Article. If the Participant's interest is distributed in the form of an annuity purchased from an insurance company, distributions thereunder will be made in accordance with the requirements of Code Section 401(a)(9) and the Treasury regulations.

11.3    Required Minimum Distributions During Participant's Lifetime.

     (a)  Amount of Required Minimum Distribution For Each Distribution Calendar
          Year. During the Participant's lifetime, the minimum amount that will
          be distributed for each distribution calendar year is the lesser of:

          (1) the quotient obtained by dividing the Participant's account
          balance by the distribution period in the Uniform Lifetime Table set
          forth in Section 1.401(a)(9)-9 of the Treasury regulations, using the
          Participant's age as of the Participant's birthday in the distribution
          calendar year; or

          (2) if the Participant's sole designated Beneficiary for the
          distribution calendar year is the Participant's spouse, the quotient
          obtained by dividing the Participant's account balance by the number
          in the Joint and Last Survivor Table set forth in Section
          1.401(a)(9)-9 of the Treasury regulations, using the Participant's and
          spouse's attained ages as of the Participant's and spouse's birthdays
          in the distribution calendar year.

     (b)  Lifetime Required Minimum Distributions Continue Through Year of
          Participant's Death. Required minimum distributions will be determined
          under this Section 11.3 beginning with the first distribution calendar
          year and up to and including the distribution calendar year that
          includes the Participant's date of death,

11.4    Required Minimum Distributions After Participant's Death.

     (a)  Death On or After Date Distributions Begin.


(1) Participant Survived by Designated Beneficiary. If the Participant dies on or after the date distributions begin and there is a designated Beneficiary, the minimum amount that will be distributed for each distribution calendar year after the year of the Participant's death is the quotient obtained by dividing the Participant's account balance by the longer of the remaining life expectancy of the Participant or the remaining life expectancy of the Participant's designated Beneficiary, determined as follows:

(i) The Participant's remaining life expectancy is calculated using the age of the Participant in the year of death, reduced by one for each subsequent year.

(ii) If the Participant's surviving spouse is the Participant's sole designated Beneficiary, the remaining life expectancy of the surviving spouse is calculated for each distribution calendar year after the year of the Participant's death using the surviving spouse's age as of the spouse's birthday in that year. For distribution calendar years after the year of the surviving spouse's death, the remaining life expectancy of the surviving spouse is calculated using the age of the surviving spouse as of the spouse's birthday in the calendar year of the spouse's death, reduced by one for each subsequent calendar year.

(iii) If the Participant's surviving spouse is not the Participant's sole designated Beneficiary, the designated Beneficiary's remaining life expectancy is calculated using the age of the beneficiary in the year following the year of the Participant's death, reduced by one for each subsequent year.

(2) No Designated Beneficiary. If the Participant dies on or after the date distributions begin and there is no designated Beneficiary as of September 30th of the year after the year of the Participant's death, the minimum amount that will be distributed for each distribution calendar year after the year of the Participant's death is the quotient obtained by dividing the Participant's account balance by the Participant's remaining life expectancy calculated using the age of the Participant in the year of death, reduced by one for each subsequent year.

(b) Death Before Date Distributions Begin.

(1) Participant Survived by Designated Beneficiary. Except as provided in Section 11.4(b)(2), if the Participant dies before the date distributions begin and there is a designated Beneficiary, the minimum amount that will be distributed for each distribution calendar year after the year of the Participant's death is the quotient obtained by dividing the Participant's account balance by the remaining life expectancy of the Participant's designated Beneficiary, determined as provided in Section 11.4(a).

(2) Participants or Beneficiaries may elect on an individual basis whether the 5-year rule or the life expectancy rule in Sections 11.2(b) and 11.4(b) applies to distributions after the death of a Participant who has a designated Beneficiary. The election must be made no later than the earlier of September 30th of the (1)


          calendar year in which distribution would be required to begin under
          Section 11.2(b), or by September 30th of the calendar year which
          contains the fifth anniversary of the Participant's (or, if
          applicable, surviving spouse's) death. If neither the Participant nor
          Beneficiary makes an election under this paragraph, distributions will
          be made in accordance with Sections 11.2(b) and 11.4(b).

          (3) No Designated Beneficiary. If the Participant dies before the date
          distributions begin and there is no designated Beneficiary as of
          September 30th of the year following the year of the Participant's
          death, distribution of the Participant's entire interest will be
          completed by December 31st of the calendar year containing the fifth
          anniversary of the Participant's death.

          (4) Death of Surviving Spouse Before Distributions to Surviving Spouse
          Are Required to Begin. If the Participant dies before the date
          distributions begin, the Participant's surviving spouse is the
          Participant's sole designated Beneficiary, and the surviving spouse
          dies before distributions are required to begin to the surviving
          spouse under Section 11.2(b)(l), this Section 11.4(b) will apply as if
          the surviving spouse were the Participant.

11.5     Definitions.

     (a)  Designated Beneficiary. The individual who is designated as the
          Beneficiary under Section 1.7 p.2 of the Plan and is the designated
          Beneficiary under Code Section 401(a)(9) and section 1.401(a)(9)-l,
          Q&A-4, of the Treasury regulations.

     (b)  Distribution calendar year. A calendar year for which a minimum
          distribution is required. For distributions beginning before the
          Participant's death, the first distribution calendar year is the
          calendar year immediately preceding the calendar year which contains
          the Participant's required beginning date. For distributions beginning
          after the Participant's death, the first distribution calendar year is
          the calendar year in which distributions are required to begin under
          Section 11.2(b). The required minimum distribution for the
          Participant's first distribution calendar year will be made on or
          before the Participant's required beginning date. The required minimum
          distribution for other distribution calendar years, including the
          required minimum distribution for the distribution calendar year in
          which the Participant's required beginning date occurs, will be made
          on or before December 31st of that distribution calendar year.

     (c)  Life expectancy. Life expectancy as computed by use of the Single Life
          Table in section 1.401(a)(9)-9 of the Treasury regulations.

     (d)  Participant's account balance. The account balance as of the last
          valuation date in the calendar year immediately preceding the
          distribution calendar year (valuation calendar year) increased by the
          amount of any contributions made and allocated or forfeitures
          allocated to the account balance as of dates in the valuation calendar
          year after the valuation date and decreased by distributions made in
          the valuation calendar year after the valuation date. The account
          balance for the valuation calendar year includes any amounts rolled
          over or transferred to the plan either in the valuation calendar year
          or in the distribution calendar year if distributed or transferred in
          the valuation calendar year.


(e) Required beginning date. The date specified in Sections 6.5(e) p.55 and 66(g) p 59 of the Plan.

ARTICLE XII
MODEL AMENDMENT UNDER REVENUE RULING 2002-27
COMPENSATION

12.1 Effective date. This Article shall apply to Plan Years and "limitation years" beginning on and after January 1, 2006.

12.2 For purposes of the definition of compensation under the Plan that includes a reference to amounts under Code Section 125, amounts under Code Section 125 include any amounts not available to a Participant in cash in lieu of group health coverage because the Participant is unable to certify that he or she has other health coverage. An amount will be treated as an amount under Code Section 125 only if the Employer does not request or collect information regarding the Participant's other health coverage as part of the enrollment process for the health plan. 12.1


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, this Amendment has been executed this 24th day of October, 2005.

ENGlobal Engineering, Inc.

October 24, 2005

//s// William A. Coskey, CEO

      EMPLOYER


EXHIBIT 10.22

ENGLOBAL 401(K) PLAN

AND ALL SUPPORTING FORMS HAVE BEEN PRODUCED FOR

SCHWAB

Copyright 2005 SunGard Corbel
All Rights Reserved


ENGLOBAL 401 (K) PLAN


TABLE OF CONTENTS

                                    ARTICLE I
                                   DEFINITIONS


                                   ARTICLE II
                                 ADMINISTRATION

2.1      POWERS AND RESPONSIBILITIES OF THE EMPLOYER..........................14
2.2      DESIGNATION OF ADMINISTRATIVE AUTHORITY..............................15
2.3      ALLOCATION AND DELEGATION OF RESPONSIBILITIES........................15
2.4      POWERS AND DUTIES OF THE ADMINISTRATOR...............................15
2.5      RECORDS AND REPORTS..................................................17
2.6      APPOINTMENT OF ADVISERS..............................................17
2.7      INFORMATION FROM EMPLOYER............................................17
2.8      PAYMENT OF EXPENSES..................................................17
2.9      MAJORITY ACTIONS.....................................................17
2.10     CLAIMS PROCEDURE.....................................................18
2.11     CLAIMS REVIEW PROCEDURE..............................................19


                                   ARTICLE III
                                   ELIGIBILITY

3.1      CONDITIONS OF ELIGIBILITY............................................20
3.2      EFFECTIVE DATE OF PARTICIPATION......................................20
3.3      DETERMINATION OF ELIGIBILITY.........................................21
3.4      TERMINATION OF ELIGIBILITY...........................................21
3.5      OMISSION OF ELIGIBLE EMPLOYEE........................................21
3.6      INCLUSION OF INELIGIBLE EMPLOYEE.....................................21
3.7      REHIRED EMPLOYEES AND BREAKS IN SERVICE..............................21


                                   ARTICLE IV
                           CONTRIBUTION AND ALLOCATION

4.1      FORMULA FOR DETERMINING EMPLOYER CONTRIBUTION........................23
4.2      PARTICIPANT'S SALARY REDUCTION ELECTION..............................23
4.3      TIME OF PAYMENT OF EMPLOYER CONTRIBUTION.............................27
4.4      ALLOCATION OF CONTRIBUTION AND EARNINGS..............................27
4.5      ACTUAL DEFERRAL PERCENTAGE TESTS.....................................30

4.6      ADJUSTMENT TO ACTUAL DEFERRAL PERCENTAGE TESTS.......................32
4.7      ACTUAL CONTRIBUTION PERCENTAGE TESTS.................................35
4.8      ADJUSTMENT TO ACTUAL CONTRIBUTION PERCENTAGE TESTS...................37
4.9      MAXIMUM ANNUAL ADDITIONS.............................................40
4.10     ADJUSTMENT FOR EXCESSIVE ANNUAL ADDITIONS............................42
4.11     ROLLOVERS AND PLAN-TO-PLAN TRANSFERS FROM QUALIFIED
          PLANS...............................................................43
4.12     DIRECTED INVESTMENT ACCOUNT..........................................45
4.13     QUALIFIED MILITARY SERVICE...........................................47
4.14     2005 VOLUNTARY COMPLIANCE............................................47

                                    ARTICLE V
                                   VALUATIONS

5.1      VALUATION OF THE TRUST FUND..........................................47
5.2      METHOD OF VALUATION..................................................48


                                   ARTICLE VI
                   DETERMINATION AND DISTRIBUTION OF BENEFITS

6.1      DETERMINATION OF BENEFITS UPON RETIREMENT............................48
6.2      DETERMINATION OF BENEFITS UPON DEATH.................................48
6.3      DETERMINATION OF BENEFITS IN EVENT OF DISABILITY.....................50
6.4      DETERMINATION OF BENEFITS UPON TERMINATION...........................50
6.5      DISTRIBUTION OF BENEFITS.............................................51
6.6      DISTRIBUTION OF BENEFITS UPON DEATH..................................57
6.7      TIME OF SEGREGATION OR DISTRIBUTION..................................59
6.8      DISTRIBUTION FOR MINOR OR INCOMPETENT BENEFICIARY....................60
6.9      LOCATION OF PARTICIPANT OR BENEFICIARY UNKNOWN.......................60
6.10     PRE-RETIREMENT DISTRIBUTION..........................................60
6.11     ADVANCE DISTRIBUTION FOR HARDSHIP....................................61
6.12     QUALIFIED DOMESTIC RELATIONS ORDER DISTRIBUTION......................62
6.13     DIRECT ROLLOVER......................................................62

                                   ARTICLE VII
                    AMENDMENT, TERMINATION, MERGERS AND LOANS

 7.1        AMENDMENT.........................................................63

7.2      TERMINATION..........................................................64
7.3      MERGER, CONSOLIDATION OR TRANSFER OF ASSETS..........................65
7.4      LOANS TO PARTICIPANTS................................................65

                                  ARTICLE VIII
                                    TOP HEAVY

8.1      TOP HEAVY PLAN REQUIREMENTS..........................................66
8.2      DETERMINATION OF TOP HEAVY STATUS....................................66

                                   ARTICLE IX
                                  MISCELLANEOUS

9.1      PARTICIPANT'S RIGHTS.................................................69
9.2      ALIENATION...........................................................70
9.3      CONSTRUCTION OF PLAN.................................................71
9.4      GENDER AND NUMBER....................................................71
9.5      LEGAL ACTION.........................................................71
9.6      PROHIBITION AGAINST DIVERSION OF FUNDS...............................71
9.7      EMPLOYER'S AND TRUSTEE'S PROTECTIVE CLAUSE...........................72
9.8      INSURER'S PROTECTIVE CLAUSE..........................................72
9.9      Receipt and RELEASE FOR PAYMENTS.....................................72
9.10     ACTION BY THE EMPLOYER...............................................73
9.11     NAMED FIDUCIARIES AND ALLOCATION OF RESPONSIBILITY...................73
9.12     HEADINGS.............................................................73
9.13     APPROVAL BY INTERNAL REVENUE SERVICE.................................73
9.14     UNIFORMITY...........................................................74

                                    ARTICLE X
                             PARTICIPATING EMPLOYERS

10.1     ADOPTION BY OTHER EMPLOYERS..........................................74
10.2     REQUIREMENTS OF PARTICIPATING EMPLOYERS..............................74
10.3     DESIGNATION OF AGENT.................................................74
10.4     EMPLOYEE TRANSFERS...................................................75
10.5     PARTICIPATING EMPLOYER CONTRIBUTION AND FORFEITURES..................75
10.6     AMENDMENT............................................................75
10.7     DISCONTINUANCE OF PARTICIPATION......................................75
10.8     ADMINISTRATOR'S AUTHORITY............................................76


ENGLOBAL 401(K) PLAN

THIS PLAN is hereby adopted by ENGlobal Engineering, Inc. (herein referred to as the "Employer").

WITNESSETH:

WHEREAS, the Employer heretofore established a Profit Sharing Plan effective January 1, 1990, (hereinafter called the "Effective Date") known as ENGlobal 401(k) Plan (herein referred to as the "Plan") in recognition of the contribution made to its successful operation by its employees and for the exclusive benefit of its eligible employees; and

WHEREAS, under the terms of the Plan, the Employer has the ability to amend the Plan, provided the Trustee joins in such amendment if the provisions of the Plan affecting the Trustee are amended;

NOW, THEREFORE, effective October 1, 2005, except as otherwise provided, the Employer in accordance with the provisions of the Plan pertaining to amendments thereof, hereby amends the Plan in its entirety and restates the Plan to provide as follows:

ARTICLE I
DEFINITIONS

1.1 "Act" means the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as it may be amended from time to time.

1.2 "Administrator" means the person or entity designated by the Employer pursuant to Section 2.2 to administer the Plan on behalf of the Employer.

1.3 "Affiliated Employer" means any corporation which is a member of a controlled group of corporations (as defined in Code Section 414(b)) which includes the Employer; any trade or business (whether or not incorporated) which is under common control (as defined in Code Section 414(c)) with the Employer; any organization (whether or not incorporated) which is a member of an affiliated service group (as defined in Code Section 414(m)) which includes the Employer; and any other entity required to be aggregated with the Employer pursuant to Regulations under Code Section 414(o).

1.4 "Aggregate Account" means, with respect to each Participant, the value of all accounts maintained on behalf of a Participant, whether attributable to Employer or Employee contributions, subject to the provisions of Section 8.2.

1.5 "Anniversary Date" means the last day of the Plan Year.

1.6 "Annuity Starting Date" means, with respect to any Participant, the first day of the first period for which an amount is paid as an annuity, or, in the case of a benefit not payable in the form of an annuity, the first day on which all events have occurred which entitles the Participant to such benefit.

1

1.7 "Beneficiary" means the person (or entity) to whom the share of a deceased Participant's total account is payable, subject to the restrictions of Sections 6.2 and 6.6.

1.8 "Code" means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended or replaced from time to time.

1.9 "Compensation" with respect to any Participant means such Participant's wages as defined in Code Section 3401 (a) and all other payments of compensation by the Employer (in the course of the Employer's trade or business) for a Plan Year for which the Employer is required to furnish the Participant a written statement under Code Sections 604l(d), 6051(a)(3) and 6052. Compensation must be determined without regard to any rules under Code Section 3401 (a) that limit the remuneration included in wages based on the nature or location of the employment or the services performed (such as the exception for agricultural labor in Code Section 3401(a)(2)).

For purposes of this Section, the determination of Compensation shall be made by:

(a) excluding (even if includible in gross income) reimbursements or other expense allowances, fringe benefits (cash or noncash), moving expenses, deferred compensation, and welfare benefits.

(b) including amounts which are contributed by the Employer pursuant to a salary reduction agreement and which are not includible in the gross income of the Participant under Code Sections 125,132(f)(4), 402(e)(3),
402(h)(l)(B), 403(b) or 457(b), and Employee contributions described in Code Section 414(h)(2) that are treated as Employer contributions.

For a Participant's initial year of participation, Compensation shall be recognized as of such Employee's effective date of participation pursuant to
Section 3.2.

Compensation in excess of $150,000 (or such other amount provided in the Code) shall be disregarded for all purposes other than for purposes of salary deferral elections pursuant to Section 4,2. Such amount shall be adjusted for increases in the cost of living in accordance with Code Section 401(a)(17)(B), except that the dollar increase in effect on January 1 of any calendar year shall be effective for the Plan Year beginning with or within such calendar year. For any short Plan Year the Compensation limit shall be an amount equal to the Compensation limit for the calendar year in which the Plan Year begins multiplied by the ratio obtained by dividing the number of full months in the short Plan Year by twelve (12).

If any class of Employees is excluded from the Plan, then Compensation for any Employee who becomes eligible or ceases to be eligible to participate during a Plan Year shall only include Compensation while the Employee is an Eligible Employee.

For purposes of this Section, if the Plan is a plan described in Code
Section 413(c) or 414(f) (a plan maintained by more than one Employer), the limitation applies separately with respect to the Compensation of any Participant from each Employer maintaining the Plan.

1.10 "Contract" or "Policy" means any life insurance policy, retirement income policy or annuity contract (group or individual) issued pursuant to the terms of the Plan. In the event of any conflict between the terms of this Plan and the terms of any contract purchased hereunder, the Plan provisions shall control.

2

1.11 "Deferred Compensation" with respect to any Participant means the amount of the Participant's total Compensation which has been contributed to the Plan in accordance with the Participant's deferral election pursuant to Section 4.2 excluding any such amounts distributed as excess "annual additions" pursuant to Section 4.10(a).

1.12 "Designated Investment Alternative" means a specific investment identified by name by the Employer (or such other Fiduciary who has been given the authority to select investment options) as an available investment under the Plan to which Plan assets may be invested by the Trustee pursuant to the investment direction of a Participant.

1.13 "Directed Investment Option" means one or more of the following:

(a) a Designated Investment Alternative.

(b) any other investment permitted by the Plan and the Participant Direction Procedures to which Plan assets may be invested by the Trustee pursuant to the investment direction of a Participant.

1.14 "Early Retirement Date" means the date on which a Participant or Former Participant attains age 55, and has completed at least 3 whole year Periods of Service with the Employer (Early Retirement Age). A Participant shall become fully Vested upon satisfying this requirement if still employed at Early Retirement Age.

A Former Participant who separates from service after satisfying the service requirement for Early Retirement and who thereafter reaches the age requirement contained herein shall be entitled to receive benefits under this Plan.

1.15 "Elective Contribution" means the Employer contributions to the Plan of Deferred Compensation excluding any such amounts distributed as excess "annual additions" pursuant to Section 4.10(a). In addition, any Employer Qualified Non-Elective Contribution made pursuant to Section 4.6(b) which is used to satisfy the "Actual Deferral Percentage" tests shall be considered an Elective Contribution for purposes of the Plan. Any contributions deemed to be Elective Contributions (whether or not used to satisfy the "Actual Deferral Percentage" tests or the "Actual Contribution Percentage" tests) shall be subject to the requirements of Sections 4.2(b) and 4.2(c) and shall further be required to satisfy the nondiscrimination requirements of Regulation 1.401(k)-l(b)(5) and Regulation 1.401(m)-l(b)(5), the provisions of which are specifically incorporated herein by reference.

1.16 "Eligible Employee" means any Employee, subject to the following:

Employees who are Leased Employees within the meaning of Code Sections 414(n)(2) and 414(o)(2) shall not be eligible to participate in this Plan.

Employees whose employment is governed by the terms of a collective bargaining agreement between Employee representatives (within the meaning of Code Section 7701(a)(46)) and the Employer under which retirement benefits were the subject of good faith bargaining between the parties will not be eligible to participate in this Plan unless such agreement expressly provides for coverage in this Plan.

3

Employees who are nonresident aliens (within the meaning of Code Section 7701(b)(l)(B)) and who receive no earned income (within the meaning of Code
Section 91 l(d)(2)) from the Employer which constitutes income from sources within the United States (within the meaning of Code Section 861(a)(3)) shall not be eligible to participate in this Plan.

Employees of Affiliated Employers shall not be eligible to participate in this Plan unless such Affiliated Employers have specifically adopted this Plan in writing.

Employees classified by the Employer as independent contractors who are subsequently determined by the Internal Revenue Service to be Employees shall not be Eligible Employees for the period during which they were classified as independent contractors.

1.17 "Employee" means any person who is employed by the Employer or Affiliated Employer, and excludes any person who is employed as an independent contractor. Employee shall include Leased Employees within the meaning of Code Sections 414(n)(2) and 414(o)(2) unless such Leased Employees are covered by a plan described in Code Section 414(n)(5) and such Leased Employees do not constitute more than 20% of the recipient's non-highly compensated work force.

1.18 "Employer" means ENGlobal Engineering, Inc. and any successor which shall maintain this Plan; and any predecessor which has maintained this Plan. The Employer is a corporation, with principal offices in the State of Texas. In addition, where appropriate, the term Employer shall include any Participating Employer (as defined in Section 10.1) which shall adopt this Plan.

1.19 "Excess Aggregate Contributions" means, with respect to any Plan Year, the excess of the aggregate amount of the Employer matching contributions made pursuant to Section 4.1 (b) and any qualified non-elective contributions or elective deferrals taken into account pursuant to Section 4.7(c) on behalf of Highly Compensated Participants for such Plan Year, over the maximum amount of such contributions permitted under the limitations of Section 4.7(a) (determined by hypothetically reducing contributions made on behalf of Highly Compensated Participants in order of the actual contribution ratios beginning with the highest of such ratios). Such determination shall be made after first taking into account corrections of any Excess Deferred Compensation pursuant to Section 4.2 and taking into account any adjustments of any Excess Contributions pursuant to Section 4.6.

1.20 "Excess Contributions" means, with respect to a Plan Year, the excess of Elective Contributions used to satisfy the "Actual Deferral Percentage" tests made on behalf of Highly Compensated Participants for the Plan Year over the maximum amount of such contributions permitted under Section 4.5(a) (determined by hypothetically reducing contributions made on behalf of Highly Compensated Participants in order of the actual deferral ratios beginning with the highest of such ratios). Excess Contributions shall be treated as an "annual addition" pursuant to Section 4.9(b).

4

1.21 "Excess Deferred Compensation" means, with respect to any taxable year of a Participant, the excess of the aggregate amount of such Participant's Deferred Compensation and the elective deferrals pursuant to Section 4.2(f) actually made on behalf of such Participant for such taxable year, over the dollar limitation provided for in Code Section 402(g), which is incorporated herein by reference. Excess Deferred Compensation shall be treated as an "annual addition" pursuant to Section 4.9(b) when contributed to the Plan unless distributed to the affected Participant not later than the first April 15th following the close of the Participant's taxable year. Additionally, for purposes of Sections 8.2 and 4.4(g), Excess Deferred Compensation shall continue to be treated as Employer contributions even if distributed pursuant to Section
4.2(f). However, Excess Deferred Compensation of Non-Highly Compensated Participants is not taken into account for purposes of Section 4.5(a) to the extent such Excess Deferred Compensation occurs pursuant to Section 4.2(d).

1.22 "Fiduciary" means any person who (a) exercises any discretionary authority or discretionary control respecting management of the Plan or exercises any authority or control respecting management or disposition of its assets, (b) renders investment advice for a fee or other compensation, direct or indirect, with respect to any monies or other property of the Plan or has any authority or responsibility to do so, or (c) has any discretionary authority or discretionary responsibility in the administration of the Plan.

1.23 "Fiscal Year" means the Employer's accounting year of 12 months commencing on January 1 of each year and ending the following December 31.

1.24 "Forfeiture" means that portion of a Participant's Account that is not Vested, and occurs on the earlier of:

(a) the distribution of the entire Vested portion of the Participant's Account of a Former Participant who has severed employment with the Employer, or

(b) the last day of the Plan Year in which a Former Participant who has severed employment with the Employer incurs five (5) consecutive 1-Year Breaks in Service.

Regardless of the preceding provisions, if a Former Participant is eligible to share in the allocation of Employer contributions or Forfeitures in the year in which the Forfeiture would otherwise occur, then the Forfeiture will not occur until the end of the first Plan Year for which the Former Participant is not eligible to share in the allocation of Employer contributions or Forfeitures. Furthermore, the term "Forfeiture" shall also include amounts deemed to be Forfeitures pursuant to any other provision of this Plan.

1.25 "Former Participant" means a person who has been a Participant, but who has ceased to be a Participant for any reason.

1.26 "415 Compensation" with respect to any Participant means such Participant's wages as defined in Code Section 3401 (a) and all other payments of compensation by the Employer (in the course of the Employer's trade or business) for a Plan Year for which the Employer is required to furnish the Participant a written statement under Code Sections 604 l(d), 6051(a)(3) and 6052. "415 Compensation" must be determined without regard to any rules under

5

Code Section 3401(a) that limit the remuneration included in wages based on the nature or location of the employment or the services performed (such as the exception for agricultural labor in Code Section 3401(a)(2)).

For purposes of this Section, the determination of "415 Compensation" shall include any elective deferral (as defined in Code Section 402(g)(3))f and any amount which is contributed or deferred by the Employer at the election of the Participant and which is not includible in the gross income of the Participant by reason of Code Sections 125, 132(f}(4) or 457.

1.27 "414(s) Compensation" means any definition of compensation that satisfies the nondiscrimination requirements of Code Section 414(s) and the Regulations thereunder. The period for determining 414(s) Compensation must be either the Plan Year or the calendar year ending with or within the Plan Year. An Employer may further limit the period taken into account to that part of the Plan Year or calendar year in which an Employee was a Participant in the component of the Plan being tested. The period used to determine 414(s) Compensation must be applied uniformly to all Participants for the Plan Year.

1.28 "Highly Compensated Employee" means an Employee described in Code
Section 414(q) and the Regulations thereunder, and generally means any Employee who:

(a) was a "five percent owner" as defined in Section 1,34(c) at any time during the "determination year" or the "look-back year"; or

(b) for the "look-back year" had "415 Compensation" from the Employer in excess of $80,000. The $80,000 amount is adjusted at the same time and in the same manner as under Code Section 415(d), except that the base period is the calendar quarter ending September 30, 1996.

The "determination year" means the Plan Year for which testing is being performed, and the "look-back year" means the immediately preceding twelve (12) month period.

A highly compensated former Employee is based on the rules applicable to determining Highly Compensated Employee status as in effect for the "determination year," in accordance with Regulation 1.414(q)-lT, A-4 and IRS Notice 97-45 (or any superseding guidance).

In determining who is a Highly Compensated Employee, Employees who are non-resident aliens and who received no earned income (within the meaning of Code Section 911 (d)(2) from the Employer constituting United States source income within the meaning of Code Section 861(a)(3) shall not be treated as Employees. Additionally, all Affiliated Employers shall be taken into account as a single employer and Leased Employees within the meaning of Code Sections 414(n)(2) and 414(o)(2) shall be considered Employees unless such Leased Employees are covered by a plan described in Code Section 414(n)(5) and are not covered in any qualified plan maintained by the Employer. The exclusion of Leased Employees for this purpose shall be applied on a uniform and consistent basis for all of the Employer's retirement plans. Highly Compensated Former Employees shall be treated as Highly Compensated Employees without regard to whether they performed services during the "determination year."

6

1.29 "Highly Compensated Participant" means any Highly Compensated Employee who is eligible to participate in the component of the Plan being tested.

1.30 "Hour of Service" means, for purposes of eligibility for participation and vesting, each hour for which an Employee is paid or entitled to payment for the performance of duties for the Employer.

1.31 "Hour of Service" means, for purposes of benefit accrual, (1) each hour for which an Employee is directly or indirectly compensated or entitled to compensation by the Employer for the performance of duties (these hours will be credited to the Employee for the computation period in which the duties are performed); (2) each hour for which an Employee is directly or indirectly compensated or entitled to compensation by the Employer (irrespective of whether the employment relationship has terminated) for reasons other than performance of duties (such as vacation, holidays, sickness, jury duty, disability, lay-off, military duty or leave of absence) during the applicable computation period (these hours will be calculated and credited pursuant to Department of Labor regulation 2530.200b~2 which is incorporated herein by reference); (3) each hour for which back pay is awarded or agreed to by the Employer without regard to mitigation of damages (these hours will be credited to the Employee for the computation period or periods to which the award or agreement pertains rather than the computation period in which the award, agreement or payment is made). The same Hours of Service shall not be credited both under (1) or (2), as the case may be, and under (3).

Notwithstanding (2) above, (i) no more than 501 Hours of Service are required to be credited to an Employee on account of any single continuous period during which the Employee performs no duties (whether or not such period occurs in a single computation period); (ii) an hour for which an Employee is directly or indirectly paid, or entitled to payment, on account of a period during which no duties are performed is not required to be credited to the Employee if such payment is made or due under a plan maintained solely for the purpose of complying with applicable worker's compensation, or unemployment compensation or disability insurance laws; and (iii) Hours of Service are not required to be credited for a payment which solely reimburses an Employee for medical or medically related expenses incurred by the Employee.

For purposes of (2) above, a payment shall be deemed to be made by or due from the Employer regardless of whether such payment is made by or due from the Employer directly, or indirectly through, among others, a trust fund, or insurer, to which the Employer contributes or pays premiums and regardless of whether contributions made or due to the trust fund, insurer, or other entity are for the benefit of particular Employees or are on behalf of a group of Employees in the aggregate.

For purposes of this Section, Hours of Service will be credited for employment with other Affiliated Employers. The provisions of Department of Labor regulations 2530.200b-2(b) and (c) are incorporated herein by reference.

1.32 "Income" means the income or losses allocable to "excess amounts" which shall equal the allocable gain or loss for the "applicable computation period". The income allocable to "excess amounts" for the "applicable computation period" is determined by multiplying the income for the "applicable

7

computation period" by a fraction. The numerator of the fraction is the "excess amount" for the "applicable computation period." The denominator of the fraction is the total "account balance" attributable to "Employer contributions" as of the end of the "applicable computation period", reduced by the gain allocable to such total amount for the "applicable computation period" and increased by the loss allocable to such total amount for the "applicable computation period". The provisions of this Section shall be applied;

(a) For purposes of Section 4.2(f), by substituting:

(1) "Excess Deferred Compensation" for "excess amounts";

(2) "taxable year of the Participant" for "applicable computation period";

(3) "Deferred Compensation" for "Employer contributions"; and

(4) "Participant's Elective Account" for "account balance."

(b) For purposes of Section 4.6(a), by substituting:

(1) "Excess Contributions" for "excess amounts";

(2) "Plan Year" for "applicable computation period";

(3) "Elective Contributions" for "Employer contributions"; and

(4) "Participant's Elective Account" for "account balance."

(c) For purposes of Section 4.8(a), by substituting:

(1) "Excess Aggregate Contributions" for "excess amounts";

(2) "Plan Year" for "applicable computation period";

(3) "Employer matching contributions made pursuant to Section 4.1 (b) and any qualified non-elective contributions or elective deferrals taken into account pursuant to Section 4.7(c)" for "Employer contributions"; and

(4) "Participant's Account" for "account balance."

Income allocable to any distribution of Excess Deferred Compensation on or before the last day of the taxable year of the Participant shall be calculated from the first day of the taxable year of the Participant to the date on which the distribution is made pursuant to either the "fractional method" or the "safe harbor method." Under such "safe harbor method," allocable Income for such period shall be deemed to equal ten percent (10%) of the Income allocable to such Excess Deferred Compensation multiplied by the number of calendar months in such period. For purposes of determining the number of calendar months in such period, a distribution occurring on or before the fifteenth day of the month shall be treated as having been made on the last day of the preceding month and a distribution occurring after such fifteenth day shall be treated as having been made on the first day of the next subsequent month.

8

1.33 "Investment Manager" means an entity that (a) has the power to manage, acquire, or dispose of Plan assets and (b) acknowledges fiduciary responsibility to the Plan in writing. Such entity must be a person, firm, or corporation registered as an investment adviser under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, a bank, or an insurance company.

1.34 "Key Employee" means an Employee as defined in Code Section 416(i) and the Regulations thereunder. Generally, any Employee or former Employee (as well as each of the Employee's or former Employee's Beneficiaries) is considered a Key Employee if the Employee, at any time during the Plan Year that contains the "Determination Date" or any of the preceding four (4) Plan Years, has been included in one of the following categories:

(a) an officer of the Employer (as that term is defined within the meaning of the Regulations under Code Section 416) having annual "415 Compensation" greater than 50 percent of the amount in effect under Code
Section 415(b)(l)(A) for any such Plan Year.

(b) one of the ten employees having annual "415 Compensation" from the Employer for a Plan Year greater than the dollar limitation in effect under Code Section 415(c)(l)(A) for the calendar year in which such Plan Year ends and owning (or considered as owning within the meaning of Code Section 318) both more than one-half percent interest and the largest interests in the Employer.

(c) a "five percent owner" of the Employer. "Five percent owner" means any person who owns (or is considered as owning within the meaning of Code
Section 318) more than five percent (5%) of the outstanding stock of the Employer or stock possessing more than five percent (5%) of the total combined voting power of all stock of the Employer or, in the case of an unincorporated business, any person who owns more than five percent (5%) of the capital or profits interest in the Employer. In determining percentage ownership hereunder, employers that would otherwise be aggregated under Code Sections 414(b), (c), (m) and (o) shall be treated as separate employers.

(d) a "one percent owner" of the Employer having an annual "415 Compensation" from the Employer of more than $150,000. "One percent owner" means any person who owns (or is considered as owning within the meaning of Code Section 318) more than one percent (1%) of the outstanding stock of the Employer or stock possessing more than one percent (1%) of the total combined voting power of all stock of the Employer or, in the case of an unincorporated business, any person who owns more than one percent (1%) of the capital or profits interest in the Employer. In determining percentage ownership hereunder, employers that would otherwise be aggregated under Code Sections 414(b), (c), (m) and (o) shall be treated as separate employers. However, in determining whether an individual has "415 Compensation" of more than $150,000, "415 Compensation" from each employer required to be aggregated under Code Sections 414(b), (c), (m) and (o) shall be taken into account.

9

For purposes of this Section, the determination of "415 Compensation" shall be made by including amounts which are contributed by the Employer pursuant to a salary reduction agreement and which are not includible in the gross income of the Participant under Code Sections 125, 132(f)(4), 402(e)(3), 402(h)(l)(B), 403(b) or 457(b), and Employee contributions described in Code Section 414(h)(2) that are treated as Employer contributions.

1.35 "Late Retirement Date" means a Participant's actual Retirement Date after having reached Normal Retirement Date.

1.36 "Leased Employee" means any person (other than an Employee of the recipient Employer) who pursuant to an agreement between the recipient Employer and any other person or entity ("leasing organization") has performed services for the recipient (or for the recipient and related persons determined in accordance with Code Section 414(n)(6)) on a substantially foil time basis for a period of at least one year, and such services are performed under primary direction or control by the recipient Employer, Contributions or benefits provided a Leased Employee by the leasing organization which are attributable to services performed for the recipient Employer shall be treated as provided by the recipient Employer. Furthermore, Compensation for a Leased Employee shall only include Compensation from the leasing organization that is attributable to services performed for the recipient Employer. A Leased Employee shall not be considered an Employee of the recipient Employer:

(a) if such employee is covered by a money purchase pension plan providing:

(1) a nonintegrated employer contribution rate of at least 10% of compensation, as defined in Code Section 415(c)(3);

(2) immediate participation;

(3) full and immediate vesting; and

(b) if Leased Employees do not constitute more than 20% of the recipient Employer's nonhighly compensated work force.

1.37 "Non-Elective Contribution" means the Employer contributions to the Plan excluding, however, contributions made pursuant to the Participant's deferral election provided for in Section 4.2 and any Qualified Non-Elective Contribution used in the "Actual Deferral Percentage" tests,

1.38 "Non-Highly Compensated Participant" means any Participant who is not a Highly Compensated Employee. However, for purposes of Section 4.5(a) and
Section 4.6, if the prior year testing method is used, a Non-Highly Compensated Participant shall be determined using the definition of Highly Compensated Employee in effect for the preceding Plan Year.

1.39 "Non-Key Employee" means any Employee or former Employee (and such Employee's or former Employee's Beneficiaries) who is not, and has never been a Key Employee.

10

1.40 "Normal Retirement Age" means the Participant's 65th birthday, or the Participant's 3rd anniversary of joining the Plan, if later. A Participant shall become fully Vested in the Participant's Account upon attaining Normal Retirement Age.

1.41 "Normal Retirement Date" means the Participant's Normal Retirement Age.

1.42 " 1 -Year Break in Service" means, for purposes of eligibility for participation and vesting, a Period of Severance of at least 12 consecutive months.

1.43 "Participant" means any Eligible Employee who participates in the Plan and has not for any reason become ineligible to participate further in the Plan.

1.44 "Participant Direction Procedures" means such instructions, guidelines or policies, the terms of which are incorporated herein, as shall be established pursuant to Section 4.12 and observed by the Administrator and applied and provided to Participants who have Participant Directed Accounts.

1.45 "Participant's Account" means the account established and maintained by the Administrator for each Participant with respect to such Participant's total interest in the Plan and Trust resulting from the Employer Non-Elective Contributions.

1.46 "Participant's Combined Account" means the total aggregate amount of each Participant's Elective Account and Participant's Account.

1.47 "Participant's Directed Account" means that portion of a Participant's interest in the Plan with respect to which the Participant has directed the investment in accordance with the Participant Direction Procedure.

1.48 "Participant's Elective Account" means the account established and maintained by the Administrator for each Participant with respect to the Participant's total interest in the Plan and Trust resulting from the Employer Elective Contributions used to satisfy the "Actual Deferral Percentage" tests. A separate accounting shall be maintained with respect to that portion of the Participant's Elective Account attributable to such Elective Contributions pursuant to Section 4,2 and any Employer Qualified Non-Elective Contributions.

1.49 "Participant's Transfer/Rollover Account" means the account established and maintained by the Administrator for each Participant with respect to the Participant's total interest in the Plan resulting from amounts transferred to this Plan from a direct plan-to-plan transfer and/or with respect to such Participant's interest in the Plan resulting from amounts transferred from another qualified plan or "conduit" Individual Retirement Account in accordance with Section 4.11,

A separate accounting shall be maintained with respect to that portion of the Participant's Transfer/Rollover Account attributable to transfers (within the meaning of Code Section 414(1)) and "rollovers."

1.50 "Period of Service" means the aggregate of all periods commencing with the Employee's first day of employment or reemployment with the Employer or Affiliated Employer and ending on the date a 1-Year Break in Service begins. The first day of employment or reemployment is the first day the Employee performs

11

an Hour of Service. An Employee will also receive partial credit for any Period of Severance of less than twelve (12) consecutive months. Fractional periods of a year will be expressed in terms of days.

Periods of Service with the following employers shall be recognized:
Triangle Engineers & Constructors, Inc.; RPM Engineering, Inc.; Petrocon of Louisiana, Inc.; Constant Power Manufacturing, Inc.; IDS Engineering, Inc.; ENGlobal Engineering, Inc.; ENGlobal Construction Resources, Inc. (formerly known as Petrocon Construction Resources, Inc.); ENGlobal Systems, Inc. (formerly known as Petrocon Systems, Inc.); ENGlobal Automation Group, Inc. (formerly known as Petrocon Technologies, Inc.); ENGlobal Corporate Services, Inc. (formerly known as Industrial Data Systems, Inc.); ENGlobal Design Group, Inc. (formerly known as Engineering Design Group, Inc.)

1.51 "Period of Severance" means a continuous period of time during which the Employee is not employed by the Employer. Such period begins on the date the Employee retires, quits or is discharged, or if earlier, the twelve (12) month anniversary of the date on which the Employee was otherwise first absent from service.

In the case of an individual who is absent from work for maternity or paternity reasons, the twelve (12) consecutive month period beginning on the first anniversary of the first day of such absence shall not constitute a 1-Year Break in Service. For purposes of this paragraph, an absence from work for maternity or paternity reasons means an absence (a) by reason of the pregnancy of the individual, (b) by reason of the birth of a child of the individual, (c) by reason of the placement of a child with the individual in connection with the adoption of such child by such individual, or (d) for purposes of caring for such child for a period beginning immediately following such birth or placement.

1.52 "Plan" means this instrument, including all amendments thereto.

1.53 "Plan Year" means the Plan's accounting year of twelve (12) months commencing on January 1 of each year and ending the following December 31.

1.54 "Qualified Non-Elective Contribution" means any Employer contributions made pursuant to Section 4.6(b) and Section 4.8(f). Such contributions shall be considered an Elective Contribution for the purposes of the Plan and used to satisfy the "Actual Deferral Percentage" tests or the "Actual Contribution Percentage" tests.

1.55 "Regulation" means the Income Tax Regulations as promulgated by the Secretary of the Treasury or a delegate of the Secretary of the Treasury, and as amended from time to time.

1.56 "Retired Participant" means a person who has been a Participant, but who has become entitled to retirement benefits under the Plan.

1.57 "Retirement Date" means the date as of which a Participant retires for reasons other than Total and Permanent Disability, whether such retirement occurs on a Participant's Normal Retirement Date, Early or Late Retirement Date (see Section 6.1).

12

1.58 "Terminated Participant" means a person who has been a Participant, but whose employment has been terminated other than by death, Total and Permanent Disability or retirement.

1.59 "Top Heavy Plan" means a plan described in Section 8.2(a).

1.60 "Top Heavy Plan Year" means a Plan Year during which the Plan is a Top Heavy Plan.

1.61 "Total and Permanent Disability" means a condition, certified by a physician selected by the Employer, in which a person is unable to engage in any substantial gainful activity due to physical or mental impairment. The physician must certify that the condition:

(a) has lasted (or is expected to last) at least 12 consecutive months; or

(b) is expected to result in death.

1.62 "Trustee" means the person or entity named as trustee herein or in any separate trust forming a part of this Plan, and any successors.

1.63 "Trust Agreement" means any trust agreement between the Employer and the Trustee with respect to the Plan, as such may be in effect from time to time, the provisions of which are incorporated herein by reference.

1.64 "Trust Fund" means the assets of the Plan and Trust as the same shall exist from time to time.

1.65 "Valuation Date" means the Anniversary Date and may include any other date or dates deemed necessary or appropriate by the Administrator for the valuation of the Participants' accounts during the Plan Year, which may include any day that the Trustee, any transfer agent appointed by the Trustee or the Employer or any stock exchange used by such agent, are open for business.

1.66 "Vested" means the nonforfeitable portion of any account maintained on behalf of a Participant.

1.67 "Year of Service" means the computation period of twelve (12) consecutive months, herein set forth, during which an Employee has at least 1000 Hours of Service.

The computation period shall be the Plan Year if not otherwise set forth herein.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, for any short Plan Year, the determination of whether an Employee has completed a Year of Service shall be made in accordance with Department of Labor regulation 2530.203-2(c).

Years of Service with the following employers shall be recognized; Triangle Engineers & Constructors, Inc.; RPM Engineering, Inc.; Petrocon of Louisiana, Inc.; Constant Power Manufacturing, Inc.; IDS Engineering, Inc.; ENGlobal Engineering, Inc.; ENGlobal Construction Resources, Inc. (formerly known as

13

Petrocon Construction Resources, Inc.); ENGlobal Systems, Inc. (formerly known as Petrocon Systems, Inc.); ENGlobal Automation Group, Inc. (formerly known as Petrocon Technologies, Inc.); ENGlobal Corporate Services, Inc. (formerly known as Industrial Data Systems, Inc.); ENGlobal Design Group, Inc. (formerly known as Engineering Design Group, Inc.)

Years of Service with any Affiliated Employer shall be recognized,

ARTICLE II
ADMINISTRATION

2.1 POWERS AND RESPONSIBILITIES OF THE EMPLOYER

(a) In addition to the general powers and responsibilities otherwise provided for in this Plan, the Employer shall be empowered to appoint and remove the Trustee and the Administrator from time to time as it deems necessary for the proper administration of the Plan to ensure that the Plan is being operated for the exclusive benefit of the Participants and their Beneficiaries in accordance with the terms of the Plan, the Code, and the Act. The Employer may appoint counsel, specialists, advisers, agents (including any nonfiduciary agent) and other persons as the Employer deems necessary or desirable in connection with the exercise of its fiduciary duties under this Plan. The Employer may compensate such agents or advisers from the assets of the Plan as fiduciary expenses (but not including any business (settlor) expenses of the Employer), to the extent not paid by the Employer.

(b) The Employer may, by written agreement or designation, appoint at its option an Investment Manager (qualified under the Investment Company Act of 1940 as amended), investment adviser, or other agent to provide direction to the Trustee with respect to any or all of the Plan assets. Such appointment shall be given by the Employer in writing in a form acceptable to the Trustee and shall specifically identify the Plan assets with respect to which the Investment Manager or other agent shall have authority to direct the investment.

(c) The Employer shall establish a "funding policy and method," i.e., it shall determine whether the Plan has a short run need for liquidity (e.g., to pay benefits) or whether liquidity is a long run goal and investment growth (and stability of same) is a more current need, or shall appoint a qualified person to do so. The Employer or its delegate shall communicate such needs and goals to the Trustee, who shall coordinate such Plan needs with its investment policy. The communication of such a "funding policy and method" shall not, however, constitute a directive to the Trustee as to the investment of the Trust Funds. Such "funding policy and method" shall be consistent with the objectives of this Plan and with the requirements of Title I of the Act.

(d) The Employer shall periodically review the performance of any Fiduciary or other person to whom duties have been delegated or allocated by it under the provisions of this Plan or pursuant to procedures

14

established hereunder. This requirement may be satisfied by formal periodic review by the Employer or by a qualified person specifically designated by the Employer, through day-to-day conduct and evaluation, or through other appropriate ways.

2.2 DESIGNATION OF ADMINISTRATIVE AUTHORITY

The Employer shall appoint one or more Administrators. Any person, including, but not limited to, the Employees of the Employer, shall be eligible to serve as an Administrator. Any person so appointed shall signify acceptance by filing written acceptance with the Employer. An Administrator may resign by delivering a written resignation to the Employer or be removed by the Employer by delivery of written notice of removal, to take effect at a date specified therein, or upon delivery to the Administrator if no date is specified.

The Employer, upon the resignation or removal of an Administrator, shall promptly designate a successor to this position. If the Employer does not appoint an Administrator, the Employer will function as the Administrator.

2.3 ALLOCATION AND DELEGATION OF RESPONSIBILITIES

If more than one person is appointed as Administrator, the responsibilities of each Administrator may be specified by the Employer and accepted in writing by each Administrator. In the event that no such delegation is made by the Employer, the Administrators may allocate the responsibilities among themselves, in which event the Administrators shall notify the Employer and the Trustee in writing of such action and specify the responsibilities of each Administrator. The Trustee thereafter shall accept and rely upon any documents executed by the appropriate Administrator until such time as the Employer or the Administrators file with the Trustee a written revocation of such designation.

2.4 POWERS AND DUTIES OF THE ADMINISTRATOR

The primary responsibility of the Administrator is to administer the Plan for the exclusive benefit of the Participants and their Beneficiaries, subject to the specific terms of the Plan. The Administrator shall administer the Plan in accordance with its terms and shall have the power and discretion to construe the terms of the Plan and to determine all questions arising in connection with the administration, interpretation, and application of the Plan. Any such determination by the Administrator shall be conclusive and binding upon all persons. The Administrator may establish procedures, correct any defect, supply any information, or reconcile any inconsistency in such manner and to such extent as shall be deemed necessary or advisable to carry out the purpose of the Plan; provided, however, that any procedure, discretionary act, interpretation or construction shall be done in a nondiscriminatory manner based upon uniform principles consistently applied and shall be consistent with the intent that the Plan shall continue to be deemed a qualified plan under the terms of Code
Section 401(a), and shall comply with the terms of the Act and all regulations issued pursuant thereto. The Administrator shall have all powers necessary or appropriate to accomplish the Administrator's duties under the Plan.

15

The Administrator shall be charged with the duties of the general administration of the Plan as set forth under the terms of the Plan, including, but not limited to, the following:

(a) the discretion to determine all questions relating to the eligibility of Employees to participate or remain a Participant hereunder and to receive benefits under the Plan;

(b) to compute, certify, and direct the Trustee with respect to the amount and the kind of benefits to which any Participant shall be entitled hereunder;

(c) to authorize and direct the Trustee with respect to all discretionary or otherwise directed disbursements from the Trust;

(d) to maintain all necessary records for the administration of the Plan;

(e) to interpret the provisions of the Plan and to make and publish such rules for regulation of the Plan as are consistent with the terms hereof;

(f) to determine the size and type of any Contract to be purchased from any insurer, and to designate the insurer from which such Contract shall be purchased;

(g) to compute and certify to the Employer and to the Trustee from time to time the sums of money necessary or desirable to be contributed to the Plan;

(h) to prepare and implement a procedure for notifying Participants and Beneficiaries of their rights to elect joint and survivor annuities as required by the Act and regulations thereunder;

(i) to prepare and implement a procedure to notify Eligible Employees that they may elect to have a portion of their Compensation deferred or paid to them in cash;

(j) to act as the named Fiduciary responsible for communications with Participants as needed to maintain Plan compliance with Act Section 404(c), including, but not limited to, the receipt and transmitting of Participant's directions as to the investment of their account(s) under the Plan and the formulation of policies, rules, and procedures pursuant to which Participants may give investment instructions with respect to the investment of their accounts;

(k) to determine the validity of, and take appropriate action with respect to, any qualified domestic relations order received by it; and

(1) to assist any Participant regarding the Participant's rights, benefits, or elections available under the Plan,

16

2.5 RECORDS AND REPORTS

The Administrator shall keep a record of all actions taken and shall keep all other books of account, records, policies, and other data that may be necessary for proper administration of the Plan and shall be responsible for supplying all information and reports to the Internal Revenue Service, Department of Labor, Participants, Beneficiaries and others as required by law.

2.6 APPOINTMENT OF ADVISERS

The Administrator, or the Trustee with the consent of the Administrator, may appoint counsel, specialists, advisers, agents (including nonfiduciary agents) and other persons as the Administrator or the Trustee deems necessary or desirable in connection with the administration of this Plan, including but not limited to agents and advisers to assist with the administration and management of the Plan, and thereby to provide, among such other duties as the Administrator may appoint, assistance with maintaining Plan records and the providing of investment information to the Plan's investment fiduciaries and to Plan Participants.

2.7 INFORMATION FROM EMPLOYER

The Employer shall supply full and timely information to the Administrator on all pertinent facts as the Administrator may require in order to perform its function hereunder and the Administrator shall advise the Trustee of such of the foregoing facts as may be pertinent to the Trustee's duties under the Plan. The Administrator may rely upon such information as is supplied by the Employer and shall have no duty or responsibility to verify such information.

2.8 PAYMENT OF EXPENSES

All expenses of administration may be paid out of the Trust Fund unless paid by the Employer. Such expenses shall include any expenses incident to the functioning of the Administrator, or any person or persons retained or appointed by any named Fiduciary incident to the exercise of their duties under the Plan, including, but not limited to, fees of accountants, counsel, Investment Managers, agents (including nonfiduciary agents) appointed for the purpose of assisting the Administrator or the Trustee in carrying out the instructions of Participants as to the directed investment of their accounts and other specialists and their agents, the costs of any bonds required pursuant to Act
Section 412, and other costs of administering the Plan. Until paid, the expenses shall constitute a liability of the Trust Fund. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Employer, on a uniform and nondiscriminatory basis, may direct that expenses and fees that are allocable to the accounts of a specific Participant shall be paid from that Participant's accounts.

2.9 MAJORITY ACTIONS

Except where there has been an allocation and delegation of administrative authority pursuant to Section 2.3, if there is more than one Administrator, then they shall act by a majority of their number, but may authorize one or more of them to sign all papers on their behalf.

17

2.10 CLAIMS PROCEDURE

Claims for benefits under the Plan may be filed in writing with the Administrator. Notice of the disposition of a claim shall be furnished to the claimant within ninety (90) days after the application is filed, or such period as is required by applicable law or Department of Labor regulation, unless the Administrator determines that special circumstances require an extension of time for processing the claim. If it is determined that an extension is needed, written notice of the extension shall be furnished to the claimant prior to the termination of the initial 90-day period specifying the special circumstances requiring the extension and the date by which the plan expects to render a decision. In no event shall such extension exceed a period of 90 days from the end of such initial period.

In the case of a claim for disability benefits, notice of the disposition of a claim shall be furnished to the claimant within forty-five (45) days after the application is filed, or such period as is required by applicable law or Department of Labor regulation, unless the Administrator determines that circumstances beyond the Plan's control require an extension of time of up to thirty (30) days for processing the claim. If it is determined that an extension is needed, notice of the extension shall be furnished to the claimant prior to the termination of the initial 45-day period specifying the circumstances requiring the extension and the date by which the Plan expects to render a decision. If prior to the end of the first 30-day extension period, the Administrator determines that circumstances beyond the Plan's control require an additional extension of time of up to thirty (30) days, the period for deciding the claim may be extended. If an additional 30-day extension is needed, notice of the extension shall be furnished to the claimant prior to the termination of the first 30-day extension period specifying the circumstances requiring the further extension and the date by which the Plan expects to render a decision. For any extension, the notice must explain the standards on which entitlement to a benefit is based, the issues that prevent a decision on the claim, and the additional information needed to resolve those issues. The claimant will be given at least 45 days to respond to the request for additional information.

In the event the claim is denied, the reasons for the denial shall be specifically set forth in the notice in language calculated to be understood by the claimant, pertinent provisions of the Plan shall be cited, and, where appropriate, an explanation as to how the claimant can perfect the claim will be provided. In addition, the claimant shall be furnished with an explanation of the Plan's claims review procedure and the time limits applicable to such procedure. In the case of a claim for disability benefits, the claimant will be provided with a copy of any internal rule, guideline, protocol or other similar criterion that was relied upon in denying the claim, or the claimant will be provided with a statement that the rule, guideline, protocol or similar criterion was relied upon and that a copy of the rule, guideline, protocol or similar criterion will be provided to the claimant free of charge upon request. Also, in the case of a claim for disability benefits that was denied based on medical necessity or experimental treatment or similar exclusion or limit, the claimant will be provided with an explanation of the specific or clinical judgment (applying the terms of the Plan to the medical circumstances) that was relied upon to deny the claim, or a statement that such explanation will be provided to the claimant free of charge upon request.

18

2.11 CLAIMS REVIEW PROCEDURE

Any Employee, former Employee, or Beneficiary of either, who has been denied a benefit by a decision of the Administrator pursuant to Section 2.10 shall be entitled to request the Administrator to give further consideration to a claim by filing with the Administrator a written request for a full and fair review. Such request, together with a written statement of the reasons why the claimant believes the claim should be allowed and any written comments, documents, records and other information relating to the claim, shall be filed with the Administrator no later than sixty (60) days after receipt of the notification provided for in Section 2.10.

If the claim is for disability benefits, the request for review must be filed with the Administrator no later than one hundred-eighty (180) days after receipt of the notification provided for in Section 2.10.

A claimant shall be provided, upon request and free of charge, reasonable access to (and copies of) all documents, records and other information relevant to the claim. The Administrator shall then conduct a review of such claim that takes into account all comments, documents, records and other information submitted by the claimant relating to the claim, regardless of whether such information was submitted or considered in the initial benefit determination.

If the claim is for disability benefits, the review will be conducted without regard to the initial adverse benefit determination by an appropriate named fiduciary of the Plan who is neither the individual nor the subordinate of the individual who made the initial adverse benefit determination. If the initial adverse benefit determination is based in whole or in part on medical judgment, the appropriate named fiduciary will consult with a health care professional who has appropriate training and experience in the field of medicine involved in the medical judgment and who was neither the individual nor a subordinate of the individual consulted in connection with the initial adverse benefit determination. Any medical or vocational experts whose advise was obtained on behalf of the Plan in connection with the initial adverse benefit determination will be identified, regardless of whether the advice was relied upon in making the adverse benefit determination.

A final decision as to the allowance of the claim shall be made by the Administrator within sixty (60) days of receipt of the appeal (unless there has been an extension of sixty (60) days due to special circumstances, provided the delay, the special circumstances occasioning it, and the expected decision date are communicated to the claimant within the sixty (60) day period). If the claim relates to disability benefits, then the previous sentence will apply but with the substitution of "forty-five (45)" for every instance in which the phrase "sixty (60)" appears in the sentence.

Such communication shall be written in a manner calculated to be understood by the claimant and shall include: specific reasons for the decision, specific references to the pertinent Plan provisions on which the decision is based, a statement that the claimant is entitled to receive reasonable access to (and copies of) all documents, records and other information relevant to the claim, a statement describing any voluntary appeal procedures offered by the Plan and the claimant's right to obtain information about such procedures, and a statement of the claimant's right to bring an action under Act Section 502(a).

19

In the case of a claim for disability benefits, the claimant will be provided with a copy of any internal rule, guideline, protocol or other similar criterion that was relied upon in denying the claim, or the claimant will be provided with a statement that the rule, guideline, protocol or similar criterion was relied upon and that a copy of the rule, guideline, protocol or similar criterion will be provided to the claimant free of charge upon request. Also, in the case of a claim for disability benefits that was denied based on medical necessity or experimental treatment or similar exclusion or limit, the claimant will be provided with an explanation of the specific or clinical judgment (applying the terms of the Plan to the medical circumstances) that was relied upon to deny the claim, or a statement that such explanation will be provided to the claimant free of charge upon request,

ARTICLE III
ELIGIBILITY

3.1 CONDITIONS OF ELIGIBILITY

Any Eligible Employee who has completed a 60 day Period of Service and has attained age 21 shall be eligible to participate hereunder as of the date such Employee has satisfied such requirements. However, any Employee who was a Participant in the Plan prior to the effective date of this amendment and restatement shall continue to participate in the Plan.

3.2 EFFECTIVE DATE OF PARTICIPATION

An Eligible Employee shall become a Participant effective as of the first day of the Plan Year quarter coinciding with or next following the date such Employee met the eligibility requirements of Section 3.1, provided said Employee was still employed as of such date (or if not employed on such date, as of the date of rehire if a 1-Year Break in Service has not occurred or, if later, the date that the Employee would have otherwise entered the Plan had the Employee not terminated employment).

If an Eligible Employee satisfies the Plan's eligibility requirement conditions by reason of recognition of service with a predecessor employer, such Employee will become a Participant as of the day the Plan credits service with a predecessor employer or, if later, the date the Employee would have otherwise entered the Plan had the service with the predecessor employer been service with the Employer.

If an Employee, who has satisfied the Plan's eligibility requirements and would otherwise have become a Participant, shall go from a classification of a noneligible Employee to an Eligible Employee, such Employee shall become a Participant on the date such Employee becomes an Eligible Employee or, if later, the date that the Employee would have otherwise entered the Plan had the Employee always been an Eligible Employee.

If an Employee, who has satisfied the Plan's eligibility requirements and would otherwise become a Participant, shall go from a classification of an Eligible Employee to a noneligible class of Employees, such Employee shall become a Participant in the Plan on the date such Employee again becomes an Eligible Employee, or, if later, the date that the Employee would have otherwise entered the Plan had the Employee always been an Eligible Employee. However, if such Employee incurs a 1-Year Break in Service, eligibility will be determined under the Break in Service rules set forth in Section 3.7.

20

3.3 DETERMINATION OF ELIGIBILITY

The Administrator shall determine the eligibility of each Employee for participation in the Plan based upon information furnished by the Employer. Such determination shall be conclusive and binding upon all persons, as long as the same is made pursuant to the Plan and the Act. Such determination shall be subject to review pursuant to Section 2.11.

3.4 TERMINATION OF ELIGIBILITY

In the event a Participant shall go from a classification of an Eligible Employee to an ineligible Employee, such Former Participant shall continue to vest in the Plan for each Period of Service completed while a noneligible Employee, until such time as the Participant's Account is forfeited or distributed pursuant to the terms of the Plan. Additionally, the Former Participant's interest in the Plan shall continue to share in the earnings of the Trust Fund.

3.5 OMISSION OF ELIGIBLE EMPLOYEE

If, in any Plan Year, any Employee who should be included as a Participant in the Plan is erroneously omitted and discovery of such omission is not made until after a contribution by the Employer for the year has been made and allocated, then the Employer shall make a subsequent contribution so that the omitted Employee receives a total amount which the Employee would have received (including both Employer contributions and earnings thereon) had the Employee not been omitted. Such contribution shall be made regardless of whether it is deductible in whole or in part in any taxable year under applicable provisions of the Code.

3.6 INCLUSION OF INELIGIBLE EMPLOYEE

If, in any Plan Year, any person who should not have been included as a Participant in the Plan is erroneously included and discovery of such inclusion is not made until after a contribution for the year has been made and allocated, the Employer shall be entitled to recover the contribution made with respect to the ineligible person provided the error is discovered within twelve (12) months of the date on which it was made. Otherwise, the amount contributed with respect to the ineligible person shall constitute a Forfeiture for the Plan Year in which the discovery is made. Notwithstanding the foregoing, any Deferred Compensation made by an ineligible person shall be distributed to the person (along with any earnings attributable to such Deferred Compensation).

3.7 REHIRED EMPLOYEES AND BREAKS IN SERVICE

(a) If any Participant becomes a Former Participant due to severance from employment with the Employer and is reemployed by the Employer before a 1-Year Break in Service occurs, the Former Participant shall become a Participant as of the reemployment date.

(b) If any Participant becomes a Former Participant due to severance from employment with the Employer and is reemployed after a 1 -Year Break in Service has occurred, Periods of Service shall include Periods of Service prior to the 1-Year Break in Service subject to the following rules:

21

(1) In the case of a Former Participant who under the Plan does not have a nonforfeitable right to any interest in the Plan resulting from Employer contributions, Periods of Service before a period of 1-Year Break in Service will not be taken into account if the number of consecutive 1-Year Breaks in Service equal or exceed the greater of (A) five (5) or (B) the aggregate number of pre-break Periods of Service. Such aggregate number of Periods of Service will not include any Periods of Service disregarded under the preceding sentence by reason of prior 1-Year Breaks in Service.

(2) A Former Participant shall participate in the Plan as of the date of reemployment.

(c) After a Former Participant who has severed employment with the Employer incurs five (5) consecutive 1-Year Breaks in Service, the Vested portion of said Former Participant's Account attributable to pre-break service shall not be increased as a result of post-break service. In such case, separate accounts will be maintained as follows:

(1) one account for nonforfeitable benefits attributable to pre-break service; and

(2) one account representing the Participant's Employer derived account balance in the Plan attributable to post-break service.

(d) If any Participant becomes a Former Participant due to severance of employment with the Employer and is reemployed by the Employer before five (5) consecutive 1-Year Breaks in Service, and such Former Participant had received a distribution of the entire Vested interest prior to reemployment, then the forfeited account shall be reinstated only if the Former Participant repays the full amount which had been distributed. Such repayment must be made before the earlier of five (5) years after the first date on which the Participant is subsequently reemployed by the Employer or the close of the first period of five (5) consecutive 1-Year Breaks in Service commencing after the distribution. If a distribution occurs for any reason other than a severance of employment, the time for repayment may not end earlier than five (5) years after the date of distribution. In the event the Former Participant does repay the full amount distributed, the undistributed forfeited portion of the Participant's Account must be restored in full, unadjusted by any gains or losses occurring subsequent to the Valuation Date preceding the distribution. The source for such reinstatement may be Forfeitures occurring during the Plan Year. If such source is insufficient, then the Employer will contribute an amount which is sufficient to restore any such forfeited Accounts.

22

ARTICLE IV
CONTRIBUTION AND ALLOCATION

4.1 FORMULA FOR DETERMINING EMPLOYER CONTRIBUTION

For each Plan Year, the Employer shall contribute to the Plan:

(a) The amount of the total salary reduction elections of all Participants made pursuant to Section 4.2(a), which amount shall be deemed an Employer Elective Contribution.

(b)(i) For Participants who are classified on the payroll records of the Employer as "regular employees," 50% of elective deferrals up to the first 4% of Compensation; and (ii) for all other Participants, 25% of elective deferrals up to the first 4% of Compensation. In other words, we are no longer referring to contract or project employees, and the match for the first group would be a maximum of 2% of pay, and for the second group, a maximum of 1% of pay.

(c) Additionally, to the extent necessary, the Employer shall contribute to the Plan the amount necessary to provide the top heavy minimum contribution. All contributions by the Employer shall be made in cash or in such property as is acceptable to the Trustee.

4.2 PARTICIPANT'S SALARY REDUCTION ELECTION

(a) Each Participant may elect to defer a portion of Compensation which would have been received in the Plan Year (except for the deferral election) by up to the maximum amount which will not cause the Plan to violate the provisions of Sections 4,5(a) and 4.9. A deferral election (or modification of an earlier election) may not be made with respect to Compensation which is currently available on or before the date the Participant executed such election. For purposes of this Section, Compensation shall be determined prior to any reductions made pursuant to Code Sections 125, 132(f)(4), 402(e)(3), 402(h)(l)(B), 403(b) or 457(b), and Employee contributions described in Code Section 414(h)(2) that are treated as Employer contributions.

The amount by which Compensation is reduced shall be that Participant's Deferred Compensation and be treated as an Employer Elective Contribution and allocated to that Participant's Elective Account.

(b) The balance in each Participant's Elective Account shall be fully Vested at all times and, except as otherwise provided herein, shall not be subject to Forfeiture for any reason.

(c) Notwithstanding anything in the Plan to the contrary, amounts held in the Participant's Elective Account may not be distributable (including any offset of loans) earlier than:

23

(1) a Participant's separation from service, Total and Permanent Disability, or death;

(2) a Participant's attainment of age 59 1/2;

(3) the termination of the Plan without the existence at the time of Plan termination of another defined contribution plan or the establishment of a successor defined contribution plan by the Employer or an Affiliated Employer within the period ending twelve months after distribution of all assets from the Plan maintained by the Employer. For this purpose, a defined contribution plan does not include an employee stock ownership plan (as defined in Code Section 4975(e)(7) or 409), a simplified employee pension plan (as defined in Code
Section 408(k)), or a simple individual retirement account plan (as defined in Code Section 408(p));

(4) the date of disposition by the Employer to an entity that is not an Affiliated Employer of substantially all of the assets (within the meaning of Code Section 409(d)(2)) used in a trade or business of such corporation if such corporation continues to maintain this Plan after the disposition with respect to a Participant who continues employment with the corporation acquiring such assets;

(5) the date of disposition by the Employer or an Affiliated Employer who maintains the Plan of its interest in a subsidiary (within the meaning of Code Section 409(d)(3)) to an entity which is not an Affiliated Employer but only with respect to a Participant who continues employment with such subsidiary; or

(6) the proven financial hardship of a Participant, subject to the limitations of Section 6.11.

(d) For each Plan Year, a Participant's Deferred Compensation made under this Plan and all other plans, contracts or arrangements of the Employer maintaining this Plan shall not exceed, during any taxable year of the Participant, the limitation imposed by Code Section 402(g), as in effect at the beginning of such taxable year. If such dollar limitation is exceeded, a Participant will be deemed to have notified the Administrator of such excess amount which shall be distributed in a manner consistent with Section 4.2(f). The dollar limitation shall be adjusted annually pursuant to the method provided in Code Section 415(d) in accordance with Regulations.

(e) In the event a Participant has received a hardship distribution from the Participant's Elective Account pursuant to Section 6.1 l(b) or pursuant to Regulation 1.401(k)-l(d)(2)(iv)(B) from any other plan maintained by the Employer, then such Participant shall not be permitted to elect to have Deferred Compensation contributed to the Plan for a period of twelve (12) months following the receipt of the distribution. Furthermore, the dollar limitation under Code Section 402(g) shall be reduced, with respect to the Participant's taxable year following the taxable year in

24

which the hardship distribution was made, by the amount of such Participant's Deferred Compensation, if any, pursuant to this Plan (and any other plan maintained by the Employer) for the taxable year of the hardship distribution.

(f) If a Participant's Deferred Compensation under this Plan together with any elective deferrals (as defined in Regulation 1.402(g)-l(b)) under another qualified cash or deferred arrangement (as described in Code
Section 401(k)), a simplified employee pension (as described in Code
Section 408(k)(6)), a simple individual retirement account plan (as described in Code Section 408(p)), a salary reduction arrangement (within the meaning of Code Section 3121(a)(5)(D)), a deferred compensation plan under Code Section 457(b), or a trust described in Code Section 501(c)(18) cumulatively exceed the limitation imposed by Code Section 402(g) (as adjusted annually in accordance with the method provided in Code Section 415(d) pursuant to Regulations) for such Participant's taxable year, the Participant may, not later than March 1 following the close of the Participant's taxable year, notify the Administrator in writing of such excess and request that the Participant's Deferred Compensation under this Plan be reduced by an amount specified by the Participant. In such event, the Administrator may direct the Trustee to distribute such excess amount (and any Income allocable to such excess amount) to the Participant not later than the first April 15th following the close of the Participant's taxable year. Any distribution of less than the entire amount of Excess Deferred Compensation and Income shall be treated as a pro rata distribution of Excess Deferred Compensation and Income. The amount distributed shall not exceed the Participant's Deferred Compensation under the Plan for the taxable year (and any Income allocable to such excess amount). Any distribution on or before the last day of the Participant's taxable year must satisfy each of the following conditions:

(1) the distribution must be made after the date on which the Plan received the Excess Deferred Compensation;

(2) the Participant shall designate the distribution as Excess Deferred Compensation; and

(3) the Plan must designate the distribution as a distribution of Excess Deferred Compensation.

Matching contributions which relate to Excess Deferred Compensation which is distributed pursuant to this Section 4.2(f) shall be forfeited.

(g) Notwithstanding Section 4,2(f) above, a Participant's Excess Deferred Compensation shall be reduced, but not below zero, by any distribution of Excess Contributions pursuant to Section 4.6(a) for the Plan Year beginning with or within the taxable year of the Participant.

(h) At Normal Retirement Date, or such other date when the Participant shall be entitled to receive benefits, the fair market value of the Participant's Elective Account shall be used to provide additional benefits to the Participant or the Participant's Beneficiary.

25

(i) Employer Elective Contributions made pursuant to this Section may be segregated into a separate account for each Participant in a federally insured savings account, certificate of deposit in a bank or savings and loan association, money market certificate, or other short-term debt security acceptable to the Trustee until such time as the allocations pursuant to Section 4.4 have been made.

(j) The Employer and the Administrator shall implement the salary reduction elections provided for herein in accordance with the following:

(1) A Participant must make an initial salary deferral election within a reasonable time, not to exceed thirty (30) days, after entering the Plan pursuant to Section 3.2. If the Participant fails to make an initial salary deferral election within such time, then such Participant may thereafter make an election in accordance with the rules governing modifications. The Participant shall make such an election by entering into a written salary reduction agreement with the Employer and filing such agreement with the Administrator. Such election shall initially be effective beginning with the pay period following the acceptance of the salary reduction agreement by the Administrator, shall not have retroactive effect and shall remain in force until revoked.

(2) A Participant may modify a prior election at any time during the Plan Year and concurrently make a new election by filing a written notice with the Administrator within a reasonable time before the pay period for which such modification is to be effective. Any modification shall not have retroactive effect and shall remain in force until revoked.

(3) A Participant may elect to prospectively revoke the Participant's salary reduction agreement in its entirety at any time during the Plan Year by providing the Administrator with thirty (30) days written notice of such revocation (or upon such shorter notice period as may be acceptable to the Administrator), Such revocation shall become effective as of the beginning of the first pay period coincident with or next following the expiration of the notice period. Furthermore, the termination of the Participant's employment, or the cessation of participation for any reason, shall be deemed to revoke any salary reduction agreement then in effect, effective immediately following the close of the pay period within which such termination or cessation occurs.

26

4.3 TIME OF PAYMENT OF EMPLOYER CONTRIBUTION

The Employer may make its contribution to the Plan for a particular Plan Year at such time as the Employer, in its sole discretion, determines. If the Employer makes a contribution for a particular Plan Year after the close of that Plan Year, the Employer will designate to the Trustee the Plan Year for which the Employer is making its contribution.

Notwithstanding anything contained herein to the contrary, Deferred Compensation must be remitted to the Trust on the earliest day on which such Deferred Compensation can reasonably be segregated from the Employer's general assets, but in no event later than the 15th business day of the month following the month in which the Participant's Deferred Compensation would otherwise have been payable to such Participant in cash, as set forth in DOL Regulation ss.2510.3-102(b)(l).

4.4 ALLOCATION OF CONTRIBUTION AND EARNINGS

(a) The Administrator shall establish and maintain an account in the name of each Participant to which the Administrator shall credit as of each Anniversary Date, or other Valuation Date, all amounts allocated to each such Participant as set forth herein.

(b) The Employer shall provide the Administrator with all information required by the Administrator to make a proper allocation of the Employer contributions for each Plan Year. Within a reasonable period of time after the date of receipt by the Administrator of such information, the Administrator shall allocate such contribution as follows:

(1) With respect to the Employer Elective Contribution made pursuant to Section 4.1 (a), to each Participant's Elective Account in an amount equal to each such Participant's Deferred Compensation for the year.

(2) With respect to the Employer Non-Elective Contribution made pursuant to Section 4.1(b), to each Participant's Account in accordance with Section 4. l(b).

(c) On or before each Anniversary Date any amounts which became Forfeitures since the last Anniversary Date may be made available to reinstate previously forfeited account balances of Former Participants, if any, in accordance with Section 3.7(d), be used to satisfy any contribution that may be required pursuant to Section 3.5 and/or 6.9, or be used to pay any administrative expenses of the Plan. The remaining Forfeitures, if any, shall be used to reduce the contribution of the Employer hereunder for the Plan Year in which such Forfeitures occur.

(d) For any Top Heavy Plan Year, Non-Key Employees not otherwise eligible to share in the allocation of contributions as provided above, shall receive the minimum allocation provided for in Section 4.4(g) if eligible pursuant to the provisions of Section 4.4(i).

27

(e) Notwithstanding the foregoing, Participants who do not complete the allocation eligibility requirements specified above due to Retirement (Early, Normal or Late), Total and Permanent Disability or death shall share in the allocation of contributions for that Plan Year.

(f) As of each Valuation Date, before the current valuation period allocation of Employer contributions, any earnings or losses (net appreciation or net depreciation) of the Trust Fund shall be allocated in the same proportion that each Participant's and Former Participant's nonsegregated accounts bear to the total of all Participants' and Former Participants' nonsegregated accounts as of such date. Earnings or losses with respect to a Participant's Directed Account shall be allocated in accordance with Section 4,12.

Participants' transfers from other qualified plans deposited in the general Trust Fund shall share in any earnings and losses (net appreciation or net depreciation) of the Trust Fund in the same manner provided above. Each segregated account maintained on behalf of a Participant shall be credited or charged with its separate earnings and losses.

(g) Minimum Allocations Required for Top Heavy Plan Years:
Notwithstanding the foregoing, for any Top Heavy Plan Year, the sum of the Employer contributions allocated to the Participant's Combined Account of each Non-Key Employee shall be equal to at least three percent (3%) of such Non-Key Employee's "415 Compensation" (reduced by contributions and forfeitures, if any, allocated to each Non-Key Employee in any defined contribution plan included with this Plan in a Required Aggregation Group). However, if (1) the sum of the Employer contributions allocated to the Participant's Combined Account of each Key Employee for such Top Heavy Plan Year is less than three percent (3%) of each Key Employee's "415 Compensation" and (2) this Plan is not required to be included in an Aggregation Group to enable a defined benefit plan to meet the requirements of Code Section 401(a)(4) or 410, the sum of the Employer contributions allocated to the Participant's Combined Account of each Non-Key Employee shall be equal to the largest percentage allocated to the Participant's Combined Account of any Key Employee, However, in determining whether a Non-Key Employee has received the required minimum allocation, such Non-Key Employee's Deferred Compensation and matching contributions needed to satisfy the "Actual Contribution Percentage" tests pursuant to Section 4.7(a) shall not be taken into account.

However, no such minimum allocation shall be required in this Plan for any Non-Key Employee who participates in another defined contribution plan subject to Code Section 412 included with this Plan in a Required Aggregation Group.

(h) For purposes of the minimum allocations set forth above, the percentage allocated to the Participant's Combined Account of any Key Employee shall be equal to the ratio of the sum of the Employer contributions allocated on behalf of such Key Employee divided by the "415 Compensation" for such Key Employee.

28

(i) For any Top Heavy Plan Year, the minimum allocations set forth above shall be allocated to the Participant's Combined Account of all Non-Key Employees who are Participants and who are employed by the Employer on the last day of the Plan Year, including Non-Key Employees who have (1) failed to complete a Year of Service; and (2) declined to make mandatory contributions (if required) or, in the case of a cash or deferred arrangement, elective contributions to the Plan.

(j) For the purposes of this Section, "415 Compensation" in excess of $150,000 (or such other amount provided in the Code) shall be disregarded. Such amount shall be adjusted for increases in the cost of living in accordance with Code Section 401(a)(17)(B), except that the dollar increase in effect on January 1 of any calendar year shall be effective for the Plan Year beginning with or within such calendar year. If "415 Compensation" for any prior determination period is taken into account in determining a Participant's minimum benefit for the current Plan Year, the "415 Compensation" for such determination period is subject to the applicable annual "415 Compensation" limit in effect for that prior period. For this purpose, in determining the minimum benefit in Plan Years beginning on or after January 1, 1989, the annual "415 Compensation" limit in effect for determination periods beginning before that date is $200,000 (or such other amount as adjusted for increases in the cost of living in accordance with Code Section 415(d) for determination periods beginning on or after January 1, 1989, and in accordance with Code Section 401(a)(17)(B) for determination periods beginning on or after January 1, 1994). For determination periods beginning prior to January 1, 1989, the $200,000 limit shall apply only for Top Heavy Plan Years and shall not be adjusted. For any short Plan Year the "415 Compensation" limit shall be an amount equal to the "415 Compensation" limit for the calendar year in which the Plan Year begins multiplied by the ratio obtained by dividing the number of full months in the short Plan Year by twelve (12).

(k) Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, Participants who terminated employment for any reason during the Plan Year shall share in the salary reduction contributions made by the Employer for the year of termination without regard to the Hours of Service credited.

(1) Notwithstanding anything in this Section to the contrary, all information necessary to properly reflect a given transaction may not be available until after the date specified herein for processing such transaction, in which case the transaction will be reflected when such information is received and processed. Subject to express limits that may be imposed under the Code, the processing of any contribution, distribution or other transaction may be delayed for any legitimate business reason (including, but not limited to, failure of systems or computer programs, failure of the means of the transmission of data, force majeure, the failure of a service provider to timely receive values or prices, and the correction for errors or omissions or the errors or omissions of any service provider). The processing date of a transaction will be binding for all purposes of the Plan.

29

4.5 ACTUAL DEFERRAL PERCENTAGE TESTS

(a) Maximum Annual Allocation; For each Plan Year, the annual allocation derived from Employer Elective Contributions to a Highly Compensated Participant's Elective Account shall satisfy one of the following tests:

(1) The "Actual Deferral Percentage" for the Highly Compensated Participant group shall not be more than the "Actual Deferral Percentage" of the Non-Highly Compensated Participant group (for the preceding Plan Year if the prior year testing method is used to calculate the "Actual Deferral Percentage" for the Non-Highly Compensated Participant group) multiplied by 1.25, or

(2) The excess of the "Actual Deferral Percentage" for the Highly Compensated Participant group over the "Actual Deferral Percentage" for the Non-Highly Compensated Participant group (for the preceding Plan Year if the prior year testing method is used to calculate the "Actual Deferral Percentage" for the Non-Highly Compensated Participant group) shall not be more than two percentage points. Additionally, the "Actual Deferral Percentage" for the Highly Compensated Participant group shall not exceed the "Actual Deferral Percentage" for the Non-Highly Compensated Participant group (for the preceding Plan Year if the prior year testing method is used to calculate the "Actual Deferral Percentage" for the Non-Highly Compensated Participant group) multiplied by 2. The provisions of Code
Section 401(k)(3) and Regulation 1,401(k)-l(b) are incorporated herein by reference.

However, in order to prevent the multiple use of the alternative method described in (2) above and in Code Section 401(m)(9)(A), any Highly Compensated Participant eligible to make elective deferrals pursuant to Section 4.2 and to make Employee contributions or to receive matching contributions under this Plan or under any other plan maintained by the Employer or an Affiliated Employer shall have a combination of such Participant's Elective Contributions and Employer matching contributions reduced pursuant to Section 4.6(a) and Regulation 1.401(m)-2, the provisions of which are incorporated herein by reference.

(b) For the purposes of this Section "Actual Deferral Percentage" means, with respect to the Highly Compensated Participant group and Non-Highly Compensated Participant group for a Plan Year, the average of the ratios, calculated separately for each Participant in such group, of the amount of Employer Elective Contributions allocated to each Participant's Elective Account for such Plan Year, to such Participant's "414(s) Compensation" for such Plan Year. The actual deferral ratio for each Participant and the "Actual Deferral Percentage" for each group shall be calculated to the nearest one-hundredth of one percent. Employer Elective Contributions allocated to each Non-Highly Compensated

30

Participant's Elective Account shall be reduced by Excess Deferred Compensation to the extent such excess amounts are made under this Plan or any other plan maintained by the Employer.

Notwithstanding the above, if the prior year test method is used to calculate the "Actual Deferral Percentage" for the Non-Highly Compensated Participant group for the first Plan Year of this amendment and restatement, the "Actual Deferral Percentage" for the Non-Highly Compensated Participant group for the preceding Plan Year shall be calculated pursuant to the provisions of the Plan then in effect.

(c) For the purposes of Sections 4.5(a) and 4.6, a Highly Compensated Participant and a Non-Highly Compensated Participant shall include any Employee eligible to make a deferral election pursuant to Section 4.2, whether or not such deferral election was made or suspended pursuant to
Section 4.2.

Notwithstanding the above, if the prior year testing method is used to calculate the "Actual Deferral Percentage" for the Non-Highly Compensated Participant group for the first Plan Year of this amendment and restatement, for purposes of Section 4.5(a) and 4.6, a Non-Highly Compensated Participant shall include any such Employee eligible to make a deferral election, whether or not such deferral election was made or suspended, pursuant to the provisions of the Plan in effect for the preceding Plan Year.

(d) For the purposes of this Section and Code Sections 401 (a)(4), 410(b) and 401 (k), if two or more plans which include cash or deferred arrangements are considered one plan for the purposes of Code Section 401(a)(4) or 410(b) (other than Code Section 410(b)(2)(A)(ii)), the cash or deferred arrangements included in such plans shall be treated as one arrangement. In addition, two or more cash or deferred arrangements may be considered as a single arrangement for purposes of determining whether or not such arrangements satisfy Code Sections 401(a)(4), 410(b) and 401(k). In such a case, the cash or deferred arrangements included in such plans and the plans including such arrangements shall be treated as one arrangement and as one plan for purposes of this Section and Code Sections
401(a)(4), 410(b) and 401(k). Any adjustment to the Non-Highly Compensated Participant actual deferral ratio for the prior year shall be made in accordance with Internal Revenue Service Notice 98-1 and any superseding guidance. Plans may be aggregated under this paragraph (d) only if they have the same plan year. Notwithstanding the above, if two or more plans which include cash or deferred arrangements are permissively aggregated under Regulation 1.410(b)-7(d), all plans permissively aggregated must use either the current year testing method or the prior year testing method for the testing year.

Notwithstanding the above, an employee stock ownership plan described in Code Section 4975(e)(7) or 409 may not be combined with this Plan for purposes of determining whether the employee stock ownership plan or this Plan satisfies this Section and Code Sections 401(a)(4), 410(b) and 401 (k).

(e) For the purposes of this Section, if a Highly Compensated Participant is a Participant under two or more cash or deferred arrangements (other than a cash or deferred arrangement which is part of an

31

employee stock ownership plan as defined in Code Section 4975(e)(7) or 409) of the Employer or an Affiliated Employer, all such cash or deferred arrangements shall be treated as one cash or deferred arrangement for the purpose of determining the actual deferral ratio with respect to such Highly Compensated Participant. However, if the cash or deferred arrangements have different plan years, this paragraph shall be applied by treating all cash or deferred arrangements ending with or within the same calendar year as a single arrangement,

(f) For the purpose of this Section, when calculating the "Actual Deferral Percentage" for the Non-Highly Compensated Participant group, the current year testing method shall be used. Any change from the current year testing method to the prior year testing method shall be made pursuant to Internal Revenue Service Notice 98-1, Section VII (or superseding guidance), the provisions of which are incorporated herein by reference.

(g) Notwithstanding anything in this Section to the contrary, the provisions of this Section and Section 4.6 may be applied separately (or will be applied separately to the extent required by Regulations) to each plan within the meaning of Regulation 1.401(k)-l(g)(l 1). Furthermore, the provisions of Code Section 401(k)(3)(F) may be used to exclude from consideration all Non-Highly Compensated Employees who have not satisfied the minimum age and service requirements of Code Section 410(a)(l)(A).

4.6 ADJUSTMENT TO ACTUAL DEFERRAL PERCENTAGE TESTS

In the event (or if it is anticipated) that the initial allocations of the Employer Elective Contributions made pursuant to Section 4.4 do (or might) not satisfy one of the tests set forth in Section 4.5(a), the Administrator shall adjust Excess Contributions pursuant to the options set forth below:

(a) On or before the fifteenth day of the third month following the end of each Plan Year, but in no event later than the close of the following Plan Year, the Highly Compensated Participant having the largest dollar amount of Elective Contributions shall have a portion of such Participant's Elective Contributions distributed until the total amount of Excess Contributions has been distributed, or until the amount of such Participant's Elective Contributions equals the Elective Contributions of the Highly Compensated Participant having the second largest dollar amount of Elective Contributions. This process shall continue until the total amount of Excess Contributions has been distributed. In determining the amount of Excess Contributions to be distributed with respect to an affected Highly Compensated Participant as determined herein, such amount shall be reduced pursuant to Section 4.2(f) by any Excess Deferred Compensation previously distributed to such affected Highly Compensated Participant for such Participant's taxable year ending with or within such Plan Year.

32

(1) With respect to the distribution of Excess Contributions pursuant to (a) above, such distribution:

(i) may be postponed but not later than the close of the Plan Year following the Plan Year to which they are allocable;

(ii) shall be adjusted for Income; and

(iii) shall be designated by the Employer as a distribution of Excess Contributions (and Income).

(2) Any distribution of less than the entire amount of Excess Contributions shall be treated as a pro rata distribution of Excess Contributions and Income.

(3) Matching contributions which relate to Excess Contributions shall be forfeited unless the related matching contribution is distributed as an Excess Aggregate Contribution pursuant to Section 4.8.

(b) Notwithstanding the above, within twelve (12) months after the end of the Plan Year, the Employer may make a special Qualified Non-Elective Contribution in accordance with one of the following provisions which contribution shall be allocated to the Participant's Elective Account of each Non-Highly Compensated Participant eligible to share in the allocation in accordance with such provision. The Employer shall provide the Administrator with written notification of the amount of the contribution being made and for which provision it is being made pursuant to:

(1) A special Qualified Non-Elective Contribution may be made on behalf of Non-Highly Compensated Participants in an amount sufficient to satisfy (or to prevent an anticipated failure of) one of the tests set forth in Section 4.5(a). Such contribution shall be allocated in the same proportion that each Non-Highly Compensated Participant's
414(s) Compensation for the year (or prior year if the prior year testing method is being used) bears to the total 414(s) Compensation of all Non-Highly Compensated Participants for such year.

(2) A special Qualified Non-Elective Contribution may be made on behalf of Non-Highly Compensated Participants in an amount sufficient to satisfy (or to prevent an anticipated failure of) one of the tests set forth in Section 4.5(a). Such contribution shall be allocated in the same proportion that each Non-Highly Compensated Participant electing salary reductions pursuant to Section 4.2 in the same proportion that each such Non-Highly Compensated Participant's Deferred Compensation for the year (or at the end of the prior Plan Year if the prior year testing method is being used) bears to the total Deferred Compensation of all such Non-Highly Compensated Participants for such year.

33

(3) A special Qualified Non-Elective Contribution may be made on behalf of Non-Highly Compensated Participants in an amount sufficient to satisfy (or to prevent an anticipated failure of) one of the tests set forth in Section 4.5(a). Such contribution shall be allocated in equal amounts (per capita).

(4) A special Qualified Non-Elective Contribution may be made on behalf of Non-Highly Compensated Participants electing salary reductions pursuant to Section 4.2 in an amount sufficient to satisfy (or to prevent an anticipated failure of) one of the tests set forth in Section 4.5(a). Such contribution shall be allocated for the year (or at the end of the prior Plan Year if the prior year testing method is used) to each Non-Highly Compensated Participant electing salary reductions pursuant to Section 4.2 in equal amounts (per capita).

(5) A special Qualified Non-Elective Contribution may be made on behalf of Non-Highly Compensated Participants in an amount sufficient to satisfy (or to prevent an anticipated failure of) one of the tests set forth in Section 4.5(a). Such contribution shall be allocated to the Non-Highly Compensated Participant having the lowest 414(s) Compensation, until one of the tests set forth in Section 4,5(a) is satisfied (or is anticipated to be satisfied), or until such Non-Highly Compensated Participant has received the maximum "annual addition" pursuant to Section 4.9. This process shall continue until one of the tests set forth in Section 4.5(a) is satisfied (or is anticipated to be satisfied).

Notwithstanding the above, at the Employer's discretion, Non-Highly Compensated Participants who are not employed at the end of the Plan Year (or at the end of the prior Plan Year if the prior year testing method is being used) shall not be eligible to receive a special Qualified Non-Elective Contribution and shall be disregarded.

Notwithstanding the above, if the testing method changes from the current year testing method to the prior year testing method, then for purposes of preventing the double counting of Qualified Non-Elective Contributions for the first testing year for which the change is effective, any special Qualified Non-Elective Contribution on behalf of Non-Highly Compensated Participants used to satisfy the "Actual Deferral Percentage" or "Actual Contribution Percentage" test under the current year testing method for the prior year testing year shall be disregarded.

(c) If during a Plan Year, it is projected that the aggregate amount of Elective Contributions to be allocated to all Highly Compensated Participants under this Plan would cause the Plan to fail the tests set forth in Section 4.5(a), then the Administrator may automatically reduce the deferral amount of affected Highly Compensated Participants, beginning with the Highly Compensated Participant who has the highest deferral ratio until it is anticipated the Plan will pass the tests or until the actual deferral ratio equals the actual deferral ratio of the Highly Compensated

34

Participant having the next highest actual deferral ratio. This process may continue until it is anticipated that the Plan will satisfy one of the tests set forth in Section 4.5(a). Alternatively, the Employer may specify a maximum percentage of Compensation that may be deferred.

(d) Any Excess Contributions (and Income) which are distributed on or after 2 1/2 months after the end of the Plan Year shall be subject to the ten percent (10%) Employer excise tax imposed by Code Section 4979.

4.7 ACTUAL CONTRIBUTION PERCENTAGE TESTS

(a) The "Actual Contribution Percentage" for the Highly Compensated Participant group shall not exceed the greater of:

(1) 125 percent of such percentage for the Non-Highly Compensated Participant group (for the preceding Plan Year if the prior year testing method is used to calculate the "Actual Contribution Percentage" for the Non-Highly Compensated Participant group); or

(2) the lesser of 200 percent of such percentage for the Non-Highly Compensated Participant group (for the preceding Plan Year if the prior year testing method is used to calculate the "Actual Contribution Percentage" for the Non-Highly Compensated Participant group), or such percentage for the Non-Highly Compensated Participant group (for the preceding Plan Year if the prior year testing method is used to calculate the "Actual Contribution Percentage" for the Non-Highly Compensated Participant group) plus 2 percentage points. However, to prevent the multiple use of the alternative method described in this paragraph and Code Section 401(m)(9)(A), any Highly Compensated Participant eligible to make elective deferrals pursuant to Section 4.2 or any other cash or deferred arrangement maintained by the Employer or an Affiliated Employer and to make Employee contributions or to receive matching contributions under this Plan or under any plan maintained by the Employer or an Affiliated Employer shall have a combination of Elective Contributions and Employer matching contributions reduced pursuant to Regulation 1.401(m)-2 and
Section 4.8(a). The provisions of Code Section 401(m) and Regulations 1.40 l(m)-l(b) and 1.401(m)-2 are incorporated herein by reference.

(b) For the purposes of this Section and Section 4.8, "Actual Contribution Percentage" for a Plan Year means, with respect to the Highly Compensated Participant group and Non-Highly Compensated Participant group (for the preceding Plan Year if the prior year testing method is used to calculate the "Actual Contribution Percentage" for the Non-Highly Compensated Participant group), the average of the ratios (calculated separately for each Participant in each group and rounded to the nearest one-hundredth of one percent) of:

(1) the sum of Employer matching contributions made pursuant to
Section 4.1(b)on behalf of each such Participant for such Plan Year;

35

(2) the Participant's "414(s) Compensation" for such Plan Year.

Notwithstanding the above, if the prior year testing method is used to calculate the "Actual Contribution Percentage" for the Non-Highly Compensated Participant group for the first Plan Year of this amendment and restatement, for purposes of Section 4.7(a), the "Actual Contribution Percentage" for the Non-Highly Compensated Participant group for the preceding Plan Year shall be determined pursuant to the provisions of the Plan then in effect.

(c) For purposes of determining the "Actual Contribution Percentage," only Employer matching contributions contributed to the Plan prior to the end of the succeeding Plan Year shall be considered. In addition, the Administrator may elect to take into account, with respect to Employees eligible to have Employer matching contributions pursuant to Section 4.1(b) allocated to their accounts, elective deferrals (as defined in Regulation 1.402(g)-l(b)) and qualified non-elective contributions (as defined in Code
Section 401(m)(4)(C)) contributed to any plan maintained by the Employer. Such elective deferrals and qualified non-elective contributions shall be treated as Employer matching contributions subject to Regulation 1.401(m)-l(b)(5) which is incorporated herein by reference. However, the Plan Year must be the same as the plan year of the plan to which the elective deferrals and the qualified non-elective contributions are made.

(d) For purposes of this Section and Code Sections 401 (a)(4), 410(b) and 401(m), if two or more plans of the Employer to which matching contributions, Employee contributions, or both, are made are treated as one plan for purposes of Code Sections 401(a)(4) or 410(b) (other than the average benefits test under Code Section 410(b)(2)(A)(ii)), such plans shall be treated as one plan. In addition, two or more plans of the Employer to which matching contributions, Employee contributions, or both, are made may be considered as a single plan for purposes of determining whether or not such plans satisfy Code Sections 401(a)(4), 410(b) and
401(m). In such a case, the aggregated plans must satisfy this Section and Code Sections 401(a)(4), 410(b) and 401 (m) as though such aggregated plans were a single plan. Any adjustment to the Non-Highly Compensated Participant actual contribution ratio for the prior year shall be made in accordance with Internal Revenue Service Notice 98-1 and any superseding guidance. Plans may be aggregated under this paragraph (d) only if they have the same plan year. Notwithstanding the above, if two or more plans which include cash or deferred arrangements are permissively aggregated under Regulation 1.410(b)-7(d), all plans permissively aggregated must use either the current year testing method or the prior year testing method for the testing year.

Notwithstanding the above, an employee stock ownership plan described in Code Section 4975(e)(7) or 409 may not be aggregated with this Plan for purposes of determining whether the employee stock ownership plan or this Plan satisfies this Section and Code Sections 401(a)(4), 410(b) and 401(m).

(e) If a Highly Compensated Participant is a Participant under two or more plans (other than an employee stock ownership plan as defined in Code
Section 4975(e)(7) or 409) which are maintained by the Employer or an

36

Affiliated Employer to which matching contributions, Employee contributions, or both, are made, all such contributions on behalf of such Highly Compensated Participant shall be aggregated for purposes of determining such Highly Compensated Participant's actual contribution ratio. However, if the plans have different plan years, this paragraph shall be applied by treating all plans ending with or within the same calendar year as a single plan.

(f) For purposes of Sections 4.7(a) and 4.8, a Highly Compensated Participant and Non-Highly Compensated Participant shall include any Employee eligible to have Employer matching contributions (whether or not a deferral election was made or suspended) allocated to the Participant's account for the Plan Year.

Notwithstanding the above, if the prior year testing method is used to calculate the "Actual Contribution Percentage" for the Non-Highly Compensated Participant group for the first Plan Year of this amendment and restatement, for the purposes of Section 4.7(a), a Non-Highly Compensated Participant shall include any such Employee eligible to have Employer matching contributions (whether or not a deferral election was made or suspended) allocated to the Participant's account for the preceding Plan Year pursuant to the provisions of the Plan then in effect.

(g) For the purpose of this Section, when calculating the "Actual Contribution Percentage" for the Non-Highly Compensated Participant group, the current year testing method shall be used. Any change from the current year testing method to the prior year testing method shall be made pursuant to Internal Revenue Service Notice 98-1, Section VII (or superseding guidance), the provisions of which are incorporated herein by reference.

(h) Notwithstanding anything in this Section to the contrary, the provisions of this Section and Section 4.8 may be applied separately (or will be applied separately to the extent required by Regulations) to each plan within the meaning of Regulation 1.401(k)-l(g)(l 1). Furthermore, the provisions of Code Section 401(k)(3)(F) may be used to exclude from consideration all Non-Highly Compensated Employees who have not satisfied the minimum age and service requirements of Code Section 410(a)(l)(A).

4.8 ADJUSTMENT TO ACTUAL CONTRIBUTION PERCENTAGE TESTS

(a) In the event (or if it is anticipated) that the "Actual Contribution Percentage" for the Highly Compensated Participant group exceeds (or might exceed) the "Actual Contribution Percentage" for the Non-Highly Compensated Participant group pursuant to Section 4.7(a), the Administrator (on or before the fifteenth day of the third month following the end of the Plan Year, but in no event later than the close of the following Plan Year) shall direct the Trustee to distribute to the Highly Compensated Participant having the largest dollar amount of contributions determined pursuant to Section 4.7(b)(l), the Vested portion of such contributions (and Income allocable to such contributions) and, if

37

forfeitable, forfeit such non-Vested contributions attributable to Employer matching contributions (and Income allocable to such forfeitures) until the total amount of Excess Aggregate Contributions has been distributed, or until the Participant's remaining amount equals the amount of contributions determined pursuant to Section 4.7(b)(l) of the Highly Compensated Participant having the second largest dollar amount of contributions. This process shall continue until the total amount of Excess Aggregate Contributions has been distributed.

If the correction of Excess Aggregate Contributions attributable to Employer matching contributions is not in proportion to the Vested and non-Vested portion of such contributions, then the Vested portion of the Participant's Account attributable to Employer matching contributions after the correction shall be subject to Section 6,5(j).

(b) Any distribution and/or forfeiture of less than the entire amount of Excess Aggregate Contributions (and Income) shall be treated as a pro rata distribution and/or forfeiture of Excess Aggregate Contributions and Income. Distribution of Excess Aggregate Contributions shall be designated by the Employer as a distribution of Excess Aggregate Contributions (and Income). Forfeitures of Excess Aggregate Contributions shall be treated in accordance with Section 4.4.

(c) Excess Aggregate Contributions, including forfeited matching contributions, shall be treated as Employer contributions for purposes of Code Sections 404 and 415 even if distributed from the Plan.

Forfeited matching contributions that are reallocated to Participants' Accounts for the Plan Year in which the forfeiture occurs shall be treated as an "annual addition" pursuant to Section 4.9(b) for the Participants to whose Accounts they are reallocated and for the Participants from whose Accounts they are forfeited.

(d) The determination of the amount of Excess Aggregate Contributions with respect to any Plan Year shall be made after first determining the Excess Contributions, if any, to be treated as after-tax voluntary Employee contributions due to recharacterization for the plan year of any other qualified cash or deferred arrangement (as defined in Code Section 401(k)) maintained by the Employer that ends with or within the Plan Year or which are treated as after-tax voluntary Employee contributions due to recharacterization pursuant to Section 4.6(a).

(e) If during a Plan Year the projected aggregate amount of Employer matching contributions to be allocated to all Highly Compensated Participants under this Plan would, by virtue of the tests set forth in
Section 4.7(a), cause the Plan to fail such tests, then the Administrator may automatically reduce proportionately or in the order provided in
Section 4.8(a) each affected Highly Compensated Participant's projected share of such contributions by an amount necessary to satisfy one of the tests set forth in Section 4.7(a).

38

(f) Notwithstanding the above, within twelve (12) months after the end of the Plan Year, the Employer may make a special Qualified Non-Elective Contribution in accordance with one of the following provisions which contribution shall be allocated to the Participant's Account of each Non-Highly Compensated eligible to share in the allocation in accordance with such provision. The Employer shall provide the Administrator with written notification of the amount of the contribution being made and for which provision it is being made pursuant to:

(1) A special Qualified Non-Elective Contribution may be made on behalf of Non-Highly Compensated Participants in an amount sufficient to satisfy (or to prevent an anticipated failure of) one of the tests set forth in Section 4.7. Such contribution shall be allocated in the same proportion that each Non-Highly Compensated Participant's 414(s) Compensation for the year (or prior year if the prior year testing method is being used) bears to the total 414(s) Compensation of all Non-Highly Compensated Participants for such year.

(2) A special Qualified Non-Elective Contribution may be made on behalf of Non-Highly Compensated Participants in an amount sufficient to satisfy (or to prevent an anticipated failure of) one of the tests set forth in Section 4.7. Such contribution shall be allocated in the same proportion that each Non-Highly Compensated Participant electing salary reductions pursuant to
Section 4.2 in the same proportion that each such Non-Highly Compensated Participant's Deferred Compensation for the year (or at the end of the prior Plan Year if the prior year testing method is being used) bears to the total Deferred Compensation of all such Non-Highly Compensated Participants for such year.

(3) A special Qualified Non-Elective Contribution may be made on behalf of Non-Highly Compensated Participants in an amount sufficient to satisfy (or to prevent an anticipated failure of) one of the tests set forth in Section 4.7. Such contribution shall be allocated in equal amounts (per capita),

(4) A special Qualified Non-Elective Contribution may be made on behalf of Non-Highly Compensated Participants electing salary reductions pursuant to Section 4.2 in an amount sufficient to satisfy (or to prevent an anticipated failure of) one of the tests set forth in Section 4.7. Such contribution shall be allocated for the year (or at the end of the prior Plan Year if the prior year testing method is used) to each Non-Highly Compensated Participant electing salary reductions pursuant to
Section 4,2 in equal amounts (per capita).

(5) A special Qualified Non-Elective Contribution may be made on behalf of Non-Highly Compensated Participants in an amount sufficient to satisfy (or to prevent an anticipated failure of) one of the tests set forth in Section 4.7. Such contribution shall be allocated to the Non-Highly Compensated Participant

39

having the lowest 414(s) Compensation, until one of the tests set forth in Section 4.7 is satisfied (or is anticipated to be satisfied), or until such Non-Highly Compensated Participant has received the maximum "annual addition" pursuant to Section 4.9. This process shall continue until one of the tests set forth in
Section 4.7 is satisfied (or is anticipated to be satisfied).

Notwithstanding the above, at the Employer's discretion, Non-Highly Compensated Participants who are not employed at the end of the Plan Year (or at the end of the prior Plan Year if the prior year testing method is being used) shall not be eligible to receive a special Qualified Non-Elective Contribution and shall be disregarded.

Notwithstanding the above, if the testing method changes from the current year testing method to the prior year testing method, then for purposes of preventing the double counting of Qualified Non-Elective Contributions for the first testing year for which the change is effective, any special Qualified Non-Elective Contribution on behalf of Non-Highly Compensated Participants used to satisfy the "Actual Deferral Percentage" or "Actual Contribution Percentage" test under the current year testing method for the prior year testing year shall be disregarded.

(g) Any Excess Aggregate Contributions (and Income) which are distributed on or after 2 1/2 months after the end of the Plan Year shall be subject to the ten percent (10%) Employer excise tax imposed by Code
Section 4979.

4.9 MAXIMUM ANNUAL ADDITIONS

(a) Notwithstanding the foregoing, the maximum "annual additions" credited to a Participant's accounts for any "limitation year" shall equal the lesser of: (1) S30,000 adjusted annually as provided in Code Section 415(d) pursuant to the Regulations, or (2) twenty-five percent (25%) of the Participant's "415 Compensation" for such "limitation year." If the Employer contribution that would otherwise be contributed or allocated to the Participant's accounts would cause the "annual additions" for the "limitation year" to exceed the maximum "annual additions," the amount contributed or allocated will be reduced so that the "annual additions" for the "limitation year" will equal the maximum "annual additions," and any amount in excess of the maximum "annual additions," which would have been allocated to such Participant may be allocated to other Participants. For any short "limitation year," the dollar limitation in (1) above shall be reduced by a fraction, the numerator of which is the number of full months in the short "limitation year" and the denominator of which is twelve (12).

(b) For purposes of applying the limitations of Code Section 415, "annual additions" means the sum credited to a Participant's accounts for any "limitation year" of (1) Employer contributions, (2) Employee contributions, (3) forfeitures, (4) amounts allocated, after March 31, 1984, to an individual medical account, as defined in Code Section 415(1)(2) which is part of a pension or annuity plan maintained by the Employer and (5) amounts derived from contributions paid or accrued after

40

December 31, 1985, in taxable years ending after such date, which are attributable to post-retirement medical benefits allocated to the separate account of a key employee (as defined in Code Section 419A(d)(3)) under a welfare benefit plan (as defined in Code Section 419(e)) maintained by the Employer. Except, however, the "415 Compensation" percentage limitation referred to in paragraph (a)(2) above shall not apply to: (1) any contribution for medical benefits (within the meaning of Code Section 419A(f)(2)) after separation from service which is otherwise treated as an "annual addition," or (2) any amount otherwise treated as an "annual addition" under Code Section 415(1)(1).

(c) For purposes of applying the limitations of Code Section 415, the transfer of funds from one qualified plan to another is not an "annual addition." In addition, the following are not Employee contributions for the purposes of Section 4.9(b)(2): (1) rollover contributions (as defined in Code Sections 402(e)(6), 403(a)(4), 403(b)(8) and 408(d)(3)); (2) repayments of loans made to a Participant from the Plan; (3) repayments of distributions received by an Employee pursuant to Code Section 41 l(a)(7)(B) (cash-outs); (4) repayments of distributions received by an Employee pursuant to Code Section 41 l(a)(3)(D) (mandatory contributions); and (5) Employee contributions to a simplified employee pension excludable from gross income under Code Section 408(k)(6).

(d) For purposes of applying the limitations of Code Section 415, the "limitation year" shall be the Plan Year,

(e) For the purpose of this Section, all qualified defined contribution plans (whether terminated or not) ever maintained by the Employer shall be treated as one defined contribution plan.

(f) For the purpose of this Section, if the Employer is a member of a controlled group of corporations, trades or businesses under common control (as defined by Code Section 1563(a) or Code Section 414(b) and (c) as modified by Code Section 415(h)), is a member of an affiliated service group (as defined by Code Section 414(m)), or is a member of a group of entities required to be aggregated pursuant to Regulations under Code
Section 414(o), all Employees of such Employers shall be considered to be employed by a single Employer.

(g) If this is a plan described in Code Section 413(c) (other than a plan described in Code Section 413(f)), then all of the benefits or contributions attributable to a Participant from all of the Employers maintaining this Plan shall be taken into account in applying the limits of this Section with respect to such Participant. Furthermore, in applying the limitations of this Section with respect to such a Participant, the total "415 Compensation" received by the Participant from all of the Employers maintaining the Plan shall be taken into account.

(h)( 1) If a Participant participates in more than one defined contribution plan maintained by the Employer which have different Anniversary Dates, the maximum "annual additions" under this Plan shall equal the maximum "annual additions" for the "limitation year" minus any "annual additions" previously credited to such Participant's accounts during the "limitation year."

41

(2) If a Participant participates in both a defined contribution plan subject to Code Section 412 and a defined contribution plan not subject to Code Section 412 maintained by the Employer which have the same Anniversary Date, "annual additions" will be credited to the Participant's accounts under the defined contribution plan subject to Code Section 412 prior to crediting "annual additions" to the Participant's accounts under the defined contribution plan not subject to Code Section 412.

(3) If a Participant participates in more than one defined contribution plan not subject to Code Section 412 maintained by the Employer which have the same Anniversary Date, the maximum "annual additions" under this Plan shall equal the product of (A) the maximum "annual additions" for the "limitation year" minus any "annual additions" previously credited under subparagraphs (1) or (2) above, multiplied by (B) a fraction (i) the numerator of which is the "annual additions" which would be credited to such Participant's accounts under this Plan without regard to the limitations of Code Section 415 and (ii) the denominator of which is such "annual additions" for all plans described in this subparagraph.

(i) Notwithstanding anything contained in this Section to the contrary, the limitations, adjustments and other requirements prescribed in this Section shall at all times comply with the provisions of Code Section 415 and the Regulations thereunder.

4.10 ADJUSTMENT FOR EXCESSIVE ANNUAL ADDITIONS

(a) If, as a result of a reasonable error in estimating a Participant's Compensation, a reasonable error in determining the amount of elective deferrals (within the meaning of Code Section 402(g)(3)) that may be made with respect to any Participant under the limits of Section 4.9 or other facts and circumstances to which Regulation 1.415-6(b)(6) shall be applicable, the "annual additions" under this Plan would cause the maximum "annual additions" to be exceeded for any Participant, the "excess amount" will be disposed of in one of the following manners, as uniformly determined by the Administrator for all Participants similarly situated.

(1) Any matched Deferred Compensation and Employer matching contributions which relate to such Deferred Compensation will be proportionately reduced to the extent they would reduce the "excess amount." The Deferred Compensation (and any gains attributable to such Deferred Compensation) will be distributed to the Participant and the Employer matching contributions (and any gains attributable to such matching contributions) will be used to reduce the Employer contribution in the next "limitation year";

(2) If, after the application of subparagraph (1) above, an "excess amount" still exists, and the Participant is covered by the Plan at the end of the "limitation year," the "excess amount" will be used to reduce the Employer contribution for such Participant in the next "limitation year," and each succeeding "limitation year" if necessary;

42

(3) If, after the application of subparagraphs (1) and (2) above, an "excess amount" still exists, and the Participant is not covered by the Plan at the end of the "limitation year," the "excess amount" will be held unallocated in a "Section 415 suspense account." The "Section 415 suspense account" will be applied to reduce future Employer contributions for all remaining Participants in the next "limitation year," and each succeeding "limitation year" if necessary;

(4) If a "Section 415 suspense account" is in existence at any time during the "limitation year" pursuant to this Section, it will not participate in the allocation of investment gains and losses of the Trust Fund. If a "Section 415 suspense account" is in existence at any time during a particular "limitation year," all amounts in the "Section 415 suspense account" must be allocated and reallocated to Participants' accounts before any Employer contributions or any Employee contributions may be made to the Plan for that "limitation year," Except as provided in (1) above, "excess amounts" may not be distributed to Participants or Former Participants.

(b) For purposes of this Article, "excess amount" for any Participant for a "limitation year" shall mean the excess, if any, of (1) the "annual additions" which would be credited to the Participant's account under the terms of the Plan without regard to the limitations of Code Section 415 over (2) the maximum "annual additions" determined pursuant to Section 4.9.

(c) For purposes of this Section, "Section 415 suspense account" shall mean an unallocated account equal to the sum of "excess amounts" for all Participants in the Plan during the "limitation year."

4.11 ROLLOVERS AND PLAN-TO-PLAN TRANSFERS FROM QUALIFIED PLANS

(a) With the consent of the Administrator, amounts may be transferred (within the meaning of Code Section 414(1)) to this Plan from other tax qualified plans under Code Section 401 (a) by Eligible Employees, provided the trust from which such funds are transferred permits the transfer to be made and the transfer will not jeopardize the tax exempt status of the Plan or Trust or create adverse tax consequences for the Employer. Prior to accepting any transfers to which this Section applies, the Administrator may require an opinion of counsel that the amounts to be transferred meet the requirements of this Section. The amounts transferred shall be set up in a separate account herein referred to as a Participant's Transfer/Rollover Account. Furthermore, for vesting purposes, the Participant's portion of the Participant's Transfer/Rollover Account attributable to any transfer shall be subject to Section 6.4(b).

Except as permitted by Regulations (including Regulation 1.411 (d)-4), amounts attributable to elective contributions (as defined in Regulation 1.401(k)-l(g)(3)), including amounts treated as elective contributions, which are transferred from another qualified plan in a plan-to-plan transfer (other than a direct rollover) shall be subject to the distribution limitations provided for in Regulation 1.401(k)-l(d).

43

(b) With the consent of the Administrator, the Plan may accept a "rollover" by Eligible Employees, provided the "rollover" will not jeopardize the tax exempt status of the Plan or create adverse tax consequences for the Employer. Prior to accepting any "rollovers" to which this Section applies, the Administrator may require the Employee to establish (by providing opinion of counsel or otherwise) that the amounts to be rolled over to this Plan meet the requirements of this Section. The amounts rolled over shall be set up in a separate account herein referred to as a "Participant's Transfer/Rollover Account." Such account shall be fully Vested at all times and shall not be subject to Forfeiture for any reason.

For purposes of this Section, the term "qualified plan" shall mean any tax qualified plan under Code Section 401 (a), or, any other plans from which distributions are eligible to be rolled over into this Plan pursuant to the Code. The term "rollover" means: (i) amounts transferred to this Plan directly from another qualified plan; (ii) distributions received by an Employee from other "qualified plans" which are eligible for tax-free rollover to a "qualified plan" and which are transferred by the Employee to this Plan within sixty (60) days following receipt thereof; (iii) amounts transferred to this Plan from a conduit individual retirement account provided that the conduit individual retirement account has no assets other than assets which (A) were previously distributed to the Employee by another "qualified plan," (B) were eligible for tax-free rollover to a "qualified plan" and (C) were deposited in such conduit individual retirement account within sixty (60) days of receipt thereof; (iv) amounts distributed to the Employee from a conduit individual retirement account meeting the requirements of clause (iii) above, and transferred by the Employee to this Plan within sixty (60) days of receipt thereof from such conduit individual retirement account; and (v) any other amounts which are eligible to be rolled over to this Plan pursuant to the Code. (

c) Amounts in a Participant's Transfer/Rollover Account shall be held by the Trustee pursuant to the provisions of this Plan and may not be withdrawn by, or distributed to the Participant, in whole or in part, except as provided in paragraph (d) of this Section. The Trustee shall have no duty or responsibility to inquire as to the propriety of the amount, value or type of assets transferred, nor to conduct any due diligence with respect to such assets; provided, however, that such assets are otherwise eligible to be held by the Trustee under the terms of this Plan.

(d) The Administrator, at the election of the Participant, shall direct the Trustee to distribute all or a portion of the amount credited to the Participant's Transfer/Rollover Account. Any distributions of amounts held in a Participant's Transfer/Rollover Account shall be made in a manner which is consistent with and satisfies the provisions of Section 6.5, including, but not limited to, all notice and consent requirements of Code Sections 417 and 411(a)(11) and the

44

Regulations thereunder. Furthermore, such amounts shall be considered as part of a Participant's benefit in determining whether an involuntary cash-out of benefits may be made without Participant consent.

(e) The Administrator may direct that Employee transfers and rollovers made after a Valuation Date be segregated into a separate account for each Participant until such time as the allocations pursuant to this Plan have been made, at which time they may remain segregated or be invested as part of the general Trust Fund or be directed by the Participant pursuant to
Section 4.12.

(f) Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, a transfer directly to this Plan from another qualified plan (or a transaction having the effect of such a transfer) shall only be permitted if it will not result in the elimination or reduction of any "Section 41 l(d)(6) protected benefit" as described in Section 7.1.

4.12 DIRECTED INVESTMENT ACCOUNT

(a) Participants may, subject to a procedure established by the Administrator (the Participant Direction Procedures) and applied in a uniform nondiscriminatory manner, direct the Trustee, in writing (or in such other form which is acceptable to the Trustee), to invest all of their accounts in specific assets, specific funds or other investments permitted under the Plan and the Participant Direction Procedures. That portion of the interest of any Participant so directing will thereupon be considered a Participant's Directed Account.

(b) As of each Valuation Date, all Participant Directed Accounts shall be charged or credited with the net earnings, gains, losses and expenses as well as any appreciation or depreciation in the market value using publicly listed fair market values when available or appropriate as follows:

(1) to the extent that the assets in a Participant's Directed Account are accounted for as pooled assets or investments, the allocation of earnings, gains and losses of each Participant's Directed Account shall be based upon the total amount of funds so invested in a manner proportionate to the Participant's share of such pooled investment; and

(2) to the extent that the assets in the Participant's Directed Account are accounted for as segregated assets, the allocation of earnings, gains and losses from such assets shall be made on a separate and distinct basis.

(c) Investment directions will be processed as soon as administratively practicable after proper investment directions are received from the Participant. No guarantee is made by the Plan, Employer, Administrator or Trustee that investment directions will be processed on a daily basis, and no guarantee is made in any respect regarding the processing time of an investment direction. Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan, the Employer, Administrator or Trustee reserves the right to not value an investment option on any given Valuation Date for any reason deemed appropriate by the Employer, Administrator or Trustee. Furthermore, the processing of any investment

45

transaction may be delayed for any legitimate business reason (including, but not limited to, failure of systems or computer programs, failure of the means of the transmission of data, force majeure, the failure of a service provider to timely receive values or prices, and correction for errors or omissions or the errors or omissions of any service provider). The processing date of a transaction will be binding for all purposes of the Plan and considered the applicable Valuation Date for an investment transaction.

(d) The Participant Direction Procedures shall provide an explanation of the circumstances under which Participants and their Beneficiaries may give investment instructions, including, but need not be limited to, the following:

(1) the conveyance of instructions by the Participants and their Beneficiaries to invest Participant Directed Accounts in Directed Investment Options;

(2) the name, address and phone number of the Fiduciary (and, if applicable, the person or persons designated by the Fiduciary to act on its behalf) responsible for providing information to the Participant or a Beneficiary upon request relating to the Directed Investment Options;

(3) applicable restrictions on transfers to and from any Designated Investment Alternative;

(4) any restrictions on the exercise of voting, tender and similar rights related to a Directed Investment Option by the Participants or their Beneficiaries;

(5) a description of any transaction fees and expenses which affect the balances in Participant Directed Accounts in connection with the purchase or sale of Directed Investment Options; and

(6) general procedures for the dissemination of investment and other information relating to the Designated Investment Alternatives as deemed necessary or appropriate, including but not limited to a description of the following:

(i) the investment vehicles available under the Plan, including specific information regarding any Designated Investment Alternative;

(ii) any designated Investment Managers; and

(iii) a description of the additional information which may be obtained upon request from the Fiduciary designated to provide such information.

(e) Any information regarding investments available under the Plan, to the extent not required to be described in the Participant Direction Procedures,

46

may be provided to the Participant in one or more written documents (or in any other form including, but not limited to, electronic media) which are separate from the Participant Direction Procedures and are not thereby incorporated by reference into this Plan.

(f) The Administrator may, in its discretion, include in or exclude by amendment or other action from the Participant Direction Procedures such instructions, guidelines or policies as it deems necessary or appropriate to ensure proper administration of the Plan, and may interpret the same accordingly,

4.13 QUALIFIED MILITARY SERVICE

Notwithstanding any provision of this Plan to the contrary, contributions, benefits and service will be provided in accordance with Code Section 414(u).

4.14 2005 VOLUNTARY COMPLIANCE

As to any person that received a distribution upon the termination of the Industrial Data Systems, Inc. 401(k) Profit Sharing Plan, is actively employed by the Employer or Affiliated Employer on the date that the Internal Revenue Service approves the voluntary compliance filing made pursuant to the terms of Revenue Procedure 2003-44 on June 3, 2005, and who elects to repay the distribution received upon such termination, an Account will be established for such repayment, reflecting the repayment in its appropriate source of funds. Such Account will be held pursuant to the terms of the Plan, until such time that payment of the Account can be made in accordance with the normal terms of the Plan.

As to any person that received a distribution upon the termination of the Industrial Data Systems, Inc. 401(k) Profit Sharing Plan, who rolled over such distribution to the Plan, and is actively employed by the Employer or Affiliated Employer on the date that the Internal Revenue Service approves the voluntary compliance filing made pursuant to the terms of Revenue Procedure 2003-44 on June 3, 2005, the amount in such Rollover Account will be reallocated under the Plan to reflect its appropriate source of funds. Such Account will be held pursuant to the terms of the Plan, until such time that payment of the Account can be made in accordance with the normal terms of the Plan.

ARTICLE V
VALUATIONS

5.1 VALUATION OF THE TRUST FUND

The Administrator shall direct the Trustee, as of each Valuation Date, to determine the net worth of the assets comprising the Trust Fund as it exists on the Valuation Date. In determining such net worth, the Trustee shall value the assets comprising the Trust Fund at their fair market value (or their contractual value in the case of a Contract or Policy) as of the Valuation Date and shall deduct all expenses for which the Trustee has not yet obtained reimbursement from the Employer or the Trust Fund. The Trustee may update the value of any

47

shares held in the Participant Directed Account by reference to the number of shares held by that Participant, priced at the market value as of the Valuation Date.

5.2 METHOD OF VALUATION

In determining the fair market value of securities held in the Trust Fund which are listed on a registered stock exchange, the Administrator shall direct the Trustee to value the same at the prices they were last traded on such exchange preceding the close of business on the Valuation Date, If such securities were not traded on the Valuation Date, or if the exchange on which they are traded was not open for business on the Valuation Date, then the securities shall be valued at the prices at which they were last traded prior to the Valuation Date. Any unlisted security held in the Trust Fund shall be valued at its bid price next preceding the close of business on the Valuation Date, which bid price shall be obtained from a registered broker or an investment banker. In determining the fair market value of assets other than securities for which trading or bid prices can be obtained, the Trustee may appraise such assets itself, or in its discretion, employ one or more appraisers for that purpose and rely on the values established by such appraiser or appraisers.

ARTICLE VI
DETERMINATION AND DISTRIBUTION OF BENEFITS

6.1 DETERMINATION OF BENEFITS UPON RETIREMENT

Every Participant may terminate employment with the Employer and retire for the purposes hereof on the Participant's Normal Retirement Date or Early Retirement Date. However, a Participant may postpone the termination of employment with the Employer to a later date, in which event the participation of such Participant in the Plan, including the right to receive allocations pursuant to Section 4.4, shall continue until such Participant's Late Retirement Date. Upon a Participant's Retirement Date, or as soon thereafter as is practicable, the Trustee shall distribute, at the election of the Participant, all amounts credited to such Participant's Combined Account in accordance with
Section 6.5.

6.2 DETERMINATION OF BENEFITS UPON DEATH

(a) Upon the death of a Participant before the Participant's Retirement Date or other termination of employment, all amounts credited to such Participant's Combined Account shall become fully Vested. The Administrator shall direct the Trustee, in accordance with the provisions of Sections 6.6 and 6.7, to distribute the value of the deceased Participant's accounts to the Participant's Beneficiary.

(b) Upon the death of a Former Participant, the Administrator shall direct the Trustee, in accordance with the provisions of Sections 6.6 and 6.7, to distribute any remaining Vested amounts credited to the accounts of a deceased Former Participant to such Former Participant's Beneficiary.

(c) Any security interest held by the Plan by reason of an outstanding loan to the Participant or Former Participant shall be taken into account in determining the amount of the death benefit.

48

(d) The Administrator may require such proper proof of death and such evidence of the right of any person to receive payment of the value of the account of a deceased Participant or Former Participant as the Administrator may deem desirable. The Administrator's determination of death and of the right of any person to receive payment shall be conclusive.

(e) The Beneficiary of the death benefit payable pursuant to this
Section shall be the Participant's spouse. Except, however, the Participant may designate a Beneficiary other than the spouse if:

(1) the spouse has waived the right to be the Participant's Beneficiary, or

(2) the Participant is legally separated or has been abandoned (within the meaning of local law) and the Participant has a court order to such effect (and there is no "qualified domestic relations order" as defined in Code Section 414(p) which provides otherwise), or

(3) the Participant has no spouse, or (4) the spouse cannot be located.

In such event, the designation of a Beneficiary shall be made on a form satisfactory to the Administrator. A Participant may at any time revoke a designation of a Beneficiary or change a Beneficiary by filing written (or in such other form as permitted by the Internal Revenue Service) notice of such revocation or change with the Administrator. However, the Participant's spouse must again consent in writing (or in such other form as permitted by the Internal Revenue Service) to any change in Beneficiary unless the original consent acknowledged that the spouse had the right to limit consent only to a specific Beneficiary and that the spouse voluntarily elected to relinquish such right.

(f) In the event no valid designation of Beneficiary exists, or if the Beneficiary is not alive at the time of the Participant's death, the death benefit will be paid to the Participant's estate. If the Beneficiary does not predecease the Participant, but dies prior to distribution of the death benefit, the death benefit will be paid to the Beneficiary's estate.

(g) Any consent by the Participant's spouse to waive any rights to the death benefit must be in writing (or in such other form as permitted by the Internal Revenue Service), must acknowledge the effect of such waiver, and be witnessed by a Plan representative or a notary public. Further, the spouse's consent must be irrevocable and must acknowledge the specific nonspouse Beneficiary.

49

6.3 DETERMINATION OF BENEFITS IN EVENT OF DISABILITY

In the event of a Participant's Total and Permanent Disability prior to the Participant's Retirement Date or other termination of employment, all amounts credited to such Participant's Combined Account shall become fully Vested. In the event of a Participant's Total and Permanent Disability, the Administrator, in accordance with the provisions of Sections 6.5 and 6.7, shall direct the distribution to such Participant of all Vested amounts credited to such Participant's Combined Account.

6.4 DETERMINATION OF BENEFITS UPON TERMINATION

(a) If a Participant's employment with the Employer is terminated for any reason other than death, Total and Permanent Disability or retirement, then such Participant shall be entitled to such benefits as are provided hereinafter pursuant to this Section 6.4.

Distribution of the funds due to a Terminated Participant shall be made on the occurrence of an event which would result in the distribution had the Terminated Participant remained in the employ of the Employer (upon the Participant's death, Total and Permanent Disability, Early or Normal Retirement). However, at the election of the Participant, the Administrator shall direct the Trustee that the entire Vested portion of the Terminated Participant's Combined Account be payable to such Terminated Participant. Any distribution under this paragraph shall be made in a manner which is consistent with and satisfies the provisions of Section 6.5, including, but not limited to, all notice and consent requirements of Code Sections 417 and 41 l(a)(l 1) and the Regulations thereunder.

If the value of a Terminated Participant's Vested benefit derived from Employer and Employee contributions does not exceed $5,000, then the Administrator shall direct the Trustee to cause the entire Vested benefit to be paid to such Participant in a single lump sum.

(b) The Vested portion of any Participant's Account shall be a percentage of the total amount credited to the Participant's Account determined on the basis of the Participant's number of whole year Periods of Service according to the following schedule:

                 Vesting Schedule
Periods of Service                  Percentage
        1                              25 %
        2                              50 %
        3                             100 %

(c) Notwithstanding the vesting schedule above, the Vested percentage of a Participant's Account shall not be less than the Vested percentage attained as of the later of the effective date or adoption date of this amendment and restatement.

50

(d) Notwithstanding the vesting schedule above, upon the complete discontinuance of the Employer contributions to the Plan or upon any full or partial termination of the Plan, all amounts then credited to the account of any affected Participant shall become 100% Vested and shall not thereafter be subject to Forfeiture.

(e) The computation of a Participant's nonforfeitable percentage of such Participant's interest in the Plan shall not be reduced as the result of any direct or indirect amendment to this Plan. In the event that the Plan is amended to change or modify any vesting schedule, or if the Plan is amended in any way that directly or indirectly affects the computation of the Participant's nonforfeitable percentage, or if the Plan is deemed amended by an automatic change to a top heavy vesting schedule, then each Participant with at least three (3) whole year Periods of Service as of the expiration date of the election period may elect to have such Participant's nonforfeitable percentage computed under the Plan without regard to such amendment or change. If a Participant fails to make such election, then such Participant shall be subject to the new vesting schedule. The Participant's election period shall commence on the adoption date of the amendment and shall end sixty (60) days after the latest of:

(1) the adoption date of the amendment,

(2) the effective date of the amendment, or

(3) the date the Participant receives written notice of the amendment from the Employer or Administrator.

6.5 DISTRIBUTION OF BENEFITS

(a) The Administrator, pursuant to the election of the Participant, shall direct the Trustee to distribute to a Participant or such Participant's Beneficiary any amount to which the Participant is entitled under the Plan in one of the following methods:

(1) One lump-sum payment in cash or in property allocated to the Participant's account. This shall be the normal form of payment, except as otherwise provided below.

(2) Payments over a period certain in monthly, quarterly, semiannual, or annual cash installments. In order to provide such installment payments, the Administrator may (A) segregate the aggregate amount thereof in a separate, federally insured savings account, certificate of deposit in a bank or savings and loan association, money market certificate or other liquid short-term security or (B) purchase a nontransferable annuity contract for a term certain (with no life contingencies) providing for such payment. The period over which such payment is to be made shall not extend beyond the Participant's life expectancy (or the life expectancy of the Participant and the Participant's designated Beneficiary).

51

(3) Purchase of or providing an annuity subject to the provisions of
Section 6.5(b).

(b) Special rules applicable to annuity payments:

(1) Unless otherwise elected as provided below, a Participant who is married on the Annuity Starting Date and who does not die before the Annuity Starting Date shall receive the value of all of such Participant's benefits in the form of a joint and survivor annuity. The joint and survivor annuity is an annuity that commences immediately and shall be equal in value to a single life annuity. Such joint and survivor benefits following the Participant's death shall continue to the spouse during the spouse's lifetime at a rate equal to fifty percent (50%) of the rate at which such benefits were payable to the Participant, This joint and survivor annuity shall be considered the designated qualified joint and survivor annuity and automatic form of payment for the purposes of this Plan. However, the Participant may, without spousal consent, elect to receive a smaller annuity benefit with continuation of payments to the spouse at a rate of seventy-five percent (75%) or one-hundred percent (100%) of the rate payable to a Participant during the Participant's lifetime, which alternative joint and survivor annuity shall be equal in value to the automatic joint and fifty percent (50%) survivor annuity. An unmarried Participant shall receive the value of such Participant's benefit in the form of a life annuity. Such unmarried Participant, however, may elect in writing to waive the life annuity. The election must comply with the provisions of this Section as if it were an election to waive the joint and survivor annuity by a married Participant, but without the spousal consent requirement. The Participant may elect to have any annuity provided for in this Section distributed upon the attainment of the "earliest retirement age" under the Plan. The "earliest retirement age" is the earliest date on which, under the Plan, the Participant could elect to receive retirement benefits.

(2) Any election to waive the joint and survivor annuity must be made by the Participant in writing (or in such other form as permitted by the Internal Revenue Service) during the election period and be consented to in writing (or in such other form as permitted by the Internal Revenue Service) by the Participant's spouse. If the spouse is legally incompetent to give consent, the spouse's legal guardian, even if such guardian is the Participant, may give consent. Such election shall designate a Beneficiary (or a form of benefits) that may not be changed without spousal consent (unless the consent of the spouse expressly permits designations by the Participant without the requirement of further consent by the spouse). Such spouse's consent shall be irrevocable and must acknowledge the effect of such election and be witnessed by a Plan representative or a notary public. Such consent shall not be required if it is established to the satisfaction of the Administrator that the required consent cannot be obtained

52

because there is no spouse, the spouse cannot be located, or other circumstances that may be prescribed by Regulations. The election made by the Participant and consented to by such Participant's spouse may be revoked by the Participant in writing (or in such other form as permitted by the Internal Revenue Service) without the consent of the spouse at any time during the election period. A revocation of a prior election shall cause the Participant's benefits to be distributed as a joint and survivor annuity. The number of revocations shall not be limited. Any new election must comply with the requirements of this paragraph. A former spouse's waiver shall not be binding on a new spouse.

(3) The election period to waive the joint and survivor annuity shall be the ninety (90) day period ending on the Annuity Starting Date.

(4) For purposes of this Section, spouse or surviving spouse means the spouse or surviving spouse of the Participant, provided that a former spouse will be treated as the spouse or surviving spouse and a current spouse will not be treated as the spouse or surviving spouse to the extent provided under a qualified domestic relations order as described in Code Section 414(p).

(5) With regard to the election, the Administrator shall provide to the Participant no less than thirty (30) days and no more than ninety
(90) days before the Annuity Starting Date a written (or in such other form as permitted by the Internal Revenue Service) explanation of:

(i) the terms and conditions of the joint and survivor annuity,

(ii) the Participant's right to make, and the effect of, an election to waive the joint and survivor annuity,

(iii) the right of the Participant's spouse to consent to any election to waive the joint and survivor annuity, and

(iv) the right of the Participant to revoke such election, and the effect of such revocation.

(6) Notwithstanding the above, if the Participant elects (with spousal consent, if applicable) to waive the requirement that the explanation be provided at least thirty (30) days before the Annuity Starting Date, the election period shall be extended to the thirtieth (30th) day after the date on which such explanation is provided to the Participant, unless the thirty (30) day period is waived pursuant to the following provisions.

Any distribution provided for in this Section 6.5(b) may commence less than thirty (30) days after the notice required by Code Section 417(a)(3) is given provided the following requirements are satisfied:

53

(i) the Administrator clearly informs the Participant that the Participant has a right to a period of thirty (30) days after receiving the notice to consider whether to waive the joint and survivor annuity and to elect (with spousal consent) to a form of distribution other than a joint and survivor annuity;

(ii) the Participant is permitted to revoke an affirmative distribution election at least until the Annuity Starting Date, or, if later, at any time prior to the expiration of the seven (7) day period that begins the day after the explanation of the joint and survivor annuity is provided to the Participant;

(iii) the Annuity Starting Date is after the date that the explanation of the joint and survivor annuity is provided to the Participant. However, the Annuity Starting Date may be before the date that any affirmative distribution election is made by the Participant and before the date that the distribution is permitted to commence under
(iv) below; and

(iv) distribution in accordance with the affirmative election does not commence before the expiration of the seven (7) day period that begins the day after the explanation of the joint and survivor annuity is provided to the Participant.

(c) In the event a married Participant duly elects pursuant to paragraph (b)(2) above not to receive benefits in the form of a joint and survivor annuity, or if such Participant is not married, in the form of a life annuity, the Administrator, pursuant to the election of the Participant, shall direct the Trustee to distribute to a Participant or Beneficiary any such amount to which the Participant or Beneficiary is entitled under the Plan in one or more of the following methods:

(1) One lump-sum payment in cash or in property allocated to the Participant's account.

(2) Payments over a period certain in monthly, quarterly, semiannual, or annual cash installments. In order to provide such installment payments, the Administrator may (A) segregate the aggregate amount thereof in a separate, federally insured savings account, certificate of deposit in a bank or savings and loan association, money market certificate or other liquid short-term security or (B) purchase a nontransferable annuity contract for a term certain (with no life contingencies) providing for such payment. The period over which such payment is to be made shall not extend beyond the Participant's life expectancy (or the life expectancy of the Participant and the Participant's designated Beneficiary).

(d) The present value of a Participant's joint and survivor annuity derived from Employer and Employee contributions may not be paid without the Participant's and the Participant's spouse's written (or in such form as permitted by the Internal Revenue Service) consent if the value exceeds $5,000 and the benefit

54

is "immediately distributable." However, spousal consent is not required if the distribution will be made in the form of a joint and survivor annuity and the benefit is "immediately distributable." A benefit is "immediately distributable" if any part of the benefit could be distributed to the Participant (or surviving spouse) before the Participant attains (or would have attained if not deceased) the later of the Participant's Normal Retirement Age or age 62. Any consent required by this Section 6.5(d) must be obtained not more than ninety (90) days before commencement of the distribution and shall be made in a manner consistent with Section 6.5(b)(2).

If the value of the Participant's benefit derived from Employer and Employee contributions does not exceed $5,000, then the Administrator shall direct the Trustee to immediately distribute such benefit in a lump sum without the Participant's and the Participant's spouse's written consent. No distribution may be made under the preceding sentence after the Annuity Starting Date unless the Participant and the Participant's spouse consent in writing (or in such form as permitted by the Internal Revenue Service) to such distribution.

(e) Any distribution to a Participant who has a benefit which exceeds $5,000, shall require such Participant's written (or in such other form as permitted by the Internal Revenue Service) consent if such distribution commences prior to the time the benefit is "immediately distributable." A benefit is "immediately distributable" if any part of the benefit could be distributed to the Participant (or surviving spouse) before the Participant attains (or would have attained if not deceased) the later of the Participant's Normal Retirement Age or age 62,

(f) The following rules will apply to the consent requirements set forth in subsections (d) and (e):

(1) No consent shall be valid unless the Participant has received a general description of the material features and an explanation of the relative values of the optional forms of benefit available under the Plan that would satisfy the notice requirements of Code Section 417.

(2) The Participant must be informed of the right to defer receipt of the distribution. If a Participant fails to consent, it shall be deemed an election to defer the commencement of payment of any benefit. However, any election to defer the receipt of benefits shall not apply with respect to distributions which are required under
Section 6.5(g).

(3) Notice of the rights specified under this paragraph shall be provided no less than thirty (30) days and no more than ninety (90) days before the Annuity Starting Date.

Notwithstanding the above, the Annuity Starting Date may be a date prior to the date the explanation is provided to the Participant if the distribution does not commence until at least thirty (30) days after such explanation is provided, subject to the waiver of the thirty (30) day period as provided for in Section 6.5(b)(6).

55

(4) Written (or such other form as permitted by the Internal Revenue Service) consent of the Participant to the distribution must not be made before the Participant receives the notice and must not be made more than ninety (90) days before the Annuity Starting Date.

(5) No consent shall be valid if a significant detriment is imposed under the Plan on any Participant who does not consent to the distribution.

Any such distribution may commence less than thirty (30) days, subject to Section 6.5(b)(6), after the notice required under Regulation 1.411(a)-l l(c) is given, provided that: (1) the Administrator clearly informs the Participant that the Participant has a right to a period of at least thirty
(30) days after receiving the notice to consider the decision of whether or not to elect a distribution (and, if applicable, a particular distribution option), and (2) the Participant, after receiving the notice, affirmatively elects a distribution.

(g) Notwithstanding any provision in the Plan to the contrary, the distribution of a Participant's benefits, whether under the Plan or through the purchase of an annuity contract, shall be made in accordance with the following requirements and shall otherwise comply with Code Section 401(a)(9) and the Regulations thereunder (including Regulation 1.401(a)(9)-2), the provisions of which are incorporated herein by reference:

(1) A Participant's benefits shall be distributed or must begin to be distributed not later than April 1st of the calendar year following the later of (1)the calendar year in which the Participant attains age 70 1/2 or (ii) the calendar year in which the Participant retires, provided, however, that this clause (ii) shall not apply in the case of a Participant who is a "five (5) percent owner" at any time during the Plan Year ending with or within the calendar year in which such owner attains age 70 1/2. Such distributions shall be equal to or greater than any required distribution.

Alternatively, distributions to a Participant must begin no later than the applicable April 1st as determined under the preceding paragraph and must be made over the life of the Participant (or the lives of the Participant and the Participant's designated Beneficiary) or the life expectancy of the Participant (or the life expectancies of the Participant and the Participant's designated Beneficiary) in accordance with Regulations.

(2) Distributions to a Participant and the Participant's Beneficiaries shall only be made in accordance with the incidental death benefit requirements of Code Section 401(a)(9)(G) and the Regulations thereunder.

With respect to distributions under the Plan made on or after October 19, 2001 for calendar years beginning on or after January 1,2001, the Plan will apply the minimum distribution requirements of Code Section 401(a)(9) in accordance with the regulations under Code Section 401(a)(9) that were proposed on January 17, 2001 (the 2001 proposed Regulations), notwithstanding any provision of

56

the Plan to the contrary. If the total amount of required minimum distributions made to a Participant for 2001 prior to October 19, 2001 are equal to or greater than the amount of required minimum distributions determined under the proposed 2001 Regulations, men no additional distributions are required for such Participant for 2001 on or after such date. If the total amount of required minimum distributions made to a Participant for 2001 prior to October 19,2001 are less than the amount determined under the 2001 proposed Regulations, then the amount of required minimum distributions for 2001 on or after such date will be determined so that the total amount of required minimum distributions for 2001 is the amount determined under the 2001 proposed Regulations. This amendment shall continue in effect until the last calendar year beginning before the effective date of the final regulations under Code Section 401(a)(9) or such other date as may be published by the Internal Revenue Service.

(h) For purposes of this Section, the life expectancy of a Participant and a Participant's spouse (other than in the case of a life annuity) shall not be redetermined in accordance with Code Section 401(a)(9)(D). Life expectancy and joint and last survivor expectancy shall be computed using the return multiples in Tables V and VI of Regulation 1.72-9.

(i) Ail annuity Contracts under this Plan shall be non-transferable when distributed. Furthermore, the terms of any annuity Contract purchased and distributed to a Participant or spouse shall comply with all of the requirements of the Plan.

(j) If a distribution is made to a Participant who has not severed employment and who is not fully Vested in the Participant's Account and the Participant may increase the Vested percentage in such account, then, at any relevant time the Participant's Vested portion of the account will be equal to an amount ("X") determined by the formula:

X equals P(AB plus D) - D

For purposes of applying the formula: P is the Vested percentage at the relevant time, AB is the account balance at the relevant time, and D is the amount of distribution.

(k) Effective November 1, 2005, no Participant may elect to receive their benefit in the form of an annuity. Any Participant who elects an annuity form of benefit prior to November 1, 2005, will receive, or continue to receive, his benefit in such form of an annuity.

6.6 DISTRIBUTION OF BENEFITS UPON DEATH

(a)(l) The death benefit payable pursuant to Section 6.2 shall be paid to the Participant's Beneficiary within a reasonable time after the Participant's death by either of the following methods, as elected by the Participant (or if no election has been made prior to the Participant's death, by the Participant's Beneficiary) subject, however, to the rules specified in Section 6.6(b):

57

(i) One lump-sum payment in cash or in property allocated to the Participant's account.

(ii) Payment in monthly, quarterly, semi-annual, or annual cash installments over a period to be determined by the Participant or the Participant's Beneficiary. After periodic installments commence, the Beneficiary shall have the right to direct the Trustee to reduce the period over which such periodic installments shall be made, and the Trustee shall adjust the cash amount of such periodic installments accordingly.

(2) In the event the death benefit payable pursuant to Section 6.2 is payable in installments, then, upon the death of the Participant, the Administrator may direct the Trustee to segregate the death benefit into a separate account, and the Trustee shall invest such segregated account separately, and the funds accumulated in such account shall be used for the payment of the installments.

(b) Notwithstanding any provision in the Plan to the contrary, distributions upon the death of a Participant shall be made in accordance with the following requirements and shall otherwise comply with Code
Section 40l(a)(9) and the Regulations thereunder. If it is determined, pursuant to Regulations, that the distribution of a Participant's interest has begun and the Participant dies before the entire interest has been distributed, the remaining portion of such interest shall be distributed at least as rapidly as under the method of distribution selected pursuant to
Section 6.5 as of the date of death. If a Participant dies before receiving any distributions of the interest in the Plan or before distributions are deemed to have begun pursuant to Regulations, then the death benefit shall be distributed to the Participant's Beneficiaries by December 31st of the calendar year in which the fifth anniversary of the Participant's date of death occurs.

However, the 5-year distribution requirement of the preceding paragraph shall not apply to any portion of the deceased Participant's interest which is payable to or for the benefit of a designated Beneficiary. In such event, such portion may, at the election of the Participant (or the Participant's designated Beneficiary) be distributed over a period not extending beyond the life expectancy of such designated Beneficiary provided such distribution begins not later than December 31st of the calendar year immediately following the calendar year in which the Participant died. However, in the event the Participant's spouse (determined as of the date of the Participant's death) is the designated Beneficiary, the requirement that distributions commence within one year of a Participant's death shall not apply. In lieu thereof, distributions must commence on or before the later of: (1) December 31st of the calendar year immediately following the calendar year in which the Participant died; or
(2) December 31st of the calendar year in which the Participant would have attained age 70 1/2. If the surviving spouse dies before distributions to such spouse begin, then the 5-year distribution requirement of this Section shall apply as if the spouse was the Participant.

58

(c) For purposes of Section 6.6(b), the election by a designated Beneficiary to be excepted from the 5-year distribution requirement must be made no later than December 31st of the calendar year following the calendar year of the Participant's death. Except, however, with respect to a designated Beneficiary who is the Participant's surviving spouse, the election must be made by the earlier of: (1) December 31st of the calendar year immediately following the calendar year in which the Participant died or, if later, December 31st of the calendar year in which the Participant would have attained age 70 1/2; or (2) December 31st of the calendar year which contains the fifth anniversary of the date of the Participant's death. An election by a designated Beneficiary must be in writing (or in such other form as permitted by the Internal Revenue Service) and shall be irrevocable as of the last day of the election period stated herein. In the absence of an election by the Participant or a designated Beneficiary, the 5-year distribution requirement shall apply.

(d) For purposes of this Section, the life expectancy of a Participant and a Participant's spouse shall not be redetermined in accordance with Code Section 401(a)(9)(D). Life expectancy and joint and last survivor expectancy shall be computed using the return multiples in Tables V and VI of Regulation 1.72-9.

(e) For purposes of this Section, any amount paid to a child of the Participant will be treated as if it had been paid to the surviving spouse if the amount becomes payable to the surviving spouse when the child reaches the age of majority.

(f) Effective November 1, 2005, no Participant or Beneficiary may elect to receive their benefit in the form of an annuity. Any Participant or Beneficiary who elects an annuity form of benefit prior to November 1, 2005, will receive, or continue to receive, his benefit in such form of an annuity.

6.7 TIME OF SEGREGATION OR DISTRIBUTION

Except as limited by Sections 6.5 and 6.6, whenever the Trustee is to make a distribution or to commence a series of payments the distribution or series of payments may be made or begun on such date or as soon thereafter as is practicable. However, unless a Former Participant elects in writing to defer the receipt of benefits (such election may not result in a death benefit that is more than incidental), the payment of benefits shall begin not later than the sixtieth (60th) day after the close of the Plan Year in which the latest of the following events occurs: (a) the date on which the Participant attains the earlier of age 65 or the Normal Retirement Age specified herein; (b) the tenth
(10th) anniversary of the year in which the Participant commenced participation in the Plan; or (c) the date the Participant terminates service with the Employer.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, the failure of a Participant and, if applicable, the Participant's spouse, to consent to a distribution that is "immediately distributable" (within the meaning of Section 6.5), shall be deemed to be an election to defer the commencement of payment of any benefit sufficient to satisfy this Section.

59

6.8 DISTRIBUTION FOR MINOR OR INCOMPETENT BENEFICIARY

In the event a distribution is to be made to a minor or incompetent Beneficiary, then the Administrator may direct that such distribution be paid to the legal guardian, or if none in the case of a minor Beneficiary, to a parent of such Beneficiary or a responsible adult with whom the Beneficiary maintains residence, or to the custodian for such Beneficiary under the Uniform Gift to Minors Act or Gift to Minors Act, if such is permitted by the laws of the state in which said Beneficiary resides. Such a payment to the legal guardian, custodian or parent of a minor Beneficiary shall fully discharge the Trustee, Employer, and Plan from further liability on account thereof.

6.9 LOCATION OF PARTICIPANT OR BENEFICIARY UNKNOWN

In the event that all, or any portion, of the distribution payable to a Participant or Beneficiary hereunder shall, at the later of the Participant's attainment of age 62 or Normal Retirement Age, remain unpaid solely by reason of the inability of the Administrator, after sending a registered letter, return receipt requested, to the last known address, and after further diligent effort, to ascertain the whereabouts of such Participant or Beneficiary, the amount so distributable shall be treated as a Forfeiture pursuant to the Plan. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if the value of a Participant's Vested benefit derived from Employer and Employee contributions does not exceed $5,000, then the amount distributable may, in the sole discretion of the Administrator, either be treated as a Forfeiture, or be paid directly to an individual retirement account described in Code Section 408(a) or an individual retirement annuity described in Code Section 408(b) at the time it is determined that the whereabouts of the Participant or the Participant's Beneficiary cannot be ascertained. In the event a Participant or Beneficiary is located subsequent to the Forfeiture, such benefit shall be restored, first from Forfeitures, if any, and then from an additional Employer contribution if necessary. However, regardless of the preceding, a benefit which is lost by reason of escheat under applicable state law is not treated as a Forfeiture for purposes of this Section nor as an impermissible forfeiture under the Code.

6.10 PRE-RETIREMENT DISTRIBUTION

Unless otherwise provided, at such time as a Participant shall have attained the age of 59 1/2 years, the Administrator, at the election of the Participant who has not severed employment with the Employer, shall direct the Trustee to distribute all or a portion of the elective deferral account maintained on behalf of the Participant. In addition, a Pre-retirement distribution may be taken from a Participant's Transfer/Rollover Account at any time (see also Section 4.1 l(d)). In the event that the Administrator makes such a distribution, the Participant shall continue to be eligible to participate in the Plan on the same basis as any other Employee. Any distribution made pursuant to this Section shall be made in a manner consistent with Section 6.5, including, but not limited to, all notice and consent requirements of Code Sections 417 and 41 l(a)(l 1) and the Regulations thereunder.

Any Participant who had accrued benefits in the RPM Engineering, Inc. Group
401(k) Profit Sharing Plan (The "RPM Plan") as of December 31, 1997, shall be entitled to receive an in-service withdrawal of all or apart of the vested account balance of employer nonelective (profit sharing) contribution or matching contribution credited on his behalf to the RPM Plan as of December 31, 1997, if the Participant has completed at least five (5) Years of Service as a Participant and subsequently merged with the Plan.

60

6.11 ADVANCE DISTRIBUTION FOR HARDSHIP

(a) The Administrator, at the election of the Participant, shall direct the Trustee to distribute to any Participant in any one Plan Year up to the lesser of 100% of the Participant's Elective Account (and earnings attributable thereto up to December 31,1988) valued as of the last Valuation Date or the amount necessary to satisfy the immediate and heavy financial need of the Participant. Any distribution made pursuant to this
Section shall be deemed to be made as of the first day of the Plan Year or, if later, the Valuation Date immediately preceding the date of distribution, and the Participant's Elective Account shall be reduced accordingly. Withdrawal under this Section is deemed to be on account of an immediate and heavy financial need of the Participant only if the withdrawal is for:

(1) Medical expenses described in Code Section 213(d) incurred by the Participant, the Participant's spouse, or any of the Participant's dependents (as defined in Code Section 152) or necessary for these persons to obtain medical care as described in Code Section 213(d);

(2) The costs directly related to the purchase (excluding mortgage payments) of a principal residence for the Participant;

(3) Payment of tuition, related educational fees, and room and board expenses for the next twelve (12) months of post-secondary education for the Participant and the Participant's spouse, children, or dependents; or

(4) Payments necessary to prevent the eviction of the Participant from the Participant's principal residence or foreclosure on the mortgage on that residence.

(b) No distribution shall be made pursuant to this Section unless the Administrator, based upon the Participant's representation and such other facts as are known to the Administrator, determines that all of the following conditions are satisfied:

(1) The distribution is not in excess of the amount of the immediate and heavy financial need of the Participant. The amount of the immediate and heavy financial need may include any amounts necessary to pay any federal, state, or local income taxes or penalties reasonably anticipated to result from the distribution;

(2) The Participant has obtained all distributions, other than hardship distributions, and all nontaxable (at the time of the loan) loans currently available under all plans maintained by the Employer;

(3) The Plan, and all other plans maintained by the Employer, provide that the Participant's elective deferrals and after-tax voluntary Employee contributions will be suspended for at least twelve (12) months after

61

receipt of the hardship distribution or, the Participant, pursuant to a legally enforceable agreement, will suspend elective deferrals and after-tax voluntary Employee contributions to the Plan and all other plans maintained by the Employer for at least twelve (12) months after receipt of the hardship distribution; and

(4) The Plan, and all other plans maintained by the Employer, provide that the Participant may not make elective deferrals for the Participant's taxable year immediately following the taxable year of the hardship distribution in excess of the applicable limit under Code
Section 402(g) for such next taxable year less the amount of such Participant's elective deferrals for the taxable year of the hardship distribution.

(c) Notwithstanding the above, distributions from the Participant's Elective Account pursuant to this Section shall be limited solely to the Participant's total Deferred Compensation as of the date of distribution, reduced by the amount of any previous distributions pursuant to this
Section and Section 6.10.

(d) Any distribution made pursuant to this Section shall be made in a manner which is consistent with and satisfies the provisions of Section 6.5, including, but not limited to, all notice and consent requirements of Code Sections 417 and 41 l(a)(l 1) and the Regulations thereunder.

6.12 QUALIFIED DOMESTIC RELATIONS ORDER DISTRIBUTION

All rights and benefits, including elections, provided to a Participant in this Plan shall be subject to the rights afforded to any "alternate payee" under a "qualified domestic relations order." Furthermore, a distribution to an "alternate payee" shall be permitted if such distribution is authorized by a "qualified domestic relations order," even if the affected Participant has not separated from service and has not reached the "earliest retirement age" under the Plan. For the purposes of this Section, "alternate payee," "qualified domestic relations order" and "earliest retirement age" shall have the meaning set forth under Code Section 414(p).

6.13 DIRECT ROLLOVER

(a) Notwithstanding any provision of the Plan to the contrary that would otherwise limit a "distributee's" election under this Section, a "distributee" may elect, at the time and in the manner prescribed by the Administrator, to have any portion of an "eligible rollover distribution" that is equal to at least $500 paid directly to an "eligible retirement plan" specified by the "distributee" in a "direct rollover."

(b) For purposes of this Section the following definitions shall apply:

(1) An "eligible rollover distribution" is any distribution of all or any portion of the balance to the credit of the "distributee," except that an "eligible rollover distribution" does not include: any distribution that is one of a series of substantially equal periodic payments (not less

62

frequently than annually) made for the life (or life expectancy) of the "distributee" or the joint lives (or joint life expectancies) of the "distributee" and the "distributee's" designated beneficiary, or for a specified period often years or more; any distribution to the extent such distribution is required under Code Section 401(a)(9); the portion of any other distribution that is not includible in gross income (determined without regard to the exclusion for net unrealized appreciation with respect to employer securities); any hardship distribution described in Code Section 401(k)(2)(B)(i)(IV); and any other distribution that is reasonably expected to total less than $200 during a year.

(2) An "eligible retirement plan" is an individual retirement account described in Code Section 408(a), an individual retirement annuity described in Code Section 408 (b), an annuity plan described in Code
Section 403 (a), or a qualified trust described in Code Section 401
(a), that accepts the "distributee's" "eligible rollover distribution." However, in the case of an "eligible rollover distribution" to the surviving spouse, an "eligible retirement plan" is an individual retirement account or individual retirement annuity.

(3) A "distributee" includes an Employee or former Employee. In addition, the Employee's or former Employee's surviving spouse and the Employee's or former Employee's spouse or former spouse who is the alternate payee under a qualified domestic relations order, as defined in Code Section 414(p), are "distributees" with regard to the interest of the spouse or former spouse.

(4) A "direct rollover" is a payment by the Plan to the "eligible retirement plan" specified by the "distributee."

ARTICLE VII
AMENDMENT, TERMINATION, MERGERS AND LOANS

7.1 AMENDMENT

(a) The Employer shall have the right at any time to amend this Plan, subject to the limitations of this Section. However, any amendment which affects the rights, duties or responsibilities of the Trustee or Administrator may only be made with the Trustee's or Administrator's written consent. Any such amendment shall become effective as provided therein upon its execution. The Trustee shall not be required to execute any such amendment unless the amendment affects the duties of the Trustee hereunder.

(b) No amendment to the Plan shall be effective if it authorizes or permits any part of the Trust Fund (other than such part as is required to pay taxes and administration expenses) to be used for or diverted to any purpose other than for the exclusive benefit of the Participants or their Beneficiaries or estates; or causes any reduction in the amount credited to the account of any Participant; or

63

causes or permits any portion of the Trust Fund to revert to or become property of the Employer.

(c) Except as permitted by Regulations (including Regulation 1.411
(d)-4) or other IRS guidance, no Plan amendment or transaction having the effect of a Plan amendment (such as a merger, plan transfer or similar transaction) shall be effective if it eliminates or reduces any "Section
411 (d)(6) protected benefit" or adds or modifies conditions relating to "Section 41 l(d)(6) protected benefits" which results in a further restriction on such benefits unless such "Section 41 l(d)(6) protected benefits" are preserved with respect to benefits accrued as of the later of the adoption date or effective date of the amendment. "Section 411(d)(6) protected benefits" are benefits described in Code Section 41l(d)(6)(A)? early retirement benefits and retirement-type subsidies, and optional forms of benefit. A Plan amendment that eliminates or restricts the ability of a Participant to receive payment of the Participant's interest in the Plan under a particular optional form of benefit will be permissible if the amendment satisfies the conditions in (1) and (2) below:

(1) The amendment provides a single-sum distribution form that is otherwise identical to the optional form of benefit eliminated or restricted. For purposes of this condition (1), a single-sum distribution form is otherwise identical only if it is identical in all respects to the eliminated or restricted optional form of benefit (or would be identical except that it provides greater rights to the Participant) except with respect to the timing of payments after commencement.

(2) The amendment is not effective unless the amendment provides that the amendment shall not apply to any distribution with an Annuity Starting Date earlier than the earlier of: (i) the ninetieth (90th) day after the date the Participant receiving the distribution has been furnished a summary that reflects the amendment and that satisfies the Act requirements at 29 CFR 2520.104b-3 (relating to a summary of material modifications) or (ii) the first day of the second Plan Year following the Plan Year in which the amendment is adopted.

7.2 TERMINATION

(a) The Employer shall have the right at any time to terminate the Plan by delivering to the Trustee and Administrator written notice of such termination. Upon any full or partial termination, all amounts credited to the affected Participants' Combined Accounts shall become 100% Vested as provided in Section 6.4 and shall not thereafter be subject to forfeiture, and all unallocated amounts, including Forfeitures, shall be allocated to the accounts of all Participants in accordance with the provisions hereof.

(b) Upon the full termination of the Plan, the Employer shall direct the distribution of the assets of the Trust Fund to Participants in a manner which is consistent with and satisfies the provisions of Section
6.5. Distributions to a Participant shall be made in cash or in property allocated to the Participant's

64

account or through the purchase of irrevocable nontransferable deferred commitments from an insurer. Except as permitted by Regulations, the termination of the Plan shall not result in the reduction of "Section 41 l(d)(6) protected benefits" in accordance with Section 7.1(c).

7.3 MERGER, CONSOLIDATION OR TRANSFER OF ASSETS

This Plan may be merged or consolidated with, or its assets and/or liabilities may be transferred to any other plan and trust only if the benefits which would be received by a Participant of this Plan, in the event of a termination of the Plan immediately after such transfer, merger or consolidation, are at least equal to the benefits the Participant would have received if the Plan had terminated immediately before the transfer, merger or consolidation, and such transfer, merger or consolidation does not otherwise result in the elimination or reduction of any "Section 41 l(d)(6) protected benefits" in accordance with Section 7.1(c).

7.4 LOANS TO PARTICIPANTS

(a) The Trustee may, in the Trustee's discretion, make loans to Participants and Beneficiaries under the following circumstances: (1) loans shall be made available to all Participants and Beneficiaries on a reasonably equivalent basis; (2) loans shall not be made available to Highly Compensated Employees in an amount greater than the amount made available to other Participants and Beneficiaries; (3) loans shall bear a reasonable rate of interest; (4) loans shall be adequately secured; and (5) loans shall provide for periodic repayment over a reasonable period of time.

(b) Loans made pursuant to this Section (when added to the outstanding balance of all other loans made by the Plan to the Participant) may, in accordance with a uniform and nondiscriminatory policy established by the Administrator, be limited to the lesser of:

(1) $50,000 reduced by the excess (if any) of the highest outstanding balance of loans from the Plan to the Participant during the one year period ending on the day before the date on which such loan is made, over the outstanding balance of loans from the Plan to the Participant on the date on which such loan was made, or

(2) one-half (112) of the present value of the non-forfeitable accrued benefit of the Participant under the Plan.

For purposes of this limit, all plans of the Employer shall be considered one plan.

(c) Loans shall provide for level amortization with payments to be made not less frequently than quarterly over a period not to exceed five
(5) years. However, loans used to acquire any dwelling unit which, within a reasonable time, is to be used (determined at the time the loan is made) as a "principal residence" of the Participant shall provide for periodic repayment over a reasonable period of time that may exceed five (5) years. For this purpose, a

65

"principal residence" has the same meaning as a "principal residence" under Code Section 1034. Loan repayments may be suspended under this Plan as permitted under Code Section 414(u)(4).

(d) Any loans granted or renewed shall be made pursuant to a Participant loan program. Such loan program shall be established in writing and must include, but need not be limited to, the following:

(1) the identity of the person or positions authorized to administer the Participant loan program;

(2) a procedure for applying for loans;

(3) the basis on which loans will be approved or denied;

(4) limitations, if any, on the types and amounts of loans offered; (

5) the procedure under the program for determining a reasonable rate of interest;

(6) the types of collateral which may secure a Participant loan; and

(7) the events constituting default and the steps that will be taken to preserve Plan assets.

Such Participant loan program shall be contained in a separate written document which, when properly executed, is hereby incorporated by reference and made a part of the Plan, Furthermore, such Participant loan program may be modified or amended in writing from time to time without the necessity of amending this Section.

(e) Notwithstanding anything in this Section to the contrary, any loans made prior to the date this amendment and restatement is adopted shall be subject to the terms of the plan in effect at the time such loan was made.

ARTICLE VIII
TOP HEAVY

8.1 TOP HEAVY PLAN REQUIREMENTS

For any Top Heavy Plan Year, the Plan shall provide the special vesting requirements of Code Section 416(b) pursuant to Section 6.4 of the Plan and the special minimum allocation requirements of Code Section 416(c) pursuant to
Section 4.4 of the Plan.

8.2 DETERMINATION OF TOP HEAVY STATUS

(a) This Plan shall be a Top Heavy Plan for any Plan Year in which, as of the Determination Date, (1) the Present Value of Accrued Benefits of Key Employees and (2) the sum of the Aggregate Accounts of Key Employees under

66

this Plan and all plans of an Aggregation Group, exceeds sixty percent (60%) of the Present Value of Accrued Benefits and the Aggregate Accounts of all Key and Non-Key Employees under this Plan and all plans of an Aggregation Group.

If any Participant is a Non-Key Employee for any Plan Year, but such Participant was a Key Employee for any prior Plan Year, such Participant's Present Value of Accrued Benefit and/or Aggregate Account balance shall not be taken into account for purposes of determining whether this Plan is a Top Heavy Plan (or whether any Aggregation Group which includes this Plan is a Top Heavy Group). In addition, if a Participant or Former Participant has not performed any services for any Employer maintaining the Plan at any time during the five year period ending on the Determination Date, any accrued benefit for such Participant or Former Participant shall not be taken into account for the purposes of determining whether this Plan is a Top Heavy Plan.

(b) Aggregate Account: A Participant's Aggregate Account as of the Determination Date is the sum of:

(1) the Participant's Combined Account balance as of the most recent valuation occurring within a twelve (12) month period ending on the Determination Date.

(2) an adjustment for any contributions due as of the Determination Date. Such adjustment shall be the amount of any contributions actually made after the Valuation Date but due on or before the Determination Date, except for the first Plan Year when such adjustment shall also reflect the amount of any contributions made after the Determination Date that are allocated as of a date in that first Plan Year.

(3) any Plan distributions made within the Plan Year that includes the Determination Date or within the four (4) preceding Plan Years. However, in the case of distributions made after the Valuation Date and prior to the Determination Date, such distributions are not included as distributions for top heavy purposes to the extent that such distributions are already included in the Participant's Aggregate Account balance as of the Valuation Date, Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, all distributions, including distributions under a terminated plan which if it had not been terminated would have been required to be included in an Aggregation Group, will be counted. Further, distributions from the Plan (including the cash value of life insurance policies) of a Participant's account balance because of death shall be treated as a distribution for the purposes of this paragraph.

(4) any Employee contributions, whether voluntary or mandatory. However, amounts attributable to tax deductible qualified voluntary employee contributions shall not be considered to be a part of the Participant's Aggregate Account balance.

67

(5) with respect to unrelated rollovers and plan-to-plan transfers (ones which are both initiated by the Employee and made from a plan maintained by one employer to a plan maintained by another employer), if this Plan provides the rollovers or plan-to-plan transfers, it shall always consider such rollovers or plan-to-plan transfers as a distribution for the purposes of this Section. If this Plan is the plan accepting such rollovers or plan-to-plan transfers, it shall not consider such rollovers or plan-to-plan transfers as part of the Participant's Aggregate Account balance,

(6) with respect to related rollovers and plan-to-plan transfers (ones either not initiated by the Employee or made to a plan maintained by the same employer), if this Plan provides the rollover or plan-to-plan transfer, it shall not be counted as a distribution for purposes of this Section. If this Plan is the plan accepting such rollover or plan-to-plan transfer, it shall consider such rollover or plan-to-plan transfer as part of the Participant's Aggregate Account balance, irrespective of the date on which such rollover or plan-to-plan transfer is accepted.

(7) For the purposes of determining whether two employers are to be treated as the same employer in (5) and (6) above, all employers aggregated under Code Section 414(b), (c), (m) and (o) are treated as the same employer.

(c) "Aggregation Group" means either a Required Aggregation Group or a Permissive Aggregation Group as hereinafter determined.

(1) Required Aggregation Group: In determining a Required Aggregation Group hereunder, each plan of the Employer in which a Key Employee is a participant in the Plan Year containing the Determination Date or any of the four preceding Plan Years, and each other plan of the Employer which enables any plan in which a Key Employee participates to meet the requirements of Code Sections 401(a)(4) or 410, will be required to be aggregated. Such group shall be known as a Required Aggregation Group.

In the case of a Required Aggregation Group, each plan in the group will be considered a Top Heavy Plan if the Required Aggregation Group is a Top Heavy Group. No plan in the Required Aggregation Group will be considered a Top Heavy Plan if the Required Aggregation Group is not a Top Heavy Group.

(2) Permissive Aggregation Group: The Employer may also include any other plan not required to be included in the Required Aggregation Group, provided the resulting group, taken as a whole, would continue to satisfy the provisions of Code Sections 401(a)(4) and 410. Such group shall be known as a Permissive Aggregation Group.

In the case of a Permissive Aggregation Group, only a plan that is part of the Required Aggregation Group will be considered a Top Heavy Plan if

68

the Permissive Aggregation Group is a Top Heavy Group. No plan in the Permissive Aggregation Group will be considered a Top Heavy Plan if the Permissive Aggregation Group is not a Top Heavy Group.

(3) Only those plans of the Employer in which the Determination Dates fall within the same calendar year shall be aggregated in order to determine whether such plans are Top Heavy Plans.

(4) An Aggregation Group shall include any terminated plan of the Employer if it was maintained within the last five (5) years ending on the Determination Date.

(d) "Determination Date" means (a) the last day of the preceding Plan Year, or (b) in the case of the first Plan Year, the last day of such Plan Year.

(e) Present Value of Accrued Benefit: In the case of a defined benefit plan, the Present Value of Accrued Benefit for a Participant other than a Key Employee, shall be as determined using the single accrual method used for all plans of the Employer and Affiliated Employers, or if no such single method exists, using a method which results in benefits accruing not more rapidly than the slowest accrual rate permitted under Code Section 41 l(b)(l)(C). The determination of the Present Value of Accrued Benefit shall be determined as of the most recent Valuation Date that falls within or ends with the 12-month period ending on the Determination Date except as provided in Code Section 416 and the Regulations thereunder for the first and second plan years of a defined benefit plan.

(f) "Top Heavy Group" means an Aggregation Group in which, as of the Determination Date, the sum of:

(1) the Present Value of Accrued Benefits of Key Employees under all defined benefit plans included in the group, and

(2) the Aggregate Accounts of Key Employees under all defined contribution plans included in the group, exceeds sixty percent (60%) of a similar sum determined for all Participants.

ARTICLE IX
MISCELLANEOUS

9.1 PARTICIPANT'S RIGHTS

This Plan shall not be deemed to constitute a contract between the Employer and any Participant or to be a consideration or an inducement for the employment of any Participant or Employee. Nothing contained in this Plan shall be deemed to give any Participant or Employee the right to be retained in the service of the Employer or to interfere with the right of

69

the Employer to discharge any Participant or Employee at any time regardless of the effect which such discharge shall have upon the Employee as a Participant of this Plan.

9.2 ALIENATION

(a) Subject to the exceptions provided below, and as otherwise permitted by the Code and the Act, no benefit which shall be payable out of the Trust Fund to any person (including a Participant or the Participant's Beneficiary) shall be subject in any manner to anticipation, alienation, sale, transfer, assignment, pledge, encumbrance, or charge, and any attempt to anticipate, alienate, sell, transfer, assign, pledge, encumber, or charge the same shall be void; and no such benefit shall in any manner be liable for, or subject to, the debts, contracts, liabilities, engagements, or torts of any such person, nor shall it be subject to attachment or legal process for or against such person, and the same shall not be recognized by the Trustee, except to such extent as may be required by law.

(b) Subsection (a) shall not apply to the extent a Participant or Beneficiary is indebted to the Plan, by reason of a loan made pursuant to
Section 7.4. At the time a distribution is to be made to or for a Participant's or Beneficiary's benefit, such proportion of the amount to be distributed as shall equal such indebtedness shall be paid to the Plan, to apply against or discharge such indebtedness. Prior to making a payment, however, the Participant or Beneficiary must be given written notice by the Administrator that such indebtedness is to be so paid in whole or part from the Participant's Combined Account. If the Participant or Beneficiary does not agree that the indebtedness is a valid claim against the Vested Participant's Combined Account, the Participant or Beneficiary shall be entitled to a review of the validity of the claim in accordance with procedures provided in Sections 2.10 and 2.11.

(c) Subsection (a) shall not apply to a "qualified domestic relations order" defined in Code Section 414(p), and those other domestic relations orders permitted to be so treated by the Administrator under the provisions of the Retirement Equity Act of 1984. The Administrator shall establish a written procedure to determine the qualified status of domestic relations orders and to administer distributions under such qualified orders. Further, to the extent provided under a "qualified domestic relations order," a former spouse of a Participant shall be treated as the spouse or surviving spouse for all purposes under the Plan.

(d) Subsection (a) shall not apply to an offset to a Participant's accrued benefit against an amount that the Participant is ordered or required to pay the Plan with respect to a judgment, order, or decree issued, or a settlement entered into, on or after August 5, 1997, in accordance with Code Sections 401(a)(13)(C) and (D). In a case in which the survivor annuity requirements of Code Section 401(a)(l 1) apply with respect to distributions from the Plan to the Participant, if the Participant has a spouse at the time at which the offset is to be made:

70

(1) either such spouse has consented in writing to such offset and such consent is witnessed by a notary public or representative of the Plan (or it is established to the satisfaction of a Plan representative that such consent may not be obtained by reason of circumstances described in Code Section 417(a)(2)(B)), or an election to waive the right of the spouse to either a qualified joint and survivor annuity or a qualified pre-retirement survivor annuity is in effect in accordance with the requirements of Code Section 417(a),

(2) such spouse is ordered or required in such judgment, order, decree or settlement to pay an amount to the Plan in connection with a violation of fiduciary duties, or

(3) in such judgment, order, decree or settlement, such spouse retains the right to receive the survivor annuity under a qualified joint and survivor annuity provided pursuant to Code Section 401(a)(ll)(A)(i) and under a qualified pre-retirement survivor annuity provided pursuant to Code Section 401(a)(11)(A)(ii).

9.3 CONSTRUCTION OF PLAN

This Plan shall be construed and enforced according to the Code, the Act and the laws of the State of Texas, other than its laws respecting choice of law, to the extent not pre-empted by the Act.

9.4 GENDER AND NUMBER

Wherever any words are used herein in the masculine, feminine or neuter gender, they shall be construed as though they were also used in another gender in all cases where they would so apply, and whenever any words are used herein in the singular or plural form, they shall be construed as though they were also used in the other form in all cases where they would so apply.

9.5 LEGAL ACTION

In the event any claim, suit, or proceeding is brought regarding the Trust and/or Plan established hereunder to which the Trustee, the Employer or the Administrator may be a party, and such claim, suit, or proceeding is resolved in favor of the Trustee, the Employer or the Administrator, they shall be entitled to be reimbursed from the Trust Fund for any and all costs, attorney's fees, and other expenses pertaining thereto incurred by them for which they shall have become liable.

9.6 PROHIBITION AGAINST DIVERSION OF FUNDS

(a) Except as provided below and otherwise specifically permitted by law, it shall be impossible by operation of the Plan or of the Trust, by termination of either, by power of revocation or amendment, by the happening of any contingency, by collateral arrangement or by any other means, for any part of the corpus or income of any Trust Fund maintained pursuant to the Plan or any funds

71

contributed thereto to be used for, or diverted to, purposes other than the exclusive benefit of Participants, Former Participants, or their Beneficiaries.

(b) In the event the Employer shall make an excessive contribution under a mistake of fact pursuant to Act Section 403(c)(2)(A), the Employer may demand repayment of such excessive contribution at any time within one
(1) year following the time of payment and the Trustees shall return such amount to the Employer within the one (1) year period. Earnings of the Plan attributable to the contributions may not be returned to the Employer but any losses attributable thereto must reduce the amount so returned.

(c) Except for Sections 3.5, 3.6, and 4.1(c), any contribution by the Employer to the Trust Fund is conditioned upon the deducibility of the contribution by the Employer under the Code and, to the extent any such deduction is disallowed, the Employer may, within one (1) year following the final determination of the disallowance, whether by agreement with the Internal Revenue Service or by final decision of a competent jurisdiction, demand repayment of such disallowed contribution and the Trustee shall return such contribution within one (1) year following the disallowance. Earnings of the Plan attributable to the contribution may not be returned to the Employer, but any losses attributable thereto must reduce the amount so returned.

9.7 EMPLOYER'S AND TRUSTEE'S PROTECTIVE CLAUSE

The Employer, Administrator and Trustee, and their successors, shall not be responsible for the validity of any Contract issued hereunder or for the failure on the part of the insurer to make payments provided by any such Contract, or for the action of any person which may delay payment or render a Contract null and void or unenforceable in whole or in part.

9.8 INSURER'S PROTECTIVE CLAUSE

Except as otherwise agreed upon in writing between the Employer and the insurer, an insurer which issues any Contracts hereunder shall not have any responsibility for the validity of this Plan or for the tax or legal aspects of this Plan. The insurer shall be protected and held harmless in acting in accordance with any written direction of the Trustee, and shall have no duty to see to the application of any funds paid to the Trustee, nor be required to question any actions directed by the Trustee. Regardless of any provision of this Plan, the insurer shall not be required to take or permit any action or allow any benefit or privilege contrary to the terms of any Contract which it issues hereunder, or the rules of the insurer.

9.9 RECEIPT AND RELEASE FOR PAYMENTS

Any payment to any Participant, the Participant's legal representative, Beneficiary, or to any guardian or committee appointed for such Participant or Beneficiary in accordance with the provisions of the Plan, shall, to the extent thereof, be in full satisfaction of all claims hereunder against the Trustee and the Employer, either of whom may require such Participant, legal representative, Beneficiary, guardian or committee, as a condition precedent to such payment, to execute a receipt and release thereof in such form as shall be determined by the Trustee or Employer.

72

9.10 ACTION BY THE EMPLOYER

Whenever the Employer under the terms of the Plan is permitted or required to do or perform any act or matter or thing, it shall be done and performed by a person duly authorized by its legally constituted authority,

9.11 NAMED FIDUCIARIES AND ALLOCATION OF RESPONSIBILITY

The "named Fiduciaries" of this Plan are (1) the Employer, (2) the Administrator, and (3) any Investment Manager appointed hereunder. The named Fiduciaries shall have only those specific powers, duties, responsibilities, and obligations as are specifically given them under the Plan including, but not limited to, any agreement allocating or delegating their responsibilities, the terms of which are incorporated herein by reference. In general, the Employer shall have the sole responsibility for making the contributions provided for under Section 4.1; and shall have the authority to appoint and remove the Trustee and the Administrator; to formulate the Plan's "funding policy and method"; and to amend or terminate, in whole or in part, the Plan. The Administrator shall have the sole responsibility for the administration of the Plan, including, but not limited to, the items specified in Article II of the Plan, as the same may be allocated or delegated thereunder. The Administrator shall act as the named Fiduciary responsible for communicating with the Participant according to the Participant Direction Procedures. The Administrator shall have the sole responsibility of management of the assets held under the Trust, except with respect to those assets, the management of which has been assigned to an Investment Manager, who shall be solely responsible for the management of the assets assigned to it, or as otherwise specifically provided in the Plan and Trust Agreement. Each named Fiduciary warrants that any directions given, information furnished, or action taken by it shall be in accordance with the provisions of the Plan, authorizing or providing for such direction, information or action, Furthermore, each named Fiduciary may rely upon any such direction, information or action of another named Fiduciary as being proper under the Plan, and is not required under the Plan to inquire into the propriety of any such direction, information or action. It is intended under the Plan that each named Fiduciary shall be responsible for the proper exercise of its own powers, duties, responsibilities and obligations under the Plan as specified or allocated herein. No named Fiduciary shall guarantee the Trust Fund in any manner against investment loss or depreciation in asset value. Any person or group may serve in more than one Fiduciary capacity.

9.12 HEADINGS

The headings and subheadings of this Plan have been inserted for convenience of reference and are to be ignored in any construction of the provisions hereof.

9.13 APPROVAL BY INTERNAL REVENUE SERVICE

Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, if, pursuant to an application for qualification filed by or on behalf of the Plan by the time prescribed by law for filing the Employer's return for the taxable year in which the Plan is adopted, or such later date that the Secretary of the Treasury may prescribe, the Commissioner of Internal Revenue Service or the Commissioner's delegate should determine that the Plan does not initially qualify as a tax-exempt plan under Code Sections 401 and 501, and such determination is not contested, or if contested,

73

is finally upheld, then if the Plan is a new plan, it shall be void ab initio and all amounts contributed to the Plan by the Employer, less expenses paid, shall be returned within one (1) year and the Plan shall terminate, and the Trustee shall be discharged from all further obligations. If the disqualification relates to an amended plan, then the Plan shall operate as if it had not been amended,

9.14 UNIFORMITY

All provisions of this Plan shall be interpreted and applied in a uniform, nondiscriminatory manner. In the event of any conflict between the terms of this Plan and any Contract purchased hereunder, the Plan provisions shall control.

ARTICLE X
PARTICIPATING EMPLOYERS

10.1 ADOPTION BY OTHER EMPLOYERS

Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, with the consent of the Employer and Trustee, any other corporation or entity, whether an affiliate or subsidiary or not, may adopt this Plan and all of the provisions hereof, and participate herein and be known as a Participating Employer, by a properly executed document evidencing said intent and will of such Participating Employer.

10.2 REQUIREMENTS OF PARTICIPATING EMPLOYERS

(a) Each such Participating Employer shall be required to use the same Trustee as provided in this Plan.

(b) The Trustee may, but shall not be required to, commingle, hold and invest as one Trust Fund all contributions made by Participating Employers, as well as all increments thereof.

c) Any expenses of the Plan which are to be paid by the Employer or borne by the Trust Fund shall be paid by each Participating Employer in the same proportion that the total amount standing to the credit of all Participants employed by such Employer bears to the total standing to the credit of all Participants.

10.3 DESIGNATION OF AGENT

Each Participating Employer shall be deemed to be a party to this Plan; provided, however, that with respect to all of its relations with the Trustee and Administrator for the purpose of this Plan, each Participating Employer shall be deemed to have designated irrevocably the Employer as its agent. Unless the context of the Plan clearly indicates the contrary, the word "Employer" shall be deemed to include each Participating Employer as related to its adoption of the Plan.

74

10.4 EMPLOYEE TRANSFERS

In the event an Employee is transferred between Participating Employers, accumulated service and eligibility shall be carried with the Employee involved. No such transfer shall effect a termination of employment hereunder, and the Participating Employer to which the Employee is transferred shall thereupon become obligated hereunder with respect to such Employee in the same manner as was the Participating Employer from whom the Employee was transferred.

10.5 PARTICIPATING EMPLOYER CONTRIBUTION AND FORFEITURES

Any contribution or Forfeiture subject to allocation during each Plan Year shall be allocated only among those Participants of the Employer or Participating Employers making the contribution or by which the forfeiting Participant was employed. However, if the contribution is made, or the forfeiting Participant was employed, by an Affiliated Employer, in which event such contribution or Forfeiture shall be allocated among all Participants of all Participating Employers who are Affiliated Employers in accordance with the provisions of this Plan. On the basis of the information furnished by the Administrator, the Trustee may keep separate books and records concerning the affairs of each Participating Employer hereunder and as to the accounts and credits of the Employees of each Participating Employer. The Trustee may, but need not, register Contracts so as to evidence that a particular Participating Employer is the interested Employer hereunder, but in the event of an Employee transfer from one Participating Employer to another, the employing Participating Employer shall immediately notify the Trustee thereof.

10.6 AMENDMENT

Amendment of this Plan by the Employer at any time when there shall be a Participating Employer hereunder shall only be by the written action of the Employer.

10.7 DISCONTINUANCE OF PARTICIPATION

Any Participating Employer shall be permitted to discontinue or revoke its participation in the Plan at any time. At the time of any such discontinuance or revocation, satisfactory evidence thereof and of any applicable conditions imposed shall be delivered to the Trustee. The Trustee shall thereafter transfer, deliver and assign Contracts and other Trust Fund assets allocable to the Participants of such Participating Employer to such new trustee as shall have been designated by such Participating Employer, in the event that it has established a separate qualified retirement plan for its employees provided, however, that no such transfer shall be made if the result is the elimination or reduction of any "Section 411 (d)(6) protected benefits" as described in Section
7.1(c). If no successor is designated, the Trustee shall retain such assets for the Employees of said Participating Employer pursuant to the provisions of the Trust. In no such event shall any part of the corpus or income of the Trust Fund as it relates to such Participating Employer be used for or diverted for purposes other than for the exclusive benefit of the Employees of such Participating Employer.

75

10.8 ADMINISTRATOR'S AUTHORITY

The Administrator shall have authority to make any and all necessary rules or regulations, binding upon all Participating Employers and all Participants, to effectuate the purpose of this Article.

76

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, this Plan has been executed on the day and year written below.

-------------------------------------             ENGlobal Engineering, Inc.
DATE

                                                  ------------------------------
                                                  EMPLOYER

77

SUPPLEMENTAL PARTICIPATION AGREEMENT

A Participation Agreement made and entered into this 24 day of October , 2005______________________, between EN Global Construction Resources, Inc. (hereinafter referred to as the "Participating Employer"), ENGlobal Engineering, Inc. (hereinafter referred to as the "Employer"), and The Charles Schwab Trust Company (hereinafter referred to as the "Trustees").

WHEREAS, the Participating Employer desires to reward its employees for faithful service, to establish a bond between employer and employee, to provide an incentive for efficient and conscientious work, to provide a fund for retirement, disability, or death, and to retain high-calibre fellow employees; and

WHEREAS, there exists a Profit Sharing Plan entered into on the 24 day of October, 2005 namely the ENGlobal 401(k) Plan, called the "Plan"; and

WHEREAS, Plan Section 10,1 provides that any other Participating Employer may, with the consent of the Employer, adopt the Plan and participate therein by a properly executed document evidencing said intent of said Participating Employer;

NOW, THEREFORE, the Participating Employer hereby becomes a party to the Plan, effective the 2*^ day of 0cf^6>f<! 2-o-osr_______________________, and the Employer and the Trustees hereby consent to such adoption and participation upon the following terms:

(1) Wherever a right or obligation is imposed upon the Employer by the terms of the Plan, the same shall extend to the Participating Employer as the "Employer" under the Plan and shall be separate and distinct from that imposed upon the Employer. It is the intention of the parties that the Participating Employer shall be a party to the Plan and treated in all respects as the Employer thereunder, with its employees to be considered as the Employees or Participants, as the case may be, thereunder. However, the participation of the Participating Employer in the Plan shall in no way diminish, augment, modify, or in any way affect the rights and duties of the Employer, its Employees, or Participants, under the Plan.

(2) The Trustees hereby agree to receive and allocate contributions made to the Plan by the Employer and by the Participating Employer, as well as to do and perform all acts that are necessary to keep records and accounts of all funds held for Participants who are Employees of the respective employers.

(3) The execution of this Agreement by this Participating Employer shall be construed as the adoption of the Plan in every respect as if said Plan had this date been executed between the Participating Employer and the Trustees, except as otherwise expressly provided herein or in any amendment that may subsequently be adopted hereto.

(4) All actions required by the Plan to be taken by the Employer shall be effective with respect to the Participating Employer if taken by the Employer and pursuant to Plan Section 10.3, the Participating Employer hereby irrevocably designates the Employer as its agent for such purposes. This shall include the (1) ability to amend the Plan or any other Plan document, in accordance with Plan Section 10.6.


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Participating Employer, the Employer and the Trustees have caused this Supplemental Participation Agreement to be executed in their respective names on the day and date first above written.

ENGlobal Construction Resources, Inc.


PARTICIPATING EMPLOYER

EMPEOYER ENGlobal Engineering, Inc.

By
EMPLOYER

The Charles Schwab Trust Company


TRUSTEE

ENGLOBAL 401(K) PLAN

FUNDING POLICY AND METHOD

A pension benefit plan (as defined in the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974) has been adopted by the company for the purpose of rewarding long and loyal service to the company by providing to employees additional financial security at retirement. Incidental benefits are provided in the case of disability, death or other termination of employment.

Since the principal purpose of the plan is to provide benefits at normal retirement age, the principal goal of the investment of the funds in the plan should be both security and long-term stability with moderate growth commensurate with the anticipated retirement dates of participants. Investments, other than "fixed dollar" investments, should be included among the plan's investments to prevent erosion by inflation. However, investments should be sufficiently liquid to enable the plan, on short notice, to make some distributions in the event of the death or disability of a participant.


SUPPLEMENTAL PARTICIPATION AGREEMENT

A Participation Agreement made and entered into this 24 day of October, 2005 between ENGlobal Systems, Inc. (hereinafter referred to as the "Participating Employer"), ENGlobal Engineering, Inc. (hereinafter referred to as the "Employer") and The Charles Schwab Trust Company (hereinafter referred to as the "Trustees").

WHEREAS, the Participating Employer desires to reward its employees for faithful service, to establish a bond between employer and employee, to provide an incentive for efficient and conscientious work, to provide a fund for retirement, disability, or death, and to retain high-calibre fellow employees; and

WHEREAS, there exists a Profit Sharing Plan entered into on the 24 day of October, 2005____namely the ENGlobal 401 (k) Plan, called the "Plan"; and

WHEREAS, Plan Section 10.1 provides that any other Participating Employer may, with the consent of the Employer, adopt the Plan and participate therein by a properly executed document evidencing said intent of said Participating Employer;

NOW, THEREFORE, the Participating Employer hereby becomes a party to the Plan, effective the .24th day of October, 2005__________________________, and the Employer and the Trustees hereby consent to such adoption and participation upon the following terms:

(1) Wherever a right or obligation is imposed upon the Employer by the terms of the Plan, the same shall extend to the Participating Employer as the "Employer" under the Plan and shall be separate and distinct from that imposed upon the Employer. It is the intention of the parties that the Participating Employer shall be a party to the Plan and treated in all respects as the Employer thereunder, with its employees to be considered as the Employees or Participants, as the case may be, thereunder. However, the participation of the Participating Employer in the Plan shall in no way diminish, augment, modify, or in any way affect the rights and duties of the Employer, its Employees, or Participants, under the Plan.

(2) The Trustees hereby agree to receive and allocate contributions made to the Plan by the Employer and by the Participating Employer, as well as to do and perform all acts that are necessary to keep records and accounts of all funds held for Participants who are Employees of the respective employers.

(3) The execution of this Agreement by this Participating Employer shall be construed as the adoption of the Plan in every respect as if said Plan had this date been executed between the Participating Employer and the Trustees, except as otherwise expressly provided herein or in any amendment that may subsequently be adopted hereto.

(4) All actions required by the Plan to be taken by the Employer shall be effective with respect to the Participating Employer if taken by the Employer and pursuant to Plan Section 10.3, the Participating Employer hereby irrevocably designates the Employer as its agent for such purposes. This shall include the (1) ability to amend the Plan or any other P!an document, in accordance with Plan Section 10.6.


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Participating Employer, the Employer and the Trustees have caused this Supplemental Participation Agreement to be executed in their respective names on the day and date first above written,

ENGlobal Systems, Inc.

PARTICIPATING

EMPLOYER ENGlobal Engineering, Inc.
EMPLOYER

The Charles Schwab Trust Company

By
TRUSTEE

ENGLOBAL 401(K) PLAN

FUNDING POLICY AND METHOD

A pension benefit plan (as defined in the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974) has been adopted by the company for the purpose of rewarding long and loyal service to the company by providing to employees additional financial security at retirement. Incidental benefits are provided in the case of disability, death or other termination of employment.

Since the principal purpose of the plan is to provide benefits at normal retirement age, the principal goal of the investment of the funds in the plan should be both security and long-term stability with moderate growth commensurate with the anticipated retirement dates of participants. Investments, other than "fixed dollar" investments, should be included among the plan's investments to prevent erosion by inflation. However, investments should be sufficiently liquid to enable the plan, on short notice, to make some distributions in the event of the death or disability of a participant.


Exhibit 10.23

SECOND AMENDMENT TO THE ENGLOBAL 401(K) PLAN

WHEREAS, ENGlobal Engineering, Inc. {the "Employer") adopted a restatement of the ENGlobal 40l(k) Plan (the "Plan"), effective as of October 1, 2005, and various subsequent amendments; and

WHEREAS, the employer has (he ability to amend the Plan pursuant to Section 7,1; and WHEREAS, the Employer now desires to amend the Plan to update the matching formulas,

NOW. THEREFORE. the Employer hereby amends the Plan in the following respects, effective as of April 1, 2006:

1. Article 4.1 (b) is amended to read as follows:

(b){i) For Participants who are classified on the payroll records of the Employer as "regular employees," 50% of elective deferrals up to the first 0% of Compensation; and (ii) for all other Participants, 33.3% of elective deferrals up to the first 6% of Compensation. In other words, we are no longer referring to contract or project employees, and the match for the first group would be a maximum of 3% of pay, and for the second group, a maximum of 2% of pay.

2. In all other respects, the terms of this Plan are hereby ratified and confirmed.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Employer has caused this Second Amendment, to he executed I counterparts. each of which shall be considered as an original, as of the date indicated be

ENGL0BAL ENGINEERING, INC,

Witness: //s//  Natalie S. Hairston        Signature  //s//  William A. Coskey
                                           Title: CEO
                                           Date: March 29, 2006


Exhibit ???

THIRD AMENDMENT TO
THE ENGLOBAL 401 (K)
PLAN

WHEREAS, ENGlobal Engineering, Inc. (the "Employer") adopted a restatement of the ENGlobal 401(k) Plan (the "Plan"), effective as of October 1, 2005, and various subsequent amendments; WHEREAS, the Employer has the ability to amend the Plan pursuant to Section 7.1; and WHEREAS, the Employer now desires to amend the Plan to include service with WRC Corporation;

NOW, THEREFORE, the Employer hereby amends the Plan in the following respects, effective as of July 1, 2006

1. The following shall be added to Section 1.50: Periods of Service with WRC Corporation shall be recognized.

2. The following shall be added to Section 1.67: Years of Service with WRC Corporation shall be recognized. 3

In all other respects, the terms of this Plan are hereby ratified and confirmed.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Employer has caused this Third Amendment to be executed in duplicate counterparts, each of which shall be considered as an original, as of the date indicated below.

ENGLOBAL ENGINEERING, INC.

//s// William A. Coskey, CEO


Date:  October 16, 2006


Witness: //s// Jean Whitaker


EXHIBIT 10.25

ENGLOBAL 401(K) PLAN

FINAL 401(k)/4Gl(m) REGULATIONS AMENDMENT

FINAL 401(k)/401(m) REGULATIONS AMENDMENT

ARTICLE I
PREAMBLE

I.I  Adoption and effective date of amendment. The sponsor adopts this Amendment
     to the Plan to reflect certain provisions of the Final Regulations under
     Code Sections 401(k) and 401(m) that were published on December 29, 2004
     (hereinafter referred to as the "Final 401(k) Regulations"). The sponsor
     intends this Amendment as good faith compliance with the requirements of
     these provisions. This Amendment shall be effective with respect to Plan
     Years beginning after December 31, 2005.

1-2  Supersession of inconsistent provisions. This Amendment shall supersede the
     provisions of the Plan to the extent those provisions are inconsistent with
     the provisions of this Amendment.

1.3  Application of provisions. Certain provisions of this Amendment relate to
     elective deferrals of a 401(k) plan; if the Plan to which this Amendment
     relates is not a 401(k) plan, then those provisions of this Amendment do
     not apply. Certain provisions of this Amendment relate to matching
     contributions and /or after-tax employee contributions subject to Code
     Section 401 (m); if the Plan to which this Amendment relates is not subject
     to Code Section 401(m), then those provisions of this Amendment do not
     apply.

                                   ARTICLE II
                               EMPLOYER ELECTIONS

2.1  Effective Date. This Amendment is effective, and the Plan shall implement
     the provisions of the Final 401 (k) Regulations, with respect to Plan Years
     beginning after December 31, 2005.

2.2  ACP Test Safe Harbor. Unless otherwise selected below, if this Plan uses
     the ADP Test Safe Harbor provisions, then the provisions of Amendment
     Section 9.2(a) apply and all matching contributions under the Plan will be
     applied without regard to any allocation conditions except as provided in
     that Section.

     a.   [ ] The provisions of Amendment Section 9.2(b) apply. The allocation
          conditions applicable to matching contributions under the Plan
          continue to apply (if selected, the Plan is not an ACP Test Safe
          Harbor Plan).

     b.   [X ]The provisions of Amendment Section 9.2(c) apply. All matching
          contributions under the Plan will be applied without regard to any
          allocation conditions as of the effective date of this Amendment.

                                   ARTICLE III
                                  GENERAL RULES

3.1  Deferral elections. A cash or deferred arrangement ("CODA") is an
     arrangement under which eligible Employees may make elective deferral
     elections. Such elections cannot relate to compensation that is currently
     available prior to the adoption or effective date of the CODA. In addition,
     except for occasional, bona fide administrative considerations,
     contributions made pursuant to such an election cannot precede the earlier
     of (1) the performance of services relating to the contribution and (2)
     when the compensation that is subject to the election would be currently
     available to the Employee in the absence of an election to defer.

3.2  Vesting provisions. Elective Contributions are always fully vested and
     nonforfeitable. The Plan shall disregard Elective Contributions in applying
     the vesting provisions of the Plan to other contributions or benefits under
     Code Section 41 l(a)(2). However, the Plan shall otherwise take a
     participant's Elective Contributions into account in determining the
     Participant's vested benefits under the Plan. Thus, for example, the Plan
     shall take Elective Contributions into account in determining whether a
     Participant has a nonforfeitable right to contributions under the Plan for
     purposes of forfeitures, and for applying provisions permitting the
     repayment of distributions to have forfeited amounts restored, and the
     provisions of Code Sections 410(a)(5)(D)(iii) and 411(a)(6)(D)(iii)
     permitting a plan to disregard certain service completed prior to
     breaks-in- service (sometimes referred to as "the rule of parity").

                                   ARTICLE IV
                             HARDSHIP DISTRIBUTIONS

4.1  Applicability. The provisions of this Article IV apply if the Plan provides
     for hardship distributions upon satisfaction of the deemed immediate and
     heavy financial need standards set forth in Regulation Section
     1.401(k)-l(d)(2)(iv)(A) as in effect prior to the issuance of the Final
     40l(k) Regulations.

4.2  Hardship events. A distribution under the Plan is hereby deemed to be on
     account of an immediate and heavy financial need of an Employee if the
     distribution is for one of the following or any other item permitted under
     Regulation Section L401(k)-l{d)(3)(iii)(B):

     (a)  Expenses for (or necessary to obtain) medical care that would be
          deductible under Code Section 213(d) (determined without regard to
          whether the expenses exceed 7.5% of adjusted gross income);

     (b)  Costs directly related to the purchase of a principal residence for
          the Employee (excluding mortgage payments);

     (c)  Payment of tuition, related educational fees, and room and board
          expenses, for up to the ......... next twelve (12) months of
          post-secondary education for the Employee, the Employee's spouse,
          children, or dependents (as defined in Code Section 152, and, for
          taxable years beginning on or after January 1, 2005, without regard to
          Code Section 152(b)(l), (b)(2), and(d)(l)(B));

     (d)  Payments necessary to prevent the eviction of the Employee from the
          Employee's principal residence or foreclosure on the mortgage on that
          residence;

     (e)  Payments for burial or funeral expenses for the Employee's deceased
          parent, spouse, children or dependents (as defined in Code Section
          152, and, for taxable years beginning on or after January 1, 2005,
          without regard to Code Section 152(d)(l)(B)); or

     (f)  Expenses for the repair of damage to the Employee's principal
          residence that would qualify for the casualty deduction under Code
          Section 165 (determined without regard to whether the loss exceeds 10%
          of adjusted gross income).

4.3  Reduction of Code Section 402(g) limit following, hardship distribution. If
     the Plan provides for hardship distributions upon satisfaction of the safe
     harbor standards set forth in Regulation Sections 1.401(k)-l(d)(3)(iii)(B)
     (deemed immediate and heavy financial need) and 1.401(k)-l(d)(3)(iv)(E)
     (deemed necessary to satisfy immediate need), then there shall be no
     reduction in the maximum amount of elective deferrals that a Participant
     may make pursuant to Code Section 402(g) solely because of a hardship
     distribution made by this Plan or any other plan of the Employer.

ARTICLE V ACTUAL DEFERRAL PERCENTAGE (ADP) TEST

5.1 Targeted contribution limit. Qualified Nonelective Contributions (as defined in Regulation Section l, 401(k)-6) cannot be taken into account in determining the Actual Deferral Ratio (ADR) for a Plan Year for a Non-Highly Compensated Employee (NHCE) to the extent such contributions exceed the product of that NHCE's Code Section 414(s) compensation and the greater of five percent (5%) or two (2) times the Plan's "representative contribution rate." Any Qualified Nonelective Contribution taken into account under an Actual Contribution Percentage (ACP) test under Regulation
Section 1.401(m)-2(a)(6) (including the determination of the representative contribution rate for purposes of Regulation Section i .401(m)-2(a)(6)(v)(B)), is not permitted to be taken into account for purposes of this Section (including the determination of the "representative contribution rate" under this Section). For purposes of this Section:

(a) The Plan's "representative contribution rate" is the lowest "applicable contribution rate" of any eligible NHCE among a group of eligible NHCEs that consists of half of all eligible NHCEs for the Plan Year (or, if greater, the lowest "applicable contribution rate" of any eligible NHCE who is in the group of all eligible NHCEs for the Plan Year and who is employed by the Employer on the last day of the Plan Year), and

(b) The "applicable contribution rate" for an eligible NHCE is the sum of the Qualified Matching Contributions (as defined in Regulation Section 1.401(k)-6) taken into account in determining the ADR for the eligible NHCE for the Plan Year and the Qualified (a) Nonelective Contributions made for the eligible NHCE for the Plan Year, divided by the eligible NHCE's Code Section 414(s) compensation for the same period.


Notwithstanding the above, Qualified Nonelective Contributions that are made in connection with an Employer's obligation to pay prevailing wages under the Davis-Bacon Act (46 Stat. 1494), Public Law 71-798, Service Contract Act of 1965 (79 Stat. 1965), Public Law 89-286, or similar legislation can be taken into account for a Plan Year for an NHCE to the extent such contributions do not exceed 10 percent (10%) of that NHCE's Code Section 414(s) compensation.

Qualified Matching Contributions may only be used to calculate an ADR to the extent that such Qualified Matching Contributions are matching contributions that are not precluded from being taken into account under the ACP test for the Plan Year under the rules of Regulation Section 1.401(m)-2(a)(5)(ii) and as set forth in Section 7.1.

5.2 Limitation on QNECs and QMACs. Qualified Nonelective Contributions and Qualified Matching Contributions cannot be taken into account to determine an ADR to the extent such contributions are taken into account for purposes of satisfying any other ADP test, any ACP test, or the requirements of Regulation Section 1.401(k)-3, 1.401(m)-3, or 1.401(k)-4. Thus, for example, matching contributions that are made pursuant to Regulation
Section 1.401(k)-3(c) cannot be taken into account under the ADP test. Similarly, if a plan switches from the current year testing method to the prior year testing method pursuant to Regulation Section 1.401(k)-2(c), Qualified Nonelective Contributions that are taken into account under the current year testing method for a year may not be taken into account under the prior year testing method for the next year,

5.3 ADR of HCE if multiple plans. The Actual Deferral Ratio (ADR) of any Participant who is a Highly Compensated Employee (HCE) for the Plan Year and who is eligible to have Elective Contributions (as defined in Regulation Section 1.401(k)-6) (and Qualified Nonelective- Contributions and/or Qualified Matching Contributions, if treated as Elective Contributions for purposes of the ADP test) allocated to such Participant's accounts under two (2) or more cash or deferred arrangements described in Code Section 401 (k), that are maintained by the same Employer, shall be determined as if such Elective Contributions (and, if applicable, such Qualified Nonelective Contributions and/or Qualified Matching Contributions) were made under a single arrangement. If an HCE participates in two or more cash or deferred arrangements of the Employer that have different Plan Years, then alt Elective Contributions made during the Plan Year being tested under all such cash or deferred arrangements shall be aggregated, without regard to the plan years of the other plans. However, for Plan Years beginning before the effective date of this Amendment, if the plans have different Plan Years, then all such cash or deferred arrangements ending with or within the same calendar year shall be treated as a single cash or deferred arrangement. Notwithstanding the foregoing, certain plans shall be treated as separate if mandatorily disaggregated under the Regulations of Code Section 401(k).

5.4 Plans using different testing methods for the ADP and ACP test. Except as otherwise provided in this Section, the Plan may use the current year testing method or prior year testing method for the ADP test for a Plan Year without regard to whether the current year testing method or prior year testing method is used for the ACP test for that Plan Year. However, if different testing methods are used, then the Plan cannot use:

(a) The recharacterization method of Regulation Section l,401(k)-2(b)(3) to correct excess contributions for a Plan Year;

(b) The rules of Regulation Section 1.401(m)-2(a)(6)(ii) to take Elective Contributions into account under the ACP test (rather than the ADP test); or

(c) The rules of Regulation Section 1.401(k)-2(a)(6)(v) to take Qualified Matching Contributions into account under the ADP test (rather than the ACP test).


ARTICLE VI
ADJUSTMENT TO ADP TEST

6.1 Distribution of Income attributable to Excess Contributions. Distributions of Excess Contributions must be adjusted for income (gain or loss), including an adjustment for income for the period between the end of the Plan Year and the date of the distribution (the "gap period"). The Administrator has the discretion to determine and allocate income using any of the methods set forth below:

(a) Reasonable, method of allocating income. The Administrator may use any reasonable method for computing the income allocable to Excess Contributions, provided that the method does not violate Code Section
403(a)(4), is used consistently for all Participants and for all corrective distributions under the Plan for the Plan Year, and is used by the Plan for allocating income to Participant's accounts. A Plan will not fail to use a reasonable method for computing the income allocable to Excess Contributions merely because the income allocable to Excess Contributions is determined on a date that is no more than seven (7) days before the distribution.

(b) Alternative method of allocating income. The Administrator may allocate income to Excess Contributions for the Plan Year by multiplying the income for the Plan Year allocable to the Elective Contributions and other amounts taken into account under the ADP test (including contributions made for the Plan Year), by a fraction, the numerator of which is the Excess Contributions for the Employee for the Plan Year, and the denominator of which is the sum of the:

(1) Account balance attributable to Elective Contributions and other amounts taken into account under the ADP test as of the beginning of the Plan Year, and

(2) Any additional amount of such contributions made for the Plan Year.

(c) Safe harbor method of allocating gap period income. The Administrator may use the safe harbor method in this paragraph to determine income on Excess Contributions for the gap period. Under this safe harbor method, income on Excess Contributions for the gap period is equal to ten percent (10%) of the income allocable to Excess Contributions for the Plan Year that would be determined under paragraph (b) above, multiplied by the number of calendar months that have elapsed since the end of the Plan Year. For purposes of calculating the number of calendar months that have elapsed under the safe harbor method, a corrective distribution that is made on or before the fifteenth (15th) day of a month is treated as made on the last day of the preceding month and a distribution made after the fifteenth day of a month is treated as made on the last day of the month.

(d) Alternative method for allocating Plan, Year and gap period income. The Administrator may determine the income for the aggregate of the Plan Year and the gap period, by applying the alternative method provided by paragraph (b) above to this aggregate period. This is accomplished by (1) substituting the income for the Plan Year and the gap period, for the income for the Plan Year, and (2) substituting the amounts taken into account under the ADP test for the Plan Year and the gap period, for the amounts taken into account under the ADP test for the Plan Year in determining the fraction that is multiplied by that income.

6.2 Corrective contributions. If a failed ADP test is to be corrected by making an Employer contribution, then the provisions of the Plan for the corrective contributions shall be applied by limiting the contribution made on behalf of any NHCE pursuant to such provisions to an amount that does not exceed the targeted contribution limits of Section 5.1 of this Amendment, or in the case of a corrective contribution that is a Qualified Matching Contribution, the targeted contribution limit of Section 7.1 of this Amendment.


ARTICLE VII

ACTUAL CONTRIBUTION PERCENTAGE (ACP0 TEST

7.1 Targeted matching contribution limit. A matching contribution with respect to an Elective. Contribution for a Plan Year is not taken into account under the Actual Contribution Percentage

(ACP) test for an NHCE to the extent it exceeds the greatest of:

(a) five percent (5%) of the NHCE's Code Section 414(s) compensation for the Plan Year;

(b) the NHCE's Elective Contributions for the Plan Year; and

(c) the product of two (2) times the Plan's "representative matching rate" and the NHCE's Elective Contributions for the Plan Year.

For purposes of this Section, the Plan's "representative matching rate" is the lowest "matching rate" for any eligible NHCE among a group of NHCEs that consists of half of all eligible NHCEs in the Plan for the Plan Year who make Elective Contributions for the Plan Year (or, if greater, the lowest "matching rate" for all eligible NHCEs in the Plan who are employed by the Employer on the last day of the Plan Year and who make Elective Contributions for the Plan Year).

For purposes of this Section, the "matching rate" for an Employee generally is the matching contributions made for such Employee divided by the Employee's Elective Contributions for the Plan Year. If the matching rate is not the same for all levels of Elective Contributions for an Employee, then the Employee's "matching rate" is determined assuming that an Employee's Elective Contributions are equal to six percent (6%) of Code
Section 414(s) compensation.

If the Plan provides a match with respect to the sum of the Employee's after-tax Employee contributions and Elective Contributions, then for purposes of this Section, that sum is substituted for the amount of the Employee's Elective Contributions in subsections (b) & (c) above and in determining the "matching rate," and Employees who make either after-tax Employee contributions or Elective Contributions are taken into account in determining the Plan's "representative matching rate." Similarly, if the Plan provides a match with respect to the Employee's after-tax Employee contributions, but not Elective Contributions, then for purposes of this subsection, the Employee's after-tax Employee contributions are substituted for the amount of the Employee's Elective Contributions in subsections (b) & (c) above and in determining the "matching rate," and Employees who make after-tax Employee contributions are taken into account in determining the Plan's "representative matching rate."

7.2 Targeted QNEC limit. Qualified Nonelective Contributions (as defined in Regulation Section 1.401(k)-6) cannot be taken into account under the Actual Contribution Percentage (ACP) test for a Plan Year for an NHCE to the extent such contributions exceed the product of that NHCE's Code
Section 414(s) compensation and the greater of five percent (5%) or two (2) times the Plan's "representative contribution rate." Any Qualified Nonelective Contribution taken into account under an Actual Deferral Percentage (ADP) test under Regulation Section 1.401(k)-2(a)(6) (including the determination of the "representative contribution rate" for purposes of Regulation Section 1.401(k)-2(a)(6)(iv)(B)) is not permitted to be taken into account for purposes of this Section (including the determination of the "representative contribution rate" for purposes of subsection (a) below). For purposes of this Section:

(a) The Plan's "representative contribution rate" is the lowest "applicable contribution rate" of any eligible NHCE among a group of eligible NHCEs that consists of half of all eligible NHCEs for the Plan Year (or, if greater, the lowest "applicable contribution rate" of any eligible NHCE who is in the group of all eligible NHCEs for the Plan Year and who is employed by the Employer on the last day of the Plan Year), and


(b) The "applicable contribution rate" for an eligible NHCE is the sum of the matching contributions (as defined in Regulation Section 1.401(m)-l(a)(2)) taken into account in determining the ACR for the eligible NHCE for the Plan Year and the Qualified Nonelective Contributions made for that NHCE for the Plan Year, divided by that NHCE's Code Section 414(s) compensation for the Plan Year.

Notwithstanding the above, Qualified Nonelective Contributions that are made in connection with an Employer's obligation to pay prevailing wages under the David-Bacon Act (46 Stat. 1494). Public Law 71-798, Service Contract Act of 1965 (79 Stat. 1965), Public Law 89-286, or similar legislation can be taken into account for a Plan Year for an NHCE to the extent such contributions do not exceed 10 Percent (10%) of that NHCE's Code Section 414(s) Compensation.

7-3 ACR of HCE if multiple plans. The Actual Contribution Ratio (ACR) for any Participant who is a Highly Compensated Employee (HCE) and who is eligible to have matching contributions or after-tax Employee contributions allocated to his or her account under two (2) or more plans described in Code Section 401 (a), or arrangements described in Code Section 401(k) that are maintained by the same Employer, shall be determined as if the total of such contributions was made under each plan and arrangement. If an HCE participates in two (2) or more such plans or arrangements that have different plan years, then all matching contributions and after-tax Employee contributions made during the Plan Year being tested under all such plans and arrangements shall be aggregated, without regard to the plan years of the other plans. For plan years beginning before the effective date of this Amendment, all such plans and arrangements ending with or within the same calendar year shall be treated as a single plan or arrangement. Notwithstanding the foregoing, certain plans shall be treated as separate if mandatorily disaggregated under the Regulations of Code
Section 401(m).

7.4 Plans using different testing methods for the ACP and ADP test. Except as otherwise provided in this Section, the Plan may use the current year testing method or prior year testing method for the ACP test for a Plan Year without regard to whether the current year testing method or prior year testing method is used for the ADP test for that Plan Year. However, if different testing methods are used, then the Plan cannot use:

(a) The recharacterization method of Regulation Section 1.401 (k)-2(b)(3) to correct excess contributions for a Plan Year;

(b) The rules of Regulation Section 1.401(m)-2(a)(6)(ii) to take Elective Contributions into account under the ACP test (rather than the ADP test); or

(c) The rules of Regulation Section l,401(k)-2(a)(6) to take Qualified Matching Contributions into account under the ADP test (rather than the ACP test).

ARTICLE VIII ADJUSTMENT TO ACP TEST

8.1 Distribution of Income attributable to Excess Aggregate Contributions. Distributions of Excess Aggregate Contributions must be adjusted for income (gain or loss), including an adjustment for income for the period between the end of the Plan Year and the date of the distribution (the "gap period"). For the purpose of this Section, "income" shall be determined and allocated in accordance with the provisions of Section 6.1 of this Amendment, except that such Section shall be applied by substituting "Excess Contributions" with "Excess Aggregate Contributions" and by substituting amounts taken into account under the ACP test for amounts taken into account under the ADP test


8.2 Corrective contributions. If a failed ACP test is to be corrected by making an Employer contribution, then the provisions of the Plan for the corrective contributions shall be applied by limiting the contribution made on behalf of any NHCE pursuant to such provisions to an amount that does not exceed the targeted contribution limits of Sections 7.1 and 7.2 of this Amendment.

ARTICLE IX SAFE HARBOR PLAN PROVISIONS

9.1 Applicability. The provisions of this Article IX apply if the Plan uses the alternative method of satisfying the Actual Deferral Percentage (ADP) test set forth in Code Section 401(k)(12) (ADP Test Safe Harbor) and/or the Actual Contribution Percentage (ACP) test set forth in Code Section 401
(m)(l 1) (ACP Test Safe Harbor).

9.2 Elimination of conditions on matching contributions. Unless otherwise provided in Section 2.2 of this Amendment, the provisions of subsection (a) below shall apply. However, if the Employer so elects in Section 2.2 of this Amendment, then the provisions of subsection (b) or (c) below shall apply.

(a) Default provision. If, prior to the date this Amendment has been executed, an ADP Test Safe Harbor notice has been given for a Plan Year for which this Amendment is effective (see Amendment Section 1.1) and such notice provides that there are no allocation conditions imposed on any matching contributions under the Plan, then (1) the Plan will be an ACP Test Safe Harbor plan, provided the ACP Test Safe Harbor requirements are met and (2) the Plan will not impose any allocation conditions on matching contributions. However, if, prior to the date this Amendment has been executed, an ADP Test Safe Harbor notice has been given for a Plan Year for which this Amendment is effective and such notice provides that there are allocation conditions imposed on any matching contributions under the Plan, then the provisions of this Amendment do not modify any such allocation conditions or provisions for that Plan Year and the Plan must satisfy the ACP Test for such Plan Year using the current year testing method. With respect to any Plan Year beginning after the date this Amendment has been executed, if the Plan uses the ADP Test Safe Harbor and provides for matching contributions, then (1) the Plan will be an ACP Test Safe Harbor plan, provided the ACP Test Safe Harbor requirements are met and (2) the Plan will not impose any allocation conditions on matching contributions.

(b) Retention of allocation conditions. If the Employer so elects in
Section 2.2 of this Amendment, then the Plan will retain any allocation conditions contained in the Plan with regard to matching contributions for any Plan Year for which this Amendment is effective. In that case, the Plan must satisfy the ACP Test for each such Plan Year.

(c) Elimination of allocation conditions. If the Employer so elects in
Section 2.2 of this Amendment, then (1) the Plan will be an ACP Test Safe Harbor plan, provided the ACP Test Safe Harbor requirements are met, and (2) the Plan will not impose any allocation conditions on matching contributions.

9.3 Matching Catch-up contributions. If the Plan provides for ADP Test Safe Harbor matching contributions or ACP Test Safe Harbor matching contributions, then catch-up contributions (as defined in Code Section
414(v)) will be taken into account in applying such matching contributions under the Plan.

9.4 Plan Year requirement. Except as provided in Regulation Sections 1.401(k)-3(e) and 1.401 (k)- 3(f), and below, the Plan will fail to satisfy the requirements of Code Section 401(k)(12) and this Section for a Plan Year unless such provisions remain in effect for an entire twelve (12) month Plan Year.


9.5 Change of Plan Year. If a Plan has a short Plan Year as a result of changing its Plan Year, then the Plan will not fail to satisfy the requirements of Section 9.4 of this Amendment merely because the Plan Year has less than twelve (12) months, provided that:

(a) The Plan satisfied the ADP Test Safe Harbor and/or ACP Test Safe Harbor requirements for the immediately preceding Plan Year; and

(b) The Plan satisfies the ADP Test Safe Harbor and/or ACP Test Safe Harbor requirements (determined without regard to Regulation Section 1.40I(k)-3(g)) for the immediately following Plan Year (or for the immediately following twelve (12) months if the immediately following Plan Year is less than twelve (12) months).

9.6 Timing of matching contributions. If the ADP Test Safe Harbor contribution being made to the Plan is a matching contribution (or any ACP Test Safe Harbor matching contribution) that is made separately with respect to each payroll period (or with respect to all payroll periods ending with or within each month or quarter of a Plan Year) taken into account under the Plan for the Plan Year, then safe harbor matching contributions with respect to any elective deferrals and/or after-tax employee contributions made during a Plan Year quarter must be contributed to the Plan by the last day of the immediately following Plan Year quarter.

9.7 Exiting safe harbor matching. The Employer may amend the Plan during a Plan Year to reduce or eliminate prospectively any or all matching contributions under the Plan (including any ADP Test Safe Harbor matching contributions) provided: (a) the Plan Administrator provides a supplemental notice to the Participants which explains the consequences of the amendment, specifies the amendment's effective date, and informs Participants that they will have a reasonable opportunity to modify their cash or deferred elections and, if applicable, after-tax Employee contribution elections; (b) Participants have a reasonable opportunity (including a reasonable period after receipt of the supplemental notice) prior to the effective date of the amendment to modify their cash or deferred elections and, if applicable, after-tax Employee contribution elections; and (c) the amendment is not effective earlier than the later of: (i) thirty (30) days after the Plan Administrator gives supplemental notice; or (ii) the date the Employer adopts the amendment. An Employer which amends its Plan to eliminate or reduce any matching contribution under this Section, effective during the Plan Year, must continue to apply all of the ADP Test Safe Harbor and/or ACP Test Safe Harbor requirements of the Plan until the amendment becomes effective and also must apply for the entire Plan Year, using current year testing, the ADP test and the ACP test.

9.8 Plan termination. An Employer may terminate the Plan during a Plan Year in accordance with Plan termination provisions of the Plan and this Section.

(a) Acquisition/disposition or substantial business hardship. If the Employer terminates the Plan resulting in a short Plan Year, and the termination is on account of an acquisition or disposition transaction described in Code Section 410(b)(6)(C), or if the termination is on account of the Employer's substantial business hardship within the meaning of Code Section 412(d), then the Plan remains an ADP Test Safe Harbor and/or ACP Test Safe Harbor Plan provided that the Employer satisfies the ADP Test Safe Harbor and/or ACP Test Safe Harbor provisions through the effective date of the Plan termination.

(b) Other termination. If the Employer terminates the Plan for any reason other than as described in Section 9.7(a) above, and the termination results in a short Plan Year, the Employer must conduct the termination under the provisions of Section 9.7 above, except that the Employer need not provide Participants with the right to change their cash or deferred elections.


ENGLOBAL 401(K) PLAN

FINAL 401(k)/401(m) REGULATIONS

AMENDMENT

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION

                           By: //s// William A. Coskey
                           Title: Chairman
                           Date: December 27, 2006


Witness //s// Natalie Hairston


EXHIBIT 10.26

FIRST AMENDMENT TO LEASE

This agreement made as of the 7 day of April. 2005, between Oral Roberts University, an Oklahoma corporation ("Landlord") and ENGlobal Engineering, Inc., a Texas Corporation ("Tenant").

WHEREAS, Landlord and Tenant entered into that certain "Lease Agreement" dated January 27, 2005 with respect to premises consisting of approximately 50,631 square feet of Net Rentable Area (the "Leased Premises") in the building located at 2448 E. 81st Street, Suite 3300, Tulsa, Oklahoma 74137 and known as CityPlex Towers (the "Building"), said premises being more particularly described in the Lease; and

WHEREAS, Landlord and Tenant (the "parties") now desire to amend and modify said Lease Agreement in the following particulars;

NOW THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual convenants contained herein, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, Landlord and Tenant agree as follows:

1. The provisions of this Agreement shall supersede any inconsistent provisions contained in the Lease, whether such inconsistent provisions are contained in the printed portion of the Lease or any addendum, rider or exhibit annexed thereto. All capitalized items not otherwise defined herein shall have the same meanings ascribed to them in the Lease.

2. Effective September 1, 2005 the Premises shall be expanded by 5,319 Net Rentable Square Feet (as shown on Exhibit "A" attached hereto).

3. The monthly Base Rental for the above described space, subject to adjustments called for in the Lease, shall be as follows:

September 1, 2005 - January 31, 2008 $ 4,299.53

The monthly Base Rental amounts above shall be in addition to the monthly Base Rental amounts contained in Section 2d. of the Addendum to Lease.

4. This Agreement shall not constitute an agreement by Landlord or Tenant and shall not be binding upon Landlord or Tenant unless and until this Agreement shall be executed by Landlord and Tenant.

5. This Agreement may be changed only in writing, signed by both parties, and shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of Landlord and Tenant, their respective heirs, successors and, as permitted, their assigns.

6. Except as herein expressly amended or modified the terms and conditions of the Lease are hereby ratified and confirmed and shall remain in full force and effect.


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, Landlord and Tenant have executed this First Amendment to Lease as of the date first written above.

                                            LANDLORD:

WITNESS:                                    ORAL ROBERTS UNIVERSITY,
                                            An Oklahoma corporation

                                            By: D. M. Bernard, Vice-President
---------------------------                 ------------------------------------
Print Name                                  Title


                                            TENANT:

WITNESS:                                    ENGLOBAL ENGINEERING, INC.
                                            A Texas corporation

                                            By:
---------------------------                 ------------------------------------

Jean Whitaker                               William A. Coskey - CEO
---------------------------                 ------------------------------------
Print Name                                  Title


EXHIBIT "A"

[GRAPHIC ON FILE]

60 Story Tower

3500 -

11,250 Sq. F

Floor Plan


EXHIBIT 10.27

SECOND AMENDMENT TO LEASE

This agreement made as of the 15 day of June ,2005, between Oral Roberts University, an Oklahoma corporation ("Landlord") and ENGlobal Engineering, Inc., a Texas Corporation ("Tenant").

WHEREAS, Landlord and Tenant entered into that certain "Lease Agreement" dated January 27, 2005 with respect to premises consisting of approximately 50,631 square feet of Net Rentable Area (the "Leased Premises") in the building located at 2448 E. 81st Street, Suite 3300, Tulsa, Oklahoma 74137 and known as CityPlex Towers (the "Building"), said premises being more particularly described in the Lease; and

WHEREAS, Landlord and Tenant (the "parties") have made and executed that certain First Amendment to Lease dated April 7, 2005, modifying and amending the Lease upon the terms and conditions therein contained and;

WHEREAS, Landlord and Tenant (the "parties") now desire to amend and modify said Lease Agreement in the following particulars;

NOW THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual convenants contained herein, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, Landlord and Tenant agree as follows:

1. The provisions of this Agreement shall supersede any inconsistent provisions contained in the Lease, whether such inconsistent provisions are contained in the printed portion of the Lease or any addendum, rider or exhibit annexed thereto. All capitalized items not otherwise defined herein shall have the same meanings ascribed to them in the Lease.

2. Effective September 1, 2005 the Premises shall be expanded by 11,250 Net Rentable Square Feet (as shown on Exhibit "A" attached hereto),

3. The monthly Base Rental for the above described space, subject to adjustments called for in the Lease, shall be as follows:

September 1, 2005 - January 31, 2008 $9,093.75

The monthly Base Rental amounts above shall be in addition to the monthly Base Rental amounts contained in Section 2d. of the Addendum to Lease and Section 3. of the First Amendment to Lease.

4. This Agreement shall not constitute an agreement by Landlord or Tenant and shall not be binding upon Landlord or Tenant unless and until this Agreement shall be executed by Landlord and Tenant.

5. This Agreement may be changed only in writing, signed by both parties, and shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of Landlord and Tenant, their respective heirs, successors and, as permitted, their assigns.

6. Except as herein expressly amended or modified the terms and conditions of the Lease are hereby ratified and confirmed and shall remain in full force and effect.


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, Landlord and Tenant have executed this Second Amendment to Lease as of the date first written above.

                                              LANDLORD:

WITNESS:                                      ORAL ROBERTS UNIVERSITY,
                                              An Oklahoma Corporation

                                              By:
Pat Binder
                                              D. M. Bernard, Vice President
                                              Title


                                              TENANT:
WITNESS:
                                              ENGLOBAL ENGINEERING, INC.
                                              A Texas corporation

Jean Whitaker
                                              By: William A. Coskey, CEO

___________________________________        _____________________________________
Print Name                                 Title


EXHIBIT "A"

60 Story Tower

2800

[GRAPHIC ON FILE]


EXHIBIT 10.28

THIRD AMENDMENT TO LEASE

This agreement made as of the 28 day of December, 2005, between Oral Roberts University, an Oklahoma corporation ("Landlord") and ENGlobal Engineering, Inc., a Texas Corporation ("Tenant").

WHEREAS, Landlord and Tenant entered into that certain "Lease Agreement" dated January 27, 2005 with respect to premises consisting of approximately 50,631 square feet of Net Rentable Area (the "Leased Premises") in the building located st 2448 E. 81st Street, Suite 3300, Tulsa, Oklahoma 74137 and known as CityPlex Towers (the "Building"), said premises being more particularly described in the Lease; and

WHEREAS, Landlord and Tenant (the "parties") have made and executed that certain First Amendment to Lease dated April 7, 2005, modifying and amending the Lease upon the terms and conditions therein contained and;

WHEREAS, Landlord and Tenant (the "parties") have made and executed that certain Second Amendment to Lease dated June 13, 2005, modifying and amending the Lease upon the terms and conditions therein contained and;

WHEREAS, Landlord and Tenant (the "parties") now desire to amend and modify said Lease Agreement in the following particulars;

NOW THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual convenants contained herein, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, Landlord and Tenant agree as follows:

1. The provisions of this Agreement shall supersede any inconsistent provisions contained in the Lease, whether such inconsistent provisions are contained in the printed portion of the Lease or any addendum, rider or exhibit annexed thereto. All capitalized items not otherwise defined herein shall have the same meanings ascribed to them in the Lease.

2. Effective February 1, 2006 the Premises shall be expanded by 11,250 Net Rentable Square Feet (as shown on Exhibit "A" attached hereto),

3. The monthly Base Rental for the above described space, subject to adjustments called for in the Lease, shall be as follows:

February 1, 2006 - February 28, 2006 $ 0.00 March 1, 2006 - January 31, 2008 $9,093.75

The monthly Base Rental amounts above shall be in addition to the monthly Base Rental amounts contained in Section 2d. of the Addendum to Lease and Section 3. of the First Amendment to Lease and Section 3. of the Second Amendment to Lease.

4. This Agreement shall not constitute an agreement by Landlord or Tenant and shall not be binding upon Landlord or Tenant unless and until this Agreement shall be executed by Landlord and Tenant.

5. This Agreement may be changed only in writing, signed by both parties, and shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of Landlord and Tenant, their respective heirs, successors and, as permitted, their assigns.

6. Except as herein expressly amended or modified the terms and conditions of the Lease are hereby ratified and confirmed and shall remain in full force and effect.


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, Landlord and Tenant have executed this Third Amendment to Lease as of the date first written above.

LANDLORD:

ORAL ROBERTS UNIVERSITY,
An Oklahoma Corporation

B. M. Bernard, Vice President

WITNESS:

Pat Binder

________________________________              Title
Print Name


                                              TENANT:

WITNESS:                                      ENGLOBAL ENGINEERING, INC.
                                              A Texas corporation

Jean Whitaker

                                              By: William A. Coskey , CEO


________________________________
Print Name                                    Title


Exhibit 10.29

FOURTH AMENDMENT TO LEASE

This agreement made as of the 27th day of February 2006, between Oral Roberts University, an Oklahoma corporation ("Landlord") and ENGlobal Engineering, Inc., a Texas Corporation ("Tenant").

WHEREAS, Landlord and Tenant entered into that certain "Lease Agreement" dated January 27, 2005 with respect to premises consisting of approximately 50,631 square feet of Net Rentable Area (the "Leased Premises") in the building located st 2448 E. 81st Street, Suite 3300, Tulsa, Oklahoma 74137 and known as CityPlex Towers (the "Building"), said premises being more particularly described in the Lease; and

WHEREAS, Landlord and Tenant (the "parties") have made and executed that certain First Amendment to Lease dated April 7, 2005, modifying and amending the Lease upon the terms and conditions therein contained and;

WHEREAS, Landlord and Tenant (the "parties") have made and executed that certain Second Amendment to Lease dated June 13, 2005, modifying and amending the Lease upon the terms and conditions therein contained and;

WHEREAS, Landlord and Tenant (the "parties") have made and executed that certain Third Amendment to Lease dated December 28, 2005, modifying and amending the Lease upon the terms and conditions therein contained and;

WHEREAS, Landlord and Tenant (the "parties") now desire to amend and modify said Lease Agreement in the following particulars;

NOW THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual convenants contained herein, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, Landlord and Tenant agree as follows:

1. The provisions of this Agreement shall supersede any inconsistent provisions contained in the Lease, whether such inconsistent provisions are contained in the printed portion of the Lease or any addendum, rider or exhibit annexed thereto. All capitalized items not otherwise defined herein shall have the same meanings ascribed to them in the Lease.

2. Effective April 1, 2006 the Premises shall be expanded by 11,250 Net Rentable Square Feet (as shown on Exhibit "A" attached hereto).

3. The monthly Base Rental for the above described space, subject to adjustments called for in the Lease, shall be as follows:

April 1, 2006 - January 31, 2008 $9,093.75

The monthly Base Rental amounts above shall be in addition to the monthly Base Rental amounts contained in Section 2d. of the Addendum to Lease and Section 3. of the First Amendment to Lease and Section 3. of the Second Amendment to Lease and Section 3. of the Third Amendment to Lease.


4. This Agreement shall not constitute an agreement by Landlord or Tenant and shall not be binding upon Landlord or Tenant unless and until this Agreement shall be executed by Landlord and Tenant.

5. This Agreement may be changed only in writing, signed by both parties, and shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of Landlord and Tenant, their respective heirs, successors and, as permitted, their assigns.

6. Except as herein expressly amended or modified the terms and conditions of the Lease are hereby ratified and confirmed and shall remain in full force and effect.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, Landlord and Tenant have executed this Fourth Amendment to Lease as of the date first written above.

                                                     LANDLORD:

WITNESS:                                    ORAL ROBERTS UNIVERSITY,
                                            An Oklahoma corporation

                                            By:
                                                -------------------------------
Austin Neal                                 D. M. Bernard, Vice-President
-----------------------------               -----------------------------------
Print Name                                  Title


                                            TENANT:

WITNESS:                                    ENGLOBAL ENGINEERING, INC.
                                            A Texas corporation

                                            By:
-----------------------------                   -------------------------------

R. David Kelley                             William A. Coskey - CEO
-----------------------------               -----------------------------------
Print Name                                  Title


EXHIBIT "A"

[GRAPHIC OMITTED]


Exhibit 10.30

FIFTH AMENDMENT TO LEASE

This agreement made as of the 28th day of July, 2006, between Oral Roberts University, an Oklahoma corporation ("Landlord") and ENGlobal Engineering, Inc., a Texas Corporation ("Tenant").

WHEREAS, Landlord and Tenant entered into that certain "Lease Agreement" dated January 27, 2005 with respect to premises consisting of approximately 50,631 square feet of Net Rentable Area (the "Leased Premises") in the building located st 2448 E. 81st Street, Suite 3300, Tulsa, Oklahoma 74137 and known as CityPlex Towers (the "Building"), said premises being more particularly described in the Lease; and

WHEREAS, Landlord and Tenant (the "parties") have made and executed that certain First Amendment to Lease dated April 7, 2005, modifying and amending the Lease upon the terms and conditions contained therein, and;

WHEREAS, Landlord and Tenant (the "parties") have made and executed that certain Second Amendment to Lease dated June 13, 2005, modifying and amending the Lease upon the terms and conditions therein contained and;

WHEREAS, Landlord and Tenant (the "parties") have made and executed that certain Third Amendment to Lease dated December 28, 2005, modifying and amending the Lease upon the terms and conditions therein contained and;

WHEREAS, Landlord and Tenant (the "parties") have made and executed that certain Fourth Amendment to Lease dated February 27, 2006, modifying and amending the Lease upon the terms and conditions therein contained and;

WHEREAS, Landlord and Tenant (the "parties") now desire to amend and modify said Lease Agreement in the following particulars;

NOW THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual convenants contained herein, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, Landlord and Tenant agree as follows:

1. The provisions of this Agreement shall supersede any inconsistent provisions contained in the Lease, whether such inconsistent provisions are contained in the printed portion of the Lease or any addendum, rider or exhibit annexed thereto. All capitalized items not otherwise defined herein shall have the same meanings ascribed to them in the Lease.

2. Effective September 1, 2006, the Premises shall be expanded by 11,250 net rentable square feet (as shown on Exhibit "A" attached hereto).

3. The monthly Base Rental for the above described space, subject to adjustments called for in the Lease, shall be as follows:

September 1, 2006 - January 31, 2008 $9,093.75

The monthly Base Rental amounts above shall be in addition to the monthly Base Rental amounts contained in Section 2d. of the Addendum to Lease and
Section 3. of the First Amendment to Lease and Section 3. of the Second Amendment to Lease and Section 3. of the Third Amendment to Lease and Section 3. of the Fourth Amendment to Lease.


4. This Agreement shall not constitute an agreement by Landlord or Tenant and shall not be binding upon Landlord or Tenant unless and until this Agreement shall be executed by Landlord and Tenant.

5. This Agreement may be changed only in writing, signed by both parties, and shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of Landlord and Tenant, their respective heirs, successors and, as permitted, their assigns.

6. Except as herein expressly amended or modified the terms and conditions of the Lease are hereby ratified and confirmed and shall remain in full force and effect.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, Landlord and Tenant have executed this Fifth Amendment to Lease as of the date first written above.

                                            LANDLORD:

WITNESS:                                    ORAL ROBERTS UNIVERSITY,
                                            An Oklahoma corporation

                                            By:
----------------------------                   --------------------------------


Pat Binder                                  D. M. Bernard, Vice President
----------------------------                ------------------------------------
Print Name                                  Title


                                            TENANT:

WITNESS:                                    ENGLOBAL ENGINEERING, INC.
                                            A Texas corporation

                                            By:
----------------------------                    -------------------------------

Jean Whitaker                               William A. Coskey, CEO
----------------------------                ------------------------------------
Print Name                                  Title


EXHIBIT "A"

[GRAPHIC OMITTED]


EXHIBIT 10.31

FIRST AMENDMENT TO CREDIT AGREEMENT

THIS FIRST AMENDMENT TO CREDIT AGREEMENT (herein called this "Amendment") is executed on the date set forth on the signature pages but is made effective as of September 30, 2004, by and among ENGLOBAL CORPORATION, a Nevada corporation; ENGLOBAL CORPORATE SERVICES, INC., a Texas corporation; THERMAIRE, INC., a Texas corporation; ENGLOBAL ENGINEERING, INC., a Texas corporation; ENGLOBAL CONSTRUCTION RESOURCES, INC., a Texas corporation; ENGLOBAL SYSTEMS, INC., a Texas corporation; RPM ENGINEERING, INC., a Louisiana corporation; ENGLOBAL TECHNOLOGIES, INC., a Texas corporation; ENGLOBAL CONSTANT POWER, INC., a Texas corporation; SENFTLEBER & ASSOCIATES, L.P., a Texas limited partnership; and ENGLOBAL DESIGN GROUP, INC., a Texas corporation (collectively, "Borrower"), and COMERICA BANK ("Bank").

THE RECITALS

WHEREAS, Borrower and Bank have entered into that certain Credit Agreement dated as of July 27, 2004 (as heretofore amended, the "Original Credit Agreement"), for the purposes and consideration therein expressed, pursuant to which Bank became obligated to make loans to Borrower as therein provided; and

WHEREAS, Borrower and Bank desire to amend the Original Credit Agreement as provided herein;

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and the mutual covenants and agreements contained herein and in the Original Credit Agreement, in consideration of the loans which may hereafter be made by Bank to Borrower, and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto do hereby agree as follows:

ARTICLE I Definitions and References

Section 1.1 Terms Defined in the Original Credit Agreement. Unless the context otherwise requires or unless otherwise expressly defined herein, the terms defined in the Original Credit Agreement shall have the same meanings whenever used in this Amendment.

Section 1.2 Other Defined Terms. Unless the context otherwise requires, the following terms when used in this Amendment shall have the meanings assigned to them in this Section 1.2.

"Amendment" means this First Amendment to Credit Agreement.


"Amendment Documents" means, collectively, this Amendment and any other document required to be delivered by Borrower pursuant to Article III hereof.

"Credit Agreement" means the Original Credit Agreement as amended hereby.

"Original Omnibus Certificate" means the Omnibus Certificate dated July 27, 2004 executed and delivered by officers of each Borrower pursuant to the Original Credit Agreement.

ARTICLE II Amendments to Original Credit Agreement

Section 2.1 Section 4.4(b) of the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by deleting the figure "18,175,000" set forth therein and substituting therefor the figure "$17,563,000".

Section 2.2 Section 5.1 of the Original Credit Agreement is hereby deleted in its entirety, and the following is substituted in place thereof:

"5.1 Capital Structure, Business Objects or Purpose. Except as permitted in Sections 5.6 and 5.7 hereof and in the proviso below, purchase, acquire or redeem any of its equity ownership interests, or enter into any reorganization or recapitalization or reclassify its equity ownership interests, or make any material change in its capital structure or general business objects or purpose; provided that (A) Borrower may repurchase up to 652,377 shares of its common stock for a purchase price of $0.96 per share, not to exceed $626,281.13 in the aggregate, such purchase price being payable in three annual installments of $208,760.71 each and being payable on or about the last day of December for the calendar years 2004, 2005 and 2006 and (B) Borrower may repurchase annually up to $100,000 of its common stock in connection with the Borrower's employee stock purchase plan."

Section 2.3 Section 5.4 of the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by deleting the word "and" at the end of Section 5.4(c), deleting the period at the end of Section 5.4(d) and substituting therefore a semi-colon and adding to
Section 5.4 a new subsection (e) to read in its entirety as follows:

"(e) additional unsecured Debt not otherwise described above not to exceed $2,000,000 at any one time outstanding."

Section 2.4 Section 5.17 of the Original Credit Agreement hereby amended by deleting the figure "$1,000,000" and substituting "1,300,000" in place thereof.

2

Section 2.5 The Defined Terms Addendum to the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by deleting the definitions of "Agreement" and "Funded Debt" and substituting therefor the following:

"'Agreement' shall mean this Credit Agreement, including the Defined Terms Addendum and the Loan Terms, Conditions and Procedures Addendum, together with all exhibits and schedules, as amended by the First Amendment and as it may be further amended from time to time.

"'Funded Debt' shall mean for the Borrower, as of any month-end determination date, the average total outstanding principal balance of Debt which should be classified in accordance with GAAP as "funded indebtedness" or "long term indebtedness" on the Borrower's balance sheet for the then-ended month including, without limitation, the outstanding amount of the Revolving Loans and the Letter of Credit Liabilities excluding any indebtedness incurred for the purpose of financing insurance premiums."

Section 2.6 The Defined Terms Addendum to the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by adding the following definitions thereto:

"'First Amendment' shall mean that certain First Amendment to Credit Agreement effective as of September 30, 2004 among Borrower and Bank."

ARTICLE III Conditions of Effectiveness

Section 3.1 Effective Date. This Amendment shall become effective as of the date first above written when and only when Bank shall have received, at Bank's office,

(a) a duly executed counterpart of this Amendment;

(b) a duly executed counterpart of the No Oral Agreements of even date herewith;

(c) a duly executed certificate of the chief financial officer and secretary of Borrower certifying that (i) resolutions of its board of directors attached to the Original Omnibus Certificate authorizing the execution, delivery, and performance of this Amendment and identifying the officers authorized to sign such instrument are in full force and effect and (ii) the specimen signatures of the officers so authorized which were attached to the Original Omnibus Certificate are true and correct; and

(d) each other document to be executed and delivered by Borrower pursuant hereto or thereto.

3

ARTICLE IV Representations and Warranties

Section 4.1 Representations and Warranties of Borrower. In order to induce Bank to enter into this Amendment, Borrower represents and warrants to Bank that:

(a) The representations and warranties contained in Section 3 of the Original Credit Agreement are true and correct at and as of the time of the effectiveness hereof;

(b) Borrower is duly authorized to execute and deliver this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents and is and will continue to be duly authorized to borrow and to perform its obligations under the Credit Agreement. Borrower has duly taken all corporate action necessary to authorize the execution and delivery of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents and to authorize the performance of the obligations of Borrower hereunder and thereunder;

(c) The execution and delivery by Borrower of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents, the performance by Borrower of its obligations hereunder and thereunder and the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby do not and will not conflict with any provision of law, statute, rule or regulation or the bylaws or partnership agreement of Borrower, or of any material agreement, judgment, license, order or permit applicable to or binding upon Borrower, or result in the creation of any lien, charge or encumbrance upon any assets or properties of Borrower. Except for those which have been duly obtained, no consent, approval, authorization or order of any court or governmental authority or third party is required in connection with the execution and delivery by Borrower of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents or to consummate the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby;

(d) When duly executed and delivered, each of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents will be a legal and binding instrument and agreement of Borrower, enforceable in accordance with its terms, except as limited by bankruptcy, insolvency and similar laws applying to creditors' rights generally and by principles of equity applying to creditors' rights generally; and

(e) No material adverse change has occurred in the financial condition or businesses or in the consolidated financial condition or businesses of Borrower since the date of the most recently delivered financial statements.

ARTICLE V Miscellaneous

Section 5.1 Ratification of Agreement. The Original Credit Agreement as hereby amended is hereby ratified and confirmed in all respects. Any reference to the Credit Agreement in any Loan Document shall be deemed to refer to this Amendment also. The execution, delivery and effectiveness of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents shall not, except as expressly provided herein, operate as a waiver of any right, power or remedy of Bank under the Credit Agreement or any other Loan Document nor constitute a waiver of any provision of the Credit Agreement or any other Loan Document.

4

Section 5.2 Survival of Agreements. All representations, warranties, covenants and agreements of Borrower herein shall survive the execution and delivery of this Amendment and the performance hereof, and shall further survive until all of the Indebtedness is paid in full. All statements and agreements contained in any certificate or instrument delivered by Borrower hereunder or under the Credit Agreement to Bank shall be deemed to constitute representations and warranties by, or agreements and covenants of, Borrower under this Amendment and under the Credit Agreement.

Section 5.3 Loan Documents. This Amendment and the other Amendment Documents are each a Loan Document, and all provisions in the Credit Agreement pertaining to Loan Documents apply hereto and thereto.

Section 5.4 Governing Law. This Amendment shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of Texas and any applicable laws of the United States of America in all respects, including construction, validity and performance.

Section 5.5 Counterparts; Fax. This Amendment may be separately executed in counterparts and by the different parties hereto in separate counterparts, each of which when so executed shall be deemed to constitute one and the same Amendment. This Amendment may be duly executed by facsimile or other electronic transmission.

THIS AMENDMENT AND THE OTHER LOAN DOCUMENTS REPRESENT THE FINAL AGREEMENT BETWEEN THE PARTIES AND MAY NOT BE CONTRADICTED BY EVIDENCE OF PRIOR, CONTEMPORANEOUS, OR SUBSEQUENT ORAL AGREEMENTS OF THE PARTIES.

THERE ARE NO UNWRITTEN ORAL AGREEMENTS BETWEEN THE PARTIES.

[REMAINDER OF PAGE INTENTIONALLY BLANK]

5

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, this Amendment is executed as of January ___, 2005 to be effective as of the date first above written.

BORROWER:

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION,
a Nevada corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL CORPORATE SERVICES, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

THERMAIRE, INC., a Texas corporation

By:
R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL ENGINEERING, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL CONSTRUCTION
RESOURCES, INC., a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL SYSTEMS, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

RPM ENGINEERING, INC.,
a Louisiana corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL TECHNOLOGIES, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL CONSTANT POWER, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

SENFTLEBER & ASSOCIATES, L.P.,
a Texas limited partnership

By: ENGlobal Design Group, Inc.,
a Texas corporation, its general
partner

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL DESIGN GROUP, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

BANK:

COMERICA BANK

By:
James R. McNutt, Sr. Vice President

EXHIBIT 10.32

SECOND AMENDMENT TO CREDIT AGREEMENT

THIS SECOND AMENDMENT TO CREDIT AGREEMENT (herein called this "Amendment") is executed on the date set forth on the signature pages but is made effective as of April 1, 2005, by and among ENGLOBAL CORPORATION, a Nevada corporation; ENGLOBAL CORPORATE SERVICES, INC., a Texas corporation; THERMAIRE, INC., a Texas corporation; ENGLOBAL ENGINEERING, INC., a Texas corporation; ENGLOBAL CONSTRUCTION RESOURCES, INC., a Texas corporation; ENGLOBAL SYSTEMS, INC., a Texas corporation; RPM ENGINEERING, INC., a Louisiana corporation; ENGLOBAL TECHNOLOGIES, INC., a Texas corporation; ENGLOBAL CONSTANT POWER, INC., a Texas corporation; SENFTLEBER & ASSOCIATES, L.P., a Texas limited partnership; and ENGLOBAL DESIGN GROUP, INC., a Texas corporation (collectively, "Borrower"); and COMERICA BANK ("Bank").

THE RECITALS

WHEREAS, Borrower and Bank have entered into that certain Credit Agreement dated as of July 27, 2004, as amended by that certain First Amendment to Credit Agreement dated as of September 30, 2004 (as amended, the "Original Credit Agreement"), for the purposes and consideration therein expressed, pursuant to which Bank became obligated to make loans to Borrower as therein provided; and

WHEREAS, Borrower and Bank desire to further amend the Original Credit Agreement as provided herein;

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and the mutual covenants and agreements contained herein and in the Original Credit Agreement, in consideration of the loans which may hereafter be made by Bank to Borrower, and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto do hereby agree as follows:

ARTICLE I Definitions and References

Section 1.1 Terms Defined in the Original Credit Agreement. Unless the context otherwise requires or unless otherwise expressly defined herein, the terms defined in the Original Credit Agreement shall have the same meanings whenever used in this Amendment.

Section 1.2 Other Defined Terms. Unless the context otherwise requires, the following terms when used in this Amendment shall have the meanings assigned to them in this Section 1.2.

"Amendment" means this Second Amendment to Credit Agreement.


"Amendment Documents" means, collectively, this Amendment and any other document required to be delivered by Borrower pursuant to Article III hereof.

"Credit Agreement" means the Original Credit Agreement as amended hereby.

"Original Omnibus Certificate" means the Omnibus Certificate dated July 27, 2004 executed and delivered by officers of each Borrower pursuant to the Original Credit Agreement.

ARTICLE II Amendments to Original Credit Agreement

Section 2.1 The Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by deleting
Section 4.4(c) and substituting therefor the following:

"(c) Maximum Leverage Ratio. Maintain as of the last day of each calendar month during the term of this Agreement a ratio of Funded Debt to Adjusted EBITDA for the twelve (12) months ending on each date occurring during the term of this Agreement no greater than 3.00 to 1; provided that, for purposes of this covenant and subject to Bank approval, Adjusted EBITDA shall have added back the trailing 12-month EBITDA of new acquisitions exceeding a gross purchase price of $2,500,000; provided further that for any calculation hereunder that includes a calendar month prior to the date of Borrower's purchase of AmTech Inspection and Cleveland Inspection (hereinafter called, the "Acquisition" and each month occurring before the Acquisition, being a "Pre-Acquisition Month"), Adjusted EBITDA shall include, for each Pre-Acquisition Month, a number equal to (i) the Adjusted EBITDA of AmTech Inspection and Cleveland Inspection for each calendar month after the Acquisition divided by (ii) the number of calendar months since the Acquisition."

Section 2.2 The Defined Terms Addendum to the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by deleting the definition of "Agreement" and substituting therefor the following:

"'Agreement' shall mean this Credit Agreement, including the Defined Terms Addendum and the Loan Terms, Conditions and Procedures Addendum, together with all exhibits and schedules, as amended by the First Amendment and the Second Amendment, and as it may be further amended from time to time.

Section 2.3 The Defined Terms Addendum to the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by adding the following definition thereto:

2

"'Second Amendment' shall mean that certain Second Amendment to Credit Agreement effective as of April ___, 2005 among Borrower and Bank."

Section 2.4 The Loan Terms, Conditions and Procedures Addendum to the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by deleting Section 1.9(a) and substituting therefor the following:

"(a) Letters of Credit. Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents, the Bank shall, upon request from Borrower from time to time prior to the Revolving Credit Maturity Date, issue one or more Letters of Credit. The Letter of Credit Liabilities shall not exceed $500,000, provided that, for Letters of Credit issued in connection with the Engineering and Procurement Services Agreement between Borrower and Coffeyville Resources Refining and Marketing LLC, Borrower may obtain Letters of Credit and incur Letter of Credit Liabilities up to an additional $4,500,000, provided further that the sum of (i) the outstanding principal balance of all Revolving Loans plus (ii) the Letter of Credit Liabilities shall not exceed the Revolving Credit Maximum Amount. Letters of Credit may be issued to finance working capital needs. Each Letter of Credit issued pursuant to this Agreement shall be in a minimum amount of $25,000. No Letter of Credit shall have a stated expiration date later than thirty (30) days prior to the Revolving Credit Maturity Date."

ARTICLE III Conditions of Effectiveness

Section 3.1 Effective Date. This Amendment shall become effective as of the date first above written when and only when Bank shall have received, at Bank's office,

(a) a duly executed counterpart of this Amendment;

(b) a duly executed counterpart of the No Oral Agreements of even date herewith;

(c) each other document to be executed and delivered by Borrower pursuant hereto or thereto; and

(d) an amendment fee in the amount of $5000.

ARTICLE IV Representations and Warranties

Section 4.1 Representations and Warranties of Borrower. In order to induce Bank to enter into this Amendment, Borrower represents and warrants to Bank that:

3

(a) The representations and warranties contained in Section 3 of the Original Credit Agreement are true and correct at and as of the time of the effectiveness hereof;

(b) Borrower is duly authorized to execute and deliver this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents and is and will continue to be duly authorized to borrow and to perform its obligations under the Credit Agreement. Borrower has duly taken all corporate action necessary to authorize the execution and delivery of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents and to authorize the performance of the obligations of Borrower hereunder and thereunder. The Original Omnibus Certificate of each Borrower delivered to Lender on the date of the Original Credit Agreement remain in full force and effect, and the specimen signatures of the officers on the Original Omnibus Certificates are true and correct;

(c) The execution and delivery by Borrower of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents, the performance by Borrower of its obligations hereunder and thereunder and the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby do not and will not conflict with any provision of law, statute, rule or regulation or the bylaws or partnership agreement of Borrower, or of any material agreement, judgment, license, order or permit applicable to or binding upon Borrower, or result in the creation of any lien, charge or encumbrance upon any assets or properties of Borrower. Except for those which have been duly obtained, no consent, approval, authorization or order of any court or governmental authority or third party is required in connection with the execution and delivery by Borrower of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents or to consummate the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby;

(d) When duly executed and delivered, each of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents will be a legal and binding instrument and agreement of Borrower, enforceable in accordance with its terms, except as limited by bankruptcy, insolvency and similar laws applying to creditors' rights generally and by principles of equity applying to creditors' rights generally; and

(e) No material adverse change has occurred in the financial condition or businesses or in the consolidated financial condition or businesses of Borrower since the date of the most recently delivered financial statements.

ARTICLE V Miscellaneous

Section 5.1 Ratification of Agreement. The Original Credit Agreement as hereby amended is hereby ratified and confirmed in all respects. Any reference to the Credit Agreement in any Loan Document shall be deemed to refer to this Amendment also. The execution, delivery and effectiveness of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents shall not, except as expressly provided herein, operate as a waiver of any right, power or remedy of Bank under the Credit Agreement or any other Loan Document nor constitute a waiver of any provision of the Credit Agreement or any other Loan Document.

4

Section 5.2 Survival of Agreements. All representations, warranties, covenants and agreements of Borrower herein shall survive the execution and delivery of this Amendment and the performance hereof, and shall further survive until all of the Indebtedness is paid in full. All statements and agreements contained in any certificate or instrument delivered by Borrower hereunder or under the Credit Agreement to Bank shall be deemed to constitute representations and warranties by, or agreements and covenants of, Borrower under this Amendment and under the Credit Agreement.

Section 5.3 Loan Documents. This Amendment and the other Amendment Documents are each a Loan Document, and all provisions in the Credit Agreement pertaining to Loan Documents apply hereto and thereto.

Section 5.4 Governing Law. This Amendment shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of Texas and any applicable laws of the United States of America in all respects, including construction, validity and performance.

Section 5.5 Counterparts; Fax. This Amendment may be separately executed in counterparts and by the different parties hereto in separate counterparts, each of which when so executed shall be deemed to constitute one and the same Amendment. This Amendment may be duly executed by facsimile or other electronic transmission.

THIS AMENDMENT AND THE OTHER LOAN DOCUMENTS REPRESENT THE FINAL AGREEMENT BETWEEN THE PARTIES AND MAY NOT BE CONTRADICTED BY EVIDENCE OF PRIOR, CONTEMPORANEOUS, OR SUBSEQUENT ORAL AGREEMENTS OF THE PARTIES.

THERE ARE NO UNWRITTEN ORAL AGREEMENTS AMONG THE PARTIES.

[REMAINDER OF PAGE INTENTIONALLY BLANK]

5

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, this Amendment is executed as of the date first above written.

BORROWER:

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION,
a Nevada corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL CORPORATE SERVICES, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

THERMAIRE, INC., a Texas corporation

By:
R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL ENGINEERING, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL CONSTRUCTION
RESOURCES, INC., a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL SYSTEMS, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

RPM ENGINEERING, INC.,
a Louisiana corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL TECHNOLOGIES, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL CONSTANT POWER, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

SENFTLEBER & ASSOCIATES, L.P.,
a Texas limited partnership

By: ENGlobal Design Group, Inc.,
a Texas corporation, its general
partner

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL DESIGN GROUP, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

BANK:

COMERICA BANK

By:
James R. McNutt, Sr. Vice President

EXHIBIT 10.33

THIRD AMENDMENT TO CREDIT AGREEMENT

THIS THIRD AMENDMENT TO CREDIT AGREEMENT (herein called this "Amendment") is executed on the date set forth on the signature pages but is made effective as of July 31, 2005, by and among ENGLOBAL CORPORATION, a Nevada corporation; ENGLOBAL CORPORATE SERVICES, INC., a Texas corporation; THERMAIRE, INC., a Texas corporation; ENGLOBAL ENGINEERING, INC., a Texas corporation; ENGLOBAL CONSTRUCTION RESOURCES, INC., a Texas corporation; ENGLOBAL SYSTEMS, INC., a Texas corporation; RPM ENGINEERING, INC., a Louisiana corporation; ENGLOBAL TECHNOLOGIES, INC., a Texas corporation; ENGLOBAL CONSTANT POWER, INC., a Texas corporation; SENFTLEBER & ASSOCIATES, L.P., a Texas limited partnership; and ENGLOBAL DESIGN GROUP, INC., a Texas corporation (collectively, "Borrower"), and COMERICA BANK ("Bank").

THE RECITALS

WHEREAS, Borrower and Bank have entered into that certain Credit Agreement dated as of July 27, 2004 (as heretofore amended by a First Amendment effective as of September 30, 2004 and a Second Amendment effective as of April 1, 2005 and as it may be hereafter amended, the "Original Credit Agreement"), for the purposes and consideration therein expressed, pursuant to which Bank became obligated to make loans to Borrower as therein provided; and

WHEREAS, Borrower and Bank desire to amend the Original Credit Agreement as provided herein;

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and the mutual covenants and agreements contained herein and in the Original Credit Agreement, in consideration of the loans which may hereafter be made by Bank to Borrower, and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto do hereby agree as follows:

ARTICLE I Definitions and References

Section 1.1 Terms Defined in the Original Credit Agreement. Unless the context otherwise requires or unless otherwise expressly defined herein, the terms defined in the Original Credit Agreement shall have the same meanings whenever used in this Amendment.

Section 1.2 Other Defined Terms. Unless the context otherwise requires, the following terms when used in this Amendment shall have the meanings assigned to them in this Section 1.2.

"Amendment" means this Third Amendment to Credit Agreement.


"Amendment Documents" means, collectively, this Amendment and any other document required to be delivered by Borrower pursuant to Article III hereof.

"Credit Agreement" means the Original Credit Agreement as amended hereby.

"Original Omnibus Certificate" means the Omnibus Certificate dated July 27, 2004 executed and delivered by officers of each Borrower pursuant to the Original Credit Agreement.

ARTICLE II Amendments to Original Credit Agreement

Section 2.1 Section 5.17 of the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by deleting the figure "$1,300,000" and substituting "2,500,000" in place thereof.

Section 2.2 The Defined Terms Addendum to the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by deleting the definition of "Agreement" and substituting therefor the following:

"'Agreement' shall mean this Credit Agreement, including the Defined Terms Addendum and the Loan Terms, Conditions and Procedures Addendum, together with all exhibits and schedules, as amended by the First Amendment, Second Amendment, Third Amendment and as it may be further amended from time to time.

Section 2.3 The Defined Terms Addendum to the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by adding the following definitions thereto:

"'Third Amendment' shall mean that certain Third Amendment to Credit Agreement executed on October __, 2005 but effective as of July 31, 2005 among Borrower and Bank."

Section 2.4 The Loan Terms, Conditions and Procedures Addendum to the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by deleting Section 1.9(a) and substituting therefor the following:

"(a) Letters of Credit. Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents, the Bank shall, upon request from Borrower from time to time prior to the Revolving Credit Maturity Date, issue one or more Letters of Credit. The Letter of Credit Liabilities shall not exceed $8,000,000 from the date of the Third Amendment until February 28, 2006 and from February 28, 2006 to May 31, 2006 the Letter of Credit Liabilities shall not exceed $3,000,000 and from and after May 31, 2006 the Letter of Credit Liabilities shall not exceed $2,000,000, provided that, at all times the sum of (i) the outstanding principal balance of all Revolving Loans plus (ii) the Letter of Credit Liabilities shall not exceed the Revolving Credit Maximum Amount. Letters of Credit may be issued to finance working capital needs. Each Letter of Credit issued pursuant to this Agreement shall be in a minimum amount of $25,000. No Letter of Credit shall have a stated expiration date later than thirty (30) days prior to the Revolving Credit Maturity Date."

2

ARTICLE III Conditions of Effectiveness

Section 3.1 Effective Date. This Amendment shall become effective as of the date first above written when and only when Bank shall have received, at Bank's office,

(a) a duly executed counterpart of this Amendment;

(b) a duly executed counterpart of the No Oral Agreements of even date herewith; and

(c) each other document to be executed and delivered by Borrower pursuant hereto or thereto.

ARTICLE IV Representations and Warranties

Section 4.1 Representations and Warranties of Borrower. In order to induce Bank to enter into this Amendment, Borrower represents and warrants to Bank that:

(a) The representations and warranties contained in Section 3 of the Original Credit Agreement are true and correct at and as of the time of the effectiveness hereof;

(b) Borrower is duly authorized to execute and deliver this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents and is and will continue to be duly authorized to borrow and to perform its obligations under the Credit Agreement. Borrower has duly taken all corporate action necessary to authorize the execution and delivery of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents and to authorize the performance of the obligations of Borrower hereunder and thereunder. The Omnibus Certificate of each Borrower delivered to Bank on the date of the Original Credit Agreement remains in full force and effect, and the specimen signatures of the officers contained in the Omnibus Certificate are true and correct;

(c) The execution and delivery by Borrower of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents, the performance by Borrower of its obligations hereunder and thereunder and the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby do not and will not conflict with any provision of law, statute, rule or regulation or the bylaws or partnership agreement of Borrower, or of any material agreement, judgment, license, order or permit applicable to or binding upon Borrower, or result in the creation of any lien, charge or encumbrance upon any assets or properties of Borrower. Except for those which have been duly obtained, no consent, approval, authorization or order of any court or governmental authority or third party is required in connection with the execution and delivery by Borrower of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents or to consummate the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby;

3

(d) When duly executed and delivered, each of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents will be a legal and binding instrument and agreement of Borrower, enforceable in accordance with its terms, except as limited by bankruptcy, insolvency and similar laws applying to creditors' rights generally and by principles of equity applying to creditors' rights generally; and

(e) No material adverse change has occurred in the financial condition or businesses or in the consolidated financial condition or businesses of Borrower since the date of the most recently delivered financial statements.

ARTICLE V Miscellaneous

Section 5.1 Ratification of Agreement. The Original Credit Agreement as hereby amended is hereby ratified and confirmed in all respects. Any reference to the Credit Agreement in any Loan Document shall be deemed to refer to this Amendment also. The execution, delivery and effectiveness of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents shall not, except as expressly provided herein, operate as a waiver of any right, power or remedy of Bank under the Credit Agreement or any other Loan Document nor constitute a waiver of any provision of the Credit Agreement or any other Loan Document.

Section 5.2 Survival of Agreements. All representations, warranties, covenants and agreements of Borrower herein shall survive the execution and delivery of this Amendment and the performance hereof, and shall further survive until all of the Indebtedness is paid in full. All statements and agreements contained in any certificate or instrument delivered by Borrower hereunder or under the Credit Agreement to Bank shall be deemed to constitute representations and warranties by, or agreements and covenants of, Borrower under this Amendment and under the Credit Agreement.

Section 5.3 Loan Documents. This Amendment and the other Amendment Documents are each a Loan Document, and all provisions in the Credit Agreement pertaining to Loan Documents apply hereto and thereto.

Section 5.4 Governing Law. This Amendment shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of Texas and any applicable laws of the United States of America in all respects, including construction, validity and performance.

4

Section 5.5 Counterparts; Fax. This Amendment may be separately executed in counterparts and by the different parties hereto in separate counterparts, each of which when so executed shall be deemed to constitute one and the same Amendment. This Amendment may be duly executed by facsimile or other electronic transmission.

THIS AMENDMENT AND THE OTHER LOAN DOCUMENTS REPRESENT THE FINAL AGREEMENT BETWEEN THE PARTIES AND MAY NOT BE CONTRADICTED BY EVIDENCE OF PRIOR, CONTEMPORANEOUS, OR SUBSEQUENT ORAL AGREEMENTS OF THE PARTIES.

THERE ARE NO UNWRITTEN ORAL AGREEMENTS BETWEEN THE PARTIES.

[REMAINDER OF PAGE INTENTIONALLY BLANK]

5

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, this Amendment is on October ___, 2005 but to be effective as of July 31, 2005.

BORROWER:

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION,
a Nevada corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL CORPORATE SERVICES, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

THERMAIRE, INC., a Texas corporation

By:
R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL ENGINEERING, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL CONSTRUCTION
RESOURCES, INC., a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL SYSTEMS, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

RPM ENGINEERING, INC.,
a Louisiana corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL TECHNOLOGIES, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL CONSTANT POWER, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

SENFTLEBER & ASSOCIATES, L.P.,
a Texas limited partnership

By: ENGlobal Design Group, Inc.,
a Texas corporation, its general
partner

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL DESIGN GROUP, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

BANK:

COMERICA BANK

By:
James R. McNutt, Sr. Vice President

EXHIBIT 10.34

FOURTH AMENDMENT TO CREDIT AGREEMENT

THIS FOURTH AMENDMENT TO CREDIT AGREEMENT (herein called this "Amendment") is executed on the date set forth on the signature pages but is made effective as of December 31, 2005, by and among ENGLOBAL CORPORATION, a Nevada Corporation ("ENGlobal Corporation"), ENGLOBAL CORPORATE SERVICES, INC., a Texas corporation ("ENGlobal Corporate"), ENGLOBAL ENGINEERING, INC., a Texas corporation ("ENGlobal Engineering"), ENGLOBAL CONSTRUCTION RESOURCES, INC., a Texas corporation ("ENGlobal Construction"), ENGLOBAL SYSTEMS, INC., a Texas corporation ("ENGlobal Systems"), RPM ENGINEERING, INC., a Louisiana corporation ("RPM Engineering"), ENGlobal Technical Services, Inc. ("ENGlobal Technical"), formerly known as ENGlobal Design Group, Inc., and ENGLOBAL AUTOMATION GROUP, INC., a Texas corporation, formerly known as ENGLOBAL TECHNOLOGIES, INC. ("ENGlobal Automation"; individually and collectively, jointly and severally, ENGlobal Corporation, ENGlobal Corporate, ENGlobal Engineering, ENGlobal Construction, ENGlobal Systems, RPM Engineering, ENGlobal Technical and ENGlobal Automation are hereinafter called "Borrower") and COMERICA BANK ("Bank").

THE RECITALS

WHEREAS, ENGlobal Corporation, ENGlobal Corporate, ENGlobal Engineering, ENGlobal Construction, ENGlobal Systems, RPM Engineering, ENGlobal Automation, ENGLOBAL TECHNICAL SERVICES, INC., a Texas corporation, formerly known as ENGLOBAL DESIGN GROUP, INC. ("ENGlobal Technical"), Thermaire, Inc., a Texas corporation ("Thermaire"), ENGlobal Constant Power, Inc., a Texas corporation ("ENGlobal Constant"), Senftleber & Associates, L.P., a Texas limited partnership ("Senftleber"), and Bank have entered into that certain Credit Agreement dated as of July 27, 2004 (as heretofore amended by a First Amendment effective as of September 30, 2004, a Second Amendment effective as of April 1, 2005 and a Third Amendment effective as of July 31, 2005, and as it may hereafter be amended, the "Original Credit Agreement"); and

WHEREAS, ENGlobal Technical, Thermaire, ENGlobal Constant and Senftleber have been dissolved; and

WHEREAS, Borrower and Bank desire to amend the Original Credit Agreement as provided herein;

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and the mutual covenants and agreements contained herein and in the Original Credit Agreement, in consideration of the loans which may hereafter be made by Bank to Borrower, and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto do hereby agree as follows:


ARTICLE I Definitions and References

Section 1.1 Terms Defined in the Original Credit Agreement. Unless the context otherwise requires or unless otherwise expressly defined herein, the terms defined in the Original Credit Agreement shall have the same meanings whenever used in this Amendment.

Section 1.2 Other Defined Terms. Unless the context otherwise requires, the following terms when used in this Amendment shall have the meanings assigned to them in this Section 1.2.

"Amendment" means this Fourth Amendment to Credit Agreement.

"Amendment Documents" means, collectively, this Amendment and any other document required to be delivered by Borrower pursuant to Article III hereof.

"Credit Agreement" means the Original Credit Agreement as amended hereby.

"Original Omnibus Certificate" means the Omnibus Certificate dated July 27, 2004 executed and delivered by officers of each Borrower pursuant to the Original Credit Agreement.

ARTICLE II Amendments to Original Credit Agreement

Section 2.1 Section 5.17 of the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by deleting the figure "$2,500,000" and substituting "3,250,000" in place thereof.

Section 2.2 The Defined Terms Addendum to the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by deleting the definition of "Agreement" and substituting therefor the following:

"'Agreement' shall mean this Credit Agreement, including the Defined Terms Addendum and the Loan Terms, Conditions and Procedures Addendum, together with all exhibits and schedules, as amended by the First Amendment, Second Amendment, Fourth Amendment and as it may be further amended from time to time."

Section 2.3 The Defined Terms Addendum to the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by adding the following definitions thereto:

"'Fourth Amendment' shall mean that certain Fourth Amendment to Credit Agreement executed on March 17, 2006 but effective as of December 31, 2005 among Borrower and Bank."

2

Section 2.4 The Loan Terms, Conditions and Procedures Addendum to the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by deleting Section 1.9(a) and substituting therefor the following:

"(a) Letters of Credit. Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents, the Bank shall, upon request from Borrower from time to time prior to the Revolving Credit Maturity Date, issue one or more Letters of Credit. The Letter of Credit Liabilities shall not exceed $8,000,000 from the date of the Third Amendment until February 28, 2006 and from February 28, 2006 the Letter of Credit Liabilities shall not exceed $3,500,000, provided that, at all times the sum of (i) the outstanding principal balance of all Revolving Loans plus (ii) the Letter of Credit Liabilities shall not exceed the Revolving Credit Maximum Amount. Letters of Credit may be issued to finance working capital needs. Each Letter of Credit issued pursuant to this Agreement shall be in a minimum amount of $25,000. No Letter of Credit shall have a stated expiration date later than thirty (30) days prior to the Revolving Credit Maturity Date."

Section 2.5 Schedule 3.5 to the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended and replaced in its entirety by Schedule 3.5 attached to this Amendment.

ARTICLE III Conditions of Effectiveness

Section 3.1 Effective Date. This Amendment shall become effective as of the date first above written when and only when Bank shall have received, at Bank's office,

(a) a duly executed counterpart of this Amendment;

(b) a duly executed counterpart of the No Oral Agreements of even date herewith; and

(c) each other document to be executed and delivered by Borrower pursuant hereto or thereto.

ARTICLE IV Representations and Warranties

Section 4.1 Representations and Warranties of Borrower. In order to induce Bank to enter into this Amendment, Borrower represents and warrants to Bank that:

(a) The representations and warranties contained in Section 3 of the Original Credit Agreement are true and correct at and as of the time of the effectiveness hereof;

(b) Borrower is duly authorized to execute and deliver this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents and is and will continue to be duly authorized to borrow and to perform its obligations under the Credit Agreement. Borrower has duly taken all corporate action necessary to authorize the execution and delivery of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents and to authorize the performance of the obligations of Borrower hereunder and thereunder. The Omnibus Certificate of each Borrower delivered to Bank on the date of the Original Credit Agreement remains in full force and effect, and the specimen signatures of the officers contained in the Omnibus Certificate are true and correct;

3

(c) The execution and delivery by Borrower of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents, the performance by Borrower of its obligations hereunder and thereunder and the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby do not and will not conflict with any provision of law, statute, rule or regulation or the bylaws or partnership agreement of Borrower, or of any material agreement, judgment, license, order or permit applicable to or binding upon Borrower, or result in the creation of any lien, charge or encumbrance upon any assets or properties of Borrower. Except for those which have been duly obtained, no consent, approval, authorization or order of any court or governmental authority or third party is required in connection with the execution and delivery by Borrower of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents or to consummate the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby;

(d) When duly executed and delivered, each of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents will be a legal and binding instrument and agreement of Borrower, enforceable in accordance with its terms, except as limited by bankruptcy, insolvency and similar laws applying to creditors' rights generally and by principles of equity applying to creditors' rights generally; and

(e) No material adverse change has occurred in the financial condition or businesses or in the consolidated financial condition or businesses of Borrower since the date of the most recently delivered financial statements.

ARTICLE V Miscellaneous

Section 5.1 Ratification of Agreement. The Original Credit Agreement as hereby amended is hereby ratified and confirmed in all respects. Any reference to the Credit Agreement in any Loan Document shall be deemed to refer to this Amendment also. The execution, delivery and effectiveness of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents shall not, except as expressly provided herein, operate as a waiver of any right, power or remedy of Bank under the Credit Agreement or any other Loan Document nor constitute a waiver of any provision of the Credit Agreement or any other Loan Document.

Section 5.2 Consent and Waiver.

(a) The Bank hereby consents to the dissolution of ENGlobal Technical, Thermaire, ENGlobal Constant and Senftleber and waives any non-compliance with Section 4.1 of the Original Credit Agreement due to the fact that ENGlobal Technical, Thermaire, ENGlobal Constant and Senftleber have been dissolved. The Bank agrees that the Borrower shall not be deemed in Default solely by reason of the dissolution of ENGlobal Technical, Thermaire, ENGlobal Constant and Senftleber.

4

(b) The foregoing waiver shall not be deemed to be a waiver by the Bank of any other covenant, condition or obligation on the part of the Borrower under the Credit Agreement or any other Loan Document. In addition, the foregoing waiver shall in no respect evidence any commitment by the Bank to grant any future consents or waivers of any covenant, condition or obligation on the part of the Borrower under the Credit Agreement or any other Loan Document. Any further waivers or consents must be specifically agreed to in writing in accordance with Section 7.10 of the Credit Agreement.

Section 5.3 Survival of Agreements. All representations, warranties, covenants and agreements of Borrower herein shall survive the execution and delivery of this Amendment and the performance hereof, and shall further survive until all of the Indebtedness is paid in full. All statements and agreements contained in any certificate or instrument delivered by Borrower hereunder or under the Credit Agreement to Bank shall be deemed to constitute representations and warranties by, or agreements and covenants of, Borrower under this Amendment and under the Credit Agreement.

Section 5.4 Loan Documents. This Amendment and the other Amendment Documents are each a Loan Document, and all provisions in the Credit Agreement pertaining to Loan Documents apply hereto and thereto.

Section 5.5 Governing Law. This Amendment shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of Texas and any applicable laws of the United States of America in all respects, including construction, validity and performance.

Section 5.6 Counterparts; Fax. This Amendment may be separately executed in counterparts and by the different parties hereto in separate counterparts, each of which when so executed shall be deemed to constitute one and the same Amendment. This Amendment may be duly executed by facsimile or other electronic transmission.

THIS AMENDMENT AND THE OTHER LOAN DOCUMENTS REPRESENT THE FINAL AGREEMENT BETWEEN THE PARTIES AND MAY NOT BE CONTRADICTED BY EVIDENCE OF PRIOR, CONTEMPORANEOUS, OR SUBSEQUENT ORAL AGREEMENTS OF THE PARTIES.

THERE ARE NO UNWRITTEN ORAL AGREEMENTS BETWEEN THE PARTIES.

[REMAINDER OF PAGE INTENTIONALLY BLANK]

5

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, this Amendment is executed on March 17, 2006 but to be effective as of December 31, 2005.

BORROWER:

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION,
a Nevada corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL CORPORATE SERVICES, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL ENGINEERING, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL CONSTRUCTION
RESOURCES, INC., a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL SYSTEMS, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

RPM ENGINEERING, INC.,
a Louisiana corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL TECHNICAL SERVICES, INC.,
a Texas corporation, formerly known as
ENGlobal Design Group, Inc.

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL AUTOMATION GROUP, INC.,
a Texas corporation, formerly known as
ENGLOBAL TECHNOLOGIES, INC.

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

BANK:

COMERICA BANK

By:
James R. McNutt, Sr. Vice President

SCHEDULE 3.5

Subsidiaries

Subsidiaries of ENGlobal Corporation:

ENGlobal Corporate Services, Inc., a Texas corporation

ENGlobal Engineering, Inc., a Texas corporation

R.P.M. Engineering, Inc., a Louisiana corporation

ENGlobal Construction Resources, Inc., a Texas corporation

ENGlobal Systems, Inc., a Texas corporation

ENGlobal Automation Group, Inc., a Texas corporation, f/k/a ENGlobal Technologies, Inc.

ENGlobal Canada ULC, an Alberta corporation

ENGlobal Technical Services, Inc., a Texas corporation, f/k/a ENGlobal Design Group, Inc.


EXHIBIT 10.35

FIFTH AMENDMENT TO CREDIT AGREEMENT

THIS FIFTH AMENDMENT TO CREDIT AGREEMENT (herein called this "Amendment") is executed on the date set forth on the signature pages but is made effective as of July 26, 2006, by and among ENGLOBAL CORPORATION, a Nevada corporation ("ENGlobal Corporation"), ENGLOBAL CORPORATE SERVICES, INC., a Texas corporation ("ENGlobal Corporate"), ENGLOBAL ENGINEERING, INC., a Texas corporation ("ENGlobal Engineering"), ENGLOBAL CONSTRUCTION RESOURCES, INC., a Texas corporation ("ENGlobal Construction"), ENGLOBAL SYSTEMS, INC., a Texas corporation ("ENGlobal Systems"), RPM ENGINEERING, INC., a Louisiana corporation ("RPM Engineering"), ENGLOBAL TECHNICAL SERVICES, INC., a Texas corporation, formerly known as ENGlobal Design Group, Inc. ("ENGlobal Technical"), ENGLOBAL AUTOMATION GROUP, INC., a Texas corporation, formerly known as ENGlobal Technologies, Inc. ("ENGlobal Automation"), PEI INVESTMENTS, A TEXAS JOINT VENTURE, a Texas general partnership ("PEI"), ENGLOBAL CANADA ULC, an Alberta corporation ("ENGlobal Canada"), WRC CORPORATION, a Colorado corporation ("WRC"), WRC CANADA LTD., an Alberta corporation ("WRC Canada"); individually and collectively, jointly and severally, ENGlobal Corporation, ENGlobal Corporate, ENGlobal Engineering, ENGlobal Construction, ENGlobal Systems, RPM Engineering, ENGlobal Technical, ENGlobal Automation, PEI, ENGlobal Canada, WRC and WRC Canada are hereinafter called "Borrower"), and COMERICA BANK ("Bank").

THE RECITALS

WHEREAS, Borrower and Bank have entered into that certain Credit Agreement dated as of July 27, 2004 (as heretofore amended by a First Amendment to Credit Agreement effective as of September 30, 2004, a Second Amendment to Credit Agreement effective as of April 1, 2005, a Third Amendment to Credit Agreement effective as of July 31, 2005, and a Fourth Amendment to Credit Agreement dated as of December 31, 2005, and as it may hereafter be amended, the "Original Credit Agreement"); and

WHEREAS, Borrower and Bank desire to amend the Original Credit Agreement as provided herein.

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and the mutual covenants and agreements contained herein and in the Original Credit Agreement, in consideration of the loans which may hereafter be made by Bank to Borrower, and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto do hereby agree as follows:

ARTICLE I Definitions and References

Section 1.1 Terms Defined in the Original Credit Agreement. Unless the context otherwise requires or unless otherwise expressly defined herein, the terms defined in the Original Credit Agreement shall have the same meanings whenever used in this Amendment.


Section 1.2 Other Defined Terms. Unless the context otherwise requires, the following terms when used in this Amendment shall have the meanings assigned to them in this Section 1.2.

"Amendment" means this Fifth Amendment to Credit Agreement.

"Amendment Documents" means, collectively, this Amendment and any other document required to be delivered by Borrower pursuant to Article III hereof.

"Credit Agreement" means the Original Credit Agreement, as amended hereby.

"Original Omnibus Certificate" means the Omnibus Certificate dated July 27, 2004 executed and delivered by officers of each Borrower pursuant to the Original Credit Agreement.

ARTICLE II Amendments to Original Credit Agreement

Section 2.1 Sections 4.3(c), (d) and (e) of the Original Credit Agreement are modified by deleting "thirty (30) days" in each instance and substituting "forty-five (45) days" therefor.

Section 2.2 The Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by deleting
Section 4.4(c) and substituting therefor the following:

"(c) Maximum Leverage Ratio. Maintain as of the last day of each calendar month during the term of this Agreement a ratio of Funded Debt to Adjusted EBITDA for the twelve (12) months ending on each date occurring during the term of this Agreement no greater than 3.00 to 1; provided that, for purposes of this covenant and subject to Bank approval, Adjusted EBITDA shall have added back the trailing 12-month EBITDA of new acquisitions exceeding a gross purchase price of $2,500,000; provided further that for any calculation hereunder that includes a calendar month prior to the date of Borrower's purchase of AmTech Inspection, Cleveland Inspection or WRC (each hereinafter called, an "Acquisition" and each month occurring before an Acquisition, being a "Pre-Acquisition Month"), Adjusted EBITDA shall include, for each Pre-Acquisition Month, a number equal to (i) the Adjusted EBITDA of AmTech Inspection, Cleveland Inspection or WRC (as applicable) for each calendar month after the applicable Acquisition divided by (ii) the number of calendar months since the applicable Acquisition."

2

Section 2.3 The Defined Terms Addendum to the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by deleting the definition of "Agreement" and substituting therefor the following:

"'Agreement' shall mean this Credit Agreement, including the Defined Terms Addendum and the Loan Terms, Conditions and Procedures Addendum, together with all exhibits and schedules, as amended by the First Amendment, Second Amendment, Third Amendment, Fourth Amendment, and Fifth Amendment, and as it may be further amended from time to time."

Section 2.4 The Defined Terms Addendum to the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by adding the following definitions thereto:

"'Fifth Amendment' shall mean that certain Fifth Amendment to Credit Agreement as of July 26, 2006 among Borrower and Bank."

Section 2.5 The Defined Terms Addendum to the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by deleting "July 26, 2007" from the definition of "Revolving Credit Maturity Date" and substituting "July 26, 2009" in place thereof.

Section 2.6 The Defined Terms Addendum to the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by deleting the definition of "Revolving Credit Maximum Amount" and substituting therefore the following:

"'Revolving Credit Maximum Amount' shall mean THIRTY MILLION DOLLARS ($30,000,000)."

Section 2.7 The Defined Terms Addendum to the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by deleting the definition of "Revolving Credit Note" and substituting therefore the following:

"'Revolving Credit Note' shall mean the Master Revolving Note-Eurodollar Rate-Maturity Date-Committed dated July 27, 2004, in the original principal amount of $22,000,000 made by Borrower payable to the order of the Bank, as renewed, extended, modified, and enlarged on July 26, 2006, to the amount of $30,000,000 made by Borrower payable to the order of the Bank, in accordance with the terms of the Fifth Amendment of even date therewith, and as renewed, extended, modified, increased or restated from time to time."

Section 2.8 The Loan Terms, Conditions and Procedures Addendum to the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by deleting Section 1.9(a) and substituting therefor the following:

3

"(a) Letters of Credit. Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents, the Bank shall, upon request from Borrower from time to time prior to the Revolving Credit Maturity Date, issue one or more Letters of Credit. The Letter of Credit Liabilities shall not exceed $1,000,000, provided that, at all times the sum of (i) the outstanding principal balance of all Revolving Loans plus (ii) the Letter of Credit Liabilities shall not exceed the Revolving Credit Maximum Amount. Letters of Credit may be issued to finance working capital needs. Each Letter of Credit issued pursuant to this Agreement shall be in a minimum amount of $25,000. No Letter of Credit shall have a stated expiration date later than thirty (30) days prior to the Revolving Credit Maturity Date."

Section 2.9 Schedule 3.5 to the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended and replaced in its entirety by Schedule 3.5 attached to this Amendment.

ARTICLE III Conditions of Effectiveness

Section 3.1 Effective Date. This Amendment shall become effective as of the date first above written when and only when Bank shall have received, at Bank's office,

(a) a duly executed counterpart of this Amendment to be executed by Borrower;

(b) a Master Revolving Note-Eurodollar Rate-Maturity Date-Committed of even date herewith to be executed by Borrower;

(c) an Act of Supplement and Amendment and Notice of Reinscription of Act of Mortgage and Security Agreement of even date herewith to be executed by RPM Engineering, Inc. and recorded in East Baton Rouge Parish, Louisiana;

(d) a Security Agreement (Accounts Receivable and Equipment) of even date herewith to be executed by PEI Investments, a Texas Joint Venture, ENGlobal Canada ULC, WRC Corporation, and WRC Canada Ltd.;

(e) a duly executed counterpart of the No Oral Agreements of even date herewith to be executed by Borrower

(f) a duly executed certificate of the partners, chief financial officer and secretary of each of PEI Investments, a Texas Joint Venture, ENGlobal Canada ULC, WRC Corporation, and WRC Canada Ltd. certifying that
(i) resolutions of its board of directors attached to the Original Omnibus Certificate authorizing the execution, delivery, and performance of this Amendment and identifying the officers authorized to sign such instrument are in full force and effect and (ii) the specimen signatures of the officers so authorized which were attached to the Original Omnibus Certificate are true and correct; and

4

(g) each other document to be executed and delivered by Borrower pursuant hereto or thereto.

ARTICLE IV Representations and Warranties

Section 4.1 Representations and Warranties of Borrower. In order to induce Bank to enter into this Amendment, Borrower represents and warrants to Bank that:

(a) The representations and warranties contained in Section 3 of the Original Credit Agreement are true and correct at and as of the time of the effectiveness hereof;

(b) Borrower is duly authorized to execute and deliver this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents and is and will continue to be duly authorized to borrow and to perform its obligations under the Credit Agreement. Borrower has duly taken all corporate action necessary to authorize the execution and delivery of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents and to authorize the performance of the obligations of Borrower hereunder and thereunder. The Omnibus Certificate of each Borrower delivered to Bank on the date of the Original Credit Agreement remains in full force and effect, and the specimen signatures of the officers contained in the Omnibus Certificate are true and correct;

(c) The execution and delivery by Borrower of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents, the performance by Borrower of its obligations hereunder and thereunder and the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby do not and will not conflict with any provision of law, statute, rule or regulation or the bylaws or partnership agreement of Borrower, or of any material agreement, judgment, license, order or permit applicable to or binding upon Borrower, or result in the creation of any lien, charge or encumbrance upon any assets or properties of Borrower. Except for those which have been duly obtained, no consent, approval, authorization or order of any court or governmental authority or third party is required in connection with the execution and delivery by Borrower of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents or to consummate the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby;

(d) When duly executed and delivered, each of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents will be a legal and binding instrument and agreement of Borrower, enforceable in accordance with its terms, except as limited by bankruptcy, insolvency and similar laws applying to creditors' rights generally and by principles of equity applying to creditors' rights generally; and

5

(e) No material adverse change has occurred in the financial condition or businesses or in the consolidated financial condition or businesses of Borrower since the date of the most recently delivered financial statements.

ARTICLE V Miscellaneous

Section 5.1 Ratification of Agreement. The Original Credit Agreement as hereby amended is hereby ratified and confirmed in all respects. Any reference to the Credit Agreement in any Loan Document shall be deemed to refer to this Amendment also. The execution, delivery and effectiveness of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents shall not, except as expressly provided herein, operate as a waiver of any right, power or remedy of Bank under the Credit Agreement or any other Loan Document nor constitute a waiver of any provision of the Credit Agreement or any other Loan Document.

Section 5.2 Survival of Agreements. All representations, warranties, covenants and agreements of Borrower herein shall survive the execution and delivery of this Amendment and the performance hereof, and shall further survive until all of the Indebtedness is paid in full. All statements and agreements contained in any certificate or instrument delivered by Borrower hereunder or under the Credit Agreement to Bank shall be deemed to constitute representations and warranties by, or agreements and covenants of, Borrower under this Amendment and under the Credit Agreement.

Section 5.3 Loan Documents. This Amendment and the other Amendment Documents are each a Loan Document, and all provisions in the Credit Agreement pertaining to Loan Documents apply hereto and thereto.

Section 5.4 Governing Law. This Amendment shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of Texas and any applicable laws of the United States of America in all respects, including construction, validity and performance.

Section 5.5 Counterparts; Fax. This Amendment may be separately executed in counterparts and by the different parties hereto in separate counterparts, each of which when so executed shall be deemed to constitute one and the same Amendment. This Amendment may be duly executed by facsimile or other electronic transmission.

THIS AMENDMENT AND THE OTHER LOAN DOCUMENTS REPRESENT THE FINAL AGREEMENT BETWEEN THE PARTIES AND MAY NOT BE CONTRADICTED BY EVIDENCE OF PRIOR, CONTEMPORANEOUS, OR SUBSEQUENT ORAL AGREEMENTS OF THE PARTIES.

THERE ARE NO UNWRITTEN ORAL AGREEMENTS BETWEEN THE PARTIES.

[REMAINDER OF PAGE INTENTIONALLY BLANK]

6

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, this Amendment is effective as of July 26, 2006.

BORROWER:

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION,
a Nevada corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL CORPORATE SERVICES, INC.,
a Texas corporation
s

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL ENGINEERING, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL CONSTRUCTION
RESOURCES, INC., a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL SYSTEMS, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

RPM ENGINEERING, INC.,
a Louisiana corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL TECHNICAL SERVICES, INC.,
a Texas corporation, formerly known as
ENGlobal Design Group, Inc.

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL AUTOMATION GROUP, INC.,
a Texas corporation, formerly known as
ENGlobal Technologies, Inc.

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

PEI INVESTMENTS, A TEXAS JOINT
VENTURE, a Texas general partnership

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL CANADA ULC,
an Alberta corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

WRC CORPORATION,
a Colorado corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

WRC CANADA LTD.,
an Alberta corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

BANK:

COMERICA BANK

By:

James R. McNutt, Sr. Vice President--Texas Division

SCHEDULE 3.5

Subsidiaries

Subsidiaries of ENGlobal Corporation:

ENGlobal Corporate Services, Inc., a Texas corporation

ENGlobal Engineering, Inc., a Texas corporation

RPM Engineering, Inc., a Louisiana corporation

ENGlobal Construction Resources, Inc., a Texas corporation

ENGlobal Systems, Inc., a Texas corporation

ENGlobal Automation Group, Inc., a Texas corporation, f/k/a ENGlobal Technologies, Inc.

ENGlobal Technical Services, Inc., a Texas corporation, f/k/a ENGlobal Design Group, Inc.

PEI Investments, a Texas Joint Venture, a Texas general partnership

ENGlobal Canada ULC, an Alberta corporation

WRC Corporation, a Colorado corporation

WRC Canada Ltd., an Alberta corporation


EXHIBIT 10.36

SIXTH AMENDMENT TO CREDIT AGREEMENT

THIS SIXTH AMENDMENT TO CREDIT AGREEMENT (herein called this "Amendment") is executed on March 3, 2007 but is effective as of December 31, 2006, by and among ENGLOBAL CORPORATION, a Nevada corporation ("ENGlobal Corporation"), ENGLOBAL CORPORATE SERVICES, INC., a Texas corporation ("ENGlobal Corporate"), ENGLOBAL ENGINEERING, INC., a Texas corporation ("ENGlobal Engineering"), ENGLOBAL CONSTRUCTION RESOURCES, INC., a Texas corporation ("ENGlobal Construction"), ENGLOBAL SYSTEMS, INC., a Texas corporation ("ENGlobal Systems"), RPM ENGINEERING, INC., a Louisiana corporation ("RPM Engineering"), ENGLOBAL TECHNICAL SERVICES, INC., a Texas corporation, formerly known as ENGlobal Design Group, Inc. ("ENGlobal Technical"), ENGLOBAL AUTOMATION GROUP, INC., a Texas corporation, formerly known as ENGlobal Technologies, Inc. ("ENGlobal Automation"), PEI INVESTMENTS, A TEXAS JOINT VENTURE, a Texas general partnership ("PEI"), ENGLOBAL CANADA ULC, an Alberta corporation ("ENGlobal Canada"), WRC CORPORATION, a Colorado corporation ("WRC"), and WRC CANADA LTD., an Alberta corporation ("WRC Canada"); individually and collectively, jointly and severally, ENGlobal Corporation, ENGlobal Corporate, ENGlobal Engineering, ENGlobal Construction, ENGlobal Systems, RPM Engineering, ENGlobal Technical, ENGlobal Automation, PEI, ENGlobal Canada, WRC and WRC Canada are hereinafter called "Borrower"), and COMERICA BANK ("Bank").

THE RECITALS

WHEREAS, Borrower and Bank have entered into that certain Credit Agreement dated as of July 27, 2004 (as heretofore amended by a First Amendment to Credit Agreement effective as of September 30, 2004, a Second Amendment to Credit Agreement effective as of April 1, 2005, a Third Amendment to Credit Agreement effective as of July 31, 2005, a Fourth Amendment to Credit Agreement dated as of December 31, 2005, and a Fifth Amendment to Credit Agreement effective as of July 26, 2006, and as it may hereafter be amended, the "Original Credit Agreement"); and

WHEREAS, Borrower and Bank desire to amend the Original Credit Agreement as provided herein.

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and the mutual covenants and agreements contained herein and in the Original Credit Agreement, in consideration of the loans which may hereafter be made by Bank to Borrower, and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto do hereby agree as follows:


ARTICLE I Definitions and References

Section 1.1 Terms Defined in the Original Credit Agreement. Unless the context otherwise requires or unless otherwise expressly defined herein, the terms defined in the Original Credit Agreement shall have the same meanings whenever used in this Amendment.

Section 1.2 Other Defined Terms. Unless the context otherwise requires, the following terms when used in this Amendment shall have the meanings assigned to them in this Section 1.2.

"Amendment" means this Sixth Amendment to Credit Agreement.

"Amendment Documents" means, collectively, this Amendment and any other document required to be delivered by Borrower pursuant to Article III hereof.

"Credit Agreement" means the Original Credit Agreement, as amended hereby.

"Original Omnibus Certificate" means the Omnibus Certificate dated July 27, 2004 executed and delivered by officers of each Borrower pursuant to the Original Credit Agreement.

ARTICLE II Amendments to Original Credit Agreement

Section 2.1 The Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by deleting
Section 4.4(b) and substituting therefor the following:

"(b) Minimum Net Worth. Maintain as of the last day of each calendar quarter during the term of this Agreement a minimum Net Worth of not less than the sum of (i) $40,116,000 plus (ii) 75% of Net Income earned in each fiscal quarter beginning with the quarter ending March 31, 2007 (without deduction for losses) plus (iii) 100% of the net proceeds of any offering, sale or other transfer of any capital stock or equity securities of any kind of the Borrower after the date hereof; provided for purposes of this covenant adjustments may be made for any non-recurring transaction costs incurred by Borrower."

Section 2.2 The Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by deleting
Section 4.4(c) and substituting therefor the following:

"(c) Maximum Leverage Ratio. Maintain as of the last day of each calendar month during the term of this Agreement a ratio of Funded Debt to Adjusted EBITDA for the twelve (12) months ending on each date occurring during the term of this Agreement no greater than 3.00 to 1; provided that, for purposes of this covenant and subject to Bank approval, Adjusted EBITDA shall have added back (A) the trailing 12-month EBITDA of new acquisitions exceeding a gross purchase price of $2,500,000; provided further that for any calculation hereunder that includes a calendar month prior to the date


of Borrower's purchase of AmTech Inspection, Cleveland Inspection or WRC (each hereinafter called, an "Acquisition" and each month occurring before an Acquisition, being a "Pre-Acquisition Month"), Adjusted EBITDA shall include, for each Pre-Acquisition Month, a number equal to (i) the Adjusted EBITDA of AmTech Inspection, Cleveland Inspection or WRC (as applicable) for each calendar month after the applicable Acquisition divided by (ii) the number of calendar months since the applicable Acquisition and (B) expenses associated with Borrower's issuance and/or granting of stock options to Borrower's directors and employees; provided further that for any calculation hereunder, Adjusted EBITDA shall exclude losses associated with the ConocoPhillips-Ferndale, Washington project which have occurred prior to January 1, 2007."

Section 2.3 Waiver.

(a) Bank hereby waives any non-compliance by the Borrower with Section 4.4(c) of the Original Credit Agreement for the month's ending November 31, 2006 and December 31, 2006 and Bank agrees that the Borrower shall not be deemed in Default, nor shall any Event of Default be deemed to have existed, solely by reason of any such non-compliance.

(b) Bank hereby waives any non-compliance by the Borrower with Section 5.17 of the Original Credit Agreement for the fiscal year ending December 31, 2006 and Bank agrees that the Borrower shall not be deemed in Default, nor shall any Event of Default be deemed to have existed, solely by reason of any such non-compliance during such fiscal year; provided Borrower's actual expenditures or commitments to acquire fixed assets by lease, purchase or otherwise for the fiscal year ending December 31, 2006 do not exceed in the aggregate $3,500,000.

(c) The foregoing waivers shall not be deemed to be a waiver by the Bank of any other covenant, condition or obligation on the part of the Borrower under the Original Credit Agreement or any other Loan Document, except as set forth in this Section 2.3. In addition, the foregoing waivers shall in no respect evidence any commitment by the Bank to grant any future consents or waivers of any covenant, condition or obligation on the part of the Borrower under the Original Credit Agreement or any other Loan Document. Any further waivers or consents must be specifically agreed to in writing in accordance with Section 7.10.

Section 2.4 The Defined Terms Addendum to the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by deleting the definition of "Agreement" and substituting therefor the following:

"'Agreement' shall mean this Credit Agreement, including the Defined Terms Addendum and the Loan Terms, Conditions and Procedures Addendum, together with all exhibits and schedules, as amended by the First Amendment, Second Amendment, Third Amendment, Fourth Amendment, Fifth Amendment, and Sixth Amendment, and as it may be further amended from time to time."


Section 2.5 The Defined Terms Addendum to the Original Credit Agreement is hereby amended by adding the following definitions thereto:

"'Sixth Amendment' shall mean that certain Sixth Amendment to Credit Agreement effective as of December 31, 2006 among Borrower and Bank."

ARTICLE III Conditions of Effectiveness

Section 3.1 Effective Date. This Amendment shall become effective as of the date first above written when and only when Bank shall have received, at Bank's office,

(a) a duly executed counterpart of this Amendment to be executed by Borrower;

(b) a duly executed counterpart of the No Oral Agreements of even date herewith to be executed by Borrower; and

(c) each other document to be executed and delivered by Borrower pursuant hereto or thereto.

ARTICLE IV Representations and Warranties

Section 4.1 Representations and Warranties of Borrower. In order to induce Bank to enter into this Amendment, Borrower represents and warrants to Bank that:

(a) The representations and warranties contained in Section 3 of the Original Credit Agreement are true and correct at and as of the time of the effectiveness hereof;

(b) Borrower is duly authorized to execute and deliver this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents and is and will continue to be duly authorized to borrow and to perform its obligations under the Credit Agreement. Borrower has duly taken all corporate action necessary to authorize the execution and delivery of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents and to authorize the performance of the obligations of Borrower hereunder and thereunder. The Omnibus Certificate of each Borrower delivered to Bank on the date of the Original Credit Agreement remains in full force and effect, and the specimen signatures of the officers contained in the Omnibus Certificate are true and correct;


(c) The execution and delivery by Borrower of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents, the performance by Borrower of its obligations hereunder and thereunder and the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby do not and will not conflict with any provision of law, statute, rule or regulation or the bylaws or partnership agreement of Borrower, or of any material agreement, judgment, license, order or permit applicable to or binding upon Borrower, or result in the creation of any lien, charge or encumbrance upon any assets or properties of Borrower. Except for those which have been duly obtained, no consent, approval, authorization or order of any court or governmental authority or third party is required in connection with the execution and delivery by Borrower of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents or to consummate the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby;

(d) When duly executed and delivered, each of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents will be a legal and binding instrument and agreement of Borrower, enforceable in accordance with its terms, except as limited by bankruptcy, insolvency and similar laws applying to creditors' rights generally and by principles of equity applying to creditors' rights generally; and

(e) No material adverse change has occurred in the financial condition or businesses or in the consolidated financial condition or businesses of Borrower since the date of the most recently delivered financial statements.

ARTICLE V Miscellaneous

Section 5.1 Ratification of Agreement. The Original Credit Agreement as hereby amended is hereby ratified and confirmed in all respects. Any reference to the Credit Agreement in any Loan Document shall be deemed to refer to this Amendment also. The execution, delivery and effectiveness of this Amendment and the other Amendment Documents shall not, except as expressly provided herein, operate as a waiver of any right, power or remedy of Bank under the Credit Agreement or any other Loan Document nor constitute a waiver of any provision of the Credit Agreement or any other Loan Document.

Section 5.2 Survival of Agreements. All representations, warranties, covenants and agreements of Borrower herein shall survive the execution and delivery of this Amendment and the performance hereof, and shall further survive until all of the Indebtedness is paid in full. All statements and agreements contained in any certificate or instrument delivered by Borrower hereunder or under the Credit Agreement to Bank shall be deemed to constitute representations and warranties by, or agreements and covenants of, Borrower under this Amendment and under the Credit Agreement.

Section 5.3 Loan Documents. This Amendment and the other Amendment Documents are each a Loan Document, and all provisions in the Credit Agreement pertaining to Loan Documents apply hereto and thereto.

Section 5.4 Governing Law. This Amendment shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of Texas and any applicable laws of the United States of America in all respects, including construction, validity and performance.


Section 5.5 Counterparts; Fax. This Amendment may be separately executed in counterparts and by the different parties hereto in separate counterparts, each of which when so executed shall be deemed to constitute one and the same Amendment. This Amendment may be duly executed by facsimile or other electronic transmission.

THIS AMENDMENT AND THE OTHER LOAN DOCUMENTS REPRESENT THE FINAL AGREEMENT BETWEEN THE PARTIES AND MAY NOT BE CONTRADICTED BY EVIDENCE OF PRIOR, CONTEMPORANEOUS, OR SUBSEQUENT ORAL AGREEMENTS OF THE PARTIES.

THERE ARE NO UNWRITTEN ORAL AGREEMENTS BETWEEN THE PARTIES.

[REMAINDER OF PAGE INTENTIONALLY BLANK]

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, this Amendment is effective as of December 31, 2006.

BORROWER:

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION,
a Nevada corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL CORPORATE SERVICES, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL ENGINEERING, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL CONSTRUCTION
RESOURCES, INC., a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL SYSTEMS, INC.,
a Texas corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

RPM ENGINEERING, INC.,
a Louisiana corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL TECHNICAL SERVICES, INC.,
a Texas corporation, formerly known as
ENGlobal Design Group, Inc.

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL AUTOMATION GROUP, INC.,
a Texas corporation, formerly known as
ENGlobal Technologies, Inc.

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

PEI INVESTMENTS, A TEXAS JOINT
VENTURE, a Texas general partnership

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

ENGLOBAL CANADA ULC,
an Alberta corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

WRC CORPORATION,
a Colorado corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

WRC CANADA LTD.,
an Alberta corporation

By:

R.W. Raiford, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

BANK:

COMERICA BANK

By:

James R. McNutt, Sr. Vice President--Texas Division

  Key Manager Incentive Plan  


1.    PURPOSE

     1.1     The purpose of this Key Manager Incentive Plan (the “ Plan ”) is to incentivize certain key managers of ENGlobal Corporation (the “ Company ”) and its subsidiaries to promote the Company’s core values, which are described in Section 5. Employees may participate in only one ENGlobal Incentive Plan at a time. Eligible Participants in the Company’s Executive Level Incentive Plan, or any other plans, shall not be entitled to participate in this Plan.

     1.2    This Plan has been approved by the Board of Directors on December 16, 2004, to be effective as of January 1, 2005, and amended by the Board of Directors on March 28, 2006, to be effective as of January 1, 2006.

2.    ELIGIBLE PARTICIPANTS

     2.1    Participants shall include individuals who have been guaranteed participation in this Plan through specific provisions in their employment contracts and may also include subsidiary presidents (or equivalent), profit center (divisional) managers and officers, business development managers and officers, and key departmental and project management personnel, unless they are eligible to participate in a separate bonus plan (“ Eligible Participants ”). The Company will pay bonuses under this Plan only to those Eligible Participants who are employed on a regular, full-time basis on the last day (the “ Bonus Determination Date ”) of each calendar year (each, a “ Bonus Period ”) for which the bonus is paid. Unless otherwise prohibited by law, an employee whose employment with the Company or its subsidiaries is terminated for any reason prior to the Bonus Determination Date for a particular Bonus Period will not be eligible to receive any bonus under this Plan based on his performance in that Bonus Period.

     2.2    The Chief Executive Officer, with the approval of the Board of Directors, may change the positions that qualify as Eligible Participants as he determines appropriate from time to time.

     2.3    If the Chief Executive Officer, after consultation with the Company’s Chairman of the Board and Chief Financial Officer (the “ Management Bonus Committee ”), determines that an Eligible Participant has exhibited bad behavior, poor teamwork, or unsafe work practices, has failed to comply with Company policies and procedures or risk management practices, has used Company funds inappropriately, or has engaged in similar types of behavior, he shall not be entitled to receive a bonus until the Chief Executive Officer has determined that the behavior has been corrected. In making the determination to restore the Eligible Participant’s right to a bonus, the Chief Executive Officer shall consult with the members of the Management Bonus Committee and the person who supervises the Eligible Participant.

     2.4    The fact that an individual is an Eligible Participant does not guarantee that he will receive a bonus under this Plan. Rather, payment of a bonus under this Plan is entirely discretionary and will depend on the Company’s evaluation of the individual’s performance, as more particularly described in this Plan.

1


  Key Manager Incentive Plan  


3.    BONUS DETERMINATIONS

     3.1    Following the end of each Bonus Period, the Chief Executive Officer will consult with each member of the Management Bonus Committee to discuss how the total bonus pool shall be divided among the Eligible Participants and if portions of the Bonus Pool shall be set aside for certain key managers (the “ Supervising Managers ”) to distribute to Eligible Participants under their supervision, as further described in Section 3.2. The substance and results of the consultations between the Chief Executive Officer and the other members of the Management Bonus Committee shall be documented. Following the consultations, the Chief Executive Officer will determine which Eligible Participants will receive a bonus for that Bonus Period and the amounts of funds to be allocated to Supervising Managers for further distribution to Eligible Participants who are their subordinates. The Chief Executive Officer and the members of the Management Bonus Committee will seek to reach a consensus decision on the payment of bonuses; however, lacking a consensus, the Chief Executive Officer will be entitled to make the final decision.

     3.2    Only individuals who report directly to the members of the Management Bonus Committee are eligible to be Supervising Managers. As an example, the presidents of the Company’s subsidiaries, and other key managerial positions who report to any member of the Management Bonus Committee are eligible to serve as Supervising Managers. The Supervising Managers shall evaluate Eligible Participants who are their subordinates using the criteria described in this Plan. Without the approval of the Chief Executive Officer, bonuses may not be awarded to any employees below the level of department head (for both billable and overhead positions) or to any project manager. The Company intends that this Plan be used to reward a smaller number of individuals with bonuses large enough to incentivize individuals to promote the goals and objectives described in this Plan. Based on studies reviewed by members of the Management Bonus Committee, it appears that this typically cannot be achieved with bonuses that are less than 7% of an individual’s annual salary. Supervising Managers should keep this in mind in awarding bonuses to their subordinates.

     3.3    Notwithstanding the other provisions herein, no bonus (other than the safety bonus, if earned) shall be paid to any profit center manager whose contribution to the Company’s net operating income for the Bonus Period is significantly below the budgeted contribution to net operating income for that profit center as set forth in the Annual Budget . Likewise, no bonus shall be paid to any profit center manager (other than the Safety Bonus, if earned) if the actual departmental costs for his profit center are significantly above (on a percentage of revenue basis) those provided for in the Annual Budget.

     3.4    The Chief Executive Officer shall also have the final authority to resolve all disputes that may arise related to this Plan. The Chief Executive Officer’s decisions will be without recourse by members of the Management Bonus Committee or the affected employees. This Plan is not intended to be, and does not constitute, a contract between the Company and any Eligible Participant or other employee. This Plan may be revised or terminated at any time by the Board of Directors without prior notice to, or the consent of, any of the Eligible Participants.

2


  Key Manager Incentive Plan  


4.    BONUS POOL AND BONUS PAYMENTS

     4.1    As long as this Plan is in effect, at the end of each Bonus Period, the Company shall designate an amount of money (the “Bonus Pool ”) to be used for the payment of bonuses to Eligible Participants. The amount of the Bonus Pool shall be determined by reference to the Company’s Adjusted Earnings per Share (as herein defined) as compared to its prior year’s Adjusted Earnings per Share for the relevant period. “ Adjusted Earnings per Share ” shall mean the Company’s actual Earnings per Share for the Bonus Period as stated in the Company’s audited financial statements filed with its Annual Report on Form 10-K, but adjusted each year to exclude unusual or infrequent transactions. The amount of the “Bonus Pool” shall be determined as follows:

     4.2    If the Company’s adjusted earnings per share ( “EPS” ) for the year for which the bonus is being paid (the “ Current Year ”), after subtracting any and all incentive compensation, exceeds adjusted EPS in the immediately preceding calendar year (the “ Base Year”), then the Company shall contribute to the Bonus Pool in the amounts, and with the restrictions, as set below.

(1)  

$65,000 for each penny per share of earnings the Company makes which is over and above the prior year’s EPS.


(2)  

Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, the total Bonus Pool for this plan, plus the Executive Level Incentive Plan, shall not exceed 13.10% of adjusted pre-tax, pre-bonus earnings.


     4.3    Bonus payments, if due hereunder, will be made within 75 days following the end of each year.

     4.4    The manner in which the total Bonus Pool is determined may be modified from time to time by the Board of Directors, without prior notice to the Participants. Notwithstanding the percentages set forth herein, unless the Board of Directors authorizes additional funding, the total of all Bonus Pools, including the Executive Level Incentive Plan and any other bonuses, for any Bonus Period shall not exceed 13.10% of adjusted pre-tax, pre-bonus earnings.

     4.5    In the discretion of the Chief Executive Officer, after consultation with the Management Bonus Committee, an amount equal to 10% to 15% of the total Bonus Pool may be allocated for any employees exhibiting performance over and above requirements of their position, when their performance has resulted in the addition of new clients, an improvement in the Company’s financial performance, the award of new projects, or other significant activities that reflect the Company’s core values as defined in this Plan. If this amount is not awarded for any Bonus Period, it may, at the election of the Chief Executive Officer, be added to the Bonus Pool for the next Bonus Period.

     4.6    Bonus payments, if due hereunder, will be made no later than 75 days following the end of the Bonus Period or, if earlier, within 10 days after the Company files its Annual Report on Form 10-K for the Bonus Period.

3


  Key Manager Incentive Plan  


5.    CORE VALUE SYSTEM

     This Plan is intended to reward performance that reinforces and supports the Company’s core values as applicable for each Eligible Participant. The evaluations for non-profit center managers (e.g. Accounting, HR, IR, Governance and IT) shall be adjusted for their “spheres of influence.” For example, “client satisfaction” would be measured based on “internal client satisfaction” for accounting managers as opposed to “external client satisfaction” for operations managers. In making bonus determinations, the Chief Executive Officer and the Management Bonus Committee will consider the following:

     5.1    Safety and Security

 

      (a) The safety and security of the Company’s employees and contractors is of paramount importance. Each manager who takes every required monthly safety test, who has not sustained any recordable injuries to himself, and who has a recordable incident rate of less than 0.5 for the group of employees (if any) under his control during the 12-month period ending on the Bonus Determination Date shall receive an automatic bonus equal to 10% of the Bonus Pool multiplied by a fraction, the numerator of which is one and the denominator of which is the total number of Eligible Participants on the Bonus Determination Date.


 

      (b) Notwithstanding Section 5.1(a), if a majority of the members of the Management Bonus Committee determines that any manager has acted in a manner that endangers the safety of the Company’s employees, he shall not be entitled to receive a bonus under this Plan until further notice.


     5.2    Financial Results

     As a public corporation, the Company is in the business of creating value for its shareholders. Consequently, for Eligible Participants who are responsible for profits or for a budget, the Company will consider each Eligible Participant’s performance in accomplishing his budget. Just as project managers are accountable for project budgets even though they may not have personally prepared the project estimate, managers are accountable to meet the budgets approved by the Board of Directors even if the approved budget differs from the budget submitted by the manager. If a manager fails to meet his budget for any Bonus Period without valid reasons, he may not be eligible for a bonus for that Bonus Period. For operations (profit center) managers, the primary budget number to be considered will be the Net Operating Income from the profit center (without any allocation of corporate general and administrative expenses) as determined in the Company’s consolidated financial statements. The Company will also consider actual variable overhead costs, actual general and administrative expenses, and accounts receivable balances greater than 60 days outstanding and actual income earned.

     5.3     Marketing

     Since higher profits are critical to the Company’s success, the Company places a high value on successful sales and marketing efforts. The Company may develop a point system to measure individual marketing efforts and to be considered in awarding bonuses. Until then, the Company will consider monthly marketing reports as well as the growth in an Eligible Participant’s particular area of operations in determining each business development manager’s bonus.

4


  Key Manager Incentive Plan  


     5.4    Work-Sharing and Cooperation

     The Company values high employee utilization rates and cross-marketing efforts. One of the Company’s key strategic goals is to encourage profit centers to work together. This Plan recognizes this in two ways: (1) the Bonus Pool is based on the consolidated profits of the Company, and (2) Eligible Participants will be evaluated on how well they cooperate with other divisions and departments through work-sharing, cross-marketing, and other types of assistance. The Company is able to serve its clients better through the strength of its combined operations rather than on a strictly local or individualized basis. During slow work periods, the Company’s goal is to keep the best people, no matter what office they are working in, by placing them on other work, if necessary, from other offices outside their local area. Under-utilization of employees is detrimental to the Company. Eligible Participants who encourage full utilization of all employees, work-sharing among Company locations and divisions, and cross-marketing will be favorably considered for a bonus under this Plan.

     5.5    Client Satisfaction

     The Company operates in a competitive environment in which clients require the Company to accept ever-increasing liability and accountability for its employees’ actions. Consequently, satisfying clients under these conditions can be difficult. Nevertheless, the Company reinforces the concept that it is in business to satisfy its clients and to obtain repeat business. The Company will give favorable consideration to Eligible Participants who succeed in this endeavor.

     5.6     Entrepreneurial Spirit

     The Company recognizes that it will be difficult to achieve significant growth internally without new business ventures and investments in new key personnel. Thus, the Company encourages its managers to make well thought out entrepreneurial decisions. Managers who have an entrepreneurial idea that they believe could help the Company achieve its goals should submit a business plan in Executive Summary format to the Chief Executive Officer for his consideration, and if appropriate, for his presentation to the Board of Directors.

     5.7     Growth Contribution

     Typically, the largest operations contribute the highest profits to the Company’s consolidated results, giving the managers of those operations the opportunity to earn a significant bonus under this Plan. However, managers of smaller operations can also qualify for a substantial bonus by achieving significant growth in the operations they manage. As a publicly traded company, the Company is seeking to be a high growth company. The Company anticipates that much of the Company’s growth will be derived from acquisitions; however, internal growth typically creates even more value for the Company’s stock. Consequently, the Company will award bonuses to managers of operations that grow significantly and in a manner that is sustainable. Because it is often easier for smaller operations to achieve a higher rate of growth, managers of small operations will also have an opportunity to receive a significant bonus. Criteria for measuring growth shall include the following weighted equally:

5


  Key Manager Incentive Plan  


(1)  

Revenue growth year over year (% and total dollars).


(2)  

Earnings growth year over year (% and total dollars).


(3)  

Percentage growth in earnings relative to other profit centers.


     5.8    Long-Term Stability and Risk Management

     The Company’s management expects each division to grow in a sustainable fashion and to create as much stability as the marketplace allows. It is relatively easy to show very fast growth rates by taking on high risk projects, such as lump sum and fixed price work. While the Company has no general objection to that type of work, it does expect the profitability of such work to be commensurate with the risks. Additionally, the Company expects the managers in charge to be diligent in managing risks so that the Company will not sustain significant losses even if a project does not go as planned. The Company may conduct audits of such projects to see if they were bid and performed in accordance with the Company’s procedures for risk management, safety, cost control, and scheduling. Fast growth will not be rewarded if the growth was obtained through undertaking unreasonable risks.

     5.9     Market Share

     Because many clients utilize alliances and partnerships with engineering firms like the Company, market share has become even more important than in the past. The Company’s goal is to be number one or two in its local, geographical area within the niche markets that it serves. These goals will be easier to obtain in markets outside of large oil and gas complexes like the Houston area. The Houston goal is to become one of the primary players in that marketplace. In the other geographical areas that the Company currently serves, the goal is to be number one or two in market share. The Company will view favorably all efforts that bring the Company closer to obtaining these goals.

     5.10    Leadership

     Employee morale is significantly influenced by the leadership qualities of the Company’s managers. The Company encourages management personnel to operate as a cohesive team and speak with integrity and truthfulness, and believes employees will emulate management’s actions. Thus, the Company values leadership, as opposed to dictatorial management styles, and will consider this in its evaluation of Eligible Participants.

     5.11    Credibility

     Part of leadership is to exhibit the highest degree of integrity and truthfulness in dealing with employees, suppliers, subcontractors, and clients. While this does not mean discussing Company business in an inappropriate manner or failing to speak tactfully, the Company values employees who are honest and accountable in their dealings. The Company’s goal is for its employees to have complete credibility with others. The Company will reward Eligible Participants whose actions support this goal.

6


  Key Manager Incentive Plan  


     5.12    Accountability

     The Company recognizes that employee performance is often influenced by outside circumstances beyond its control. However, the Company values managers who are accountable for their areas of responsibility and for the performance of their subordinates even when the unexpected occurs. Managers should accept responsibility for their area rather than asking forgiveness or making excuses when business does not go as planned. The Company values accountability and will reward Eligible Participants accordingly.

     5.13     Empowerment

     The Company cannot grow at the pace it has established unless managers empower their subordinates to make decisions and hold their subordinates accountable for their actions. While employees are expected to participate and cooperate with each other to achieve the goals described in this Plan, the Company’s general operating philosophy should be one of empowering associates and providing them with coaching, mentoring, and training necessary to make good decisions.

6.    MISCELLANEOUS

     6.1    This Bonus Plan shall be governed by the laws of the State of Texas, excluding choice of law and conflict of law principles that direct the application of the laws of a different state. The Board of Directors is hereby authorized to resolve any ambiguities in this Plan.

     6.2    This Bonus Plan represents the sole Bonus Plan covering the Eligible Participants, and all rights to participate in any other bonus plans (other than any plan under which the Company may award options or other equity consideration) are hereby revoked in their entirety. This Bonus Plan may be modified or amended at any time by the Board of Directors of the Company, with or without prior notice to the Eligible Participants.

     6.3    There are no third party beneficiaries to this Bonus Plan.

     6.4    This Bonus Plan is an unfunded and unsecured compensation arrangement. It is not governed by the Employee’s Retirement and Income Security Act of 1974.

Adopted by Resolution of the Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors
April 17, 2006

/s/    William A. Coskey, P.E.
William A. Coskey, P.E.
Chairman of the Board

7

  Executive Level Incentive Plan  


1.    PURPOSE AND EFFECTIVE DATE

     1.1 The purpose of this Executive Level Incentive Plan (this “ Plan ”) is to provide financial incentives to certain corporate officers (the “ Participants ”) of ENGlobal Corporation (“ ENGlobal ” or the “ Company ”) to use their best efforts on behalf of the Company and to provide bonuses commensurate with the industry peer group if the Company is successful in raising earnings per share.

     1.2 This Plan was approved by the Board of Directors on December 16, 2004 and shall be effective as of January 1, 2005, and amended by the Board of Directors on March 28, 2006, to be effective as of January 1, 2006.

2.    ELIGIBLE PARTICIPANTS

     The Participants in this Plan shall be the Chairman of the Board, President and Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer, Executive Vice President of Business Development, and such other participants as the Board of Directors may designate from time to time.

3.    BONUS POOL AND BONUS PAYMENTS

     The “ Bonus Pool ” (herein so called) from which bonuses shall be paid to Participants under this Plan shall be calculated and paid as follows:

     3.1 If the Company’s adjusted earnings per share (“ EPS ”) for the year for which the bonus is being paid (the “ Current Year ”), after subtracting any and all incentive compensation, exceeds adjusted EPS in the immediately preceding calendar year (the “ Base Year”), then the Company shall contribute to the Bonus Pool in the amounts, and with the restrictions, as set below. “ Adjusted Earnings per Share ” shall mean the Company’s actual Earnings per Share for the Bonus Period as stated in the Company’s audited financial statements filed with its Annual Report on Form 10-K, but adjusted each year to exclude unusual or infrequent transactions. The amount of the “ Bonus Pool ” shall be determined as follows:

(1)  

$88,000 for each penny per share of earnings the Company makes which is over and above the prior year’s earnings per share.


(2)  

Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, the total Bonus Pool for this plan, plus the Key Manager Incentive Plan, shall not exceed 13.10% of adjusted pre-tax, pre-bonus earnings (after adjusting for non-operating and non-recurring events).


(3)  

Additionally, no Participant shall be entitled to a bonus hereunder that is greater than 1.5 times the Participant’s annual salary for the year for which the bonus is paid.


     3.2 Bonus payments, if due hereunder, will be made within 75 days following the end of each year.


  Executive Level Incentive Plan  


4.    BONUS DETERMINATIONS

     The amount of the Bonus shall be divided among the Eligible Participants in proportion to their salaries for the year in which the bonus is being paid.

5.    MISCELLANEOUS

     5.1 This Bonus Plan shall be governed by the laws of the State of Texas, excluding choice of law and conflict of law principles that direct the application of the laws of a different state. The Board of Directors is hereby authorized to resolve any ambiguities in this Plan.

     5.2 This Bonus Plan represents the sole Bonus Plan covering the Participants, and all rights to participate in any other Bonus Plans (other than any plan under which the Company may award options or other equity consideration) are hereby revoked in their entirety. This Bonus Plan may be modified or amended at any time by the Board of Directors of the Company, with or without prior notice to the Participants.

     5.3 There are no third-party beneficiaries to this Bonus Plan.

     5.4 This Bonus Plan is an unfunded and unsecured compensation arrangement. It is not governed by the Employee’s Retirement and Income Security Act of 1974.

Adopted by Resolution of the Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors
April 17, 2006

/s/    William A. Coskey, P.E.
William A. Coskey, P.E.
Chairman of the Board

2

KEY EXECUTIVE EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT

     THIS AGREEMENT effective January 1, 2006, is between ENGlobal Corporate Services, Inc., a Texas corporation (the “Company” ) , and William A. Coskey, a resident of Montgomery, Texas (the “Executive” ).

     The Company and the Executive agree as follows:

     1. Employment, Duties and Acceptance.

          1.1 Employment by the Company . The Company agrees to employ the Executive as Chairman of the Board of the Company for the duration of the Employment Term (as defined in Section 2 below), to render such services and to perform such duties as are normally associated with and inherent in the executive capacity in which the Executive will be serving, as well as such other duties, which are not inconsistent with the Executive’s position with the Company, as shall from time to time reasonably be assigned to him by the Board of Directors of the Company (the “Board of Directors” ).

          1.2 Extent of Service . The Executive agrees to render the services required of him under Section 1.1. During the Employment Term, the Executive shall devote his full business time, attention and energy to the business of the Company and the performance of his duties under this Agreement. The foregoing shall not, however, prohibit the Executive from making and managing personal investments, or from engaging in civic or charitable activities, that do not materially impair the performance of his duties under this Agreement. If appointed or elected, as applicable, the Executive also shall serve during all or any part of the Employment Term as any other officer and/or as a director of the Company or any of its subsidiaries or affiliates, without any additional compensation other than that specified in this Agreement.

          1.3 Place of Performance . The Executive shall be based in the Houston Metropolitan Area, and nothing in this Agreement shall require the Executive to relocate his base of employment or principal place of residence from the Houston Metropolitan Area.

     2. Employment Term . The term of the Executive’s employment under this Agreement (the “Employment Term” ) shall commence on January 1, 2006 (the “Commencement Date” ), and shall expire on December 31, 2007 (the “Expiration Date” ) , unless extended by the Company or earlier terminated as herein provided. At the end of the Employment Term, this Agreement shall be automatically renewed year to year thereafter, unless (a) Employee’s employment has been terminated prior to such day, or (b) not later than 60 days prior to such day, either party to this Agreement shall have given written notice to the other party that he or it does not wish to extend further the Termination Date (and the Employment Term).

     3. Compensation and Other Benefits.

          3.1 Annual Salary . As compensation for services to be rendered under this Agreement, the Company shall pay the Executive a salary (the “Annual Salary” ), subject to such increases as the Board of Directors may, in its discretion, approve, at a rate of $245,000.00 per annum. The Executive shall also be eligible, during the Employment Term, to receive such other compensation, whether in the form of cash bonuses, incentive compensation, stock options, stock appreciation rights, restricted stock awards or otherwise (collectively, the “Additional Compensation” ), as the Board of Directors (or any committee of the Board) may, in its discretion, approve. The Annual Salary and the Additional Compensation shall be payable in accordance with the applicable payroll and/or other compensation policies and plans of the Company as in effect from time to time during the Employment Term, less such deductions as shall be required to be withheld by applicable law and regulations.


          3.2 Participation in Employee Benefit Plans . The Executive shall be permitted, during the Employment Term, if and to the extent he is and continues to meet all applicable eligibility requirements, to participate in any group life, hospitalization or disability insurance plan, health program, pension plan, similar benefit plan or other “fringe benefits” of the Company, which may be available to all other similarly situated members of the Company’s management on generally the same terms.

          3.3 Executive Support . The Company shall provide to the Executive office facilities, furniture, and equipment, secretarial and support personnel and other management level support services as the Executive shall reasonably require in connection with his performance of his duties under this Agreement.

          3.4 Reimbursement of Business Expenses . The Executive may incur reasonable, ordinary and necessary business expenses in the course of his performance of his duties under this Agreement, including expenses for travel, food and entertainment. The Company shall reimburse the Executive for all such business expenses if (i) the expenses are incurred by the Executive in accordance with the Company’s business expense reimbursement policy, if any, as may be established and modified by the Company from time to time, and (ii) the Executive provides to the Company a record of and appropriate receipts for (A) the amount of the expense, (B) the date, place and nature of the expense, (C) the business reason for the expense and (D) the names, occupations and other data concerning individuals entertained sufficient to establish their business relationship to the Company. The Company shall have no obligation to reimburse the Executive for expenses that are not incurred and substantiated as required by this Section 3.4.

     4. Non-Competition.

          4.1 Covenants Against Competition . During the Employment Term, the Company will provide confidential information to the Executive. The Executive acknowledges that (i) the Company, which for purposes of this Section 4 includes the Company, and all present and future subsidiaries and affiliates, and any subsidiaries and affiliates that may be formed or incorporated during the Restricted Period (as defined in Section 4.1.1), is engaged in the business of providing a broad range of engineering services, including planning, engineering, design, procurement, construction management, in-plant staffing, field inspection, land management, and control system services (the “Business” ); (ii) the Executive is one of a limited number of persons who has performed a significant role in developing the Business; (iii) the Business is conducted throughout the United States and internationally; (iv) the Company will give him possession of, and access to, trade secrets of, and confidential, proprietary information concerning, the Company; (v) the agreements and covenants contained in this Section 4 (collectively, the “Restrictive Covenants” ) are essential to protect the Business and the goodwill of the Company; and (vi) the Restrictive Covenants will not impair his ability to engage in a wide array of professional activities. Accordingly, the Executive agrees as follows:

2


               4.1.1 Competitive Activities . During the Restricted Period, the Executive shall not (A) engage, anywhere within the Territory (as hereinafter defined), as an officer, director or in any other managerial capacity or as an owner, co-owner or other investor or creditor in or of, whether as an employee, independent contractor, consultant or advisor, in any business selling or providing any services which are sold or offered by the Company, within the territory surrounding each office or facility (each a “facility” ) at which the Executive was employed by the Company within the one-year period immediately preceding the date of the Executive’s termination of employment (for purposes of this Section 4.1, the territory surrounding a facility shall be: (1) the city, town or village in which the facility is located, (2) the county or parish in which the facility is located, (3) the counties or parishes contiguous to the county or parish in which the facility is located and (4) the area located within 100 miles of the facility, all of such locations being herein collectively called the “Territory”), or (B) call on any person or entity that at the time is, or at any time within one year prior to the date of termination of the Executive’s employment was, a customer of the Company, for the purpose of soliciting or selling any product or service which is then sold or offered within the Territory by the Company if the Executive has knowledge of that customer relationship; provided, however, that nothing in this Section 4.1.1 shall prohibit the Executive from owning, directly or indirectly, solely as an investment, securities of any entity traded on any national securities exchange or over-the-counter market if the Executive is not a controlling person of, or a member of a group which controls, such entity and does not, directly or indirectly, own one percent or more of any class of securities of such entity. As used in this Section 4, the term “Restricted Period” means the period beginning on the Commencement Date and ending on the expiration of the Total Severance Benefit Period (as defined in Section 5.5).

               4.1.2 Confidential Information; Personal Relationships . During the Restricted Period and thereafter, the Executive shall keep secret and retain in strict confidence, and shall not use for the benefit of himself or others, all confidential matters of the Company, including, without limitation, “know-how,” trade secrets, customer lists, details of client or consultant contracts, pricing policies, bidding practices and procedures, operational methods, marketing plans or strategies, project development techniques or plans, business acquisition plans, new personnel acquisition plans, methods of production, manufacture and installation, technical processes, designs and design projects, inventions and research projects of the Company learned by the Executive heretofore or during the Restricted Period.

               4.1.3 Property of the Company . All memoranda, notes, lists, records and other documents or papers (and all copies thereof, including such items stored in computer memories, on microfiche or by any other means, made or compiled by or on behalf of the Executive, or made available to the Executive relating to the Company, other than purely personal matters, are and shall be the Company’s property and shall be delivered to the Company promptly upon the termination of the Executive’s employment (whether such termination is for Cause, as hereinafter defined, or otherwise) or at any other time on request of the Company.

               4.1.4 Employees of the Company . During the Employment Term and the Restricted Period, the Executive shall not, directly or indirectly, recruit or solicit any employee of the Company away from the Company or encourage any such employee to leave such employment.

3


               4.1.5 Consultants of the Company . During the Employment Term and the Restricted Period, the Executive shall not, directly or indirectly, recruit or solicit any consultant then under contract with the Company or encourage such consultant to terminate such relationship.

               4.1.6 Acquisition Candidates . During the Employment Term and the Restricted Period, the Executive shall not call on any Acquisition Candidate (as defined below in this Section 4.1.6), with the knowledge of such Acquisition Candidate’s status as such, for the purpose of acquiring, or arranging the acquisition of, that Acquisition Candidate by any person or entity other than the Company. In this Section 4.1.6 “Acquisition Candidate” means any person or entity engaged in any of the businesses of providing engineering services, including planning, design procurement, construction management, in-plant maintenance, field inspection and control system services, and (i) which was called on by the Company, in connection with the possible acquisition by the Company of that person or entity, or (ii) with respect to which the Company has made an acquisition analysis.

          4.2 Rights and Remedies upon Breach . If the Executive breaches or threatens to commit a breach of the Restrictive Covenants, the Company shall have the following rights and remedies, each of which shall be independent of the others and severally enforceable, and each of which is in addition to, and not in lieu of, any other rights and remedies available to the Company under law or in equity:

               4.2.1 Injunctive Relief . The right and remedy to have the Restrictive Covenants specifically enforced by any court of competent jurisdiction, it being agreed that any breach or threatened breach of the Restrictive Covenants would cause irreparable injury to the Company and that money damages would not provide an adequate remedy to the Company.

               4.2.2 Accounting . The right and remedy to require the Executive to account for and pay over to the Company all compensation, profits, monies, accruals, increments or other benefits derived or received by the Executive as the result of any transaction constituting a breach of the Restrictive Covenants.

          4.3 Severability of Covenants . The Executive acknowledges and agrees that the Restrictive Covenants are reasonable and valid in geographical and temporal scope and in all other respects. If any court determines that any of the Restrictive Covenants, or any part thereof, is invalid or unenforceable, the remainder of the Restrictive Covenants shall not thereby be affected and shall be given full effect, without regard to the invalid portions.

          4.4 Reformation . If any court determines that any Restrictive Covenant, or any part thereof, is unenforceable because of the duration or geographic scope of such provision, such court shall have the power to reduce the duration or scope of such provision, as the case may be, and, in its reduced form, such provision shall then be enforceable.

4


          4.5 Enforceability . The Company and the Executive intend to and hereby confer exclusive jurisdiction to enforce the Restrictive Covenants upon the federal and state courts of Harris County, Texas.

          4.6 Definitions. For the purposes of this Section 4 only, the term “Company” shall not only include ENGlobal Corporate Services, Inc., but its parents, subsidiaries, and affiliates.

     5. Termination.

          5.1 Termination upon Death . If the Executive dies during the Employment Term, this Agreement shall terminate, except that the Executive’s legal representatives, successors, heirs or assigns shall be entitled to receive the Annual Salary, the Additional Compensation and other accrued benefits, if any, earned up to the date of the Executive’s death; provided, however, if any Additional Compensation or other benefits are governed by the provisions of any written employee benefit plan or policy of the Company, any written agreement contemplated thereunder or any other separate written agreement entered into between the Executive and the Company, the terms and conditions of such plan, policy or agreement shall control in the event of any discrepancy or conflict with the provisions of this Agreement regarding such Additional Compensation or other benefit upon the death, termination or disability of the Executive.

          5.2 Termination for Cause . At any time during the Employment Term, the Company shall have the right to terminate the Executive’s employment under this Agreement and discharge the Executive for Cause, exercisable upon the affirmative vote of no less than three (3) members of the Board of Directors and the service of written notice upon the Executive. If such right is exercised, the Company’s obligation to the Executive shall be limited to the payment of any unpaid Annual Salary, Additional Compensation and other benefits, if any, accrued up to the effective date specified in the Company’s notice of termination (which date shall not be retroactive). As used in this Section 5.2 and elsewhere in this Agreement, the term “Cause” shall mean the determination that (i) after notice and a right to cure, there has been a material breach by the Executive of the terms of this Agreement, (ii) after receipt of a written warning, the Executive has failed or refused to follow the reasonable policies, performance objectives, or directives established by the Board of Directors or executive officers of the Company senior to the Executive, (iii) the Executive has misappropriated money or other assets or properties of the Company or any subsidiary or affiliate of the Company, (iv) the Executive has been convicted of any felony or other serious crime, (v) the Executive’s employment performance has been substantially impaired by chronic absenteeism, alcoholism or drug addiction, or (vi) the Executive has exhibited gross moral turpitude relevant to his office or employment with the Company or any subsidiary or affiliate of the Company.

          5.3 Termination Without Cause . At any time during the Employment Term, the Company shall have the right to terminate the Executive’s employment under this Agreement and discharge the Executive without Cause, exercisable upon the affirmative vote of no less than three (3) members of the Board of Directors and the service of written notice to the Executive. If such right is exercised, the Company’s obligation to the Executive shall be as set forth in Section 5.5 below.

5


          5.4 Termination upon Disability . If during the Employment Term the Executive becomes physically or mentally disabled, whether totally or partially, as evidenced by the written statement of a competent physician licensed to practice medicine in the United States, so that the Executive is unable to substantially perform his services hereunder with reasonable accommodation for (i) a period of six consecutive months, or (ii) for shorter periods aggregating six months during any period of twelve consecutive months, the Company may at any time after the last day of the six consecutive months of disability, or the day on which the shorter periods of disability equal an aggregate of six months within a period of twelve consecutive months, terminate the Executive’s employment hereunder, exercisable upon the affirmative vote of no less than three (3) members of the Board of Directors and the service of written notice to the Executive. If such right is exercised, the Company’s obligation to the Executive shall be as set forth in Section 5.5 below.

          5.5 Severance Benefit . If at any time during or after the Employment Term, the Executive’s employment by the Company is terminated for any reason other than (i) a termination for Cause under Section 5.2, (ii) his voluntary resignation (including in breach of this Agreement), or (iii) his death, then for a period of six (6) months following the date of termination of the Executive’s employment (the “Initial Severance Benefit Period” ), the Company shall continue to (a) pay to the Executive, in payroll period installments in accordance with the Company’s normal payroll policies, the monthly amount of Executive’s Annual Salary in effect at the date of termination of his employment and (b) under the same cost sharing arrangements as were in place prior to termination, continue to include the Executive and his eligible dependents under the coverage of all group health, medical and dental insurance policies, plans and programs maintained by the Company during the Initial Severance Benefit Period for the Company’s employees, or management employees, generally.

     The Company, at its option, which shall be exercisable by a written notice sent to the Executive at least sixty (60) days prior to the expiration of the Initial Severance Benefit Period, may elect to extend the Initial Severance Benefit Period for a period of an additional six (6) months following the expiration of the Initial Severance Benefit Period. If the Company so elects to extend the Initial Severance Benefit Period, the Company, during the Second Severance Benefit Period shall (i) pay to the Executive, in payroll period installments in accordance with the Company’s normal payroll policies, an amount equal to 50% of the monthly amount of Executive’s Annual Salary in effect at the date of termination of his employment and (ii) under the same cost sharing arrangements as were in place prior to termination, continue to include the Executive and his eligible dependants under the coverage of all group health, medical and dental insurance policies, plans and programs maintained by the Company during the Second Severance Benefit Period, for the Company’s employees, or management employees, generally.

     For purposes of Section 4.1.1 of this Agreement, the term “Total Severance Benefit Period” means the total period (including the Initial Severance Benefit Period and, if applicable, the Second Severance Benefit Period) during which the Company is obligated to pay and provide, and performs its obligations to pay and provide, severance benefits to the Executive under this Section 5.5.

     6. Insurance . The Company may, from time to time, apply for and take out, in its own name and at its own expense, naming itself or others as the designated beneficiary (which it may change from time to time), policies for health, accident, disability or other insurance upon the Executive or his life, in any amount or amounts that it may deem necessary or appropriate to protect its interest. The Executive agrees to aid the Company in procuring such insurance by submitting to reasonable medical examinations and by filling out, executing and delivering such applications and other instruments in writing as may reasonably be required by an insurance company or companies to which any application or applications for insurance may be made by or for the Company.

6


     7. Arbitration.

          7.1 Binding Effect . Except as provided in Section 7.2 below, any and all controversies, claims or disputes by the Executive or the Company relating to the provisions or obligations under this Agreement, or with respect to the employment or termination thereof of the Executive by the Company, shall be submitted to final and binding arbitration in accordance with the Employment Dispute Resolution Rules of the American Arbitration Association in effect at the time a demand for arbitration is made. It is the intention of the Executive and the Company that this Arbitration provision shall be enforceable under the Federal Arbitration Act.

          7.2 Excluded Matters . This Arbitration provision shall not apply to any claims for workers’ compensation benefits, unemployment compensation benefits, or claims by the Company for injunctive and/or other equitable relief for any violation of Section 4 of this Agreement.

     8. Other Provisions.

          8.1 Notices . Any notice or other communication required or permitted hereunder shall be in writing and shall be delivered personally, telegraphed, telexed, sent by facsimile transmission or sent by certified, registered or express mail, postage prepaid. Any such notice shall be deemed given when so delivered personally, telegraphed, telexed or sent by facsimile transmission or, if mailed, five days after the date of deposit in the United States mail, as follows:

 

          if to the Company, to:


 

Chairman of the Compensation Committee
ENGlobal Corporation
654 N. Sam Houston Pkwy E., Suite 400
Houston, TX 77060-5914


 

          if to the Executive, to:


 

William A. Coskey
265 Waterford Way
Montgomery, TX 77356


     Either party may change its address for notice hereunder by notice to the other party.

7


          8.2 Entire Agreement . This Agreement contains the entire agreement and understanding between the parties with respect to its subject matter and supersedes all prior agreements, written or oral, with respect thereto; provided, however, that nothing herein shall in any way limit the obligation, rights or liabilities of the parties under any written stock option agreement separately entered into by the parties.

          8.3 Waivers and Amendments . This Agreement may be amended, modified, superseded, canceled, renewed or extended, and the terms and conditions hereof may be waived, only by a written instrument signed by the parties or, in the case of a waiver, by the party waiving compliance. No delay on the part of any party in exercising any right, power or privilege hereunder shall operate as a waiver thereof, nor shall any waiver on the part of any party of any right, power or privilege hereunder, nor any single or partial exercise of any right, power or privilege hereunder preclude any other or further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right, power or privilege hereunder.

          8.4 Governing Law; Venue . This Agreement, except as set forth in Section 4.5 hereof, shall be governed by, and construed in accordance with, the laws of the State of Texas without reference to principles governing choice or conflicts of law. Venue shall exclusively lie in the state and federal courts of Harris County, Texas.

          8.5 Assignment . This Agreement, and any rights and obligations hereunder, may not be assigned by any party hereto without the prior written consent of the other party, except that the Company may assign this Agreement to any of its subsidiaries or affiliates without the Executive’s consent provided such assignment does not diminish any of the Executive’s benefits, rights or obligations hereunder.

          8.6 Counterparts . This Agreement may be executed in two or more counterparts, each of which shall be deemed an original, but all of which together shall constitute one and the same instrument.

          8.7 Headings . The headings in this Agreement are for reference purposes only and shall not in any way affect the meaning or interpretation of this Agreement.






8


     IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have executed this Agreement as of the date and year first above written:

 

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION


 

By:_____________________________


 

_______________________________
David C. Roussel
Chairman of Compensation Committee




 

WILLIAM A. COSKEY


 

By:_____________________________


 

_______________________________
William A. Coskey








9

KEY EXECUTIVE EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT

     THIS AGREEMENT effective January 1, 2006, is between ENGlobal Corporate Services, Inc., a Texas corporation (the “Company” ) , and Michael L. Burrow, a resident of Beaumont, Texas (the “Executive” ).

     The Company and the Executive agree as follows:

     1. Employment, Duties and Acceptance.

          1.1 Employment by the Company . The Company agrees to employ the Executive as President and Chief Executive Officer of the Company for the duration of the Employment Term (as defined in Section 2 below), to render such services and to perform such duties as are normally associated with and inherent in the executive capacity in which the Executive will be serving, as well as such other duties, which are not inconsistent with the Executive’s position with the Company, as shall from time to time reasonably be assigned to him by the Board of Directors of the Company (the “Board of Directors” ).

          1.2 Extent of Service . The Executive agrees to render the services required of him under Section 1.1. During the Employment Term, the Executive shall devote his full business time, attention and energy to the business of the Company and the performance of his duties under this Agreement. The foregoing shall not, however, prohibit the Executive from making and managing personal investments, or from engaging in civic or charitable activities, that do not materially impair the performance of his duties under this Agreement. If appointed or elected, as applicable, the Executive also shall serve during all or any part of the Employment Term as any other officer and/or as a director of the Company or any of its subsidiaries or affiliates, without any additional compensation other than that specified in this Agreement.

          1.3 Place of Performance . The Executive shall be based in the Houston/Beaumont Metropolitan Area, and nothing in this Agreement shall require the Executive to relocate his base of employment or principal place of residence from the Houston/Beaumont Metropolitan Area.

     2. Employment Term . The term of the Executive’s employment under this Agreement (the “Employment Term” ) shall commence on January 1, 2006 (the “Commencement Date” ), and shall expire on December 31, 2007 (the “Expiration Date” ) , unless extended by the Company or earlier terminated as herein provided. At the end of the Employment Term, this Agreement shall be automatically renewed year to year thereafter, unless (a) Employee’s employment has been terminated prior to such day, or (b) not later than 60 days prior to such day, either party to this Agreement shall have given written notice to the other party that he or it does not wish to extend further the Termination Date (and the Employment Term).

     3. Compensation and Other Benefits.

          3.1 Annual Salary . As compensation for services to be rendered under this Agreement, the Company shall pay the Executive a salary (the “Annual Salary” ), subject to such increases as the Board of Directors may, in its discretion, approve, at a rate of $320,000.00 per annum. The Executive shall also be eligible, during the Employment Term, to receive such other compensation, whether in the form of cash bonuses, incentive compensation, stock options, stock appreciation rights, restricted stock awards or otherwise (collectively, the “Additional Compensation” ), as the Board of Directors (or any committee of the Board) may, in its discretion, approve. The Annual Salary and the Additional Compensation shall be payable in accordance with the applicable payroll and/or other compensation policies and plans of the Company as in effect from time to time during the Employment Term, less such deductions as shall be required to be withheld by applicable law and regulations.


          3.2 Participation in Employee Benefit Plans . The Executive shall be permitted, during the Employment Term, if and to the extent he is and continues to meet all applicable eligibility requirements, to participate in any group life, hospitalization or disability insurance plan, health program, pension plan, similar benefit plan or other “fringe benefits” of the Company, which may be available to all other similarly situated members of the Company’s management on generally the same terms.

          3.3 Executive Support . The Company shall provide to the Executive office facilities, furniture, and equipment, secretarial and support personnel and other management level support services as the Executive shall reasonably require in connection with his performance of his duties under this Agreement.

          3.4 Reimbursement of Business Expenses . The Executive may incur reasonable, ordinary and necessary business expenses in the course of his performance of his duties under this Agreement, including expenses for travel, food and entertainment. The Company shall reimburse the Executive for all such business expenses if (i) the expenses are incurred by the Executive in accordance with the Company’s business expense reimbursement policy, if any, as may be established and modified by the Company from time to time, and (ii) the Executive provides to the Company a record of and appropriate receipts for (A) the amount of the expense, (B) the date, place and nature of the expense, (C) the business reason for the expense and (D) the names, occupations and other data concerning individuals entertained sufficient to establish their business relationship to the Company. The Company shall have no obligation to reimburse the Executive for expenses that are not incurred and substantiated as required by this Section 3.4.

     4. Non-Competition.

          4.1 Covenants Against Competition . During the Employment Term, the Company will provide confidential information to the Executive. The Executive acknowledges that (i) the Company, which for purposes of this Section 4 includes the Company, and all present and future subsidiaries and affiliates, and any subsidiaries and affiliates that may be formed or incorporated during the Restricted Period (as defined in Section 4.1.1), is engaged in the business of providing a broad range of engineering services, including planning, design procurement, construction management, in-plant maintenance, field inspection and control system services (the “Business” ); (ii) the Executive is one of a limited number of persons who has performed a significant role in developing the Business; (iii) the Business is conducted throughout the United States and internationally; (iv) the Company will give him possession of, and access to, trade secrets of, and confidential, proprietary information concerning, the Company; (v) the agreements and covenants contained in this Section 4 (collectively, the “Restrictive Covenants” ) are essential to protect the Business and the goodwill of the Company; and (vi) the Restrictive Covenants will not impair his ability to engage in a wide array of professional activities. Accordingly, the Executive agrees as follows:

2


               4.1.1 Competitive Activities . During the Restricted Period, the Executive shall not (A) engage, anywhere within the Territory (as hereinafter defined), as an officer, director or in any other managerial capacity or as an owner, co-owner or other investor or creditor in or of, whether as an employee, independent contractor, consultant or advisor, in any business selling or providing any services which are sold or offered by the Company, within the territory surrounding each office or facility (each a “facility” ) at which the Executive was employed by the Company within the one-year period immediately preceding the date of the Executive’s termination of employment (for purposes of this Section 4.1, the territory surrounding a facility shall be: (1) the city, town or village in which the facility is located, (2) the county or parish in which the facility is located, (3) the counties or parishes contiguous to the county or parish in which the facility is located and (4) the area located within 100 miles of the facility, all of such locations being herein collectively called the “Territory”), or (B) call on any person or entity that at the time is, or at any time within one year prior to the date of termination of the Executive’s employment was, a customer of the Company, for the purpose of soliciting or selling any product or service which is then sold or offered within the Territory by the Company if the Executive has knowledge of that customer relationship; provided, however, that nothing in this Section 4.1.1 shall prohibit the Executive from owning, directly or indirectly, solely as an investment, securities of any entity traded on any national securities exchange or over-the-counter market if the Executive is not a controlling person of, or a member of a group which controls, such entity and does not, directly or indirectly, own one percent or more of any class of securities of such entity. As used in this Section 4, the term “Restricted Period” means the period beginning on the Commencement Date and ending on the expiration of the Total Severance Benefit Period (as defined in Section 5.5).

               4.1.2 Confidential Information; Personal Relationships . During the Restricted Period and thereafter, the Executive shall keep secret and retain in strict confidence, and shall not use for the benefit of himself or others, all confidential matters of the Company, including, without limitation, “know-how,” trade secrets, customer lists, details of client or consultant contracts, pricing policies, bidding practices and procedures, operational methods, marketing plans or strategies, project development techniques or plans, business acquisition plans, new personnel acquisition plans, methods of production, manufacture and installation, technical processes, designs and design projects, inventions and research projects of the Company learned by the Executive heretofore or during the Restricted Period.

               4.1.3 Property of the Company . All memoranda, notes, lists, records and other documents or papers (and all copies thereof, including such items stored in computer memories, on microfiche or by any other means, made or compiled by or on behalf of the Executive, or made available to the Executive relating to the Company, other than purely personal matters, are and shall be the Company’s property and shall be delivered to the Company promptly upon the termination of the Executive’s employment (whether such termination is for Cause, as hereinafter defined, or otherwise) or at any other time on request of the Company.

3


               4.1.4 Employees of the Company . During the Employment Term and the Restricted Period, the Executive shall not, directly or indirectly, recruit or solicit any employee or consultant engineer of the Company away from the Company or encourage any such employee or agent to leave such employment.

               4.1.5 Consultants of the Company . During the Employment Term and the Restricted Period, the Executive shall not, directly or indirectly, recruit or solicit any consultant then under contract with the Company or encourage such consultant to terminate such relationship.

               4.1.6 Acquisition Candidates . During the Employment Term and the Restricted Period, the Executive shall not call on any Acquisition Candidate (as defined below in this Section 4.1.6), with the knowledge of such Acquisition Candidate’s status as such, for the purpose of acquiring, or arranging the acquisition of, that Acquisition Candidate by any person or entity other than the Company. In this Section 4.1.6 “Acquisition Candidate” means any person or entity engaged in any of the businesses of providing engineering services, including planning, design procurement, construction management, in-plant maintenance, field inspection and control system services, and (i) which was called on by the Company, in connection with the possible acquisition by the Company of that person or entity, or (ii) with respect to which the Company has made an acquisition analysis.

          4.2 Rights and Remedies upon Breach . If the Executive breaches or threatens to commit a breach of the Restrictive Covenants, the Company shall have the following rights and remedies, each of which shall be independent of the others and severally enforceable, and each of which is in addition to, and not in lieu of, any other rights and remedies available to the Company under law or in equity:

               4.2.1 Injunctive Relief . The right and remedy to have the Restrictive Covenants specifically enforced by any court of competent jurisdiction, it being agreed that any breach or threatened breach of the Restrictive Covenants would cause irreparable injury to the Company and that money damages would not provide an adequate remedy to the Company.

               4.2.2 Accounting . The right and remedy to require the Executive to account for and pay over to the Company all compensation, profits, monies, accruals, increments or other benefits derived or received by the Executive as the result of any transaction constituting a breach of the Restrictive Covenants.

          4.3 Severability of Covenants . The Executive acknowledges and agrees that the Restrictive Covenants are reasonable and valid in geographical and temporal scope and in all other respects. If any court determines that any of the Restrictive Covenants, or any part thereof, is invalid or unenforceable, the remainder of the Restrictive Covenants shall not thereby be affected and shall be given full effect, without regard to the invalid portions.

          4.4 Reformation . If any court determines that any Restrictive Covenant, or any part thereof, is unenforceable because of the duration or geographic scope of such provision, such court shall have the power to reduce the duration or scope of such provision, as the case may be, and, in its reduced form, such provision shall then be enforceable.

4


          4.5 Enforceability . The Company and the Executive intend to and hereby confer exclusive jurisdiction to enforce the Restrictive Covenants upon the federal and state courts of Harris County, Texas.

          4.6 Definitions. For the purposes of this Section 4 only, the term “Company” shall not only include ENGlobal Corporate Services, Inc., but its parents, subsidiaries, and affiliates.

     5. Termination.

          5.1 Termination upon Death . If the Executive dies during the Employment Term, this Agreement shall terminate, except that the Executive’s legal representatives, successors, heirs or assigns shall be entitled to receive the Annual Salary, the Additional Compensation and other accrued benefits, if any, earned up to the date of the Executive’s death; provided, however, if any Additional Compensation or other benefits are governed by the provisions of any written employee benefit plan or policy of the Company, any written agreement contemplated thereunder or any other separate written agreement entered into between the Executive and the Company, the terms and conditions of such plan, policy or agreement shall control in the event of any discrepancy or conflict with the provisions of this Agreement regarding such Additional Compensation or other benefit upon the death, termination or disability of the Executive.

          5.2 Termination for Cause . At any time during the Employment Term, the Company shall have the right to terminate the Executive’s employment under this Agreement and discharge the Executive for Cause, exercisable upon the affirmative vote of no less than three (3) members of the Board of Directors and the service of written notice upon the Executive. If such right is exercised, the Company’s obligation to the Executive shall be limited to the payment of any unpaid Annual Salary, Additional Compensation and other benefits, if any, accrued up to the effective date specified in the Company’s notice of termination (which date shall not be retroactive). As used in this Section 5.2 and elsewhere in this Agreement, the term “Cause” shall mean the determination that (i) after notice and a right to cure, there has been a material breach by the Executive of the terms of this Agreement, (ii) after receipt of a written warning, the Executive has failed or refused to follow the reasonable policies, performance objectives, or directives established by the Board of Directors or executive officers of the Company senior to the Executive, (iii) the Executive has misappropriated money or other assets or properties of the Company or any subsidiary or affiliate of the Company, (iv) the Executive has been convicted of any felony or other serious crime, (v) the Executive’s employment performance has been substantially impaired by chronic absenteeism, alcoholism or drug addiction, or (vi) the Executive has exhibited gross moral turpitude relevant to his office or employment with the Company or any subsidiary or affiliate of the Company.

          5.3 Termination Without Cause . At any time during the Employment Term, the Company shall have the right to terminate the Executive’s employment under this Agreement and discharge the Executive without Cause, exercisable upon the affirmative vote of no less than three (3) members of the Board of Directors and the service of written notice to the Executive. If such right is exercised, the Company’s obligation to the Executive shall be as set forth in Section 5.5 below.

5


          5.4 Termination upon Disability . If during the Employment Term the Executive becomes physically or mentally disabled, whether totally or partially, as evidenced by the written statement of a competent physician licensed to practice medicine in the United States, so that the Executive is unable to substantially perform his services hereunder with reasonable accommodation for (i) a period of six consecutive months, or (ii) for shorter periods aggregating six months during any period of twelve consecutive months, the Company may at any time after the last day of the six consecutive months of disability, or the day on which the shorter periods of disability equal an aggregate of six months within a period of twelve consecutive months, terminate the Executive’s employment hereunder, exercisable upon the affirmative vote of no less than three (3) members of the Board of Directors and the service of written notice to the Executive. If such right is exercised, the Company’s obligation to the Executive shall be as set forth in Section 5.5 below.

          5.5 Severance Benefit . If at any time during or after the Employment Term, the Executive’s employment by the Company is terminated for any reason other than (i) a termination for Cause under Section 5.2, (ii) his voluntary resignation (including in breach of this Agreement), or (iii) his death, then for a period of six (6) months following the date of termination of the Executive’s employment (the “Initial Severance Benefit Period” ), the Company shall continue to (a) pay to the Executive, in payroll period installments in accordance with the Company’s normal payroll policies, the monthly amount of Executive’s Annual Salary in effect at the date of termination of his employment and (b) under the same cost sharing arrangements as were in place prior to termination, continue to include the Executive and his eligible dependents under the coverage of all group health, medical and dental insurance policies, plans and programs maintained by the Company during the Initial Severance Benefit Period for the Company’s employees, or management employees, generally.

     The Company, at its option, which shall be exercisable by a written notice sent to the Executive at least sixty (60) days prior to the expiration of the Initial Severance Benefit Period, may elect to extend the Initial Severance Benefit Period for a period of an additional six (6) months following the expiration of the Initial Severance Benefit Period. If the Company so elects to extend the Initial Severance Benefit Period, the Company, during the Second Severance Benefit Period shall (i) pay to the Executive, in payroll period installments in accordance with the Company’s normal payroll policies, an amount equal to 50% of the monthly amount of Executive’s Annual Salary in effect at the date of termination of his employment and (ii) under the same cost sharing arrangements as were in place prior to termination, continue to include the Executive and his eligible dependants under the coverage of all group health, medical and dental insurance policies, plans and programs maintained by the Company during the Second Severance Benefit Period, for the Company’s employees, or management employees, generally.

     For purposes of Section 4.1.1 of this Agreement, the term “Total Severance Benefit Period” means the total period (including the Initial Severance Benefit Period and, if applicable, the Second Severance Benefit Period) during which the Company is obligated to pay and provide, and performs its obligations to pay and provide, severance benefits to the Executive under this Section 5.5.

6


     6. Insurance . The Company may, from time to time, apply for and take out, in its own name and at its own expense, naming itself or others as the designated beneficiary (which it may change from time to time), policies for health, accident, disability or other insurance upon the Executive or his life, in any amount or amounts that it may deem necessary or appropriate to protect its interest. The Executive agrees to aid the Company in procuring such insurance by submitting to reasonable medical examinations and by filling out, executing and delivering such applications and other instruments in writing as may reasonably be required by an insurance company or companies to which any application or applications for insurance may be made by or for the Company.

     7. Arbitration.

          7.1 Binding Effect . Except as provided in Section 7.2 below, any and all controversies, claims or disputes by the Executive or the Company relating to the provisions or obligations under this Agreement, or with respect to the employment or termination thereof of the Executive by the Company, shall be submitted to final and binding arbitration in accordance with the Employment Dispute Resolution Rules of the American Arbitration Association in effect at the time a demand for arbitration is made. It is the intention of the Executive and the Company that this Arbitration provision shall be enforceable under the Federal Arbitration Act.

          7.2 Excluded Matters . This Arbitration provision shall not apply to any claims for workers’ compensation benefits, unemployment compensation benefits, or claims by the Company for injunctive and/or other equitable relief for any violation of Section 4 of this Agreement.

     8. Other Provisions.

          8.1 Notices . Any notice or other communication required or permitted hereunder shall be in writing and shall be delivered personally, telegraphed, telexed, sent by facsimile transmission or sent by certified, registered or express mail, postage prepaid. Any such notice shall be deemed given when so delivered personally, telegraphed, telexed or sent by facsimile transmission or, if mailed, five days after the date of deposit in the United States mail, as follows:

 

          if to the Company, to:


 

Chairman of the Compensation Committee
654 N. Sam Houston Pkwy E., Suite 400
Houston, TX 77060-5914


 

          if to the Executive, to:


 

Michael L. Burrow
7955 Shire Lane
Beaumont, TX 77706


     Either party may change its address for notice hereunder by notice to the other party.

7


          8.2 Entire Agreement . This Agreement contains the entire agreement and understanding between the parties with respect to its subject matter and supersedes all prior agreements, written or oral, with respect thereto; provided, however, that nothing herein shall in any way limit the obligation, rights or liabilities of the parties under any written stock option agreement separately entered into by the parties.

          8.3 Waivers and Amendments . This Agreement may be amended, modified, superseded, canceled, renewed or extended, and the terms and conditions hereof may be waived, only by a written instrument signed by the parties or, in the case of a waiver, by the party waiving compliance. No delay on the part of any party in exercising any right, power or privilege hereunder shall operate as a waiver thereof, nor shall any waiver on the part of any party of any right, power or privilege hereunder, nor any single or partial exercise of any right, power or privilege hereunder preclude any other or further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right, power or privilege hereunder.

          8.4 Governing Law; Venue . This Agreement, except as set forth in Section 4.5 hereof, shall be governed by, and construed in accordance with, the laws of the State of Texas without reference to principles governing choice or conflicts of law. Venue shall exclusively lie in the state and federal courts of Harris County, Texas.

          8.5 Assignment . This Agreement, and any rights and obligations hereunder, may not be assigned by any party hereto without the prior written consent of the other party, except that the Company may assign this Agreement to any of its subsidiaries or affiliates without the Executive’s consent provided such assignment does not diminish any of the Executive’s benefits, rights or obligations hereunder.

          8.6 Counterparts . This Agreement may be executed in two or more counterparts, each of which shall be deemed an original, but all of which together shall constitute one and the same instrument.

          8.7 Headings . The headings in this Agreement are for reference purposes only and shall not in any way affect the meaning or interpretation of this Agreement.








8


     IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have executed this Agreement as of the date and year first above written:

 

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION


 

By:_____________________________


 

_______________________________
William A. Coskey


 

MICHAEL L. BURROW


 

By:_____________________________


 

_______________________________
Michael L. Burrow








9

KEY EXECUTIVE EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT

     THIS AGREEMENT effective January 1, 2006, is between ENGlobal Corporate Services, Inc., a Texas corporation (the “Company” ) , and Robert W. Raiford, a resident of Houston, Texas (the “Executive” ).

     The Company and the Executive agree as follows:

     1. Employment, Duties and Acceptance.

          1.1 Employment by the Company . The Company agrees to employ the Executive as Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer of the Company for the duration of the Employment Term (as defined in Section 2 below), to render such services and to perform such duties as are normally associated with and inherent in the executive capacity in which the Executive will be serving, as well as such other duties, which are not inconsistent with the Executive’s position with the Company, as shall from time to time reasonably be assigned to him by the Board of Directors of the Company (the “Board of Directors” ).

          1.2 Extent of Service . The Executive agrees to render the services required of him under Section 1.1. During the Employment Term, the Executive shall devote his full business time, attention and energy to the business of the Company and the performance of his duties under this Agreement. The foregoing shall not, however, prohibit the Executive from making and managing personal investments, or from engaging in civic or charitable activities, that do not materially impair the performance of his duties under this Agreement. If appointed or elected, as applicable, the Executive also shall serve during all or any part of the Employment Term as any other officer and/or as a director of the Company or any of its subsidiaries or affiliates, without any additional compensation other than that specified in this Agreement.

          1.3 Place of Performance . The Executive shall be based in the Houston/Beaumont Metropolitan Area, and nothing in this Agreement shall require the Executive to relocate his base of employment or principal place of residence from the Houston/Beaumont Metropolitan Area.

     2. Employment Term . The term of the Executive’s employment under this Agreement (the “Employment Term” ) shall commence on January 1, 2006 (the “Commencement Date” ), and shall expire on December 31, 2007 (the “Expiration Date” ) , unless extended by the Company or earlier terminated as herein provided. At the end of the Employment Term, this Agreement shall be automatically renewed year to year thereafter, unless (a) Employee’s employment has been terminated prior to such day, or (b) not later than 60 days prior to such day, either party to this Agreement shall have given written notice to the other party that he or it does not wish to extend further the Termination Date (and the Employment Term).

     3. Compensation and Other Benefits.

          3.1 Annual Salary . As compensation for services to be rendered under this Agreement, the Company shall pay the Executive a salary (the “Annual Salary” ), subject to such increases as the Board of Directors may, in its discretion, approve, at a rate of $245,000.00 per annum. The Executive shall also be eligible, during the Employment Term, to receive such other compensation, whether in the form of cash bonuses, incentive compensation, stock options, stock appreciation rights, restricted stock awards or otherwise (collectively, the “Additional Compensation” ), as the Board of Directors (or any committee of the Board) may, in its discretion, approve. The Annual Salary and the Additional Compensation shall be payable in accordance with the applicable payroll and/or other compensation policies and plans of the Company as in effect from time to time during the Employment Term, less such deductions as shall be required to be withheld by applicable law and regulations.


          3.2 Participation in Employee Benefit Plans . The Executive shall be permitted, during the Employment Term, if and to the extent he is and continues to meet all applicable eligibility requirements, to participate in any group life, hospitalization or disability insurance plan, health program, pension plan, similar benefit plan or other “fringe benefits” of the Company, which may be available to all other similarly situated members of the Company’s management on generally the same terms.

          3.3 Executive Support . The Company shall provide to the Executive office facilities, furniture, and equipment, secretarial and support personnel and other management level support services as the Executive shall reasonably require in connection with his performance of his duties under this Agreement.

          3.4 Reimbursement of Business Expenses . The Executive may incur reasonable, ordinary and necessary business expenses in the course of his performance of his duties under this Agreement, including expenses for travel, food and entertainment. The Company shall reimburse the Executive for all such business expenses if (i) the expenses are incurred by the Executive in accordance with the Company’s business expense reimbursement policy, if any, as may be established and modified by the Company from time to time, and (ii) the Executive provides to the Company a record of and appropriate receipts for (A) the amount of the expense, (B) the date, place and nature of the expense, (C) the business reason for the expense and (D) the names, occupations and other data concerning individuals entertained sufficient to establish their business relationship to the Company. The Company shall have no obligation to reimburse the Executive for expenses that are not incurred and substantiated as required by this Section 3.4.

     4. Non-Competition.

          4.1 Covenants Against Competition . During the Employment Term, the Company will provide confidential information to the Executive. The Executive acknowledges that (i) the Company, which for purposes of this Section 4 includes the Company, and all present and future subsidiaries and affiliates, and any subsidiaries and affiliates that may be formed or incorporated during the Restricted Period (as defined in Section 4.1.1), is engaged in the business of providing a broad range of engineering services, including planning, design procurement, construction management, in-plant maintenance, field inspection and control system services (the “Business” ); (ii) the Executive is one of a limited number of persons who has performed a significant role in developing the Business; (iii) the Business is conducted throughout the United States and internationally; (iv) the Company will give him possession of, and access to, trade secrets of, and confidential, proprietary information concerning, the Company; (v) the agreements and covenants contained in this Section 4 (collectively, the “Restrictive Covenants” ) are essential to protect the Business and the goodwill of the Company; and (vi) the Restrictive Covenants will not impair his ability to engage in a wide array of professional activities. Accordingly, the Executive agrees as follows:

2


               4.1.1 Competitive Activities . During the Restricted Period, the Executive shall not (A) engage, anywhere within the Territory (as hereinafter defined), as an officer, director or in any other managerial capacity or as an owner, co-owner or other investor or creditor in or of, whether as an employee, independent contractor, consultant or advisor, in any business selling or providing any services which are sold or offered by the Company, within the territory surrounding each office or facility (each a “facility” ) at which the Executive was employed by the Company within the one-year period immediately preceding the date of the Executive’s termination of employment (for purposes of this Section 4.1, the territory surrounding a facility shall be: (1) the city, town or village in which the facility is located, (2) the county or parish in which the facility is located, (3) the counties or parishes contiguous to the county or parish in which the facility is located and (4) the area located within 100 miles of the facility, all of such locations being herein collectively called the “Territory”), or (B) call on any person or entity that at the time is, or at any time within one year prior to the date of termination of the Executive’s employment was, a customer of the Company, for the purpose of soliciting or selling any product or service which is then sold or offered within the Territory by the Company if the Executive has knowledge of that customer relationship; provided, however, that nothing in this Section 4.1.1 shall prohibit the Executive from owning, directly or indirectly, solely as an investment, securities of any entity traded on any national securities exchange or over-the-counter market if the Executive is not a controlling person of, or a member of a group which controls, such entity and does not, directly or indirectly, own one percent or more of any class of securities of such entity. As used in this Section 4, the term “Restricted Period” means the period beginning on the Commencement Date and ending on the expiration of the Total Severance Benefit Period (as defined in Section 5.5).

               4.1.2 Confidential Information; Personal Relationships . During the Restricted Period and thereafter, the Executive shall keep secret and retain in strict confidence, and shall not use for the benefit of himself or others, all confidential matters of the Company, including, without limitation, “know-how,” trade secrets, customer lists, details of client or consultant contracts, pricing policies, bidding practices and procedures, operational methods, marketing plans or strategies, project development techniques or plans, business acquisition plans, new personnel acquisition plans, methods of production, manufacture and installation, technical processes, designs and design projects, inventions and research projects of the Company learned by the Executive heretofore or during the Restricted Period.

               4.1.3 Property of the Company . All memoranda, notes, lists, records and other documents or papers (and all copies thereof, including such items stored in computer memories, on microfiche or by any other means, made or compiled by or on behalf of the Executive, or made available to the Executive relating to the Company, other than purely personal matters, are and shall be the Company’s property and shall be delivered to the Company promptly upon the termination of the Executive’s employment (whether such termination is for Cause, as hereinafter defined, or otherwise) or at any other time on request of the Company.

3


               4.1.4 Employees of the Company . During the Employment Term and the Restricted Period, the Executive shall not, directly or indirectly, recruit or solicit any employee or consultant engineer of the Company away from the Company or encourage any such employee or agent to leave such employment.

               4.1.5 Consultants of the Company . During the Employment Term and the Restricted Period, the Executive shall not, directly or indirectly, recruit or solicit any consultant then under contract with the Company or encourage such consultant to terminate such relationship.

               4.1.6 Acquisition Candidates . During the Employment Term and the Restricted Period, the Executive shall not call on any Acquisition Candidate (as defined below in this Section 4.1.6), with the knowledge of such Acquisition Candidate’s status as such, for the purpose of acquiring, or arranging the acquisition of, that Acquisition Candidate by any person or entity other than the Company. In this Section 4.1.6 “Acquisition Candidate” means any person or entity engaged in any of the businesses of providing engineering services, including planning, design procurement, construction management, in-plant maintenance, field inspection and control system services, and (i) which was called on by the Company, in connection with the possible acquisition by the Company of that person or entity, or (ii) with respect to which the Company has made an acquisition analysis.

          4.2 Rights and Remedies upon Breach . If the Executive breaches or threatens to commit a breach of the Restrictive Covenants, the Company shall have the following rights and remedies, each of which shall be independent of the others and severally enforceable, and each of which is in addition to, and not in lieu of, any other rights and remedies available to the Company under law or in equity:

               4.2.1 Injunctive Relief . The right and remedy to have the Restrictive Covenants specifically enforced by any court of competent jurisdiction, it being agreed that any breach or threatened breach of the Restrictive Covenants would cause irreparable injury to the Company and that money damages would not provide an adequate remedy to the Company.

               4.2.2 Accounting . The right and remedy to require the Executive to account for and pay over to the Company all compensation, profits, monies, accruals, increments or other benefits derived or received by the Executive as the result of any transaction constituting a breach of the Restrictive Covenants.

          4.3 Severability of Covenants . The Executive acknowledges and agrees that the Restrictive Covenants are reasonable and valid in geographical and temporal scope and in all other respects. If any court determines that any of the Restrictive Covenants, or any part thereof, is invalid or unenforceable, the remainder of the Restrictive Covenants shall not thereby be affected and shall be given full effect, without regard to the invalid portions.

          4.4 Reformation . If any court determines that any Restrictive Covenant, or any part thereof, is unenforceable because of the duration or geographic scope of such provision, such court shall have the power to reduce the duration or scope of such provision, as the case may be, and, in its reduced form, such provision shall then be enforceable.

4


          4.5 Enforceability . The Company and the Executive intend to and hereby confer exclusive jurisdiction to enforce the Restrictive Covenants upon the federal and state courts of Harris County, Texas.

          4.6 Definitions. For the purposes of this Section 4 only, the term “Company” shall not only include ENGlobal Corporate Services, Inc., but its parents, subsidiaries, and affiliates.

     5. Termination.

          5.1 Termination upon Death . If the Executive dies during the Employment Term, this Agreement shall terminate, except that the Executive’s legal representatives, successors, heirs or assigns shall be entitled to receive the Annual Salary, the Additional Compensation and other accrued benefits, if any, earned up to the date of the Executive’s death; provided, however, if any Additional Compensation or other benefits are governed by the provisions of any written employee benefit plan or policy of the Company, any written agreement contemplated thereunder or any other separate written agreement entered into between the Executive and the Company, the terms and conditions of such plan, policy or agreement shall control in the event of any discrepancy or conflict with the provisions of this Agreement regarding such Additional Compensation or other benefit upon the death, termination or disability of the Executive.

          5.2 Termination for Cause . At any time during the Employment Term, the Company shall have the right to terminate the Executive’s employment under this Agreement and discharge the Executive for Cause, exercisable upon the affirmative vote of no less than three (3) members of the Board of Directors and the service of written notice upon the Executive. If such right is exercised, the Company’s obligation to the Executive shall be limited to the payment of any unpaid Annual Salary, Additional Compensation and other benefits, if any, accrued up to the effective date specified in the Company’s notice of termination (which date shall not be retroactive). As used in this Section 5.2 and elsewhere in this Agreement, the term “Cause” shall mean the determination that (i) after notice and a right to cure, there has been a material breach by the Executive of the terms of this Agreement, (ii) after receipt of a written warning, the Executive has failed or refused to follow the reasonable policies, performance objectives, or directives established by the Board of Directors or executive officers of the Company senior to the Executive, (iii) the Executive has misappropriated money or other assets or properties of the Company or any subsidiary or affiliate of the Company, (iv) the Executive has been convicted of any felony or other serious crime, (v) the Executive’s employment performance has been substantially impaired by chronic absenteeism, alcoholism or drug addiction, or (vi) the Executive has exhibited gross moral turpitude relevant to his office or employment with the Company or any subsidiary or affiliate of the Company.

          5.3 Termination Without Cause . At any time during the Employment Term, the Company shall have the right to terminate the Executive’s employment under this Agreement and discharge the Executive without Cause, exercisable upon the affirmative vote of no less than three (3) members of the Board of Directors and the service of written notice to the Executive. If such right is exercised, the Company’s obligation to the Executive shall be as set forth in Section 5.5 below.

5


          5.4 Termination upon Disability . If during the Employment Term the Executive becomes physically or mentally disabled, whether totally or partially, as evidenced by the written statement of a competent physician licensed to practice medicine in the United States, so that the Executive is unable to substantially perform his services hereunder with reasonable accommodation for (i) a period of six consecutive months, or (ii) for shorter periods aggregating six months during any period of twelve consecutive months, the Company may at any time after the last day of the six consecutive months of disability, or the day on which the shorter periods of disability equal an aggregate of six months within a period of twelve consecutive months, terminate the Executive’s employment hereunder, exercisable upon the affirmative vote of no less than three (3) members of the Board of Directors and the service of written notice to the Executive. If such right is exercised, the Company’s obligation to the Executive shall be as set forth in Section 5.5 below.

          5.5 Severance Benefit . If at any time during or after the Employment Term, the Executive’s employment by the Company is terminated for any reason other than (i) a termination for Cause under Section 5.2, (ii) his voluntary resignation (including in breach of this Agreement), or (iii) his death, then for a period of six (6) months following the date of termination of the Executive’s employment (the “Initial Severance Benefit Period” ), the Company shall continue to (a) pay to the Executive, in payroll period installments in accordance with the Company’s normal payroll policies, the monthly amount of Executive’s Annual Salary in effect at the date of termination of his employment and (b) under the same cost sharing arrangements as were in place prior to termination, continue to include the Executive and his eligible dependents under the coverage of all group health, medical and dental insurance policies, plans and programs maintained by the Company during the Initial Severance Benefit Period for the Company’s employees, or management employees, generally.

     The Company, at its option, which shall be exercisable by a written notice sent to the Executive at least sixty (60) days prior to the expiration of the Initial Severance Benefit Period, may elect to extend the Initial Severance Benefit Period for a period of an additional six (6) months following the expiration of the Initial Severance Benefit Period. If the Company so elects to extend the Initial Severance Benefit Period, the Company, during the Second Severance Benefit Period shall (i) pay to the Executive, in payroll period installments in accordance with the Company’s normal payroll policies, an amount equal to 50% of the monthly amount of Executive’s Annual Salary in effect at the date of termination of his employment and (ii) under the same cost sharing arrangements as were in place prior to termination, continue to include the Executive and his eligible dependants under the coverage of all group health, medical and dental insurance policies, plans and programs maintained by the Company during the Second Severance Benefit Period, for the Company’s employees, or management employees, generally.

     For purposes of Section 4.1.1 of this Agreement, the term “Total Severance Benefit Period” means the total period (including the Initial Severance Benefit Period and, if applicable, the Second Severance Benefit Period) during which the Company is obligated to pay and provide, and performs its obligations to pay and provide, severance benefits to the Executive under this Section 5.5.

     6. Insurance . The Company may, from time to time, apply for and take out, in its own name and at its own expense, naming itself or others as the designated beneficiary (which it may change from time to time), policies for health, accident, disability or other insurance upon the Executive or his life, in any amount or amounts that it may deem necessary or appropriate to protect its interest. The Executive agrees to aid the Company in procuring such insurance by submitting to reasonable medical examinations and by filling out, executing and delivering such applications and other instruments in writing as may reasonably be required by an insurance company or companies to which any application or applications for insurance may be made by or for the Company.

6


     7. Arbitration.

          7.1 Binding Effect . Except as provided in Section 7.2 below, any and all controversies, claims or disputes by the Executive or the Company relating to the provisions or obligations under this Agreement, or with respect to the employment or termination thereof of the Executive by the Company, shall be submitted to final and binding arbitration in accordance with the Employment Dispute Resolution Rules of the American Arbitration Association in effect at the time a demand for arbitration is made. It is the intention of the Executive and the Company that this Arbitration provision shall be enforceable under the Federal Arbitration Act.

          7.2 Excluded Matters . This Arbitration provision shall not apply to any claims for workers’ compensation benefits, unemployment compensation benefits, or claims by the Company for injunctive and/or other equitable relief for any violation of Section 4 of this Agreement.

     8. Other Provisions.

          8.1 Notices . Any notice or other communication required or permitted hereunder shall be in writing and shall be delivered personally, telegraphed, telexed, sent by facsimile transmission or sent by certified, registered or express mail, postage prepaid. Any such notice shall be deemed given when so delivered personally, telegraphed, telexed or sent by facsimile transmission or, if mailed, five days after the date of deposit in the United States mail, as follows:

 

          if to the Company, to:


 

Chairman of the Compensation Committee
654 N. Sam Houston Pkwy E., Suite 400
Houston, TX 77060-5914


 

          if to the Executive, to:


 

Robert W. Raiford
15123 Greenleaf Lane
Houston, TX 77062


     Either party may change its address for notice hereunder by notice to the other party.

7


          8.2 Entire Agreement . This Agreement contains the entire agreement and understanding between the parties with respect to its subject matter and supersedes all prior agreements, written or oral, with respect thereto; provided, however, that nothing herein shall in any way limit the obligation, rights or liabilities of the parties under any written stock option agreement separately entered into by the parties.

          8.3 Waivers and Amendments . This Agreement may be amended, modified, superseded, canceled, renewed or extended, and the terms and conditions hereof may be waived, only by a written instrument signed by the parties or, in the case of a waiver, by the party waiving compliance. No delay on the part of any party in exercising any right, power or privilege hereunder shall operate as a waiver thereof, nor shall any waiver on the part of any party of any right, power or privilege hereunder, nor any single or partial exercise of any right, power or privilege hereunder preclude any other or further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right, power or privilege hereunder.

          8.4 Governing Law; Venue . This Agreement, except as set forth in Section 4.5 hereof, shall be governed by, and construed in accordance with, the laws of the State of Texas without reference to principles governing choice or conflicts of law. Venue shall exclusively lie in the state and federal courts of Harris County, Texas.

          8.5 Assignment . This Agreement, and any rights and obligations hereunder, may not be assigned by any party hereto without the prior written consent of the other party, except that the Company may assign this Agreement to any of its subsidiaries or affiliates without the Executive’s consent provided such assignment does not diminish any of the Executive’s benefits, rights or obligations hereunder.

          8.6 Counterparts . This Agreement may be executed in two or more counterparts, each of which shall be deemed an original, but all of which together shall constitute one and the same instrument.

          8.7 Headings . The headings in this Agreement are for reference purposes only and shall not in any way affect the meaning or interpretation of this Agreement.






8


     IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have executed this Agreement as of the date and year first above written:

 

ENGLOBAL CORPORATION


 

By:_____________________________


 

_______________________________
William A. Coskey




 

ROBERT W. RAIFORD


 

By:_____________________________


 

_______________________________
Robert W. Raiford







9

EXECUTIVE EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT

     THIS AGREEMENT dated as of December 22, 2005 , by and between ENGlobal Corporation , a Texas corporation (the “Company” ), and Michael M. Patton , a resident of Houston, Texas (the “Executive” ).

RECITALS

     WHEREAS, the Executive is willing to accept employment by the Company on the terms and conditions of this Agreement;

     NOW, THEREFORE, the Company and the Executive agree as follows:

     1. Employment Duties and Acceptance.

     1.1 Employment by the Company . The Company agrees to employ the Executive as Senior Vice President of Business Development for the duration of the Employment Term (as defined in Section 2 below), to render such services and to perform such duties as are normally associated with and inherent in the executive capacity in which the Executive will be serving, as well as such other duties, which are not inconsistent with the Executive’s position with the Company, as shall from time to time reasonably be assigned to him by the Chief Executive Officer of the Company (the “CEO” ), including, but not limited to, possible assignments to render services and perform duties with ENGlobal Corporation and/or its subsidiaries.

     1.2 Acceptance of Employment by the Executive . The Executive accepts such employment for the Employment Term and agrees to render the services required of him under Section 1.1. During the Employment Term, the Executive shall devote his full business time, attention and energy to the business of the Company and the performance of his duties under this Agreement. The foregoing shall not, however, prohibit the Executive from making and managing personal investments, or from engaging in civic or charitable activities, that do not materially impair the performance of his duties under this Agreement. If appointed or elected, as applicable, the Executive also shall serve during all or any part of the Employment Term as any other officer and/or as a director of the Company or any of its subsidiaries or affiliates, without any additional compensation other than that specified in this Agreement.

     1.3 Place of Performance . The Executive shall be based in the Houston Metropolitan Area, and nothing in this Agreement shall require the Executive to relocate his base of employment or principal place of residence from the Houston Metropolitan Area.

     1.4 Termination of Existing Contracts . The Executive agrees that all agreements and contracts, whether written or oral, relating to the employment of the Executive by the Company, or any of its subsidiaries or affiliates, shall be superceded effective as of the commencement of the Employment Term. However, nothing in this Section 1.4 shall (i) affect accrued vacation, holiday or sick pay accruals, (ii) require the Company to cease to make available to the Executive, and, subject to his meeting all applicable eligibility requirements, the Executive shall be entitled to continue to be covered under, all group health, medical and dental insurance policies, plans and programs maintained by the Company for its executive level employees generally, in each case until replacement coverage is provided by the Company, or (iii) impair or adversely affect any indemnification rights that the Executive may have under statutes empowering corporations in the Company’s or any of its subsidiaries’ states of incorporation to indemnify their officers and directors, or under the Company’s or any of its affiliates’ bylaws or any written indemnification agreement between the Executive and the Company or any of its affiliates implementing such statutory indemnification rights, but only with respect to third-party claims or proceedings that relate to actions taken by the Executive as an officer or director of the Company or any of its affiliates prior to the date hereof.

1


     2. Employment Term . The term of the Executive’s employment under this Agreement (the “Employment Term” ) shall commence on the effective date of February 7, 2006 (the “Commencement Date” ), and shall continue through and expire on the 3rd anniversary of the Commencement Date (the “Expiration Date” ), unless extended by the Company or earlier terminated as herein provided. By written notice given by the Company to the Executive at any time at least 60 days before the Expiration Date, the Company may elect to extend the Employment Term for one additional one-year period beginning on the Expiration Date. In that case, and from that point forward, the “Employment Term” shall become the four-year period beginning on the Commencement Date, and the term “Expiration Date shall be deemed to refer to the fourth anniversary of the Commencement Date.

     3. Compensation and Other Benefits.

     3.1 Annual Salary . As compensation for services to be rendered under this Agreement, the Company shall pay the Executive a salary (the “Annual Salary” ), subject to such increases as the Board of Directors may, in its discretion, approve, at a rate of $210,000.00 per annum. The Executive shall also be eligible, during the Employment Term, to receive such other compensation, whether in the form of cash bonuses, incentive compensation, stock options, stock appreciation rights, restricted stock awards or otherwise (collectively, the “Additional Compensation” ), as the Board of Directors (or any committee of the Board) may, in its discretion, approve. The Annual Salary and the Additional Compensation shall be payable in accordance with the applicable payroll and/or other compensation policies and plans of the Company as in effect from time to time during the Employment Term, less such deductions as shall be required to be withheld by applicable law and regulations, or authorized by Executive.

     3.2 Participation in Employee Benefit Plans . The Executive shall be permitted, during the Employment Term, if and to the extent he is and continues to meet all applicable eligibility requirements, to participate in any group life, hospitalization or disability insurance plan, health program, pension plan, similar benefit plan or other “fringe benefits” of the Company, which may be available to all other similarly situated executives and officers of the Company on generally the same terms.

     3.3 Executive Support . The Company shall provide to the Executive office facilities, furniture, and equipment, secretarial and support personnel and other management level support services as the Executive shall reasonably require in connection with his performance of his duties under this Agreement.

2


     3.4 Reimbursement of Business Expenses . The Executive may incur reasonable, ordinary and necessary business expenses in the course of his performance of his duties under this Agreement, including expenses for travel, food and entertainment. The Company shall reimburse the Executive for all such business expenses if (i) the expenses are incurred by the Executive in accordance with the Company’s business expense reimbursement policy, if any, as may be established and modified by the Company from time to time, and (ii) the Executive provides to the Company a record of and appropriate receipts for (A) the amount of the expense, (B) the date, place and nature of the expense, (C) the business reason for the expense and (D) the names, occupations and other data concerning individuals entertained sufficient to establish their business relationship to the Company. The Company shall have no obligation to reimburse the Executive for expenses that are not incurred and substantiated as required by this Section 3.4.

     4. Non-Competition.

     4.1 Covenants Against Competition . The Executive acknowledges that (i) the Company, which for purposes of this Section 4 includes the Company, and all of its present and future subsidiaries and affiliates, engaged in the business of providing a broad range of engineering services and engineered systems (instrumentation systems), including planning, design procurement, construction management, in-plant maintenance, field inspection and control system services (“the Business”); (ii) the Executive is one of a limited number of persons who has performed a significant role in developing the Business; (iii) the Business is conducted throughout the United States and internationally; (iv) his work for the Company will give him possession of, and access to, trade secrets of, and confidential, proprietary information concerning, the Company; (v) the agreements and covenants contained in this Section 4 (collectively, the “Restrictive Covenants” ) are essential to protect the Business and the goodwill of the Company. Accordingly, the Executive agrees as follows:

     4.1.1 Non-Compete . During the Restricted Period, the Executive shall not (A) engage, anywhere within the Territory (as hereinafter defined), as an owner, co-owner, investor, creditor, officer, director, employee, independent contractor, consultant, advisor, or in any other managerial capacity in any business selling or providing any services which are sold or offered by the Company, within the area surrounding each office or facility ( “Facility ”) at which the Executive was employed by the Company within the two-year period immediately preceding the date of the Executive’s termination of employment (for purposes of this Section 4.1, the area surrounding a Facility shall be: (1) the city, town or village in which the Facility is located, (2) the county or parish in which the Facility is located, (3) the counties or parishes contiguous to the county or parish in which the Facility is located and (4) the area located within 150 miles of the Facility, all of such locations being herein collectively called the “Territory” , or (B) call on any person or entity that at the time is, or at any time within one-year prior to the date of termination of the Executive’s employment was, a customer of the Company, for the purpose of soliciting or selling any product or service which is then sold or offered within the Territory by the Company if the Executive has knowledge of that customer relationship; provided, however, that nothing in this Section 4.1.1 shall prohibit the Executive from owning, directly or indirectly, solely as an investment, securities of any entity traded on any national securities exchange or over-the-counter market if the Executive is not a controlling person of, or a member of a group which controls, such entity and does not, directly or indirectly, own one percent or more of any class of securities of such entity. As used in this Section 4, the term “Restricted Period” means the period beginning on the Commencement Date and ending:

3


 

      (i)  if the Executive’s employment terminates as a result of (a) a termination for Cause under Section 5.2 or (b) the Executive’s voluntary resignation, the third anniversary of the Executive’s date of termination of employment; or


 

      (ii)  if the Executive’s employment terminates as a result of (a) a termination without Cause under Section 5.3 or (b) a termination for disability under Section 5.4, on the expiration of the Total Severance Benefit Period (as defined in Section 5.5).


     4.1.2 Confidential Information; Personal Relationships . During the Restricted Period and thereafter, the Executive shall keep secret and retain in strict confidence, and shall not use for the benefit of himself or others, all confidential matters of the Company, including, without limitation, “know-how,” trade secrets, customer lists, details of client or consultant contracts, pricing policies, bidding practices and procedures, operational methods, marketing plans or strategies, project development techniques or plans, business acquisition plans, new personnel acquisition plans, methods of production, manufacture and installation, technical processes, designs and design projects, inventions and research projects of the Company learned by the Executive heretofore or during the Restricted Period; nor shall the Executive exploit for his own benefit, or the benefit of others, personal relationships with customers, suppliers or agents of the Company in connection with or adversely affecting the Business formed previously during the course of his association with the Company or formed during the Restricted Period.

     4.1.3 Property of the Company . All memoranda, notes, lists, records and other documents or papers (and all copies thereof), including such items stored in computer memories, on microfiche or by any other means, made or compiled by or on behalf of the Executive, or made available to the Executive relating to the Company, other than purely personal matters, are and shall be the Company’s property. Upon the termination of the Executive’s employment (whether such termination is for Cause, as hereinafter defined, or otherwise) or at any other time on request of the Company, Executive shall promptly (i) return all Company property, (ii) download into useable format and provide to the Company all such information stored on computers or other electronic storage, and immediately thereafter destroy or permanently delete the information from Executive’s possession, and (iii) within five days of the Company’s written request, provide the Company with a sworn affidavit verifying that all such materials have been returned to the Company or destroyed.

     4.1.4 Employees of the Company . During the Restricted Period and thereafter for as long as the Executive shall remain an employee of or consultant to the Company, the Executive shall not, directly or indirectly, hire or solicit any employee or consultant engineer of the Company away from the Company or encourage any such employee or agent to leave such employment.

     4.1.5 Consultants of the Company . During the Restricted Period and thereafter for as long as the Executive shall remain an employee of or consultant to the Company, the Executive shall not, directly or indirectly, hire or solicit any consultant then under contract with the Company or encourage such consultant to terminate such relationship.

     4.1.6 Acquisition Candidates . During the Restricted Period and thereafter for as long as the Executive shall remain an employee of or consultant to the Company, the Executive shall not call on any Acquisition Candidate (as defined below in this Section 4.1.6), with the knowledge of such Acquisition Candidate’s status as such, for the purpose of acquiring, or arranging the acquisition of, that Acquisition Candidate by any person or entity other than the Company. In this Section 4.1.6 “Acquisition Candidate” means any person or entity engaged in any of the businesses of engineering services, including planning, design procurement, construction management, in-plant maintenance, field inspection and control system services, and (i) which was called on by the Company, in connection with the possible acquisition by the Company of that person or entity, or (ii) with respect to which the Company has made an acquisition analysis within two (2) years preceding the date of Executive’s termination of employment.

4


     4.2 Rights and Remedies upon Breach . If the Executive breaches or threatens to commit a breach of the Restrictive Covenants, the Company shall have the following rights and remedies, each of which shall be independent of the others and severally enforceable, and each of which is in addition to, and not in lieu of, any other rights and remedies available to the Company under law or in equity.

     4.2.1 Specific Performance . The right and remedy to have the Restrictive Covenants specifically enforced by any court of competent jurisdiction, it being agreed that any breach or threatened breach of the Restrictive Covenants would cause irreparable injury to the Company and that money damages would not provide an adequate remedy to the Company.

     4.2.2 Accounting . The right and remedy to require the Executive to account for and pay over to the Company all compensation, profits, monies, accruals, increments or other benefits derived or received by the Executive as the result of any transaction constituting a breach of the Restrictive Covenants.

     4.3 Severability of Covenants . The Executive acknowledges and agrees that the Restrictive Covenants are reasonable and valid in geographical and temporal scope and in all other respects. If any court determines that any of the Restrictive Covenants, or any part thereof, is invalid or unenforceable, the remainder of the Restrictive Covenants shall not thereby be affected and shall be given full effect, without regard to the invalid portions.

     4.4 Reformation . If any court determines that any Restrictive Covenant, or any part thereof, is unenforceable because of the duration or geographic scope of such provision, such court shall have the power to reduce the duration or scope of such provision, as the case may be, and, in its reduced form, such provision shall then be enforceable.

     4.5 Enforceability . The Company and the Executive intend to and hereby confer exclusive jurisdiction to enforce the Restrictive Covenants upon the state and federal courts of Harris County, Texas.

     5. Termination.

     5.1 Termination upon Death . If the Executive dies during the Employment Term, this Agreement shall terminate, except that the Executive’s legal representatives, successors, heirs or assigns shall be entitled to receive the Annual Salary, the Additional Compensation and other accrued benefits, if any, earned up to the date of the Executive’s death and for a period of three (3) months thereafter; provided, however, if any Additional Compensation or other benefits are governed by the provisions of any written employee benefit plan or policy of the Company, any written agreement contemplated thereunder or any other separate written agreement entered into between the Executive and the Company, the terms and conditions of such plan, policy or agreement shall control in the event of any discrepancy or conflict with the provisions of this Agreement regarding such Additional Compensation or other benefit upon the death, termination or disability of the Executive.

5


     5.2 Termination for Cause . At any time during the Employment Term, the Company shall have the right to terminate the Executive’s employment under this Agreement and discharge the Executive for Cause, exercisable upon the service of written notice upon the Executive. If such right is exercised, the Company’s obligation to the Executive shall be limited to the payment of any unpaid Annual Salary, Additional Compensation and other benefits, if any, accrued up to the effective date specified in the Company’s notice of termination (which date shall not be retroactive). As used in this Section 5.2 and elsewhere in this Agreement, the term “Cause” shall mean the determination that (i) after notice and a right to cure, there has been a material breach by the Executive of the terms of this Agreement, (ii) after receipt of a written warning, the Executive has failed or refused to follow the reasonable policies, performance objectives, or directives established by the Board of Directors or executive officers of the Company senior to the Executive, (iii) the Executive has wrongfully misappropriated money or other assets or properties of the Company or any subsidiary or affiliate of the Company, (iv) the Executive has been convicted of any felony or other serious crime, (v) the Executive’s employment performance has been substantially impaired by chronic absenteeism, alcoholism or drug addiction, or (vi) the Executive has exhibited gross moral turpitude relevant to his office or employment with the Company or any subsidiary or affiliate of the Company.

     5.3 Termination Without Cause . At any time during the period beginning on the first anniversary of the Commencement Date and continuing through the end of the Employment Term, the Company shall have the right to terminate the Executive’s employment under this Agreement and discharge the Executive without Cause, exercisable upon the service of written notice to the Executive. If such right is exercised, the Company’s obligation to the Executive shall be as set forth in Section 5.5 below.

     5.4 Termination Upon Disability . If during the Employment Term the Executive becomes physically or mentally disabled, whether totally or partially, as evidenced by the written statement of a competent physician licensed to practice medicine in the United States, so that the Executive is unable to substantially perform his services hereunder with reasonable accommodation for (i) a period of six consecutive months, or (ii) for shorter periods aggregating six months during any period of twelve consecutive months, the Company may at any time after the last day of the six consecutive months of disability, or the day on which the shorter periods of disability equal an aggregate of six months within a period of twelve consecutive months, terminate the Executive’s employment hereunder, exercisable by written notice to the Executive. If such right is exercised, the Company’s obligation to the Executive shall be as set forth in Section 5.5 below.

     5.5 Severance Benefit . If at any time during or after the Employment Term, the Executive’s employment by the Company is terminated for any reason other than (i) a termination for Cause under Section 5.2, (ii) Executive’s voluntary resignation, or (iii) Executive’s death, then for a period of six (6) months following the date of termination of the Executive’s employment (the “Initial Severance Benefit Period” ), the Company shall continue to (a) pay to the Executive, in payroll period installments in accordance with the Company’s normal payroll policies, the monthly amount of Executive’s base monthly salary in effect at the date of termination of his employment, and (b) at the Company’s expense, provide coverage for the Executive and his eligible dependents under the coverage of all group health, medical and dental insurance policies, plans and programs maintained by the Company during the Initial Severance Benefit Period for the Company’s employees, or management employees, generally, as allowed by law.

6


     The Company, at its option, which shall be exercisable by a written notice sent to the Executive at least sixty (60) days prior to the expiration of the Initial Severance Benefit Period, may elect to extend the Initial Severance Benefit Period for a period of an additional six (6) months following the expiration of the Initial Severance Benefit Period. If the Company so elects to extend the Initial Severance Benefit Period, the Company, during the Second Severance Benefit Period shall (i) pay to the Executive, in payroll period installments in accordance with the Company’s normal payroll policies, an amount equal to 100% of the monthly amount of Executive’s base monthly salary in effect at the date of termination of his employment, and (ii) at the Company’s expense, provide coverage for the Executive and his eligible dependents under the coverage of all group health, medical and dental insurance policies, plans and programs maintained by the Company during the Second Severance Benefit Period, for the Company’s employees, or management employees, generally, as allowed by law.

     For purposes of Section 4.1.1 of this Agreement, the term “Total Severance Benefit Period” means the total period (including the Initial Severance Benefit Period and, if applicable, the Second Severance Benefit Period) during which the Company is obligated to pay and provide, and performs its obligations to pay and provide, severance benefits to the Executive under this Section 5.5.

     6. Insurance . The Company may, from time to time, apply for and take out, in its own name and at its own expense, naming itself or others as the designated beneficiary (which it may change from time to time), policies for health, accident, disability or other insurance upon the Executive or his life, in any amount or amounts that it may deem necessary or appropriate to protect its interest. The Executive agrees to aid the Company in procuring such insurance by submitting to reasonable medical examinations and by filling out, executing and delivering such applications and other instruments in writing as may reasonably be required by an insurance company or companies to which any application or applications for insurance may be made by or for the Company.

     7. Arbitration.

     7.1 Binding Effect . Except as provided in Section 7.2 below, any and all controversies, claims or disputes by and between the Executive and the Company relating to the provisions or obligations under this Agreement, or with respect to the employment or termination thereof of the Executive by the Company, shall be submitted to final and binding arbitration in accordance with the Employment Dispute Resolution Rules of the American Arbitration Association in effect at the time a demand for arbitration is made. It is the intention of the Executive and the Company that this Arbitration provision shall be enforceable under the Federal Arbitration Act, the Texas General Arbitration Act, and at common law.

     7.2 Excluded Matters . This Arbitration provision shall not apply to any claims for workers’ compensation benefits, unemployment compensation benefits, or claims by the Company for injunctive and/or other equitable relief for any violation of Section 4 of this Agreement.

7


     8. Other Provisions.

     8.1 Notices . Any notice or other communication required or permitted hereunder shall be in writing and shall be delivered personally, telegraphed, telexed, sent by facsimile transmission or sent by certified, registered or express mail, postage prepaid. Any such notice shall be deemed given when so delivered personally, telegraphed, telexed or sent by facsimile transmission or, if mailed, five days after the date of deposit in the United States mail, as follows:

if to the Company, to:   Corporate Secretary  
      654 N. Sam Houston Pkwy., #400  
      Houston, Texas 77060-5914  
 
 
if to the Executive, to:   Michael M. Patton  
      16007 Stratton Park Drive  
      Spring, Texas 77379-6866  
 

     Either party may change its address for notice hereunder by notice to the other party.

     8.2 Entire Agreement . This Agreement contains the entire agreement and understanding between the parties with respect to its subject matter and supersedes all prior agreements, written or oral, with respect thereto; provided, however, that nothing herein shall in any way limit the obligation, rights or liabilities of the parties under any written stock option agreement separately entered into by the parties.

     8.3 Waivers and Amendments . This Agreement may be amended, modified, superseded, canceled, renewed or extended, and the terms and conditions hereof may be waived, only by a written instrument signed by the parties or, in the case of a waiver, by the party waiving compliance. No delay on the part of any party in exercising any right, power or privilege hereunder shall operate as a waiver thereof, nor shall any waiver on the part of any party of any right, power or privilege hereunder, nor any single or partial exercise of any right, power or privilege hereunder preclude any other or further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right, power or privilege hereunder.

     8.4 Governing Law; Venue . This Agreement, except as set forth in Section 4.5 hereof, shall be governed by, and construed in accordance with, the laws of the State of Texas without reference to principles governing choice or conflicts of law. Venue shall exclusively lie in the state and federal courts of Harris County, Texas.

     8.5 Assignment . This Agreement, and any rights and obligations hereunder, may not be assigned by any party hereto without the prior written consent of the other party, except that the Company may assign this Agreement to any of its subsidiaries or affiliates without the Executive’s consent provided such assignment does not diminish any of the Executive’s benefits, rights or obligations hereunder.

     8.6 Counterparts . This Agreement may be executed in two or more counterparts, each of which shall be deemed an original, but all of which together shall constitute one and the same instrument.

8


     8.7 Headings . The headings in this Agreement are for reference purposes only and shall not in any way affect the meaning or interpretation of this Agreement.

     IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have executed this Agreement as of the date and year first above written:

 

ENGlobal Corporation


 

By:________________________________


 

Title: _______________________________


 

(SIGNATURE OF EXECUTIVE)


 

____________________________________
Michael M. Patton












9

                                                   EXHIBIT 21.1
                                             SUBSIDIARIES OF REGISTRANT



ENGlobal Corporate Services, Inc.                                  Incorporated in the State of Texas

ENGlobal Engineering, Inc.                                         Incorporated in the  State of Texas

ENGlobal Systems, Inc. Incorporated in the State of Texas

ENGlobal Construction Resources, Inc.                              Incorporated in the State of Texas

RPM Engineering, Inc. dba ENGlobal Engineering, Inc.               Incorporated in the State of Louisiana

ENGlobal Automation Group, Inc.                                    Incorporated in the State of Texas

ENGlobal Technical Services, Inc.                                  Incorporated in the State of Texas

ENGlobal Canada, ULC                                               Incorporated in the Province of Alberta, Canada

WRC                                                                Incorporated in the State of Colorado

WRC, Canada                                                        Incorporated in the Province of Alberta, Canada


EXHIBIT 23.1

INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS'S CONSENT

The Board of Directors:

We hereby consent to the incorporation by reference in the Registration Statements filed on Form S-8 and Form S-3 of our report dated March 15, 2007, relating to the financial statements of ENGlobal Corporation appearing in the Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2006.

HEIN & ASSOCIATES LLP

Houston, Texas
March 15, 2007


EXHIBIT 31.1

Certification by the Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

I Michael L. Burrow, certify that:

1. I have reviewed this report on Form 10-K of ENGlobal Corporation;

2. Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statements of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

4. The registrant's other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) for the registrant and have:

a) Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;
b) [Reserved];

c) Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant's disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

d) Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant's internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant's most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant's fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant's internal control over financial reporting; and

5. The registrant's other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant's auditors and the audit committee of the registrant's board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

a) All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant's ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

b) Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant's internal control over financial reporting.

Date:  March 15, 2007                            //s// Michael L. Burrow
                                                 Michael L. Burrow
                                                 Chief Executive Officer


EXHIBIT 31.2

Certification by the Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

I Robert W. Raiford, certify that:

1. I have reviewed this report on Form 10-K of ENGlobal Corporation;

2. Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statements of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

4. The registrant's other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) for the registrant and have:

a) Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

b) [Reserved];

c) Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant's disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

d) Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant's internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant's most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant's fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant's internal control over financial reporting; and

5. The registrant's other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant's auditors and the audit committee of the registrant's board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

a) All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant's ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

b) Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant's internal control over financial reporting.

Date:  March 15, 2007                              //s// Robert W. Raiford
                                                   Robert W. Raiford
                                                   Chief Financial Officer


EXHIBIT 32.1

Certification by the Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to 18 U. S. C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

Pursuant to 18 U. S. C. Section 1350, I, Michael L. Burrow, hereby certify that, to the best of my knowledge, the Annual Report on Form 10-K of ENGlobal Corporation for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2005 (the "Report") fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or Section 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, and that the information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of ENGlobal Corporation.

Date: March 15, 2007                               //s// Michael L. Burrow
                                                   Michael L. Burrow
                                                   Chief Executive Officer

This certification accompanies this Report on Form 10-K pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and shall not, except to the extent required by such Act, be deemed filed by the Company for purposes of Section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the "Exchange Act"). Such certification will not be deemed to be incorporated by reference into any filing under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or the Exchange Act, except to the extent that the Company specifically incorporates it by reference.


EXHIBIT 32.2

Certification by the Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to 18 U. S. C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

Pursuant to 18 U. S. C. Section 1350, I, Robert W. Raiford, hereby certify that, to the best of my knowledge, the Annual Report on Form 10-K of ENGlobal Corporation for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2005 (the "Report") fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or Section 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, and that the information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of ENGlobal Corporation.

Date:  March 15, 2007                                 //s// Robert W. Raiford
                                                      Robert W. Raiford
                                                      Chief Financial Officer

This certification accompanies this Report on Form 10-K pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and shall not, except to the extent required by such Act, be deemed filed by the Company for purposes of Section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the "Exchange Act"). Such certification will not be deemed to be incorporated by reference into any filing under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or the Exchange Act, except to the extent that the Company specifically incorporates it by reference.